<?xml version='1.0' encoding='UTF-8'?><rss xmlns:atom="http://www.w3.org/2005/Atom" xmlns:openSearch="http://a9.com/-/spec/opensearchrss/1.0/" xmlns:blogger="http://schemas.google.com/blogger/2008" xmlns:georss="http://www.georss.org/georss" xmlns:gd="http://schemas.google.com/g/2005" xmlns:thr="http://purl.org/syndication/thread/1.0" version="2.0"><channel><atom:id>tag:blogger.com,1999:blog-7378876034739256240</atom:id><lastBuildDate>Sun, 08 Sep 2024 09:04:46 +0000</lastBuildDate><title>COMMON ELECTRICAL TERMS AND DEFINITIONS</title><description></description><link>http://john-bose.blogspot.com/</link><managingEditor>noreply@blogger.com (bose)</managingEditor><generator>Blogger</generator><openSearch:totalResults>1</openSearch:totalResults><openSearch:startIndex>1</openSearch:startIndex><openSearch:itemsPerPage>25</openSearch:itemsPerPage><item><guid isPermaLink="false">tag:blogger.com,1999:blog-7378876034739256240.post-2768282118872719676</guid><pubDate>Thu, 21 May 2009 15:31:00 +0000</pubDate><atom:updated>2009-05-21T08:34:24.044-07:00</atom:updated><title></title><description>Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 1 -&lt;br /&gt;1. What is static electricity?&lt;br /&gt;Static electricity means electricity at rest. If we join a charged conductor to another&lt;br /&gt;conductor, electricity flows from one to the other. This way an electric current is&lt;br /&gt;produced, which lasts for a moment only. Static electricity is no use. Rubbing of two&lt;br /&gt;different materials having different electrons produces this.&lt;br /&gt;2. What is current?&lt;br /&gt;Flow of electrons in any conductor is called electric current. Its symbol is ‘I’ and&lt;br /&gt;measuring unit is Ampere measured by ammeter or ampere meter.&lt;br /&gt;3. What is electro-motive force (emf) or voltage?&lt;br /&gt;It is the pressure that moves the electrons to flow in any conductor. It is also known&lt;br /&gt;as electromotive force voltage. Its symbol is ‘E’ or ‘V’ and measuring unit is volt&lt;br /&gt;measured by voltmeter.&lt;br /&gt;4. What is potential difference (P.D)?&lt;br /&gt;The difference of potential between two points in a circuit is the voltage required to&lt;br /&gt;drive the current between them or the voltage drop between those two points is&lt;br /&gt;called the potential difference.&lt;br /&gt;P.D = R * I volts.&lt;br /&gt;5. What is terminal voltage (VT)?&lt;br /&gt;It is the voltage available at the terminal of the source of supply. It’s symbol is VT.&lt;br /&gt;VT = emf – P.D&lt;br /&gt;6. What is resistance?&lt;br /&gt;Resistance is the property of a substance, which gives opposition to flow of electrons&lt;br /&gt;through itself. Its measuring unit is ohm and measured by ohmmeter, multi meter,&lt;br /&gt;wheat stone bridge, and post office box. There are two types of resistances and they&lt;br /&gt;are fixed resistance and variable resistance.&lt;br /&gt;7. What is ampere?&lt;br /&gt;The international ampere is defined as that steady current which, flowing through a&lt;br /&gt;solution of silver nitrate, deposits silver at the rate of 0.001118 gm/sec.&lt;br /&gt;8. What is volt?&lt;br /&gt;The international volt is defined as 1/1.0183 of the emf of a Weston cadmium cell. It&lt;br /&gt;is that difference of potential which, when applied to a conductor whose resistance is&lt;br /&gt;1 (one) international ohm, will cause a current of 1 (one) international ampere to&lt;br /&gt;flow.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 2 -&lt;br /&gt;9. What is matter?&lt;br /&gt;The matter is defined as anything, which possesses weight and occupies space and&lt;br /&gt;can be in any of three forms solid, liquid or gaseous. The matter consists of three&lt;br /&gt;ingredients, which are protons, neutrons and electrons.&lt;br /&gt;10. What is the speed of electricity or electrons?&lt;br /&gt;The speed of electricity or electrons is 297842 km (186000 miles) per second.&lt;br /&gt;11. How we get electric shock?&lt;br /&gt;On all alternators, transformers neutral is earthed. Human body is conductor and&lt;br /&gt;when touched to the live conductor it completes its shortest root though the body and&lt;br /&gt;the body gets electric shock in which its nervous system, the heart, respiratory&lt;br /&gt;system may cease to function.&lt;br /&gt;12. What is fuse and what materials used for fuse wire?&lt;br /&gt;Fuse is a weakest point in an electrical circuit, which melts when the excess current&lt;br /&gt;flows through it in the electrical circuit.&lt;br /&gt;The materials, which can be used in fuses, are tin, lead, zinc, silver, antimony,&lt;br /&gt;copper, and aluminium, etc.&lt;br /&gt;13. What is fusing factor?&lt;br /&gt;The ratio of minimum fusing current and the current rating of fusing element is&lt;br /&gt;called the fusing factor.&lt;br /&gt;Fusing factor = minimum fusing current / current rating of fusing element. Its value&lt;br /&gt;is always more than 1 (one).&lt;br /&gt;14. What is soldering and what is brazing?&lt;br /&gt;Soldering is the process of joining two metals with an alloy whose melting point is&lt;br /&gt;less that of the materials to be soldered.&lt;br /&gt;Soldering at high temperature using brass as solder is called brazing or hard&lt;br /&gt;soldering.&lt;br /&gt;The composition of the fine solder (soft solder) is tin 60% and lead 40%. Its melting&lt;br /&gt;point is 190°C and is widely used.&lt;br /&gt;15. What are the sources of electricity?&lt;br /&gt;a. Battery (chemical source)&lt;br /&gt;b. Generator (magnetism)&lt;br /&gt;c. Thermocouple (heat generated)&lt;br /&gt;d. Light (photo electric or solar cell)&lt;br /&gt;e. Pressure (piezo electricity)&lt;br /&gt;f. Friction (static electricity)&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 3 -&lt;br /&gt;16. What are the effects of electric current?&lt;br /&gt;a. Physical effect.&lt;br /&gt;b. Chemical effect.&lt;br /&gt;c. Magnetic effect.&lt;br /&gt;d. Heating effect.&lt;br /&gt;e. X-ray effect.&lt;br /&gt;17. What is fire?&lt;br /&gt;Destructive burning of any material is called the fire. Fire is the result of combining&lt;br /&gt;fuel, oxygen and heat. If any one among three is separated the fire will come to end.&lt;br /&gt;18. On what factor resistance of the substance depends (Laws of resistance)?&lt;br /&gt;a. The resistance of the conductor is directly proportional to the length of the&lt;br /&gt;conductor.&lt;br /&gt;b. The resistance of the conductor is inversely proportional to the cross-section of&lt;br /&gt;the conductor.&lt;br /&gt;c. The resistance of the conductor depends on the nature of the material by which it&lt;br /&gt;is made. That is specific resistance of the material.&lt;br /&gt;d. The resistance of the conductor depends on its temperature.&lt;br /&gt;The formula to find the resistance of the substance is below.&lt;br /&gt;R = ρ L Ω&lt;br /&gt;A&lt;br /&gt;Where ρ is the constant for the material called its specific resistance or resistivity.&lt;br /&gt;19. What is specific resistance or resistivity of the material?&lt;br /&gt;Specific resistance of the material is the resistance of a piece of unit length and unit&lt;br /&gt;cross-section (unit cube of that material). That is the resistance between the opposite&lt;br /&gt;faces of unit cube of the material.&lt;br /&gt;Or the specific resistance of any material is the resistance offered by the opposite&lt;br /&gt;face of that material.&lt;br /&gt;The unit of specific resistance is Ω/cm3, Ω/inch3, Ω/m3.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 4 -&lt;br /&gt;20. What is the temperature co-efficient of resistance?&lt;br /&gt;Temperature co-efficient of the resistance of any substance is, change in its original&lt;br /&gt;resistance due to the change in temperature. The temperature co-efficient of&lt;br /&gt;resistance of material is the ratio of increase in resistance of 1°C rise in temperature&lt;br /&gt;to the original resistance of the material (strictly at 0°C).&lt;br /&gt;Formula for the resistance measurement is,&lt;br /&gt;Rt = R0 (1+αt)&lt;br /&gt;Where Rt 􀃆 Resistance at t°C.&lt;br /&gt;R0 􀃆 Resistance at 0°C.&lt;br /&gt;α 􀃆 Temperature co-efficient.&lt;br /&gt;t 􀃆 Temperature rise.&lt;br /&gt;21. What are the effects of temperature on resistance?&lt;br /&gt;The effects of temperature on resistance are&lt;br /&gt;a. In certain pure metals such as gold, copper, silver, aluminium etc. the resistance&lt;br /&gt;increases with increasing temperature at fairly regular manner. Such metals&lt;br /&gt;possess positive temperature co-efficient of resistance.&lt;br /&gt;b. In certain materials (alloys) such as eureka, nichrome etc. the change in resistance&lt;br /&gt;due to increasing temperature is irregular and negligible for a considerable range&lt;br /&gt;of temperature.&lt;br /&gt;c. In case of certain materials belongs to insulators, electrolytes such as paper,&lt;br /&gt;rubber, glass, mica, carbon, acids, alkalies etc. the resistance decreases with&lt;br /&gt;increasing temperature at fairly regular manner. Such materials posses negative&lt;br /&gt;co-efficient of resistance.&lt;br /&gt;22. What are the classifications of voltages?&lt;br /&gt;a. Low voltage: Voltage not exceeding 250V. That is 0 – 250V.&lt;br /&gt;b. Medium voltage: Voltage above 250V upto 650V comes under medium voltage.&lt;br /&gt;c. High voltage: Voltage above 650V upto 33 kV comes under high voltage.&lt;br /&gt;d. Extra high voltage: Above 33 kV voltages are extra high voltages.&lt;br /&gt;23. What is coulomb?&lt;br /&gt;It is the unit of charge. One (1) coulomb is the quantity of electricity, which is&lt;br /&gt;circulated by a current of one (1) ampere in one second. The letter Q denotes it.&lt;br /&gt;So that 1 coulomb = 1 amp * 1 second.&lt;br /&gt;24. What is farad?&lt;br /&gt;Farad is the unit of capacitance and the letter F denotes it. A condenser has a&lt;br /&gt;capacitance of one (1) farad, if it is capable to maintain a charge of one coulomb&lt;br /&gt;under a potential difference of one volt between its plates.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 5 -&lt;br /&gt;1 farad = 1 coulomb / 1 volt. = Q/V.&lt;br /&gt;25. What is henry?&lt;br /&gt;It is the unit of inductance and the letter H denotes it. A circuit has inductance of one&lt;br /&gt;henry, if an electro-motive force of one volt if induced in that circuit, when the&lt;br /&gt;current in that circuit changes at the rate of one ampere per second.&lt;br /&gt;1 henry = 1 volt sec / ampere.&lt;br /&gt;26. What is the least count of out-side micrometer?&lt;br /&gt;The least count of out-side micrometer is 0.01mm.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 6 -&lt;br /&gt;27. State symbols for quantities and units.&lt;br /&gt;Sl.No Name of the quantity Symbol Name of the unit Symbol&lt;br /&gt;1 Volume V Cubic meter m3&lt;br /&gt;2 Time T Second S&lt;br /&gt;3 Frequency F Hertz Hz&lt;br /&gt;4 Rotational frequency N Reciprocal second S-1&lt;br /&gt;5 Slip S&lt;br /&gt;6 Speed, Velocity V Meter per second m/s&lt;br /&gt;7 Mass M Kilogramme Kg&lt;br /&gt;8 Density P Kilogramme per cubic meter Kg / m3&lt;br /&gt;9 Momentum P Kilogram meter per second Kg m/S&lt;br /&gt;10 Force F Newton N&lt;br /&gt;11 Weight G Newton N&lt;br /&gt;12 Torque T Newton meter Nm&lt;br /&gt;13 Pressure P Newton per square meter N/ m2&lt;br /&gt;14 Work W Joule J&lt;br /&gt;15 Energy E,W Joule J&lt;br /&gt;16 Power P Watt W&lt;br /&gt;17 Efficiency η&lt;br /&gt;18 Electric charge Q Coulomb C&lt;br /&gt;19 Emf, Voltage, PD E Volt V&lt;br /&gt;20 Electric flux ψ Coulomb C&lt;br /&gt;21 Capacitance C Farad F&lt;br /&gt;22 Electric current I Ampere A&lt;br /&gt;23 Magneto motive force Fm Ampere turns AT&lt;br /&gt;24 Magnetic flux density B Telsa T&lt;br /&gt;25 Magnetic flux ϕ Weber Wb&lt;br /&gt;26 Self inductance L Henry H&lt;br /&gt;27 Mutual inductance Lmm, m Henry H&lt;br /&gt;28 Resistance R Ohm Ω&lt;br /&gt;29 Resistivity ρ Ohm meter Ωm&lt;br /&gt;30 Conductance G Mho&lt;br /&gt;31 Reluctance S Reciprocal henry H-1&lt;br /&gt;32 Impedance Z Ohm Ω&lt;br /&gt;33 Reactance X Ohm Ω&lt;br /&gt;34 Admittance Y Mho&lt;br /&gt;35 Active power P Watt W&lt;br /&gt;36 Reactive power Q VAR VAR&lt;br /&gt;37 Apparent power S Volt-ampere VA&lt;br /&gt;38 Number of turns N&lt;br /&gt;39 Speed N Rotation per minute r.p.m&lt;br /&gt;40 Number of phases M&lt;br /&gt;41 Number of pair of poles P&lt;br /&gt;42 Luminous intensity L Candela Ca&lt;br /&gt;43 Luminous flux φ Lumen lm&lt;br /&gt;44 Quantity of light Q Lumen second lm S&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 7 -&lt;br /&gt;45 Illumination E Lux lx&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 8 -&lt;br /&gt;28. State Greek alphabets and what for they are used?&lt;br /&gt;Sl.No Symbol Name Used for to indicate&lt;br /&gt;1 α Alpha Angle, temperature co-efficient of resistance&lt;br /&gt;2 β Beta Angle&lt;br /&gt;3 γ Gamma Angle, conductivity&lt;br /&gt;4 δ Delta&lt;br /&gt;5 η eta Efficiency&lt;br /&gt;6 θ Theta Angle, temperature&lt;br /&gt;7 λ Lambada Wave length&lt;br /&gt;8 μ Mu Amplification factor&lt;br /&gt;9 π Pi 22/7&lt;br /&gt;10 ρ Rho Specific resistance, resistivity&lt;br /&gt;11 σ Sigma Charge density, fractional slip&lt;br /&gt;12 φ Phi Phase angle&lt;br /&gt;13 ϕ Capital phi Magnetic flux&lt;br /&gt;14 Ψ Psi&lt;br /&gt;15 ψ Capital psi Electric flux&lt;br /&gt;16 ω Omega Angular velocity&lt;br /&gt;29. What is conductance?&lt;br /&gt;Conductance is the property of the conductor, which allows the flow of electric&lt;br /&gt;current through it. Conductance is denoted by the letter G and is reciprocal of&lt;br /&gt;resistance. The unit of conductance is mho. A substance, which posses conductance&lt;br /&gt;as its major property can be called as a good conductor.&lt;br /&gt;30. What you mean by insulator? What are the qualities of good insulator?&lt;br /&gt;A substance, which will not allow the flow of electric current to pass through it is&lt;br /&gt;called the insulator. The conductance and conductivity is zero in insulators.&lt;br /&gt;Insulators are used to isolate the electric current from neighbouring parts. Insulators&lt;br /&gt;will not allow the leakage of current, short-circuiting current, shock to the operator&lt;br /&gt;and isolates the electric current safely with out any diversion to any other place.&lt;br /&gt;Qualities of good insulator&lt;br /&gt;a. It should be flexible&lt;br /&gt;b. It should have good mechanical strength&lt;br /&gt;c. It should easily moulded into any shape&lt;br /&gt;d. It should not be effected by acid&lt;br /&gt;e. It should be non-inflammable&lt;br /&gt;f. It should have very high specific resistance to prevent leakage current&lt;br /&gt;g. It should be withstand high temperature. Because insulators posses negative temperature coefficient&lt;br /&gt;of resistance. That is resistance decreases with increasing temperature&lt;br /&gt;h. It should have high dielectric strength&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 9 -&lt;br /&gt;31. What is electrode?&lt;br /&gt;A conducting element used for converging (centering) current to and from a medium&lt;br /&gt;is called electrode. There are two types of electrode. A positive and other is negative.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 10 -&lt;br /&gt;32. What is force?&lt;br /&gt;Force is that which charge or tends to change a body state of rest or uniform motion&lt;br /&gt;through a straight line. The unit of force is Newton.&lt;br /&gt;33. What is Newton?&lt;br /&gt;One Newton is that amount of force which acting on one-kilogram mass for one&lt;br /&gt;second gives an acceleration 1 meter/sec/sec.&lt;br /&gt;34. What is weight?&lt;br /&gt;Weight is the gravitation force by which a body attracted to the earth. Gravitational&lt;br /&gt;unit of force in M.K.S system is kilogram weight or 9.81 Newton.&lt;br /&gt;Weight is the force with which 1-kilogram mass is attracted by the earth towards its&lt;br /&gt;center.&lt;br /&gt;35. What is bayer?&lt;br /&gt;Bayer is the C.G.S unit of pressure and is equal to 1-dyne/cm2.&lt;br /&gt;36. What is conductor?&lt;br /&gt;Substances such as metals, which have large number of free electrons are said to&lt;br /&gt;offer a low resistance to the flow of electrons under the influence of emf and hence&lt;br /&gt;are called conductors.&lt;br /&gt;Conductors are used to conduct electricity from one place to another place due to its&lt;br /&gt;major property conductance. Conductors are classified into three main groups.&lt;br /&gt;a. Good conductors.&lt;br /&gt;b. Semi conductors.&lt;br /&gt;c. Fair conductors.&lt;br /&gt;37. What are the properties of good conductor?&lt;br /&gt;Properties of good conductor&lt;br /&gt;a. It posses very low resistance or specific resistance.&lt;br /&gt;b. It posses more conductance and there by conducts electricity readily through it.&lt;br /&gt;c. It is a good conductor of heat.&lt;br /&gt;d. It is highly resistance to corrosion by liquid.&lt;br /&gt;e. It must be malleable and ductile.&lt;br /&gt;f. It must be flexible.&lt;br /&gt;g. It posses better tensile strength.&lt;br /&gt;h. It should not react with climatic conditions.&lt;br /&gt;i. It can be drawn in very fine wires.&lt;br /&gt;j. It must be readily joinable.&lt;br /&gt;k. It must be very low in cost.&lt;br /&gt;l. It must available in plenty.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 11 -&lt;br /&gt;37. What are the common conductors in sequence with high conductivity?&lt;br /&gt;a. Silver&lt;br /&gt;b. Silver copper alloy&lt;br /&gt;c. Copper (Hard down and Annealed)&lt;br /&gt;d. Gold&lt;br /&gt;e. Zinc&lt;br /&gt;f. Platinum&lt;br /&gt;g. Tin&lt;br /&gt;h. Aluminum&lt;br /&gt;i. Iron&lt;br /&gt;j. Brass&lt;br /&gt;k. Phosphorous bronze&lt;br /&gt;l. Nickel&lt;br /&gt;m. Lead&lt;br /&gt;n. Germanium silver&lt;br /&gt;o. Antimony&lt;br /&gt;p. Platinoid&lt;br /&gt;q. Mercury&lt;br /&gt;r. Bismuth&lt;br /&gt;s. Platinum iridium&lt;br /&gt;38. What is semiconductor?&lt;br /&gt;Semiconductors posses less conductivity (conductance) than good conductors. That&lt;br /&gt;is semiconductors gives opposition (resistance) to the flow of free electrons than that&lt;br /&gt;of good conductor.&lt;br /&gt;Examples for semiconductor are&lt;br /&gt;a. Dilute acid&lt;br /&gt;b. Metallic ores&lt;br /&gt;c. See water&lt;br /&gt;d. Moist earth&lt;br /&gt;e. Silicone&lt;br /&gt;f. Germanium&lt;br /&gt;39. What is fair conductor?&lt;br /&gt;Fair conductors are the materials, which have less conductivity than that of&lt;br /&gt;semiconductor. Fair conductor gives more opposition to the flow of free electrons&lt;br /&gt;than that of semiconductors.&lt;br /&gt;Examples for fair conductors are&lt;br /&gt;a. Charcoal&lt;br /&gt;b. Coke&lt;br /&gt;c. Carbon&lt;br /&gt;d. Plumbago&lt;br /&gt;40. What is resistor?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 12 -&lt;br /&gt;Resistors posses high resistance, but less conductance. This property is well utilized&lt;br /&gt;to convert electrical energy into heat energy. Common application of resistors is&lt;br /&gt;production of heaters. Examples are eureka, carbon, nichrome, tungsten, manganin,&lt;br /&gt;germanium, and tentalum. In case of heaters, electrical iron and soldering iron etc the&lt;br /&gt;heating element are made of nichrome, but in lamps filament is made of tungsten.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 13 -&lt;br /&gt;41. What is the difference between resistor, rheostat and potential divider?&lt;br /&gt;Resistor: a fixed resistance connected permanently in the circuit for limiting the&lt;br /&gt;current to definite value is called the resistor.&lt;br /&gt;Rheostat: a variable resistance by sliding contacts on it the current can be varied is&lt;br /&gt;called rheostat.&lt;br /&gt;Potential divider: when a resistance is used to develop a voltage drop it is called a&lt;br /&gt;potential divider.&lt;br /&gt;42. What is solder?&lt;br /&gt;Solder is an alloy of lead and tin mixed in different proposition as per the work to be&lt;br /&gt;done. In some cases certain % of bismuth and cadmium is also added to decrease the&lt;br /&gt;melting point of the solder. Antimony increases the melting point of the solder.&lt;br /&gt;Bismuth has a special quality in comparing to most of other metals. That is it&lt;br /&gt;expands when it cools. This property helps to shrink the solder and there by it allows&lt;br /&gt;the joint become firm.&lt;br /&gt;The quality of the solder depends on the % of tin in the solder. To get stronger joint&lt;br /&gt;add more tin in the solder.&lt;br /&gt;For electrical work fine solder of 1½ part tin and 1 part lead is used and for sheet&lt;br /&gt;metal works soft solder of 1 part tin and 1 part lead is used.&lt;br /&gt;43. What is flux?&lt;br /&gt;Flux is a cleanser and is used to remove and prevent oxidation of the metals,&lt;br /&gt;allowing the solder to flow from and to, to unite the solder more firmly with the&lt;br /&gt;surface to be joined.&lt;br /&gt;44. What is skin effect?&lt;br /&gt;Electricity has affinity (fondness) to pass through peripheral surface of the&lt;br /&gt;conductor. This effect of electricity flowing through the peripheral surface of the&lt;br /&gt;conductor is known as skin effect.&lt;br /&gt;45. What are the advantages of stranded cables?&lt;br /&gt;a. It gives flexibility.&lt;br /&gt;b. It prevents skin effect.&lt;br /&gt;c. Increases current carrying capacity.&lt;br /&gt;d. It provides easy in soldering joint.&lt;br /&gt;e. If one strand breaks the other will carry the load current.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 14 -&lt;br /&gt;46. State the Ohm’s law.&lt;br /&gt;In a closed electrical circuit, at a constant temperature, the ratio between the resulting&lt;br /&gt;unvarying current or direct current and applied voltage is a constant. That constant is&lt;br /&gt;known as resistance.&lt;br /&gt;OR&lt;br /&gt;In simple manner Ohm’s law says that, in a closed electrical circuit the current is&lt;br /&gt;directly proportional to the voltage and inversely proportional to the resistance of the&lt;br /&gt;circuit.&lt;br /&gt;I = V/R or&lt;br /&gt;R = V/I or&lt;br /&gt;E = IR.&lt;br /&gt;Ohm&#39;s Law / Power Formulas&lt;br /&gt;P = watts&lt;br /&gt;I = amps&lt;br /&gt;R = ohms&lt;br /&gt;E = Volts&lt;br /&gt;47. What is series circuit? What are the characteristics of series circuit?&lt;br /&gt;It is that circuit where two or more electrical consuming devices are connected so as&lt;br /&gt;to provide only one path to the flow of current.&lt;br /&gt;Characteristics of series circuit&lt;br /&gt;a. It has only one path for the flow of current.&lt;br /&gt;b. If any breakage happens the whole system will be out of that circuit.&lt;br /&gt;c. It is very difficult to find the fault.&lt;br /&gt;d. Individual voltage drop depends on individual resistance (V = I rn).&lt;br /&gt;e. The total resistance of a series circuit is the sum of the individual resistance.&lt;br /&gt;f. Addition of the resistance increases total resistance and decreases the current.&lt;br /&gt;g. Individual device will not get its full efficiency.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 15 -&lt;br /&gt;48. What is parallel circuit? What are the characteristics of parallel circuit?&lt;br /&gt;It is that circuit where two or more electrical consuming devices are connected so as&lt;br /&gt;to provide as many parallel paths to the flow of current.&lt;br /&gt;Characteristics of parallel circuit&lt;br /&gt;a. As many parallel paths as there are devices.&lt;br /&gt;b. Individual devices will get its full efficiency.&lt;br /&gt;c. Breakage in one circuit will not affect the other circuit.&lt;br /&gt;d. Current in each device is different according to the resistance of the device.&lt;br /&gt;e. If the individual resistance increases the total resistance will decrease&lt;br /&gt;(1/R = 1/ r1 + 1/ r2 +1/ rn)&lt;br /&gt;f. The reciprocal of total resistance is equal to the sum of the reciprocal of&lt;br /&gt;individual parallel resistances (1/R = 1/ r1 + 1/ r2 +1/ rn).&lt;br /&gt;g. Individual conductance is inversely proportional to the individual resistance.&lt;br /&gt;h. If two same value resistors are connected in parallel circuit the total resistance is&lt;br /&gt;the resistance of one resistor. And the total of parallel circuit resistance will be&lt;br /&gt;less than the least resistance in that circuit.&lt;br /&gt;49. What is capacitor? On what factor capacity of a capacitor depends?&lt;br /&gt;Capacitor or condenser is a device to store electrical energy and to release it into the&lt;br /&gt;circuit of which the capacitor forms a part.&lt;br /&gt;Capacity of a capacitor depends on following factors&lt;br /&gt;a. Capacity of the capacitor is directly proportional to the area of the plate.&lt;br /&gt;b. Capacity is inversely proportional to the distance between the plate. That is if the&lt;br /&gt;distance is more the capacity decreases or if the distance is less the capacity more.&lt;br /&gt;c. It depends on the nature of dielectric constant.&lt;br /&gt;50. On what factor voltage rating of the capacitor depend?&lt;br /&gt;The voltage rating of the capacitor depends on the distance between the plates of the&lt;br /&gt;capacitor. If the voltage exceeds, the electrons across the space between the plates&lt;br /&gt;can result in permanent damage to the capacitor.&lt;br /&gt;51. What are the types of capacitor?&lt;br /&gt;a. Paper capacitor.&lt;br /&gt;b. Rolled plastic cover or polyester type capacitor.&lt;br /&gt;c. Mica capacitor.&lt;br /&gt;d. Silver mica capacitor.&lt;br /&gt;e. Ceramic capacitor.&lt;br /&gt;f. Electrolytic capacitor.&lt;br /&gt;52. What is the resultant capacitance in series and parallel circuit?&lt;br /&gt;In series circuit the resultant capacitance 1/CT = 1/c1+1/c2 + 1cn farad.&lt;br /&gt;In parallel circuit the resultant capacitance CT = c1 + c2 + cn farad.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 16 -&lt;br /&gt;53. What is the formula to find the capacitance in a circuit?&lt;br /&gt;C = Q/E farad.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 17 -&lt;br /&gt;54. What is work?&lt;br /&gt;Work is said to be done, when the point of application of the force moves. Work&lt;br /&gt;done is equal to force * distance. The unit of work is Newton (M.K.S system) and&lt;br /&gt;joule (1 Newton Meter).&lt;br /&gt;55. What is power?&lt;br /&gt;Power is the rate of doing work or power is the work done per second.&lt;br /&gt;Power = Work / time.&lt;br /&gt;Unit of electrical power is watt. One mechanical horsepower is equal to 746 watts&lt;br /&gt;(British) and 735.5 watts (metric) or 735.5 joules/sec. So 1 kW is equal to 1.34&lt;br /&gt;horsepower (British) and 1.36 horsepower (metric).&lt;br /&gt;56. What is energy?&lt;br /&gt;Energy is the capacity to do the work. The unit of energy is joule or watt-second or&lt;br /&gt;watt-hour or kilo watt-hour.&lt;br /&gt;57. Define Joule’s law.&lt;br /&gt;The heat generated in conductor (resistance) while the flow of current is directly&lt;br /&gt;proportional to the square of the current, the resistance of the conductor and time for&lt;br /&gt;which the current flows.&lt;br /&gt;H = I2 R t/J calories.&lt;br /&gt;Where J is mechanical equivalent of heat is equal to 4.2 Joules.&lt;br /&gt;In electricity H = 0.24 I2 R t calories.&lt;br /&gt;58. What is electrolysis?&lt;br /&gt;When current passes through an acid or a salt, it de-composes and the two decomposed&lt;br /&gt;portions tend to move in opposite direction. This process is called the&lt;br /&gt;electrolysis.&lt;br /&gt;Or the process of decomposing a liquid by the passage of electric current (DC)&lt;br /&gt;through it is called the electrolysis or electric analysis.&lt;br /&gt;59. What are the Faradays laws of electrolysis?&lt;br /&gt;First law&lt;br /&gt;The mass ions liberated at an electrode are directly proportional to the quantity of&lt;br /&gt;electricity (coulomb Q) which has passed through the electrolyte. That is M∝Q or&lt;br /&gt;M∝I t.&lt;br /&gt;And M = Z I t.&lt;br /&gt;Where Z is electro chemical equivalent.&lt;br /&gt;Second law&lt;br /&gt;If the same quantity of electricity passes through several electrolyte the masses of the&lt;br /&gt;ions liberated are proportional to their respective chemical equivalent.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 18 -&lt;br /&gt;60. What is electro plating?&lt;br /&gt;The process of depositing a metal on the surface of another metal by electrolysis is&lt;br /&gt;known as electro plating. Usually the plating material will be silver, chromium etc.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 19 -&lt;br /&gt;61. What are the applications of electrolysis?&lt;br /&gt;a. Electro plating.&lt;br /&gt;b. Purification of copper and extraction of number of metals and number of&lt;br /&gt;commercial compounds like sodium, hydrogen, hydroxide, oxygen etc.&lt;br /&gt;c. Electro typing.&lt;br /&gt;d. Determination of DC polarity.&lt;br /&gt;e. Electro refining of metals.&lt;br /&gt;62. State the laws of magnetism.&lt;br /&gt;a. Magnet imparts its magnetic properties to other metals.&lt;br /&gt;b. When a magnet is suspended freely horizontally, it stands at geographical north&lt;br /&gt;and south.&lt;br /&gt;c. Every magnet has a north and its associated separable South Pole.&lt;br /&gt;d. If a magnet broken in any number of pieces, each piece will act as a separate&lt;br /&gt;magnet having north and south poles.&lt;br /&gt;e. Like poles repulse and unlike poles attracts.&lt;br /&gt;f. The amount of attraction or repulsion is directly proportional to the pole&lt;br /&gt;strength and inversely proportional to the square of the distance between them.&lt;br /&gt;This is some times known as inverse square law.&lt;br /&gt;63. What is flux density?&lt;br /&gt;It is the flux passing per unit area in a substance through a plain at a right angle to&lt;br /&gt;the flux. The letter ‘B’ denotes it and it is measured in Weber/cm2.&lt;br /&gt;B = Q/a Weber/cm2.&lt;br /&gt;64. What is magneto motive force?&lt;br /&gt;The force, which drives the magnetic flux through a magnetic circuit, is called the&lt;br /&gt;magneto motive force.&lt;br /&gt;65. What is permeability?&lt;br /&gt;Permeability of a substance is the conducting power for lines of force of magnetic&lt;br /&gt;material as compared with the air.&lt;br /&gt;66. What is reluctivity?&lt;br /&gt;It is the specific reluctance of a magnetic circuit or magnetic material as in the case&lt;br /&gt;of resistivity in an electric circuit.&lt;br /&gt;67. What is reluctance?&lt;br /&gt;It is the property of a magnetic material, which opposes the establishment of&lt;br /&gt;magnetic flux in it, as in the case resistance in an electric circuit.&lt;br /&gt;68. What is permeance?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 20 -&lt;br /&gt;It is the reciprocal of reluctance, which helps to develop or establish magnetic flux&lt;br /&gt;easily in a magnetic material as in the case of conductivity in an electrical circuit.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 21 -&lt;br /&gt;69. What are the methods of magnetization?&lt;br /&gt;a. Tough method&lt;br /&gt;b. By means of electric current&lt;br /&gt;c. Induction method&lt;br /&gt;70. How the polarity of the magnet can be determined?&lt;br /&gt;Polarity of the magnet can be determined by ‘End rule’ and ‘Palm rule’.&lt;br /&gt;71. What are the advantages of electro magnetism?&lt;br /&gt;a. Electro magnets can be magnetised very easily by sending DC through it.&lt;br /&gt;b. Changing the direction of the current through the coil can change the polarity of&lt;br /&gt;the poles.&lt;br /&gt;c. The strength of the magnet can be controlled by the electric current.&lt;br /&gt;d. Electro magnets can be made in any shape depending upon the need.&lt;br /&gt;e. The magnetic strength remains constant as long as the current is constant.&lt;br /&gt;72. State ‘Cork screw rule’ and ‘Right hand thumb rule’.&lt;br /&gt;Cork screw rule&lt;br /&gt;Direction of magnetic lines of force around a straight current carrying conductor can&lt;br /&gt;be determined by these rules.&lt;br /&gt;‘Cork screw rule’ says that, the direction of magnetic lines of force around a straight&lt;br /&gt;current carrying conductor is the same as that in which the cork screw must be&lt;br /&gt;rotated to cause to an advance in the direction of the current in conductor.&lt;br /&gt;Right hand thumb rule&lt;br /&gt;Grasp the conductor with right hand in such a way that the extended thumb must be&lt;br /&gt;in the direction of current in the conductor. Then the folded fingers or encircling&lt;br /&gt;fingers must be in the direction of magnetic lines of force around the conductor.&lt;br /&gt;73. Who discovered electro magnetism?&lt;br /&gt;‘Orsted’ a denish scientist discovered that whenever an electric current passes&lt;br /&gt;through a conductor, a magnetic field will be produced around that conductor in&lt;br /&gt;concentric circle. In addition to that heat will be produced in that conductor.&lt;br /&gt;74. State the faraday’s laws of electro magnetic induction.&lt;br /&gt;In 1831 Faraday discovered the production of electric current in electric conductor&lt;br /&gt;by converting magnetism. Faraday has mentioned two laws known as faraday’s laws&lt;br /&gt;of electro magnetic induction.&lt;br /&gt;First law&lt;br /&gt;Whenever a conductor causes to cut the magnetic lines of force an emf will be&lt;br /&gt;induced in that conductor.&lt;br /&gt;Second law&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 22 -&lt;br /&gt;The quantity of electricity or the value of the emf produced in that conductor is&lt;br /&gt;directly proportional to the rate of change of flux linked with that conductor.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 23 -&lt;br /&gt;75. How we can find the direction of induced emf?&lt;br /&gt;The direction of induced emf can be find out by the ‘Fleming’s right hand rule’, and&lt;br /&gt;‘lenz’s law’&lt;br /&gt;Fleming’s right hand rule&lt;br /&gt;Fleming’s right hand rule states that, if one extends the thumb, fore finger and&lt;br /&gt;middle finger of the right hand at right angle to each other in such a way that the&lt;br /&gt;thumb point in direction of motion of the conductor, the fore finger in the direction&lt;br /&gt;of flux (from north to south pole), then the middle finger is indicate the direction of&lt;br /&gt;the induced emf in the conductor.&lt;br /&gt;Lenz’s law&lt;br /&gt;The lenz’s law states that, electro magnetically induced current always flows in such&lt;br /&gt;a way or direction that the action of magnetic field set up by induced current tends to&lt;br /&gt;opposes the root cause which produces it.&lt;br /&gt;76. What is eddy current?&lt;br /&gt;Eddy currents are those which are produced or induced in the mass of metal&lt;br /&gt;whenever the metal are moved in magnetic field of the magnetic field is moved&lt;br /&gt;across the mass metal so as to link it. The direction of this eddy current is always in&lt;br /&gt;opposite direction to the cause to produce them as per lenz’s law.&lt;br /&gt;Eddy current can be calculated by following equation&lt;br /&gt;We = k Bmax&lt;br /&gt;2 f2 t2 v watt.&lt;br /&gt;Where k – Constant&lt;br /&gt;Bmax – Maximum flux density&lt;br /&gt;f – frequency of magnetic reversal&lt;br /&gt;t – thickness of each lamination&lt;br /&gt;v – volume if the armature core or mass metal.&lt;br /&gt;Development of eddy current is made use in energy meters to provide controlling&lt;br /&gt;torque and also in form of automatic starters in moving coil measuring instruments.&lt;br /&gt;77. What is magnetic Hysteresis?&lt;br /&gt;Lagging of magnetization or induction flux density ‘B’ behind the magnetising force&lt;br /&gt;‘H’ is known as magnetic hysteresis.&lt;br /&gt;78. What are the types of induced electro motive force?&lt;br /&gt;a. Dynamically induced emf.&lt;br /&gt;b. Statically induced emf.&lt;br /&gt;Statically induced emf can be further divided into two groups.&lt;br /&gt;a. Mutually induced emf.&lt;br /&gt;b. Self induced emf.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 24 -&lt;br /&gt;79. What are the use of mutual induction and self-induction?&lt;br /&gt;Use of mutual induction&lt;br /&gt;a. Transformers are works on this principle.&lt;br /&gt;b. An inductance furnace makes use of it.&lt;br /&gt;c. Used in ignition coils of motor car, motor cycles, scooters etc.&lt;br /&gt;Use of self-induction&lt;br /&gt;a. In regulators to give reduced voltage to the fans.&lt;br /&gt;b. In fluorescence tube light to give high voltage at the time of starting and to give&lt;br /&gt;law voltage at it’s normal working time.&lt;br /&gt;c. Used in welding plant rectifiers to keep arc stationary by smoothing choke.&lt;br /&gt;80. What are the different methods used to measure the resistance?&lt;br /&gt;The different methods developed to measure the resistances are as follows.&lt;br /&gt;a. Wheat stone bridge.&lt;br /&gt;b. Slide wire bridge.&lt;br /&gt;c. Post office box.&lt;br /&gt;d. Ohm meter.&lt;br /&gt;e. AVO meter or multi meter.&lt;br /&gt;f. Bridge megger.&lt;br /&gt;g. Megger.&lt;br /&gt;81. What is generator? What are the essential parts of the generator?&lt;br /&gt;Generator is a machine, which converts mechanical energy into electrical energy.&lt;br /&gt;A generator works on under the principle of faraday’s laws of electro magnetic&lt;br /&gt;induction.&lt;br /&gt;It’s essential parts are conductor, magnetic field and the movement of either the&lt;br /&gt;conductor or the magnetic field so as to create a rate of change of flux linkage with&lt;br /&gt;the conductor by the action of applied mechanical energy.&lt;br /&gt;82. What is the equation used to find out frequency of number of cycles of induced emf?&lt;br /&gt;f = NP/120&lt;br /&gt;83. What are the types of generators?&lt;br /&gt;There are two types of generator.&lt;br /&gt;a. Permanent magnet generator.&lt;br /&gt;b. Electro magnet generator.&lt;br /&gt;In electro magnet generator there are two types.&lt;br /&gt;a. Self excited generator.&lt;br /&gt;b. Separately excited generator.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 25 -&lt;br /&gt;84. What are main types of DC generator?&lt;br /&gt;Mainly there are three types.&lt;br /&gt;a. Series generator or series wound generator.&lt;br /&gt;b. Shunt generator or shunt wound generator.&lt;br /&gt;c. Compound generator.&lt;br /&gt;There are different types of compound generator.&lt;br /&gt;a. Short shunt commulative compound generator.&lt;br /&gt;b. Short shunt differential compound generator.&lt;br /&gt;c. Long shunt commulative compound generator.&lt;br /&gt;d. Long shunt differential compound generator.&lt;br /&gt;Depending upon the terminal voltage characteristics there are three types of&lt;br /&gt;compound generator.&lt;br /&gt;a. Under compound generator.&lt;br /&gt;b. Flat or level compound generator.&lt;br /&gt;c. Over compound generator.&lt;br /&gt;85. What is the emf equation for generator?&lt;br /&gt;emf = P * φ * Z * N / A * 60&lt;br /&gt;Where,&lt;br /&gt;φ = Flux per pole in Weber.&lt;br /&gt;Z = Total number of armature conductors.&lt;br /&gt;P = Number of poles.&lt;br /&gt;A = Number of parallel paths in armature.&lt;br /&gt;N = Speed in rpm.&lt;br /&gt;emf = emf generated in one parallel path and it is the emf generated of that generator.&lt;br /&gt;For a wave wound generator there are only two (2) parallel paths in the armature. In&lt;br /&gt;such cases A=2 and in lap wave wound armature parallel paths is equal to the&lt;br /&gt;number of poles in the armature winding.&lt;br /&gt;86. What are the losses in DC generator?&lt;br /&gt;There are two main losses.&lt;br /&gt;a. Copper losses or electrical losses.&lt;br /&gt;b. Stray losses or rotational losses or constant losses.&lt;br /&gt;Copper losses includes following losses&lt;br /&gt;a. Armature copper losses (Ia&lt;br /&gt;2 ra).&lt;br /&gt;b. Field copper losses (Ise&lt;br /&gt;2 rse) or (Ish&lt;br /&gt;2 rsh).&lt;br /&gt;c. Losses in brush.&lt;br /&gt;Stray losses are as follows&lt;br /&gt;a. Magnetic losses (Iron loss or core loss).&lt;br /&gt;b. Mechanical losses.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 26 -&lt;br /&gt;87. What is efficiency of generator?&lt;br /&gt;Efficiency = Out put / input&lt;br /&gt;= Out put / out put + losses&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 27 -&lt;br /&gt;88. What is armature reaction?&lt;br /&gt;Armature reaction is the effect of armature flux on the main field flux.&lt;br /&gt;The effects of armature reaction are follows.&lt;br /&gt;a. Armature reaction destroys (cross magnetizes) and weakens the main field flux&lt;br /&gt;produced by the main pole.&lt;br /&gt;b. It causes to reduce the induced emf in the armature.&lt;br /&gt;c. It causes to reduce the efficiency of machine.&lt;br /&gt;d. It causes to produce sparking at the brushes due to the shifting of M.N.A&lt;br /&gt;(magnetic neutral axis).&lt;br /&gt;e. At short-circuited loads or at very heavy loads, in case of self-excited generators&lt;br /&gt;de-magnetising of pole cores (wiping of residual magnetism) may takes place.&lt;br /&gt;89. What are the remedies for armature reaction?&lt;br /&gt;a. Brushes have to shift to new M.N.A position in the direction of rotation of&lt;br /&gt;armature.&lt;br /&gt;b. To over come the weakening of the field extra turns have to be added in armature.&lt;br /&gt;c. Pole shoes have to modify at trailing pole tip side to increase the reluctance.&lt;br /&gt;d. Pole shoes have to modify to increase the reluctance.&lt;br /&gt;e. In big machines there is chance of load fluctuation, a compensating winding to be&lt;br /&gt;placed at the pole shoes and it is connected in series with the armature winding&lt;br /&gt;such that the current in that winding is opposite to the armature winding.&lt;br /&gt;90. What is commutation?&lt;br /&gt;Usually the width of the brush is equal to the two segments of the commutator.&lt;br /&gt;Whenever a brush contacts two or more commutator segments, the connected to&lt;br /&gt;those segments are short-circuited. After the period of short-circuiting the current on&lt;br /&gt;those coils changes their current direction in it. The change that takes place in the&lt;br /&gt;coil after the period of short-circuiting of that coil is called commutation.&lt;br /&gt;When that changes take place slowly, that commutation is known as smooth&lt;br /&gt;commutation and when that changes take place suddenly, that commutation is known&lt;br /&gt;as rough commutation.&lt;br /&gt;If the commutation is not smooth, the spark may be more and that will damage the&lt;br /&gt;commutator surface, commutator segments and so the winding.&lt;br /&gt;The remedies for rough commutation are resistance commutation method and emf&lt;br /&gt;commutation method.&lt;br /&gt;91. What are the characteristics of DC generator?&lt;br /&gt;There are three main characteristics of DC generator and they are,&lt;br /&gt;a. No load saturation characteristics or OCC or magnetic characteristics (E0/If).&lt;br /&gt;b. Internal or total characteristics (E/Ia).&lt;br /&gt;c. External characteristics (V/I).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 28 -&lt;br /&gt;92. What is motor? How DC motor works?&lt;br /&gt;A motor is a machine, which takes electrical energy and converts that electrical&lt;br /&gt;energy into mechanical energy.&lt;br /&gt;DC motor works under the principle, that whenever a current carrying conductor&lt;br /&gt;placed in a magnetic field, a mechanical force will be acts upon that conductor and&lt;br /&gt;the conductor tends to rotate, if it is arranged freely to rotate.&lt;br /&gt;The direction of the force or rotation can be determine by “Fleming’s left hand rule”&lt;br /&gt;93. What is torque?&lt;br /&gt;Whenever a current carrying conductor placed in a magnetic field, a mechanical&lt;br /&gt;force will be acts upon that conductor and the conductor tends to rotate, if it is&lt;br /&gt;arranged freely to rotate. This rotation is due to the turning or twisting force acted on&lt;br /&gt;that conductor. This turning or twisting movement of a force about an axis is called&lt;br /&gt;torque ‘T’.&lt;br /&gt;T = force * radius Newton-meter.&lt;br /&gt;Work done per revolution = force * distance covered in one revolution.&lt;br /&gt;∴ Work done per revolution = force * 2πr.&lt;br /&gt;Work done per second = force * 2πr N (r.p.s)&lt;br /&gt;Work done per second = 2π N T (äT = F * r)&lt;br /&gt;So power developed in metric horsepower is equal to force 2πNT/735.5 hp.&lt;br /&gt;94. What are the classifications of DC motor?&lt;br /&gt;a. DC series motor.&lt;br /&gt;b. DC shunt motor.&lt;br /&gt;c. DC compound motor.&lt;br /&gt;There are two types of DC compound motor.&lt;br /&gt;a. Differential compound motor.&lt;br /&gt;b. Commulative compound motor.&lt;br /&gt;95. What are the losses in DC motor?&lt;br /&gt;The losses in DC motor are same as that of DC generator. They are copper losses,&lt;br /&gt;magnetic losses and mechanical losses.&lt;br /&gt;96. What are the characteristics of DC motor?&lt;br /&gt;The characteristics of DC motor shows the relation between armature current (Ia),&lt;br /&gt;speed (N) and torque (T).&lt;br /&gt;a. Torque and armature current characteristics. It is also known as electrical&lt;br /&gt;characteristics.&lt;br /&gt;b. Speed and armature current characteristics.&lt;br /&gt;c. Speed and torque characteristics.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 29 -&lt;br /&gt;97. What is the necessity of DC motor starter?&lt;br /&gt;Eb = V – Ia ra.&lt;br /&gt;∴ Ia = V – Eb / ra.&lt;br /&gt;At the time of starting from the rest there is no any back emf (Eb) in the armature. So&lt;br /&gt;a large current flows through the armature based on V / ra. This very large current&lt;br /&gt;blow out the fuses and before to that it will damage the commutator, commutator&lt;br /&gt;brushes and winding. To avoid this difficulties a proper resistance has to be&lt;br /&gt;introduce in series with the armature till the motor reaches it’s rated speed or till&lt;br /&gt;development of Eb in the armature to reduce the starting large current to safe value.&lt;br /&gt;This starting resistance is gradually cut out as the motor gains speed and the&lt;br /&gt;develops back emf (Eb) which regulates it’s speed and armature current. This can be&lt;br /&gt;achieved by the help of starter.&lt;br /&gt;98. What are the types of DC motor starter?&lt;br /&gt;a. DC two point starter for series motor.&lt;br /&gt;b. DC three point starter for shunt motor.&lt;br /&gt;c. DC four point starter for compound motor.&lt;br /&gt;99. How speed control of DC motor can be achieved?&lt;br /&gt;Induced emf in the armature E = P * φ * Z * N / A * 60 volts.&lt;br /&gt;Where Z and A are constant.&lt;br /&gt;N ∝ Eb / φ&lt;br /&gt;N ∝ V – Ia ra / φ.&lt;br /&gt;We can consider that the Ia ra drop is very small and there by in the place of V – Ia ra&lt;br /&gt;we can consider only V. If it so then N ∝ V/ φ.&lt;br /&gt;So speed may be varied by varying either applied voltage to the armature and by&lt;br /&gt;varying field flux or field strength per pole or total field flux.&lt;br /&gt;100. What is cell?&lt;br /&gt;Cell is one unit for converting chemical energy into electrical energy. A cell&lt;br /&gt;essentially requires two electrodes, electrolyte and container.&lt;br /&gt;101. What is battery?&lt;br /&gt;The combination of two or more cells is called the battery.&lt;br /&gt;102. What are the classifications of cell?&lt;br /&gt;a. Primary cells.&lt;br /&gt;b. Secondary cells.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 30 -&lt;br /&gt;103. What are the differences between primary cell and secondary cell?&lt;br /&gt;Primary cells are those cells, which cannot be re-charged after the substances&lt;br /&gt;(electrolyte, electrode and container) used in it becomes useless.&lt;br /&gt;The common primary cells in use are,&lt;br /&gt;a. Simple voltaic cell (one fluid cell).&lt;br /&gt;b. Daniel cell (two fluid cell).&lt;br /&gt;c. Leclanche cell (two fluid cell).&lt;br /&gt;d. Dry cell.&lt;br /&gt;e. Standard cell or Weston cadmium cell.&lt;br /&gt;Secondary cells are those cells, which can be re-charged and use again once they&lt;br /&gt;discharged or used for the work for number of times with out re-newing it’s&lt;br /&gt;materials.&lt;br /&gt;Most commonly used secondary cells are,&lt;br /&gt;a. Lead acid cell.&lt;br /&gt;b. Nickel iron alkaline cell.&lt;br /&gt;c. Nickel cadmium alkaline cell.&lt;br /&gt;104. What is polarization? What is local action?&lt;br /&gt;Polarization&lt;br /&gt;The hydrogen bubbles which are clinging over the surface of copper electrode&lt;br /&gt;(anode) becomes a thin film of hydrogen over the copper electrode. This hydrogen&lt;br /&gt;film increases the internal resistance and reduces the emf of the cell and hence the&lt;br /&gt;cell soon becomes inactive. This effect is known as polarization.&lt;br /&gt;Local action&lt;br /&gt;In voltaic cell it is observed that, when the cell is not connected to the load and not&lt;br /&gt;supplying any current zinc will continuously dissolving in the electrolyte. This is&lt;br /&gt;due to the impurities (copper, iron, tin, and lead) in the commercial zinc. So that&lt;br /&gt;whenever commercial zinc is used as a electrode, separate small cells are&lt;br /&gt;developed between the impurities and zinc with the presence of electrolyte. These&lt;br /&gt;local cells consume always zinc and the emf developed by those local cells are&lt;br /&gt;always opposite to the main emf. The action of these cells is known as local action.&lt;br /&gt;105. What are the advantages of secondary cells over primary cell?&lt;br /&gt;a. It gives high current capacity.&lt;br /&gt;b. Its internal resistance is very low.&lt;br /&gt;c. It gives a constant current.&lt;br /&gt;d. It posses very high efficiency.&lt;br /&gt;e. It posses fairly constant emf.&lt;br /&gt;f. It posses good mechanical strength.&lt;br /&gt;g. It posses large storage capacity.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 31 -&lt;br /&gt;h. It can be renewed by charging after it is discharge.&lt;br /&gt;i. It is durable.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 32 -&lt;br /&gt;106. What is Plante plate and Faure plate?&lt;br /&gt;There are two types of positive plate preparation. They are Plante plate and Faure&lt;br /&gt;plate.&lt;br /&gt;Plante plate&lt;br /&gt;As per plante process positive plate PbO2 are prepared by a process of repeated&lt;br /&gt;charging and discharging of pure lead. Positive plates, which are made by this&lt;br /&gt;process, are also called ‘formal plates’. This process of positive plate preparation&lt;br /&gt;required very long time for it’s manufacturing and so it is very costly.&lt;br /&gt;Faure plate&lt;br /&gt;Faure plates are generally made up of rectangular lead grid into which the active&lt;br /&gt;material lead peroxide PbO2 is filled in the form of paste.&lt;br /&gt;107. How negative plate is made up of?&lt;br /&gt;The negative plate of a lead acid cell is made up of spongy lead ‘Pb’. The negative&lt;br /&gt;plates are also of rectangular lead grid and the active material Pb in the form of&lt;br /&gt;paste is held firmly in this lead grid.&lt;br /&gt;108. Why negative plates are one more than positive plates?&lt;br /&gt;Negative plates are one more than positive plates so as to get negative plates on&lt;br /&gt;both the sides of positive plates. This is to prevent the buckling action of the lead&lt;br /&gt;on positive plate in the multi plate lead acid cell. The other reason is that both the&lt;br /&gt;sides of positive plates will become active and the efficiency of the positive plate&lt;br /&gt;and the cell will increase.&lt;br /&gt;109. What is electrolyte?&lt;br /&gt;Electrolyte is the medium through which the current produces chemical changes.&lt;br /&gt;Electrolyte is a mixture of sulphuric acid o 1.85 specific gravity (concentrated&lt;br /&gt;sulphuric acid) diluted with distilled water in the ratio of 1:3 approximately, so the&lt;br /&gt;specific gravity of the dilute sulphuric acid is 1.280.&lt;br /&gt;110. What are the types of grouping of cells?&lt;br /&gt;There are three main ways of grouping.&lt;br /&gt;a. Series grouping.&lt;br /&gt;b. Parallel grouping.&lt;br /&gt;c. Series parallel grouping.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 33 -&lt;br /&gt;111. What are the advantages of series grouping and parallel grouping?&lt;br /&gt;Advantages of series grouping.&lt;br /&gt;a. The total emf increases and is equal to ‘nE’. Where n – total number of cells in&lt;br /&gt;series and E – emf of one cell.&lt;br /&gt;b. The internal resistance ‘r’ also increases and equal to ‘nr’. So total resistance of&lt;br /&gt;the circuit also increases and is equal to R + nr ohms. Where R – external load&lt;br /&gt;resistance.&lt;br /&gt;c. Total current is equal to one cell current. That is there is no current increase. If&lt;br /&gt;the internal resistance is negligible or less then current will be maximum.&lt;br /&gt;Advantages of parallel grouping.&lt;br /&gt;a. In parallel grouping emf of one cell will be the total emf of the grouping.&lt;br /&gt;b. Total internal resistance of the parallel group is equal to r/n.&lt;br /&gt;c. Total resistance of the group is equal to R + r/n.&lt;br /&gt;d. Total current = E / (R +r/n) amps.&lt;br /&gt;So we can understand that parallel useful when the external resistance is small as&lt;br /&gt;compared to internal resistance of the parallel group. But at the same time series&lt;br /&gt;grouping is useful when the internal resistance is small compared to the external&lt;br /&gt;resistance of the group.&lt;br /&gt;112. What are the methods of charging of battery.&lt;br /&gt;Mainly there are three types of charging of battery.&lt;br /&gt;a. Constant current charging system.&lt;br /&gt;In this system the charging current is kept to constant by varying the supplied DC&lt;br /&gt;voltage by the help of rheostat or filament lamps in series with the battery, so as to&lt;br /&gt;over come the increased back emf of the battery or of the cell.&lt;br /&gt;Charging current = V – Eb / R + r amps.&lt;br /&gt;b. Constant voltage or potential charging.&lt;br /&gt;In this system the voltage is kept to constant, so the charging current in the&lt;br /&gt;beginning will be high when the back emf or counter emf of the battery is low and&lt;br /&gt;current will be small when the back or counter emf increases as the battery gets&lt;br /&gt;charge.&lt;br /&gt;c. Trickle charging system.&lt;br /&gt;The continuous charging of a battery at a very low rate for keeping the battery&lt;br /&gt;ready in good working condition is called the trickle charging. This is to maintain&lt;br /&gt;the losses occurring at the idle period. The value of the trickle charging current is&lt;br /&gt;approximately 2% of the full charging current of the battery.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 34 -&lt;br /&gt;113. What are the factors on which the capacity of the battery depends?&lt;br /&gt;The capacity of the battery is measured in ampere-hour. The capacity of the battery&lt;br /&gt;depends upon the following factors.&lt;br /&gt;a. Number and area of the positive plate.&lt;br /&gt;b. Discharge voltage. A cell should not be discharged below 1.8 V. If it is&lt;br /&gt;discharged below 1.8 V it may cause to reduce the capacity.&lt;br /&gt;c. Discharge rate. Capacity decreases with increase rate of discharge.&lt;br /&gt;d. Specific gravity of electrolyte. With rapid rate of discharge causes to weaken&lt;br /&gt;the electrolyte so the chemical action also weakens and there by the capacity&lt;br /&gt;decreases. When the specific gravity increases the capacity of the battery&lt;br /&gt;increases.&lt;br /&gt;e. Quantity of electrolyte. Electrolyte level should be at the top plate level.&lt;br /&gt;f. The design of separator. The design of the separator should be thin.&lt;br /&gt;g. Temperature. When the temperature increases the resistance of the battery&lt;br /&gt;decreases and the capacity increases.&lt;br /&gt;114. Explain Kirchhoff’s laws.&lt;br /&gt;Kirchhoff’s laws are used in complex network circuits to determine the equivalent&lt;br /&gt;total resistance and the current flowing in various conductors of that circuit.&lt;br /&gt;Mainly there are two laws.&lt;br /&gt;a. Point law or current law.&lt;br /&gt;b. Mesh law or voltage law.&lt;br /&gt;Point law or current law.&lt;br /&gt;The point law states that, the algebraic sum of the currents meeting at any point or&lt;br /&gt;junction or node of a network is zero. In other words the sum of the currents&lt;br /&gt;flowing towards the junction or node or any point of network is equal to the total&lt;br /&gt;current flowing away from that junction.&lt;br /&gt;Mesh law or voltage law.&lt;br /&gt;The mesh law states that, in any closed electrical circuit the algebraic sum of the&lt;br /&gt;potential drops is equal to the sum of the impressed emf’s acting in that close&lt;br /&gt;circuit. In this the important factor is to determine the emf sign to calculate the total&lt;br /&gt;emf.&lt;br /&gt;115. What are the types of wiring?&lt;br /&gt;Mainly there are two types of wiring systems.&lt;br /&gt;a. Tree system.&lt;br /&gt;b. Distribution system.&lt;br /&gt;116. What are the systems of wiring?&lt;br /&gt;Following are the general systems of domestic wiring and industrial wiring.&lt;br /&gt;a. Cleat system wiring.&lt;br /&gt;b. Casing and capping system wiring.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 35 -&lt;br /&gt;c. Lead sheathed system wiring.&lt;br /&gt;d. C.T.S, T.R.S, P.V.C sheathed system wiring.&lt;br /&gt;e. Conduit system wiring.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 36 -&lt;br /&gt;117. What are the testing of wiring installation?&lt;br /&gt;Following are the tests to be done after installation of wiring.&lt;br /&gt;a. Polarity test.&lt;br /&gt;b. Short circuit test.&lt;br /&gt;c. Continuity test.&lt;br /&gt;d. Insulation test between conductors and conductors to the earth.&lt;br /&gt;e. Earth continuity test.&lt;br /&gt;118. What are the advantages of AC over DC?&lt;br /&gt;a. For the same capacity alternators are cheaper than DC generators, because&lt;br /&gt;alternator is not having commutator arrangement and there by small in size.&lt;br /&gt;b. Alternating current produces pulsating magnetic field and there by it posses the&lt;br /&gt;property of inductance and capacitance.&lt;br /&gt;c. Alternating current can be step-up or step-down by static transformer.&lt;br /&gt;d. AC can be transmitted with very less cost in comparing to DC transmission.&lt;br /&gt;e. Alternating line losses are very less comparing to DC line losses.&lt;br /&gt;f. An alternators and AC motor requires very less maintenance.&lt;br /&gt;g. Charge per unit for AC is less than DC.&lt;br /&gt;119. Define AC.&lt;br /&gt;Alternating current is that type of electric current, which changes it’s magnetude&lt;br /&gt;and direction periodically.&lt;br /&gt;120. What is cycle?&lt;br /&gt;One complete set of changes in value and direction of alternating quantity and emf&lt;br /&gt;or current is called a cycle.&lt;br /&gt;121. What is periodic time?&lt;br /&gt;Periodic time is the time taken to complete on cycle. Its symbol is ‘T’. For example&lt;br /&gt;Indian standard frequency is 50 cycles per second. So the periodic time T = 1/50&lt;br /&gt;seconds. That is equal to 20 m seconds.&lt;br /&gt;122. What is frequency?&lt;br /&gt;Number of cycles per second is called frequency.&lt;br /&gt;123. What is amplitude value or peak value?&lt;br /&gt;It is the maximum value of an alternating quantity that can be obtained in any one&lt;br /&gt;direction.&lt;br /&gt;124. What is instantaneous value?&lt;br /&gt;The value of an alternating quantity at a particular instant is called instantaneous&lt;br /&gt;value.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 37 -&lt;br /&gt;125. What is average value or mean value?&lt;br /&gt;Average of all instantaneous values of emf or current over a half cycle is known as&lt;br /&gt;average value or mean value.&lt;br /&gt;Average value = 0.637 * Emax or Imax&lt;br /&gt;126. What is root mean square value (R.M.S)?&lt;br /&gt;The R.M.S value is also known as effective value or virtual value. The&lt;br /&gt;instantaneous value of both the directions will all be squared up and will be added&lt;br /&gt;together. Then divide to get the average with the number of instantaneous values&lt;br /&gt;and find the square root of this average to calculate the R.M.S value of the emf or&lt;br /&gt;current.&lt;br /&gt;Or&lt;br /&gt;The R.M.S value of an alternating current or emf is equal to the same value of&lt;br /&gt;direct current (DC), which produces the same amount of heat with the same time&lt;br /&gt;when applied the DC through the same circuit as AC is produced.&lt;br /&gt;R.M.S value = maximum value / √2 = 1/√2 = 0.707.&lt;br /&gt;∴ R.M.S value or effective value = 0.707 * Emax or Imax&lt;br /&gt;127. What is form factor?&lt;br /&gt;The ratio of the R.M.S value to the average value is called the form factor.&lt;br /&gt;∴ Form factor = 0.707 * Emax or Imax : 0.637 * Emax or Imax&lt;br /&gt;= 0.707 * Emax or Imax / 0.637 * Emax or Imax&lt;br /&gt;= 1.11&lt;br /&gt;So that R.M.S value = average value * 1.11&lt;br /&gt;Or average value = R.M.S value / 1.11&lt;br /&gt;128. What is crest factor or peak factor?&lt;br /&gt;The ratio of maximum value to the R.M.S value is known as crest factor. So the&lt;br /&gt;crest factor = maximum value / R.M.S value.&lt;br /&gt;= Emax or Imax / (Emax or Imax / √2)&lt;br /&gt;= Emax or Imax * √2 / Emax or Imax = √2 = 1.414&lt;br /&gt;129. What is vector quantity and what is scalar quantity?&lt;br /&gt;Vector quantity&lt;br /&gt;A quantity, which has both the direction and magnitude is said to be a vector&lt;br /&gt;quantity. Examples are force, emf, current etc.&lt;br /&gt;Scalar quantity&lt;br /&gt;A scalar quantity is that, which has only magnitude but no direction. Examples are&lt;br /&gt;temperature, mass, volume etc.&lt;br /&gt;130. What is phase?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 38 -&lt;br /&gt;The development of an AC quantity through different stages is known as Phase.&lt;br /&gt;The term phase refers to the number of separate individual voltage setup in an AC&lt;br /&gt;circuit.&lt;br /&gt;131. What is in-phase?&lt;br /&gt;When those two vectors (voltage and current) attain (reaches) their maximum and&lt;br /&gt;minimum values simultaneously (at the same time), then those two quantities are&lt;br /&gt;said in-phase. Here between those quantities there is no angle.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 39 -&lt;br /&gt;132. What is out of phase?&lt;br /&gt;When two alternating quantities voltage and current do not reaches their maximum&lt;br /&gt;and minimum values simultaneously, then they are called out of phase.&lt;br /&gt;133. What is phase angle?&lt;br /&gt;Phase angle is an angular displacement between two alternating quantities. Phase&lt;br /&gt;angle is measured in electrical degrees or radians.&lt;br /&gt;134. What is quadrature quantity?&lt;br /&gt;When the phase angle between two vectors is 90° electrical, then they are said to be&lt;br /&gt;quadrature quantity.&lt;br /&gt;135. What anti-phase quantity?&lt;br /&gt;When two quantities are out of phase by 180° electrical, then they are said to be&lt;br /&gt;anti-phase quantities.&lt;br /&gt;136. What is leading quantity?&lt;br /&gt;The alternating quantity that reaches its maximum value earlier than the other&lt;br /&gt;quantity is known as the leading quantity.&lt;br /&gt;137. What is lagging quantity?&lt;br /&gt;The alternating quantity that attains its maximum value later than the other quantity&lt;br /&gt;is called the lagging quantity.&lt;br /&gt;138. What is the relation between voltage and current in AC circuit containing only&lt;br /&gt;resistance?&lt;br /&gt;Current (I) is in-phase with the voltage.&lt;br /&gt;I = V/R amps.&lt;br /&gt;P = I * V * cosϕ or I2 R watts. (Where cosϕ is zero because the voltage and current&lt;br /&gt;are in-phase. So cosϕ 0° (zero) = 1)&lt;br /&gt;139. What is the relation between voltage and current in AC circuit containing only&lt;br /&gt;inductance?&lt;br /&gt;Current (I) is lags behind the voltage by 90°.&lt;br /&gt;I = V/XL amps.&lt;br /&gt;XL = 2πfL ohms.&lt;br /&gt;P = I * V * cosϕ watts. (Where cosϕ is 90 because current lags behind voltage by&lt;br /&gt;90°. So cosϕ 90° = 0)&lt;br /&gt;∴ P = I * V * 0 = 0 watts.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 40 -&lt;br /&gt;140. What is the relation between voltage and current in AC circuit containing only&lt;br /&gt;capacitance?&lt;br /&gt;Current (I) is leading the voltage by 90°.&lt;br /&gt;I = V/XC amps.&lt;br /&gt;XC = 1/2πfC ohms.&lt;br /&gt;P = I * V * cosϕ watts. (Where cosϕ is 90 because current is leading the voltage by&lt;br /&gt;90°. So cosϕ 90° = 0)&lt;br /&gt;∴ P = I * V * 0 = 0 watts.&lt;br /&gt;141. What is inductance and inductive reactance?&lt;br /&gt;Inductance&lt;br /&gt;A coil carrying alternating current produces an alternating flux, which causes to&lt;br /&gt;link with same coil and produces an emf in the coil, which opposes the applied&lt;br /&gt;emf. This property is known as inductance. The unit for measurement is henry.&lt;br /&gt;Inductive reactance&lt;br /&gt;The opposition or the reactance offered by the property of inductance in the circuit&lt;br /&gt;is known as inductive reactance and denoted by the letter XL. The unit for&lt;br /&gt;measurement is ohm.&lt;br /&gt;142. What is capacitance and capacitive reactance?&lt;br /&gt;Capacitance&lt;br /&gt;The property of a capacitor to store electrical energy in it, when it is connected to&lt;br /&gt;an electric supply is called capacitance. Unit for measurement is farad. Capacitor&lt;br /&gt;store an electric energy in the unit of charge and the unit of charge is coulomb.&lt;br /&gt;Capacitive reactance&lt;br /&gt;The opposition due to capacitance of capacitor in an electric circuit is called&lt;br /&gt;capacitive reactance and it denoted by the letter XC. The unit for measurement is&lt;br /&gt;ohm.&lt;br /&gt;143. What is impedance?&lt;br /&gt;The total opposition offered by an AC circuit for the flow of current through it is&lt;br /&gt;called Impedance. The letter ‘Z’ denotes it and the unit is ohm.&lt;br /&gt;∴ Z = √ R2 + (XL ∼ XC) 2&lt;br /&gt;Z = √ R2 + (X) 2&lt;br /&gt;Where ∼ indicates the difference of XL and XC and denoted in the letter X (net&lt;br /&gt;reactance of the AC circuit).&lt;br /&gt;144. What is ohm’s law for AC circuit?&lt;br /&gt;I = V/Z amps.&lt;br /&gt;Z = V/I ohms.&lt;br /&gt;V = I * Z volts.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 41 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 42 -&lt;br /&gt;145. What is the current and power in an AC circuit?&lt;br /&gt;Current&lt;br /&gt;AC circuit contains resistance ‘R’ and reactance ‘X’.&lt;br /&gt;In resistive circuit IR = I cosϕ. Because resistance current (IR) is in-phase with&lt;br /&gt;voltage (ER).&lt;br /&gt;In reactance circuit IX = I sinϕ. Because reactance current will lead or lag the&lt;br /&gt;voltage (ER) by 90°.&lt;br /&gt;So the resultant current (I) is the vector sum of I cosϕ and I sinϕ. So that circuit&lt;br /&gt;current I = √ (I cosϕ)2 + (I sinϕ)2 amps.&lt;br /&gt;I cosϕ is some times known as power component of current or the power current or&lt;br /&gt;energy current and the I sinϕ is known as reactive component of current or wattless&lt;br /&gt;current. Because I sinϕ is not taking any energy from the circuit.&lt;br /&gt;Power&lt;br /&gt;Power in watts = terminal voltage * power component of current.&lt;br /&gt;a. True power = E * I * cosϕ watts.&lt;br /&gt;This true power is some times known as energy component or active&lt;br /&gt;component or watt-full component. Because this is the power used to produce&lt;br /&gt;torque in motor and supplies heat, light etc. or this true power is the power&lt;br /&gt;consumption of all source of electric circuit.&lt;br /&gt;b. Reactive power = E * I * sinϕ watts.&lt;br /&gt;This reactive power is some times known as reactive or in-active component or&lt;br /&gt;watt less component or VARS.&lt;br /&gt;c. Apparent power = E * I watts.&lt;br /&gt;The terminal voltage multiplied by the actual resultant current (I) is called the&lt;br /&gt;apparent power or volt-ampere or VA.&lt;br /&gt;146. What is power factor?&lt;br /&gt;So from the above power explanation,&lt;br /&gt;Cosϕ = true power / apparent power = E * I * cosϕ / E * I.&lt;br /&gt;So that power factor is equal to&lt;br /&gt;a. Cosine of angle of lead and lag of the resultant current with the applied voltage.&lt;br /&gt;b. The ratio of R/Z.&lt;br /&gt;c. The ratio of true power to the apparent power.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 43 -&lt;br /&gt;147. What is resonance in series circuit?&lt;br /&gt;If in an AC circuit inductive reactance XL and capacitive reactance XC is equal the&lt;br /&gt;voltage across both will be equal and are 180° out of phase. So that each will&lt;br /&gt;cancel each other and the current limiting component will be the resistance of the&lt;br /&gt;circuit.&lt;br /&gt;If we are in a position to alter the frequency of supply voltage at a particular&lt;br /&gt;frequency named as ‘resonant frequency’, AC series circuit’s XL = XC and the net&lt;br /&gt;reactance will be zero. So the current in the circuit is in-phase with the voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Because the controlling component of the circuit is resistance only and the current&lt;br /&gt;is maximum and equal to V/R amps.&lt;br /&gt;This above said condition is called ‘series resonance’ and the frequency at which it&lt;br /&gt;occurs is called resonant frequency and the resonant frequency (FR) is equal to&lt;br /&gt;(FR) = 1/2π√LC cycles per second.&lt;br /&gt;148. What is Q-factor?&lt;br /&gt;The ratio of VL/V or VC/V at the resonant frequency is called the voltage&lt;br /&gt;magnification denoted as Q-factor.&lt;br /&gt;Q-factor = 1 √L/C&lt;br /&gt;R&lt;br /&gt;149. What is Admittance?&lt;br /&gt;Admittance: Admittance is the reciprocal of impedance. It is denoted by the letter&lt;br /&gt;‘Y’ and the unit of measurement is mho.&lt;br /&gt;Y = I/E = RMS current / RMS voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Equation used in admittance&lt;br /&gt;a. Conductance ‘G’ = Y * cosϕ = 1/Z *R/Z = R/Z2 mho.&lt;br /&gt;b. Susceptance ‘B’ = Y * sinϕ = 1/Z * X/Z = X/Z2 mho.&lt;br /&gt;c. Admittance ‘Y’ = √G2 + B2 mho.&lt;br /&gt;d. In special cases when X = zero, then G = 1/R and R = zero, then B = 1/X.&lt;br /&gt;150. What is the resonance frequency equation for parallel circuit?&lt;br /&gt;In parallel circuit when XC = XL, the circuit is called the parallel resonance circuit.&lt;br /&gt;That is 2πfL = 1/2πfC.&lt;br /&gt;In term (FR) = 1/2π√1/LC – R2/L2 cycles per second.&lt;br /&gt;If ‘R’ is negligible, then (FR) = 1/2π√LC cycles per second.&lt;br /&gt;151. What is poly phase?&lt;br /&gt;A system with two or more the two phases is known as poly phase system.&lt;br /&gt;152. What is phase sequence?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 44 -&lt;br /&gt;The sequence of attaining the maximum value of the induced emf in each set of&lt;br /&gt;winding among those three sets is known as phase sequence. This phase sequence&lt;br /&gt;is usually indicated by the letters R, Y, B.&lt;br /&gt;153. What is phase voltage?&lt;br /&gt;The voltage between one of the phase and neutral is known as phase voltage and it&lt;br /&gt;is denoted by VPh.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 45 -&lt;br /&gt;154. What is line voltage?&lt;br /&gt;The voltage across any two phases of the supply system is called line voltage and it&lt;br /&gt;is denoted by the letter VL.&lt;br /&gt;155. What is phase current?&lt;br /&gt;The current flowing through any of the phase winding is known as phase current&lt;br /&gt;and it is denoted by IPh.&lt;br /&gt;156. What is line current?&lt;br /&gt;The current flowing between any two phases of the winding is called line current&lt;br /&gt;and it is denoted by the letter IL.&lt;br /&gt;157. What is balanced load and unbalance load?&lt;br /&gt;Balanced load&lt;br /&gt;In a three-phase system the power factors and the phase current or line currents of&lt;br /&gt;the 3-phase are equal, then that load is called balanced load.&lt;br /&gt;Unbalance load&lt;br /&gt;If the three-phases have different power factors and the phase current, then the load&lt;br /&gt;is called the unbalance load.&lt;br /&gt;158. What is phase power and total power?&lt;br /&gt;Phase power&lt;br /&gt;The power measured between a phase and neutral is known as phase power.&lt;br /&gt;Total power&lt;br /&gt;The total power measured between the three phases is called total power.&lt;br /&gt;159. What are the methods of connecting 3-phase windings?&lt;br /&gt;There are two methods.&lt;br /&gt;a. Star or wye (Y) connection.&lt;br /&gt;b. Delta or mesh (&lt;) connection.&lt;br /&gt;160. What are the value of voltage and current in star connection and in delta&lt;br /&gt;connection?&lt;br /&gt;Star connection&lt;br /&gt;a. IL = IPh.&lt;br /&gt;b. VL = √3 VPh. ∴ VPh = VL/√3.&lt;br /&gt;Note: in star connection we are getting neutral point and we can able to measure&lt;br /&gt;the phase as well as line voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Delta connection&lt;br /&gt;a. VL = VPh.&lt;br /&gt;b. IL = √3 IPh. ∴ IPh = IL/√3.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 46 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 47 -&lt;br /&gt;161. What is the power in 3-phase supply system?&lt;br /&gt;In a single-phase system power ‘P’ = VPh * IPh * cosϕ watts.&lt;br /&gt;In 3-ϕ system power ‘P’ = 3 * VPh * IPh * cosϕ watts.&lt;br /&gt;In Star connection, IL = IPh and VPh = VL/√3. Substituting the value of IPh and VPh&lt;br /&gt;in the above 3-ϕ power equation,&lt;br /&gt;P = 3 * VPh * IPh * cosϕ watts.&lt;br /&gt;P = 3 * VL/√3 * IL * cosϕ watts.&lt;br /&gt;P = √3 * VL * IL * cosϕ watts.&lt;br /&gt;In Delta connection, VL = VPh and IPh = IL/√3. Substituting the value of IPh and VPh&lt;br /&gt;in the above 3-ϕ power equation,&lt;br /&gt;P = 3 * VPh * IPh * cosϕ watts.&lt;br /&gt;P = 3 * VL* IL/√3 * cosϕ watts.&lt;br /&gt;P = √3 * VL * IL * cosϕ watts.&lt;br /&gt;So that the power in three phase supply system whether star connected or delta&lt;br /&gt;connected is same and power P = √3 * VL * IL * cosϕ watts.&lt;br /&gt;So cosϕ = P/ √3 * VL * IL .&lt;br /&gt;162. What are the advantages of rotating field system?&lt;br /&gt;a. For rotating field alternators only two slip rings and brush gear assembly are&lt;br /&gt;required irrespective of number of phases.&lt;br /&gt;b. The DC excitation voltage is low and it is very easy to insulate. This intern&lt;br /&gt;reduces the size of the machine.&lt;br /&gt;c. Out put current can be taken directly from the fixed terminals on the stator. It is&lt;br /&gt;easy to insulate high voltage stationary stator (armature).&lt;br /&gt;d. The armature winding can be easily braced to prevent any deformation&lt;br /&gt;produced by the mechanical stress set as a result of short circuit current and the&lt;br /&gt;high centrifugal brought into play.&lt;br /&gt;163. What are the types of alternator?&lt;br /&gt;Depending upon the speed there are three types.&lt;br /&gt;a. Low speed. b. Medium speed. c. High speed.&lt;br /&gt;Depending on rotation there are two types.&lt;br /&gt;a. Armature rotating b. Field rotating.&lt;br /&gt;Depending on number of phases there are two types.&lt;br /&gt;a. Single phase b. Poly phases.&lt;br /&gt;With respect to excitation there are two types.&lt;br /&gt;a. Self excited b. Separately excited.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 48 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 49 -&lt;br /&gt;164. What is the voltage equation for alternator?&lt;br /&gt;165. What is voltage regulation?&lt;br /&gt;166. How alternators are rated?&lt;br /&gt;Alternators are rated in kVA.&lt;br /&gt;167. What are the losses in an alternator?&lt;br /&gt;Losses in alternators are same as DC generator and they are as follows.&lt;br /&gt;a. Copper losses includes following losses&lt;br /&gt;Armature copper losses (Ia&lt;br /&gt;2 ra).&lt;br /&gt;Field copper losses (Ife&lt;br /&gt;2 rf).&lt;br /&gt;Losses in brush.&lt;br /&gt;b. Stray losses are as follows&lt;br /&gt;Magnetic losses (Iron loss or core loss and pole shoes loss).&lt;br /&gt;Mechanical losses includes bearing friction, slip ring friction and friction due to&lt;br /&gt;windage.&lt;br /&gt;168. When the efficiency of the alternator is maximum or on what factor the efficiency&lt;br /&gt;of the alternator depends?&lt;br /&gt;Efficiency of an alternator depends on its load power factor for a given load. As&lt;br /&gt;the power factor decreases Ia increases and the copper losses increases and thus&lt;br /&gt;efficiency decreases. The efficiency for given load is maximum only when the&lt;br /&gt;power factor is unity and it decreases as the power factor fall.&lt;br /&gt;169. What are the methods of synchronizing?&lt;br /&gt;a. Lamp method.&lt;br /&gt;Dark lamp method and bright lamp method.&lt;br /&gt;b. Synchroscope method.&lt;br /&gt;170. What is synchroscope?&lt;br /&gt;Synchroscope is an instrument, which shows the phase relationship of emf of the&lt;br /&gt;incoming alternator and at the same time it also indicates whether it is running slow&lt;br /&gt;or fast. This instrument works on the principle of rotating magnetic fields. It&lt;br /&gt;consists of a small motor with rotor and stator. Both wound for two phase. A&lt;br /&gt;potential transformer connected to two of the main bus-bar give supply to the stator&lt;br /&gt;‘A’ winding and another potential transformer of same type connected to the&lt;br /&gt;corresponding terminals on the incoming machine supply to the stator ‘B’ winding.&lt;br /&gt;The rotor rotates if the stator resultant flux in the ‘A’ and ‘B’ is different and the&lt;br /&gt;exact time of synchronizing is the stand still position of the rotor. That means the&lt;br /&gt;both the voltages in winding ‘A’ and ‘B’ are same and there is no resultant flux to&lt;br /&gt;rotate the rotor. The speed of the rotor depends on the frequency of the alternator&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 50 -&lt;br /&gt;and is too fast when alternator (incoming machine) speed is more and less when&lt;br /&gt;alternator is too slow.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 51 -&lt;br /&gt;171. What is transformer?&lt;br /&gt;Transformer is a static device by which AC power at one voltage in one circuit will&lt;br /&gt;be transformed into AC power of same frequency at another (decreased or&lt;br /&gt;increased voltage) or same voltage to an another circuit, which is in mutual&lt;br /&gt;inductive influence with the previous circuit and it is based on mutual electro&lt;br /&gt;magnetic induction.&lt;br /&gt;172. What are the purposes or advantages of transformer?&lt;br /&gt;Purposes&lt;br /&gt;a. Electrical energy may be transmitted economically over long distance by&lt;br /&gt;stepping up of voltages to reduce the line losses.&lt;br /&gt;b. To distribute the low voltages at consumer side by stepping down the voltages.&lt;br /&gt;Advantages&lt;br /&gt;a. Transformer is a static machine and losses are very less. There by efficiency is&lt;br /&gt;high and about 95 to 98%.&lt;br /&gt;b. Practically maintenance is very less.&lt;br /&gt;173. What is the working principle of transformer?&lt;br /&gt;A transformer works under the principle of mutual electro magnetic induction&lt;br /&gt;(Faraday’s laws of Electro-magnetic induction). It says that, when ever a changing&lt;br /&gt;flux links with a coil an emf is induced in it and this induced emf is proportional to&lt;br /&gt;the rate of change of flux and the number of turns in the coils linking the flux.&lt;br /&gt;174. What are the types of transformer core?&lt;br /&gt;a. Core type transformer core.&lt;br /&gt;b. Shell type transformer core.&lt;br /&gt;c. Berry type transformer core.&lt;br /&gt;d. Spiral type transformer core.&lt;br /&gt;175. What is the transformation ratio in transformer?&lt;br /&gt;Equation for transformation ratio is,&lt;br /&gt;E2/E1 = N2/N1 = k&lt;br /&gt;k = &gt;1 in step up transformer, where secondary turns are more and thus voltage is&lt;br /&gt;more to reduce the transmission current.&lt;br /&gt;k = &lt;1 in step down transformer, where secondary turns are less than primary and&lt;br /&gt;low voltage for consumer use.&lt;br /&gt;If we include the current in transformation ration the equation is,&lt;br /&gt;E2/E1 = N2/N1 = I1/I2 = k&lt;br /&gt;176. What is the use of conservator in the transformer?&lt;br /&gt;It is a drum type cylinder mounted on the top of the transformer through a small&lt;br /&gt;pipe. … of the conservator is kept empty. To indicate the level of oil in the&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 52 -&lt;br /&gt;transformer an indicator is fixed. Conservator will help the oil inside the tank by&lt;br /&gt;providing sufficient space to expand and to contract as its temperature varies&lt;br /&gt;without exposing much surface area. That is it limits the air with oil due to its less&lt;br /&gt;surface area.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 53 -&lt;br /&gt;177. What is the use of breather in the transformer?&lt;br /&gt;Breather is a bottle shaped steel tube, which is attached to one side of conservator&lt;br /&gt;to allow the air to pass in and out of the tank or conservator through the calcium&lt;br /&gt;chloride and silica gel, which is filled in it to absorb the moisture contained in the&lt;br /&gt;air. When the silica gel absorb the moisture its colour changes from blue to pink.&lt;br /&gt;178. What is the use of buchholz relay in the transformer?&lt;br /&gt;It’s a protection relay used in oil immersed transformer to protect the transformer&lt;br /&gt;from insulation failure, core heating or any other type of internal faults, which may&lt;br /&gt;cause the heating of winding beyond the specified temperature. This relay is placed&lt;br /&gt;in between the pipe connecting the conservator and the tank. Generally used in&lt;br /&gt;power transformer of above 500 kVA.&lt;br /&gt;It consists of two operating floats and is operated by two mercury switches&lt;br /&gt;separately provided for the alarm and trip. Due to internal fault (collection of gases)&lt;br /&gt;or leakage of oil if the oil level comes down the alarm relay first operates and then&lt;br /&gt;the trip relay operates to isolate the transformer from the circuit.&lt;br /&gt;179. What is the use of explosion vent in the transformer?&lt;br /&gt;It is also a safety device of a transformer, which protects the transformer tank from&lt;br /&gt;the high consequences of the high-pressure gases induced or developed by any type&lt;br /&gt;of short circuit in the transformer by allowing the gas to escape by puncturing the&lt;br /&gt;diaphragm.&lt;br /&gt;180. What is the emf equation for transformer?&lt;br /&gt;Always maximum flux reaches from zero to maximum in one quarter of the cycle.&lt;br /&gt;That is in … of second. That is equal to 1/200 second.&lt;br /&gt;Average rate of change of flux = Qm / … f. = Qm * 4 * f.&lt;br /&gt;= 4 f Qm Weber / second.&lt;br /&gt;As the coil has N turns the average emf induced in the coil = 4 f Qm N volts.&lt;br /&gt;But the rms. Value = average value * form factor.&lt;br /&gt;∴ rms. Value of emf = 1.11 * 4 f Qm N volts.&lt;br /&gt;= 4.44 f Qm N volts.&lt;br /&gt;181. What are the losses in transformer?&lt;br /&gt;In transformer there are losses due to,&lt;br /&gt;1. Resistance of the winding (copper losses).&lt;br /&gt;2. Eddy current and Hysterisis in the iron parts and core (core and iron losses)&lt;br /&gt;3. Losses due to leakage reactance (leakage flux).&lt;br /&gt;At No load the copper losses and leakage flux losses are negligible due to the very&lt;br /&gt;less primary current.&lt;br /&gt;At loaded condition copper losses and leakage flux losses will exist in cosiderable&lt;br /&gt;manner. Copper losses are variable and can be calculated by Ip&lt;br /&gt;2*rp and Is&lt;br /&gt;2*rs.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 54 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 55 -&lt;br /&gt;182. What are the types of cooling in transformer?&lt;br /&gt;1. Natural cooling.&lt;br /&gt;a. Air natural cooling (Dry type).&lt;br /&gt;b. Oil immersed natural cooling.&lt;br /&gt;c. Oil immersed, forced oil circulation with natural cooling.&lt;br /&gt;2. Artificial cooling.&lt;br /&gt;a. Oil immersed forced air circulation with air blast cooling.&lt;br /&gt;b. Oil immersed blast cooling.&lt;br /&gt;c. Air blast cooling.&lt;br /&gt;3. Artificial cooling (water).&lt;br /&gt;a. Oil immersed water cooling.&lt;br /&gt;b. Oil immersed forced oil circulation with water cooling.&lt;br /&gt;4. Mixed cooling (water).&lt;br /&gt;This is the method of cooling combining oil natural, water, air natural, air blast&lt;br /&gt;and forced oil.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 56 -&lt;br /&gt;183. State the type transformers?&lt;br /&gt;Transformers can be classified into different groups and types based on the&lt;br /&gt;following factors.&lt;br /&gt;1. Type of core.&lt;br /&gt;a. Core type transformer core.&lt;br /&gt;b. Shell type transformer core.&lt;br /&gt;c. Berry type transformer core.&lt;br /&gt;d. Spiral type transformer core.&lt;br /&gt;2. Method of cooling.&lt;br /&gt;a. Natural cooling transformer.&lt;br /&gt;b. Artificial cooling transformer.&lt;br /&gt;c. Artificial cooling (water) transformer.&lt;br /&gt;d. Mixed cooling transformer.&lt;br /&gt;3. As per transformer ratio.&lt;br /&gt;a. One to one transformer.&lt;br /&gt;b. Step down transformer.&lt;br /&gt;c. Step up transformer.&lt;br /&gt;4. Based on number of phases.&lt;br /&gt;a. Single-phase transformer.&lt;br /&gt;b. Two-phase transformer.&lt;br /&gt;c. Three phase transformer.&lt;br /&gt;5. As per winding connection.&lt;br /&gt;a. Star-star connected.&lt;br /&gt;b. Star-delta connected.&lt;br /&gt;c. Delta-delta connected.&lt;br /&gt;d. Delta-star connected.&lt;br /&gt;e. Open delta connected.&lt;br /&gt;f. Scott connected.&lt;br /&gt;6. As per the size of the transformer.&lt;br /&gt;a. Distribution transformer (upto 500 kVA).&lt;br /&gt;b. Power transformer (above 500 kVA).&lt;br /&gt;7. Based on function and utilization.&lt;br /&gt;a. Auto transformer.&lt;br /&gt;b. Potential transformer (instrument transformer).&lt;br /&gt;c. Current transformer (instrument transformer).&lt;br /&gt;184. What is the humming of transformer?&lt;br /&gt;Humming is a sound, which is produced due to the vibration of the cores in the&lt;br /&gt;transformer. The vibrations are produced due to the change in polarity of an&lt;br /&gt;alternating current or voltage and by the loose of lamination of the core. Both can&lt;br /&gt;be minimised by tightening the core of the transformer.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 57 -&lt;br /&gt;185. What are the types of AC three phase motors?&lt;br /&gt;Mainly there are two types.&lt;br /&gt;1. Synchronous motors.&lt;br /&gt;a. Plain synchronous motors.&lt;br /&gt;b. Auto synchronous motors.&lt;br /&gt;2. A-synchronous motors.&lt;br /&gt;a. Induction motors.&lt;br /&gt;1. Single phase motors&lt;br /&gt;• Shaded pole motor.&lt;br /&gt;• Capacitor start capacitors run motor.&lt;br /&gt;• Capacitor start induction’s run motor.&lt;br /&gt;• Split face motor.&lt;br /&gt;2. Three phase motors.&lt;br /&gt;• 3φ single squirrel cage motor.&lt;br /&gt;• 3φ double squirrel cage motor.&lt;br /&gt;• Squirrel deep bar induction motor.&lt;br /&gt;• Slipring induction motor.&lt;br /&gt;b. Commutator motors.&lt;br /&gt;1. Single phase commutator motors.&lt;br /&gt;• Plain repulsion motor.&lt;br /&gt;• Repulsion start induction’s run motor.&lt;br /&gt;• Repulsion induction motor.&lt;br /&gt;• Series motor or universal motor.&lt;br /&gt;2. 3φ commutator motors.&lt;br /&gt;• 3φ series motor&lt;br /&gt;• Charge motor.&lt;br /&gt;• Compensated motor.&lt;br /&gt;186. What is the working principle of 3φ induction motor?&lt;br /&gt;When 3φ supply is given to stator, a rotating magnetic field of constant magnitude&lt;br /&gt;is produced. This rotating magnetic field produces induced emf in the rotor&lt;br /&gt;winding as per faraday’s laws and this induced emf causes to circulate a heavy&lt;br /&gt;induced current in the rotor winding due to very small resistance of rotor. At the&lt;br /&gt;initial moment the frequency of induced emf is equal to the frequency of the stator&lt;br /&gt;supply voltage, when the rotor is stationary as in the case of secondary of a&lt;br /&gt;transformer. The rotor induced current according to lenz’s law flows in such a&lt;br /&gt;direction that it opposes the cause, which is inducing it. In this case the cause&lt;br /&gt;producing the rotor current is the relative speed between the rotating magnetic field&lt;br /&gt;if stator and the rotor and is maximum when the rotor is stationary. Hence to reduce&lt;br /&gt;this relative speed rotor conductor (rotor) starts to rotate in the same direction in&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 58 -&lt;br /&gt;which the stator field is rotating and tries to catch it up. The rotation of this rotor is&lt;br /&gt;developed due tog the torque developed in the rotor by interaction between the&lt;br /&gt;rotating magnetic field of stator and the field produced by the rotor current.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 59 -&lt;br /&gt;187. What is torque?&lt;br /&gt;As said above torque is a turning or twisting moment of a force about an axis and it&lt;br /&gt;is measured by the product of force * radius at which the force acts.&lt;br /&gt;There are two types of torques.&lt;br /&gt;a. Starting torque: This is the torque, which is required to start the motor at&lt;br /&gt;load or no-load.&lt;br /&gt;b. Running torque: This is the torque, which is required to run the motor at&lt;br /&gt;normal speed and at normal load.&lt;br /&gt;The letter ‘T’ denotes torque in induction motor and torque is proportional to&lt;br /&gt;Ir φ cosϕr.&lt;br /&gt;That is T ∝ Ir φ cosϕr. Where Ir = rotor current.&lt;br /&gt;φ = Flux = stator flux per pole in Weber.&lt;br /&gt;Cosϕr = rotor power factor.&lt;br /&gt;188. What is slip?&lt;br /&gt;The difference in speed of stator magnetic speed ‘Ns’&lt;br /&gt;(synchronous speed) and rotor speed ‘Nr’ is called slip&lt;br /&gt;or absolute slip and it is denoted by the letter ‘S’.&lt;br /&gt;∴ S = Ns – Nr / Ns.&lt;br /&gt;Slip has no unit. Percentage of slip of induction&lt;br /&gt;motor varies from 4 to 5% in small motors and 1.5 to&lt;br /&gt;2.5% in big motors.&lt;br /&gt;In other words slip ‘S’ = fr / f. Where fr is rotor&lt;br /&gt;frequency and f is stator frequency.&lt;br /&gt;189. What is the working principle of double squirrel cage&lt;br /&gt;induction motor?&lt;br /&gt;In double squirrel cage motor outer cage rotor winding&lt;br /&gt;is of high resistance and low reactance. Inner cage&lt;br /&gt;winding is of high reactance and low resistance.&lt;br /&gt;At the time of starting rotor frequency is equal to&lt;br /&gt;the stator frequency and there by the reactance of the&lt;br /&gt;inner cage winding is comparatively high (XL = 2πfL) because&lt;br /&gt;it is linking more inner winding than the outer winding. So the impedance of inner&lt;br /&gt;cage winding is very high. Hence the current flow through inner cage winding is&lt;br /&gt;very less comparing to the outer cage winding. That is a very high ratio of current&lt;br /&gt;is passing through the outer cage winding at the time of starting and there by&lt;br /&gt;produces very high starting torque.&lt;br /&gt;When the rotor starts running the speed of the motor can be increased and the slip&lt;br /&gt;will be decreased and there by the rotor frequency (‘S’ = fr / f). So that in&lt;br /&gt;the running condition the reactance of the inner cage decreases to the lowest value&lt;br /&gt;and hence the Impedance (XL = 2πfL). So the current in inner cage winding will be&lt;br /&gt;comparatively more than the outer cage winding at the time of running. So now&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 60 -&lt;br /&gt;inner cage winding produces more torque than outer cage at the time of running&lt;br /&gt;and the motor running torque is good enough.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 61 -&lt;br /&gt;190. Why starter is necessary to start the AC motor?&lt;br /&gt;a. At the time of starting motor starting current is&lt;br /&gt;high (4 to 5 times). Therefore if motor is directly&lt;br /&gt;started the supply voltage may be disturb.&lt;br /&gt;b. By the help of starters starting and stopping of&lt;br /&gt;motors can be made easily as we required. Because&lt;br /&gt;starters provides overload tripping difficulties.&lt;br /&gt;c. The help of starters can protect motor against the&lt;br /&gt;single phasing by the action of overload&lt;br /&gt;arrangements.&lt;br /&gt;d. Protect the motor from no-voltage and its&lt;br /&gt;difficulties.&lt;br /&gt;e. Permits automatic control when required.&lt;br /&gt;191. What are the types starters used for starting of&lt;br /&gt;induction motor?&lt;br /&gt;a. Direct on line starter (air break) mechanically.&lt;br /&gt;b. Direct on line starter (air break or oil immersed)&lt;br /&gt;electrically.&lt;br /&gt;c. Star delta starter.&lt;br /&gt;d. Slipring motor starter.&lt;br /&gt;e. Auto transformer starter.&lt;br /&gt;192. What are the speed control methods of induction motor?&lt;br /&gt;a. By controlling the supply voltage.&lt;br /&gt;b. By controlling the supply frequency (Ns = 120f / P).&lt;br /&gt;c. By varying the number of poles (Ns = 120f / P).&lt;br /&gt;d. By rotor rheostatic control (for small speed&lt;br /&gt;variation).&lt;br /&gt;193. What is magnetic locking or cogging effect of&lt;br /&gt;induction motor?&lt;br /&gt;In squirrel cage induction motor some times the rotor&lt;br /&gt;and stator care teeth or slots are comes face to face&lt;br /&gt;or parallel at stationary condition. If we are starting&lt;br /&gt;the motor at this condition the motor get hesitated to&lt;br /&gt;start or run due to the attraction developed between&lt;br /&gt;those rotor and stator teeth or slots. This is known as&lt;br /&gt;the magnetic locking or cogging effect of a squirrel&lt;br /&gt;cage induction motor. This type of magnetic locking in&lt;br /&gt;squirrel cage induction motor can be avoided either by&lt;br /&gt;skewing the rotor slot or by selecting the rotor slot,&lt;br /&gt;such that there is no common factor between the rotor&lt;br /&gt;slot and stator slots.&lt;br /&gt;194. What is skewing?&lt;br /&gt;Skewing can be done by turning the rotor slots about 15°&lt;br /&gt;from the parallel position of slots with the shaft.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 62 -&lt;br /&gt;That is rotor slots are not in parallel with the shaft&lt;br /&gt;but there is an angle of about 15° with the shaft.&lt;br /&gt;195. What are the losses in induction motor?&lt;br /&gt;a. Stator losses (stator copper losses, stator iron&lt;br /&gt;losses).&lt;br /&gt;b. Rotor losses (rotor copper losses, rotor iron&lt;br /&gt;losses).&lt;br /&gt;c. Windage and friction losses.&lt;br /&gt;196. What is synchronous motor?&lt;br /&gt;An alternator, which is running as a motor can be&lt;br /&gt;called as synchronous motor and it runs at synchronous&lt;br /&gt;speed while it converts electrical energy into&lt;br /&gt;mechanical energy. It requires both AC for armature and&lt;br /&gt;DC supply for field.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 63 -&lt;br /&gt;197. What are the advantages and dis-advantages of&lt;br /&gt;synchronous motor?&lt;br /&gt;Advantages&lt;br /&gt;a. It’s a constant speed motor and is equal to&lt;br /&gt;synchronous speed from no load to full load.&lt;br /&gt;b. It has good efficiency higher than induction motor.&lt;br /&gt;c. It can be run as a motor and also as an alternator as&lt;br /&gt;per the requirement. More over it can be used as&lt;br /&gt;synchronous condenser.&lt;br /&gt;Dis-advantages&lt;br /&gt;a. It can not be used as a varying speed motor. Because&lt;br /&gt;its speed can not be varied.&lt;br /&gt;b. As a motor it is not self-starting type and it can&lt;br /&gt;not be started on load.&lt;br /&gt;c. It requires both AC and DC supply.&lt;br /&gt;d. Hunting is also produced in this motor.&lt;br /&gt;198. What are the applications of synchronous motor?&lt;br /&gt;a. These motors are used in powerhouses, in sub stations&lt;br /&gt;for the improvement of power factor by connecting it&lt;br /&gt;in parallel to the supply and it is run without load&lt;br /&gt;under over excitation of field.&lt;br /&gt;b. Used in big industries where many induction motors&lt;br /&gt;are installed to improve the power factor.&lt;br /&gt;c. Used for constant mechanical loads.&lt;br /&gt;199. What is hunting effect?&lt;br /&gt;When the load is varied to the motor the oscillation&lt;br /&gt;being setup in the rotor about the position of&lt;br /&gt;equilibrium corresponding to change of load condition.&lt;br /&gt;So the damper winding acts the magnetic lines of force&lt;br /&gt;and causes to create the opposite torque, which keeps&lt;br /&gt;the rotor in the same position of the particular load.&lt;br /&gt;This oscillation of the rotor is known as Hunting or&lt;br /&gt;Phase swinging. To reduce this hunting damper winding&lt;br /&gt;is helpful.&lt;br /&gt;200. What is synchronous condenser or phase advancer?&lt;br /&gt;An over excited synchronous motor takes leading current&lt;br /&gt;just like a condenser and gives leading power factor. A&lt;br /&gt;synchronous motor, which I used only for the purpose of&lt;br /&gt;improving power factor, can be called as synchronous&lt;br /&gt;condenser or phase advancer.&lt;br /&gt;201. Why single-phase motors are not self-starting?&lt;br /&gt;When a 1φ supply is given to the single winding of the&lt;br /&gt;single phase motor, the field produced by it changes in&lt;br /&gt;magnitude and direction sinusoidally (pulsating flux).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 64 -&lt;br /&gt;Such and alternating field is equivalent to two fields&lt;br /&gt;of equal magnitude and speed rotating in opposite&lt;br /&gt;direction. Such rotating magnetic fields produces two&lt;br /&gt;torque’s on the rotor. So the rotor can not rotate in&lt;br /&gt;any direction. Because the net torque developed by the&lt;br /&gt;motor is equal to zero. So a single-phase motor is not&lt;br /&gt;self-starting.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 65 -&lt;br /&gt;202. What are the methods to self-starting of single-phase&lt;br /&gt;motor?&lt;br /&gt;a. Splitting one phase into two phases.&lt;br /&gt;b. By using capacitor.&lt;br /&gt;c. By using repulsion method.&lt;br /&gt;d. By shading the poles.&lt;br /&gt;e. By connecting the field in series with the rotor&lt;br /&gt;having winding with commutator (AC series motor or&lt;br /&gt;universal motor).&lt;br /&gt;203. What are the methods to control the speed of singlephase&lt;br /&gt;motor?&lt;br /&gt;In AC single-phase motors speed control can not be&lt;br /&gt;achieve as smooth as in DC motor. There are following&lt;br /&gt;few methods of speed control.&lt;br /&gt;a. By changing the number of poles of stator.&lt;br /&gt;b. By changing the applied voltage to the stator.&lt;br /&gt;c. Frequency control method.&lt;br /&gt;d. Rotor rheostat control.&lt;br /&gt;e. By operating two motors in concatenation or cascade&lt;br /&gt;or tandem method.&lt;br /&gt;f. By injecting an emf in the rotor circuit.&lt;br /&gt;g. By changing slip.&lt;br /&gt;204. What are the classifications of electrical measuring&lt;br /&gt;instruments?&lt;br /&gt;a. Absolute instruments. These instruments give the&lt;br /&gt;value of the quantity to be measure in terms of the&lt;br /&gt;constant of the instrument and their deflection only.&lt;br /&gt;There is no any calibrated scale.&lt;br /&gt;b. Secondary instruments. Secondary instruments are&lt;br /&gt;those, which are calibrated in comparison with some&lt;br /&gt;absolute instrument so as to indicate the electrical&lt;br /&gt;quantity to be measured with the deflection of needle&lt;br /&gt;or pointer of that meter over a calibrated scale.&lt;br /&gt;205. What are the operating principles of electrical&lt;br /&gt;measuring instruments?&lt;br /&gt;a. Magnetic effect.&lt;br /&gt;b. Electro dynamic effect.&lt;br /&gt;c. Electro magnetic effect.&lt;br /&gt;d. Thermal effect.&lt;br /&gt;e. Chemical effect.&lt;br /&gt;f. Electro static effect.&lt;br /&gt;206. What are the classifications of secondary instruments?&lt;br /&gt;a. Indicating instruments.&lt;br /&gt;b. Recording instruments.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 66 -&lt;br /&gt;c. Integrating instruments.&lt;br /&gt;207. What are the essentials of indicating instrument?&lt;br /&gt;a. Deflecting torque or force (effect of electricity).&lt;br /&gt;b. Controlling torque or force (spring control and&lt;br /&gt;gravity control).&lt;br /&gt;c. Damping torque or force (air friction, eddy current&lt;br /&gt;and fluid friction).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 67 -&lt;br /&gt;208. What are the possible errors in induction (energy&lt;br /&gt;meter) measuring instruments?&lt;br /&gt;a. Phase error: Field flux in induction meter does not&lt;br /&gt;lag 90° behind the supply voltage due to its&lt;br /&gt;resistance. This can be adjusted by copper shading&lt;br /&gt;rings, which are placed at the central limb of the&lt;br /&gt;shunt magnet.&lt;br /&gt;b. Speed error: An error in speed, which is tested on&lt;br /&gt;the non-inductive load, can be eliminated by&lt;br /&gt;correctly adjusting the position of the brake magnet.&lt;br /&gt;c. Friction error: It can be reduced very much by&lt;br /&gt;providing two copper shading st the both outer limbs.&lt;br /&gt;d. Creeping error: Some time slow, continuous rotation&lt;br /&gt;of the disc (rotor) when only the pressure coil is&lt;br /&gt;excited, but no current flowing in the circuit (no&lt;br /&gt;current in current coil) may happen. It may be caused&lt;br /&gt;due to incorrect friction compensator, stray magnetic&lt;br /&gt;field, and excess voltage. This can be rectified by&lt;br /&gt;drilling two holes in the disc on the opposite sides&lt;br /&gt;of the spindle. This causes sufficient distortion of&lt;br /&gt;the field to prevent rotation, when one of the holes&lt;br /&gt;comes under one of the pole of the shunt magnet.&lt;br /&gt;209. What is illumination?&lt;br /&gt;The quantity of a light emitted by a lighting source is&lt;br /&gt;known as illumination. Heating effect of electric&lt;br /&gt;current is used in producing illumination. When a solid&lt;br /&gt;or vapour is heated it begins to radiate energy in the&lt;br /&gt;surrounding media.&lt;br /&gt;Lux is the unit for illumination. Lux is the&lt;br /&gt;illumination produced by a uniform source of candle&lt;br /&gt;power on the inner surface of a sphere of radius one&lt;br /&gt;(1) meter.&lt;br /&gt;210. What are the laws of illumination?&lt;br /&gt;a. Illumination ‘E’ is directly proportional to the&lt;br /&gt;luminous intensity ‘I’ of the source. ie E ∝ I.&lt;br /&gt;b. Inverse square law: The illumination of the surface&lt;br /&gt;is inversely proportional to the square of the&lt;br /&gt;distance of the surface from the source. ie E ∝ 1/d2.&lt;br /&gt;c. Illumination ‘E’ is directly proportional to the&lt;br /&gt;cosine of angle made by the normal to the&lt;br /&gt;illumination surface and the direction of the&lt;br /&gt;incident light and is known as lam pod’s cosine&lt;br /&gt;angle.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 68 -&lt;br /&gt;211. What are the factors to be considered for correct&lt;br /&gt;illumination?&lt;br /&gt;a. Nature of work.&lt;br /&gt;b. Determine the foot-candle illumination required after&lt;br /&gt;studying the nature of work. Example for precision&lt;br /&gt;work – 100 foot candle, for fine engraving – 50 foot&lt;br /&gt;candle, for reading, typing, drawing, fine machine&lt;br /&gt;works 25 foot candle etc.&lt;br /&gt;c. Design of apartment using for the proper projection&lt;br /&gt;of illumination for better work or purpose.&lt;br /&gt;212. What are the types of lighting?&lt;br /&gt;a. Direct lighting: light directly comes from the source&lt;br /&gt;to the surface.&lt;br /&gt;b. Indirect lighting: light reflects from the wall,&lt;br /&gt;reflector or ceilings etc.&lt;br /&gt;c. Semi direct lighting: light comes through the shade.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 69 -&lt;br /&gt;213. What are the properties of good illumination?&lt;br /&gt;a. It should have sufficient light.&lt;br /&gt;b. It should not strike the eyes.&lt;br /&gt;c. It should not produce glares.&lt;br /&gt;d. Light should be uniform.&lt;br /&gt;e. It should be of harmonious.&lt;br /&gt;f. It should be of correct type as needed.&lt;br /&gt;g. It should have suitable shade and reflector.&lt;br /&gt;h. Economically productive.&lt;br /&gt;214. What are the sources of light?&lt;br /&gt;a. Incandescent lamps.&lt;br /&gt;b. Carbon arc lamps.&lt;br /&gt;c. Gas discharge lamps.&lt;br /&gt;215. What are the materials used in Neon sign tube lamps&lt;br /&gt;for different colors?&lt;br /&gt;Following are the materials used in neon sign tubes for&lt;br /&gt;different colors.&lt;br /&gt;For, Red – Neon gas.&lt;br /&gt;Reddish orange – Neon gas + Argon gas.&lt;br /&gt;Blue – Vapour of mercury.&lt;br /&gt;Golden – Neon gas + Helium gas.&lt;br /&gt;Green – mixture of Neon gas and mercury in yellow&lt;br /&gt;glass tube.&lt;br /&gt;By depositing fluorescent powder on the inner surface&lt;br /&gt;of the tube varying colors in intensity can be made.&lt;br /&gt;216. What is the material used in florescent tube?&lt;br /&gt;The fluorescent tube is filled with argon gas at law&lt;br /&gt;pressure and some mercury after evacuating the tube.&lt;br /&gt;This argon gas gives initial starting at quick manner.&lt;br /&gt;Initially the mercury is in the form of globules on the&lt;br /&gt;inside of the tube surface. As the temperature&lt;br /&gt;increases the liquid takes globules mercury changes&lt;br /&gt;into vapour form and takes over the conduction of the&lt;br /&gt;current.&lt;br /&gt;217. What are the importances of conversion of AC into DC?&lt;br /&gt;a. For traction purpose a DC series motor is most&lt;br /&gt;important. Examples in railways, in electrical lifts&lt;br /&gt;etc.&lt;br /&gt;b. For electrolytic and electro chemical processes such&lt;br /&gt;as electro plating, electrolysis, electro refining&lt;br /&gt;only DC is essential.&lt;br /&gt;c. DC is essential for battery charging, running arc&lt;br /&gt;lamp torch, cinema projector and for arc welding.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 70 -&lt;br /&gt;d. It is required for operating relays, timer,&lt;br /&gt;telephone, circuit breakers etc.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 71 -&lt;br /&gt;218. What is rectifier? Write few types of rectifiers.&lt;br /&gt;Rectifier is a device which converts AC supply into DC.&lt;br /&gt;Following are the types of rectifiers generally used.&lt;br /&gt;a. Copper oxide rectifier.&lt;br /&gt;b. Selenium rectifier.&lt;br /&gt;c. Electrolytic rectifier.&lt;br /&gt;d. Mercury arc rectifier.&lt;br /&gt;e. Tungar rectifier.&lt;br /&gt;219. What are the parts of paper insulated lead covered&lt;br /&gt;cable?&lt;br /&gt;a. Core.&lt;br /&gt;b. Insulation of cable.&lt;br /&gt;c. Metallic sheath.&lt;br /&gt;d. Bedding.&lt;br /&gt;e. Armouring.&lt;br /&gt;f. Serving.&lt;br /&gt;220. What are the factors considered for selecting a cable?&lt;br /&gt;Following factors considered for the selection of the&lt;br /&gt;cable.&lt;br /&gt;a. System voltage.&lt;br /&gt;b. Condition of installation.&lt;br /&gt;c. Continuous current to be carried.&lt;br /&gt;d. Maximum operating conductor temperature (70°).&lt;br /&gt;e. Ambient air temperature (40°).&lt;br /&gt;f. Thermal resistivity of soil.&lt;br /&gt;g. Depth of laying.&lt;br /&gt;h. Short circuit current. Ish = Ka / (t/2). Where ‘K’ is&lt;br /&gt;constant (K = 109 for copper cables), ‘a’ is area and&lt;br /&gt;‘t’ is time duration of short circuit in seconds.&lt;br /&gt;221. What are the advantages of high voltage transmission?&lt;br /&gt;a. Saving in conductor materials.&lt;br /&gt;b. Low power loss (I2R) of transmission lines due to&lt;br /&gt;decrease in current.&lt;br /&gt;c. Better efficiency of line due to fewer losses.&lt;br /&gt;d. Better voltage regulation due to less voltage drop in&lt;br /&gt;line due to less transmission current.&lt;br /&gt;e. Due to the less cross section of conductor distance&lt;br /&gt;between the poles increases and the cost decreases&lt;br /&gt;and the labour cost also decreases.&lt;br /&gt;222. What are the types of distribution system?&lt;br /&gt;a. Radial distribution system.&lt;br /&gt;b. Ring distribution system.&lt;br /&gt;c. Grid distribution system.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 72 -&lt;br /&gt;223. What are types of distribution of supply?&lt;br /&gt;a. Over head distribution system.&lt;br /&gt;b. Under ground distribution system.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 73 -&lt;br /&gt;224. What are the main items used in over head distribution&lt;br /&gt;system?&lt;br /&gt;a. Conductor material.&lt;br /&gt;b. Pole.&lt;br /&gt;c. Cross arm.&lt;br /&gt;d. Insulators.&lt;br /&gt;e. Strain insulator.&lt;br /&gt;f. Post insulator.&lt;br /&gt;g. Stay wire.&lt;br /&gt;h. Support with insulator and stay lightner.&lt;br /&gt;225. Write types of lightning arrestor.&lt;br /&gt;a. Horn gap lightning arrestor.&lt;br /&gt;b. Oxide film lightning arrestor.&lt;br /&gt;c. Pellet lightning arrestor.&lt;br /&gt;d. Thyrite lightning arrestor.&lt;br /&gt;226.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 74 -&lt;br /&gt;Motor, Generator and Exciter.&lt;br /&gt;1. What are the main classifications of alternator?&lt;br /&gt;a. Salient pole.&lt;br /&gt;b. Non – salient pole.&lt;br /&gt;2. What is the emf equation of alternator?&lt;br /&gt;Flux cut per second by each conductor = 2 φm f&lt;br /&gt;Average emf generated in each conductor = 2 φm f Z&lt;br /&gt;Average emf generated per phase = kd kc 2 φm f Z&lt;br /&gt;r.m.s emf generated per phase = kf kd kc 2 φm f Z&lt;br /&gt;For sinusoidal waveform when kf is 1.11 then emf generated&lt;br /&gt;= 1.11 *2 kd kc φm f Z&lt;br /&gt;= 2.22 kd kc φm f Z&lt;br /&gt;kf 􀃆form factor&lt;br /&gt;f 􀃆 Frequency&lt;br /&gt;φm 􀃆 Flux maximum&lt;br /&gt;Z 􀃆 Turns per phase&lt;br /&gt;kd 􀃆 Breadth factor or distribution factor&lt;br /&gt;kc 􀃆 Coil span&lt;br /&gt;3. Why conductors in alternator are transposed?&lt;br /&gt;To reduce eddy current losses.&lt;br /&gt;4. What is the effect of frequency and high voltage at the start of motor.&lt;br /&gt;For a constant load if frequency decreases motor current will increase and at the start&lt;br /&gt;if voltage is more motor current also increases.&lt;br /&gt;5. What is the minimum voltage required for starting of 6.6 kV motors?&lt;br /&gt;Minimum 80% of rated voltage.&lt;br /&gt;6. What are the limits of vibration measurement for motors?&lt;br /&gt;50 microns for displacement and 5 mm/second for velocity.&lt;br /&gt;7. What you mean by SPDP?&lt;br /&gt;Screen protected drip proof.&lt;br /&gt;8. What is the current in single phasing?&lt;br /&gt;2 times of rated current.&lt;br /&gt;9. What is the impedance per phase of delta connected motor?&lt;br /&gt;1.5 times the total impedance.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 75 -&lt;br /&gt;10. What is the slip of an induction motor during normal running?&lt;br /&gt;More than zero.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 76 -&lt;br /&gt;11. What is the effect of increased load on power factor of induction motor?&lt;br /&gt;Power factor of an induction motor increases with loading.&lt;br /&gt;12. Explain the behavior of generator when operating alone and operating parallel with&lt;br /&gt;grid.&lt;br /&gt;Generator operating alone.&lt;br /&gt;a) The power factor of generator depends on load power factor.&lt;br /&gt;b) The terminal voltage decreases when generator is loaded.&lt;br /&gt;c) Governor decides the frequency of generator.&lt;br /&gt;d) Increase in excitation increases the terminal voltage of the generator.&lt;br /&gt;Generator parallel with grid.&lt;br /&gt;a) If we increase the steam input to the generator the frequency of the generator will&lt;br /&gt;not change. It will remain practically constant as same as grid frequency. That is&lt;br /&gt;grid decides the frequency of the generator.&lt;br /&gt;b) Increase in the excitation will not increase the terminal voltage. Instead the&lt;br /&gt;reactive power out put of the generator increases. This reactive power supplies for&lt;br /&gt;the magnetizing current of motors, transformers and etc.&lt;br /&gt;c) Increase in the steam input increases the active power of the generator.&lt;br /&gt;d) If generator is under excited it will draw leading reactive current from the grid.&lt;br /&gt;13. Draw and explain following.&lt;br /&gt;a) Load current Vs terminal voltage at different power factors.&lt;br /&gt;1. At leading power factor as the load current increases the terminal voltage also&lt;br /&gt;increases.&lt;br /&gt;2. At lagging power factor as the load current increases the terminal voltage&lt;br /&gt;drops.&lt;br /&gt;3. At unity power factor as the load current increases there is slight drop in&lt;br /&gt;terminal voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Leading power factor&lt;br /&gt;Unity power factor&lt;br /&gt;Lagging power factor&lt;br /&gt;Ter. Vol.&lt;br /&gt;Load current&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 77 -&lt;br /&gt;b) Torque Vs slip characteristics of induction motor.&lt;br /&gt;Torque (T) = φ I2 cosφ2&lt;br /&gt;Where φ - main flux.&lt;br /&gt;I2 – rotor current Pull out torque (R = XL) I&lt;br /&gt;Cosφ2 – rotor power factor.&lt;br /&gt;Starting current&lt;br /&gt;Starting torque (1.5 times)&lt;br /&gt;Torque Full load current&lt;br /&gt;1 Slip 0&lt;br /&gt;When motor is started from rest the slip is 1 (one) at time of starting and starting&lt;br /&gt;torque is 1.5 times of rated torque. As the motor accelerates slip reduces and torque&lt;br /&gt;increases. Because the power factor of rotor is improving due to the decrease in rotor&lt;br /&gt;frequency and at certain slip the rotor reactance is equal to rotor resistance. At that&lt;br /&gt;time torque is maximum (pull out torque). When the motor accelerates to the rated&lt;br /&gt;speed the torque comes to the rated value, which is less than the starting torque.&lt;br /&gt;Torque is zero when slip is zero, because there will be no relative motion between&lt;br /&gt;stator magnetic field and rotor.&lt;br /&gt;c) Generator capability curve&lt;br /&gt;This curve gives the operating limits of the turbine generator at different power&lt;br /&gt;factor what should the power output of the generator to avoid the heating of&lt;br /&gt;generator stator winding, rotor parts and end parts.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 78 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 79 -&lt;br /&gt;14. What is the cooling medium for different parts of the turbo generator?&lt;br /&gt;Stator – DM water.&lt;br /&gt;Rotor – Hydrogen.&lt;br /&gt;Bearing – Oil.&lt;br /&gt;15. What are the effects of unbalanced voltage on induction motor?&lt;br /&gt;There will be negative sequence current, which will heat up the stator winding and&lt;br /&gt;weakens the insulation. These currents will induce emf in rotor and heat up the rotor&lt;br /&gt;bars and cause breakage in them. Also due to high leakage fluxes due to negative&lt;br /&gt;phase sequence current the end parts heating will be more.&lt;br /&gt;16. What are the types of bearings are adopted for small motors and large motors?&lt;br /&gt;Small motors (LT motors)&lt;br /&gt;Horizontal mounted – deep groove ball bearing at both ends.&lt;br /&gt;Medium motors&lt;br /&gt;Roller bearing at DE and deep groove bearing at NDE.&lt;br /&gt;Large motors (HT motors above 750 kW)&lt;br /&gt;Horizontal mounted – sleeve bearing (pedestal) cooled by lub oil.&lt;br /&gt;Vertical mounted – face to face angular contact ball bearing at NDE and roller or ball&lt;br /&gt;bearing at DE.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 80 -&lt;br /&gt;Insulation classification and testing.&lt;br /&gt;1. What is good dielectric break down value for insulating oil?&lt;br /&gt;60 kV.&lt;br /&gt;2. What is the temperature coefficient of insulating materials?&lt;br /&gt;Insulators are negative temperature coefficient materials.&lt;br /&gt;3. What is gap between the electrodes in transformer oil testing kit?&lt;br /&gt;0.1 Inch.&lt;br /&gt;4. What is the life insulation if temperature increased by 10°C?&lt;br /&gt;The life of the machine insulation decreases by half if the temperature of the&lt;br /&gt;insulation increases by 10°C.&lt;br /&gt;5. What is the value of vacuum maintained by vacuum pump in oil filteration machine?&lt;br /&gt;27 Hg.&lt;br /&gt;6. What is the DC HV test voltage range?&lt;br /&gt;1.7* 1.5* rated voltage.&lt;br /&gt;7. What do you mean by term insulating resistance? How it is measured?&lt;br /&gt;Insulating resistance: insulating resistance is the opposition offered by an insulating&lt;br /&gt;material to the flow of current (electrons) through it when an high potential is&lt;br /&gt;applied across it.&lt;br /&gt;Insulating resistance are measured by megger.&lt;br /&gt;First the equipment whose resistance is to be measured is disconnected from supply.&lt;br /&gt;If the machine is a large one, there may be accumulated static charge on the machine.&lt;br /&gt;So we have to discharge it by connecting a wire between the terminals and ground&lt;br /&gt;for 15 minutes. Otherwise megger will give wrong reading.&lt;br /&gt;After this we should remove the wire and we have to connect megger terminals (live&lt;br /&gt;&amp;amp; earth) to the motor terminal and earth. The rating of the megger should be selected&lt;br /&gt;properly. Then rotate the megger at rated speed of 160 rpm and take the readings.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 81 -&lt;br /&gt;8. What you mean by dielectric absorption test?&lt;br /&gt;Whenever we apply a potential from the megger to test the IR value, initially the&lt;br /&gt;needle of the megger will go to low value of the resistance. This is due the&lt;br /&gt;capacitance effect of the insulation material and after some seconds the needle will&lt;br /&gt;start moving towards the higher value. Because in the insulating material there is&lt;br /&gt;strain on the molecules when the potential is applied. Polarization of the molecules&lt;br /&gt;occurs and they form a Di – pole. The negative charges are attracted to positive&lt;br /&gt;terminal and positive charges are attracted to negative terminal. So there is a strain&lt;br /&gt;on the insulation molecules and they align themselves parallel. This aligning may&lt;br /&gt;take more time. This test is done to know the condition of insulating material.&lt;br /&gt;I&lt;br /&gt;(μ Amps)&lt;br /&gt;(A)&lt;br /&gt;(B)&lt;br /&gt;Time&lt;br /&gt;If the insulation is good the graph is as shown as B and if there is dirt, moisture the&lt;br /&gt;graph will flatten early as shown in A.&lt;br /&gt;After the test terminals to be discharged so that molecules may return to their&lt;br /&gt;unstressed state.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 82 -&lt;br /&gt;9. Draw the transformer drying out curve and explain each stage.&lt;br /&gt;At this point the heaters are&lt;br /&gt;IR and Switched off.&lt;br /&gt;Temp. Temp.&lt;br /&gt;IR&lt;br /&gt;1st 2nd 3rd&lt;br /&gt;Time in hours&lt;br /&gt;When we start the filtering process initially the temperature will be low, as the&lt;br /&gt;insulation value is high. But on temperature increases the IR value starts to decrease&lt;br /&gt;because the moisture entrapped in the coils are released due to rise in temperature&lt;br /&gt;and this causes the IR value to go down. This is the first stage.&lt;br /&gt;Then comes the point where all the moisture is released and then will be no decrease&lt;br /&gt;in IR value or rise in the temperature. This is the second stage.&lt;br /&gt;At this point the heaters are switched off. Now the moisture is removed by the oil&lt;br /&gt;filters and the IR value goes up and as the heaters are off the temperature decreases.&lt;br /&gt;This is the third stage.&lt;br /&gt;10. The insulation resistance of a DC motor is observed to be 15 MΩ at a temp. of 70°C.&lt;br /&gt;what is its value corrected to 40°C. the correction factor for 70°C is 8.0.&lt;br /&gt;Observed resistance at 70°C – 15 MΩ.&lt;br /&gt;Temperature correction factor – 8.&lt;br /&gt;Rm = kt * Rt kt – correction factor.&lt;br /&gt;Rm = 8 * 15 Rt – resistance measured at +°C.&lt;br /&gt;Rm = 120 MΩ. Rm – corrected value to 40°C&lt;br /&gt;The IR of DC motor corrected to 40°C is 120 MΩ.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 83 -&lt;br /&gt;11. The armature of a 600 kW, 0.24 k, 1000 rpm DC generator has an indicated IR to&lt;br /&gt;ground of 2 MΩ at a temp. of 30°C. what is the recommended value of insulation? Is&lt;br /&gt;it advisable to put the machine in service? Give reason. Correction factor for 30°C is&lt;br /&gt;0.5.&lt;br /&gt;Data given are&lt;br /&gt;kV – 0.24&lt;br /&gt;Indicated IR – 2MΩ&lt;br /&gt;Temp. - 30°C&lt;br /&gt;Correction factor – 0.5&lt;br /&gt;Recommended value (Rm) = kV + 1 MΩ&lt;br /&gt;= 0.24 + 1&lt;br /&gt;= 1.24 MΩ&lt;br /&gt;Indicated IR at 30°C = 2MΩ&lt;br /&gt;Correction factor – 0.5&lt;br /&gt;So value corrected to 40°C = Rm = kt * Rt&lt;br /&gt;= 0.5 * 2&lt;br /&gt;= 1MΩ&lt;br /&gt;The generator cannot be put in service because the corrected value is lesser than&lt;br /&gt;recommended value. It should be sent for IR re-conditioning .&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 84 -&lt;br /&gt;Motorised valve actuator&lt;br /&gt;1. What are the advantages of motorised valve actuators?&lt;br /&gt;Advantages&lt;br /&gt;a. Can be used to operate in remote areas, high heat areas etc.&lt;br /&gt;b. Suitable logics can be wired up easily.&lt;br /&gt;c. Hammer blow mechanism (which will release valve in stuck open or close). The&lt;br /&gt;motor has high torque.&lt;br /&gt;2. What are the four basic parts of any valve actuators?&lt;br /&gt;a. Valve motor.&lt;br /&gt;b. Gear mechanism.&lt;br /&gt;c. Limit switch and torque switch assembly.&lt;br /&gt;d. Terminal box.&lt;br /&gt;3. Explain how the motor motion is transmitted to the valve stem?&lt;br /&gt;The motor shaft is connected to a spar gear. It engages on a worm wheel. The worm&lt;br /&gt;wheel has dog teeth. This dog teeth engages or hits the dig teeth on moving or sliding&lt;br /&gt;clutch. The sliding clutch has splines and these are on the splines of valve stem. So&lt;br /&gt;when the sliding clutch rotates the valve also rotates simultaneously.&lt;br /&gt;4. Do you require separate limit switch for closing and separate limit switch for&lt;br /&gt;opening? Ans. YES.&lt;br /&gt;5. What does the limit switch mechanism senses to operate?&lt;br /&gt;Limit switch mechanism senses whether the open and close travel of the motor has&lt;br /&gt;exceeded the limit setting of the motor to operate.&lt;br /&gt;6. What does the torque switch mechanism senses to operate?&lt;br /&gt;Torque switch senses whether the torque of motor has exceeded the set point&lt;br /&gt;irrespective of position of valve.&lt;br /&gt;7. Explain the operational aspects of limit switch and torque switch in rotork valve&lt;br /&gt;actuator.&lt;br /&gt;a. When limit function is selected?&lt;br /&gt;b. When torque function is selected?&lt;br /&gt;Limit function – when limit function is selected in rotork valve, the limit switches&lt;br /&gt;will operate when the limit set points are reached. Suppose limit switches fails to&lt;br /&gt;operate the torque switches will act and cuts off the supply to the motor (both torque&lt;br /&gt;switch and limit switches can act when selected to limit function).&lt;br /&gt;Torque function – when torque function is selected the torque switches will act when&lt;br /&gt;set point is reached. The limit switches will not act (only torque switch will act when&lt;br /&gt;selected to torque function).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 85 -&lt;br /&gt;8. Indicate how you will select the limit switch contacts for indication and for cutting&lt;br /&gt;the supply to the motor?&lt;br /&gt;For cutting off the supply to the motor normally closed (NC) contacts of limit switch&lt;br /&gt;(LS) should be wired in series with interposing relay coil of respective direction of&lt;br /&gt;the valve so that when valve reaches their respective direction contact will open and&lt;br /&gt;cut the control supply. For indication normally open contacts (NO) of opposite&lt;br /&gt;direction of valve should be used so that when valve fully closes open indication&lt;br /&gt;contact should remain NC only and vice-versa.&lt;br /&gt;So for close direction&lt;br /&gt;NC contact of close direction&lt;br /&gt;9. What indication will you get in control room when&lt;br /&gt;a) valve is open – green&lt;br /&gt;b) valve is closed – amber&lt;br /&gt;c) valve is intermediate – both&lt;br /&gt;d) valve is closing and torque switch operate – both&lt;br /&gt;10. What is the function of hammer blow mechanism?&lt;br /&gt;Hammer blow mechanism allows motor to rotate freely for ½ or ¼ turn and the dog&lt;br /&gt;teeth on worm gear comes against the dog teeth on sliding clutch with a blow. This is&lt;br /&gt;use full when valve is stuck in fully open or closed condition.&lt;br /&gt;11. How will you proceed to operate the valve manually after an electrical operation?&lt;br /&gt;After electrical operation to operate manually we must tilt the lever provided on the&lt;br /&gt;actuator to hand (manual) position by which the sliding clutch gets engaged with&lt;br /&gt;hand drive.&lt;br /&gt;12. Know the setting procedure for all valves.&lt;br /&gt;13. Know the control and power circuit diagram of electrical motorised valve.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 86 -&lt;br /&gt;Transformers&lt;br /&gt;1. What is the colour of silica gel in dry stage and when saturated with moisture in a&lt;br /&gt;breather?&lt;br /&gt;Dry stage – Deep blue.&lt;br /&gt;Saturated stage – Whitish pink.&lt;br /&gt;2. What is the static pressure of diaphragm in the transformer explosion vent?&lt;br /&gt;5 psi.&lt;br /&gt;3. In buchholz relay how the top and bottom mercury switches are connected?&lt;br /&gt;Top mercury switch is connected for alarm and bottom switch for trip.&lt;br /&gt;4. What is the normal value of moisture content allowed in transformer oil?&lt;br /&gt;&lt;10 ppm.&lt;br /&gt;5. What is the vector group of distribution transformer?&lt;br /&gt;Dy11.&lt;br /&gt;6. What are the losses in a power transformer and mention how these losses can be&lt;br /&gt;minimised?&lt;br /&gt;There are two losses in a transformer.&lt;br /&gt;a. Iron losses.&lt;br /&gt;b. Copper losses.&lt;br /&gt;Iron losses – Iron losses constitutes of two losses.&lt;br /&gt;a. Eddy current losses, these are due to the induced emf in the core, which&lt;br /&gt;constitutes a current in the core. These will heats up the core.&lt;br /&gt;Eddy current losses can be minimised by using laminated core immersed in&lt;br /&gt;varnish. This provides a high resistance between the laminations and thus eddy&lt;br /&gt;current in reduced.&lt;br /&gt;b. Hysterisis losses, these are due to the magnetic reversal of current by which there&lt;br /&gt;is friction between molecules of core and heat is generated.&lt;br /&gt;Hysterisis losses can be minimised by selecting proper magnetic material, like&lt;br /&gt;silicon steel.&lt;br /&gt;Copper losses – these losses are due to the resistance of the winding, which is equal&lt;br /&gt;to I2rt (calories). These losses are depends on load. That is the losses are&lt;br /&gt;increased to the square of the load current&lt;br /&gt;I – current through winding.&lt;br /&gt;r – resistance of winding.&lt;br /&gt;t – time duration.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 87 -&lt;br /&gt;7. Define the percentage voltage regulation and efficiency of a power transformer.&lt;br /&gt;Voltage regulation is the difference between no load voltage and full load voltage by&lt;br /&gt;no load voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Voltage regulation = No load voltage – Full load voltage / No load voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Voltage regulation is mentioned in % (percentage).&lt;br /&gt;% Voltage regulation = No load voltage – Full load voltage * 100 / No load voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Efficiency of a transformer is the ratio of output in watts and input in watts.&lt;br /&gt;Efficiency = Output in watts / Input in watts.&lt;br /&gt;% Efficiency = Output in watts * 100 / Input in watts.&lt;br /&gt;% Efficiency = Output in watts * 100 / Output in watts + losses.&lt;br /&gt;8. Mention the important parts of a power transformer and their purposes.&lt;br /&gt;Conservator: This allows for shrinkage and swelling of transformer oil. When the oil&lt;br /&gt;is heated up it swells and rises to the conservator. When cools down it goes back to&lt;br /&gt;main tank. Conservator reduces sludge formation of oil because only the oil surface&lt;br /&gt;in conservator is exposed to atmosphere where oil in the main tank is not exposed to&lt;br /&gt;atmosphere.&lt;br /&gt;Breather: It provides dry sir to conservator when transformer breathes. That is when&lt;br /&gt;there is shrinkage of oil atmospheric air enters conservator through breather. The&lt;br /&gt;moisture is absorbed in breather by silica gel.&lt;br /&gt;Buchholz relay (gas operated): If there is an initial fault, heating up of core, high&lt;br /&gt;resistance joints heating up by conduction through insulation and supports. There is&lt;br /&gt;heating up of oil, which breaks down and gases are released. This gas actuates the&lt;br /&gt;mechanics in the relay, There by closing contacts of mercury switches for alarm.&lt;br /&gt;Also if there is a short circuit, the buchholz relay will trip the transformer. Also if&lt;br /&gt;there is any leakage of oil through bushing etc and oil level comes down the relay&lt;br /&gt;will give alarm and also will trip the transformer if transformer oil level comes down&lt;br /&gt;the point. Gases can be taken from the relay to identify nature of fault.&lt;br /&gt;Explosion vent: It provided on transformer main tank, provided with two Bakelite&lt;br /&gt;diaphragm which break when the pressure exceeds 5 psi in the transformer tank and&lt;br /&gt;relieve the pressure.&lt;br /&gt;Core: To provide low reluctance path for the magnetic lines of force. It carries both&lt;br /&gt;the HV and LV windings.&lt;br /&gt;HV Winding: High voltage is given to HV winding and low voltage is taken from&lt;br /&gt;the LV winding.&lt;br /&gt;LV Winding: Low voltage is given to LV winding and high voltage is taken from the&lt;br /&gt;HV winding.&lt;br /&gt;Cooling tubes: These are provided to cool the transformer oil so that the heat of oil&lt;br /&gt;will be given to the atmosphere.&lt;br /&gt;HT bushing: Carries the HV terminals.&lt;br /&gt;LT bushing: Carries the LV terminals.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 88 -&lt;br /&gt;Tap changer: this is provided so that we can get the required voltage out put. There&lt;br /&gt;are two types of tap changer. Online tap changer and off line tap changer.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 89 -&lt;br /&gt;9. Mention the properties of transformer oil.&lt;br /&gt;Properties of transformer oil are,&lt;br /&gt;a) Colour – pale yellow.&lt;br /&gt;b) Moisture content - &lt;10 ppm.&lt;br /&gt;c) Acidity (KOH/gramme of oil) – &lt;0.1.&lt;br /&gt;d) Dielectric strength – limit value is 45 kV and preferable value is 60 kV.&lt;br /&gt;e) Flash point - 141º C.&lt;br /&gt;f) Inter surface tension – 30 to 40 dynes / cm or 0.3 to 0.4 Newton.&lt;br /&gt;g) Resistivity –&lt;br /&gt;10. How explosion vent works?&lt;br /&gt;Explosion vent is provided on the transformer tank to relieve pressure if the pressure&lt;br /&gt;in the transformer exceeds 5 psi. It is swan neck shaped having two Bakelite&lt;br /&gt;diaphragms. One at top and another at bottom. These break if the static pressure&lt;br /&gt;increases to 5 psi. Wire meshes are provided below the bottom diaphragm and above&lt;br /&gt;the top diaphragm. When there is any breakage due to excess pressure the bottom&lt;br /&gt;wire mesh prevents broken pieces from entering transformer tank and the wire mesh&lt;br /&gt;provided above the top diaphragm protects the diaphragm from any external damage.&lt;br /&gt;There is an oil level indicator provided above the bottom diaphragm. It indicates the&lt;br /&gt;level of oil in the vent if the bottom diaphragm ruptures.&lt;br /&gt;A ruptured diaphragm must be immediately replaced. Also we should check the top&lt;br /&gt;diaphragm for any external damage.&lt;br /&gt;11. Explain the operation of silica gel breather.&lt;br /&gt;Silica gel breather is used in a transformer to provide dry atmospheric air to the&lt;br /&gt;conservator when transformer breathes. The breather consists of an inner container&lt;br /&gt;and outer container. The inner container contains silica gel, which absorbs moisture.&lt;br /&gt;An oil bath in provided at the bottom of breather so that the silica gel will not be in&lt;br /&gt;direct contact with the atmosphere. Also it will trap dust and dirt entering the&lt;br /&gt;breather. Dry silica gel will be deep blue in colour. After it gets saturated with&lt;br /&gt;moisture it will turn into white pink. The change of colour silica gel can be viewed&lt;br /&gt;externally through transparent viewer provided on the breather. When the silica gel is&lt;br /&gt;saturated with moisture it must be replaced or regenerated or recharged. Silica gel is&lt;br /&gt;recharged by heating it to a temperature of 250º F to 300º F till the deep blue colour&lt;br /&gt;of silica gel is got back.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 90 -&lt;br /&gt;12. Explain with diagram the operation of on load tap changer.&lt;br /&gt;Tap changer (ON LOAD type) can be used to increase or decrease transformer&lt;br /&gt;output voltage without break in the voltage to the load.&lt;br /&gt;The tap changer consists of a diverter switch. The odd taps are taken on one side and&lt;br /&gt;even on another side as shown in figure.&lt;br /&gt;The diverter switch is provided so that there will be no break in the supply to the&lt;br /&gt;load and also no cut of transition resistance when the tap changing is achieved.&lt;br /&gt;Transition resistors are provided to limit the current when the windings are shortcircuited&lt;br /&gt;by the diverter switch.&lt;br /&gt;Operation: In the above figure, the voltage at tap 2 is 406 V. the position of diverter&lt;br /&gt;switch is shown. It short-circuited with transition resistance.&lt;br /&gt;We want to increase voltage to 420 V at tap 5. When we begin to change the tap the&lt;br /&gt;diverter switch connects 2 transition resistance and when the tap changeover is&lt;br /&gt;achieved that is when the tap changer reaches tap 5, the diverter switch short circuits&lt;br /&gt;transition resistance and thus the resistance is eliminated. The diverter switch&lt;br /&gt;switching time is very high. This is to reduce arcing, which can decompose the oil.&lt;br /&gt;The whole assembly is immersed in oil. OLTC is connected to HV side, because in&lt;br /&gt;LV side current handled will be more. But in HT side current to be handled is lesser&lt;br /&gt;than LV side.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 91 -&lt;br /&gt;13. Explain the procedure for finding out the vector group of a transformer.&lt;br /&gt;Procedure: Take the nameplate details. See from nameplate what group the&lt;br /&gt;transformer belongs. Suppose nameplate says that transformer belongs to Dy11.&lt;br /&gt;Take the IR value between&lt;br /&gt;a) HV and LV with body grounded. That is between A2 – a2, B2 – b2, C2 – c2.&lt;br /&gt;b) HV and body with LV grounded and&lt;br /&gt;c) LV and body with HV grounded. A2 c2 a2&lt;br /&gt;C2 B2 b2&lt;br /&gt;Connect A2 to a2 and give low voltage (415 V) to HV side. Measure voltage between&lt;br /&gt;a. C2 – b2 􀃆 410 V (example).&lt;br /&gt;b. C2 – c2 􀃆 395 V (example).&lt;br /&gt;c. B2 – b2 􀃆 395 V (example).&lt;br /&gt;d. B2 – c2 􀃆 395 V (example).&lt;br /&gt;Draw the diagram of Dy11 and check that the readings got are correct.&lt;br /&gt;A2&lt;br /&gt;a2&lt;br /&gt;30º&lt;br /&gt;b2&lt;br /&gt;c2&lt;br /&gt;According to the fig. C2 B2&lt;br /&gt;C2 c2 = B2 b2 = B2 c2.&lt;br /&gt;And C2 b2 will be greater than C2 c2 , B2 b2, B2 c2.&lt;br /&gt;That is C2 b2 &gt;&gt; C c2.&lt;br /&gt;If these conditions are satisfied then that transformer belongs to vector group Dy11.&lt;br /&gt;A2&lt;br /&gt;/ a2&lt;br /&gt;For Dy1 transformer&lt;br /&gt;B2 c2 will be greater than B2 b2, C2 c2, C2 b2.&lt;br /&gt;That is B2 b2 &gt;&gt; B b2. c2&lt;br /&gt;C2&lt;br /&gt;b2 B2&lt;br /&gt;For Yy0 transformer A2/a2&lt;br /&gt;B2 c2 = C2 b2&lt;br /&gt;B b2 = C c2&lt;br /&gt;B b2 and C c2 will be lesser than B2 b2 and C2 b2.&lt;br /&gt;C2/c2 B2/b2&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 92 -&lt;br /&gt;Turbine Generator Basics&lt;br /&gt;1. Explain the principle of working of impulse steam turbine.&lt;br /&gt;When steam enters the turbine it suffers a change in direction and momentum, which&lt;br /&gt;gives rise to the rotation of the turbine. There will be no drop in pressure in impulse&lt;br /&gt;steam turbine.&lt;br /&gt;2. Mention the four processes involved in Renkine cycle.&lt;br /&gt;Saturated liquid line.&lt;br /&gt;4 1&lt;br /&gt;Saturated vapour line.&lt;br /&gt;3’&lt;br /&gt;3 2&lt;br /&gt;1 – 2 􀃆 Expansion process.&lt;br /&gt;2 – 3 􀃆 Constant pressure heat rejection.&lt;br /&gt;3 – 3’􀃆 Reverse adiabatic expansion.&lt;br /&gt;3 – 4 and 4 – 1 􀃆 Constant pressure heating.&lt;br /&gt;3. What are the methods of removing moisture from turbine?&lt;br /&gt;a. External method by moisture separator and reheater, which separates the moisture&lt;br /&gt;and reheates the steam.&lt;br /&gt;b. Internally by stainless steel mesh, which reduces moisture (water particles) to&lt;br /&gt;1%.&lt;br /&gt;c. By main steam reheat.&lt;br /&gt;4. Define capacity factor.&lt;br /&gt;Capacity factor can be defined as net power produced by the plant divided by perfect&lt;br /&gt;net power that can be produced in the plant.&lt;br /&gt;Capacity factor = Net power produced / Perfect net power produced.&lt;br /&gt;5. What is the purpose of turbine governing system?&lt;br /&gt;Turbine governing system governs the speed of the turbine with the help of&lt;br /&gt;centrifugal governer. It reduces the steam inlet when turbine over speeds.&lt;br /&gt;6. What are the benefits of feed water heating?&lt;br /&gt;a. It improves the plant efficiency.&lt;br /&gt;b. Feed water is heated nearer to saturation point thus thermal shock to boiler is&lt;br /&gt;avoided.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 93 -&lt;br /&gt;7. Mention parameters monitored by turbovisory instruments.&lt;br /&gt;a. Speed governing.&lt;br /&gt;b. Eccentricity monitoring.&lt;br /&gt;c. Vibration monitoring.&lt;br /&gt;d. Valve position monitoring.&lt;br /&gt;e. Temperature monitoring.&lt;br /&gt;f. Pressure monitoring.&lt;br /&gt;g. Level monitoring.&lt;br /&gt;h. Gas leak monitoring.&lt;br /&gt;i. Conductivity monitoring.&lt;br /&gt;j. Flow monitoring.&lt;br /&gt;8. What are the purposes of turning gear?&lt;br /&gt;Turning gear is used to run the turbine from rest to low speed and from normal&lt;br /&gt;running speed to low speed with the help of barring motor to eliminate the hogging&lt;br /&gt;and sagging of turbine because of the high temperature.&lt;br /&gt;9. Explain the differences between the two types of feed water heaters.&lt;br /&gt;a. Open type: In which bleed steam and condensed water are mixes directly and there&lt;br /&gt;is also dearation of steam.&lt;br /&gt;b. Closed type (shell type): It has tubes and shell. The water passes through the tubes&lt;br /&gt;and steam passes through shell. The heat exchange takes placcce through the&lt;br /&gt;metal tubes.&lt;br /&gt;10. Why condenser back-pressure must be low? How it is achieved?&lt;br /&gt;Condenser back- pressure must be low, because steam should be dumped into the&lt;br /&gt;condenser so as to recycle it to boiler through the recycle process. It improves&lt;br /&gt;efficiency of the turbine, as the heat rejection is less. It is achieved by the help of&lt;br /&gt;ejectors and also passing cold water in the condenser through the tubes of the&lt;br /&gt;condenser so that maximum vacuum can be obtained.&lt;br /&gt;11. What are the materials used for TG rotor and blades?&lt;br /&gt;TG rotor is made up of alloy steel and blades are made up of stainless steel.&lt;br /&gt;12. Define the term heat rate?&lt;br /&gt;Heat rate is defined as the heat supplied in to the plant in Btu by power generated or&lt;br /&gt;output by the plant in kWh.&lt;br /&gt;Heat rate = Heat supplied in Btu / Power output in kWh.&lt;br /&gt;13. What is the purpose of gland steam system?&lt;br /&gt;Gland steam system is provided to arrest the steam leak from the turbine and to&lt;br /&gt;protect the air ingress into the turbine.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 94 -&lt;br /&gt;14. Explain the main difference between impulse and reaction turbine.&lt;br /&gt;When the inlet pressure of steam to the turbine is equal to outlet pressure of steam&lt;br /&gt;from the turbine the turbine is called the impulse turbine. In this type the heat is&lt;br /&gt;added is very less.&lt;br /&gt;In reaction turbine the outlet pressure of steam is less than the inlet pressure of the&lt;br /&gt;steam. There is reduction in pressure with the increase in kinetic energy.&lt;br /&gt;15. What is meant by hydrodynamic film lubrication?&lt;br /&gt;In high-speed turbines the lubricating oil will be at the sides and there is metal to&lt;br /&gt;metal contact when turbine at rest. When the turbine speeds up there is pressure&lt;br /&gt;pushing the oil through the metal to metal contact. When turbine finally achieves its&lt;br /&gt;speed the oil film breaks the barrier and it takes the load on itself. This is&lt;br /&gt;hydrodynamic lubrication.&lt;br /&gt;16. How does the hydrostatic lubrication differ from hydrodynamic type?&lt;br /&gt;In hydrostatic lubrication which is used in slow speed turbines the lubricating oil is&lt;br /&gt;pressurised externally where as in hydrodynamic system it forms oil film by its speed&lt;br /&gt;which pushes the lubrication oil to form film.&lt;br /&gt;17. What are the functions of dearator?&lt;br /&gt;Dearator removes non-condensable gases (O2), which gets added in the steam and it,&lt;br /&gt;mixes steam with the condensed water for feed water heating. This is a contact type&lt;br /&gt;feed water heater.&lt;br /&gt;18. Why non-return valves are provided in the steam extraction lines?&lt;br /&gt;Non-return valves are provided because when the turbine trips there will be an&lt;br /&gt;instant drop in pressure inside the turbine. But there will be steam in feed water&lt;br /&gt;heaters, which is at high pressure. These will rush in to the turbine and overspeed&lt;br /&gt;will be there in turbine. So non-return valves are provided in steam extraction lines&lt;br /&gt;to prevent over speeding of turbine.&lt;br /&gt;19. What is the function of the steam traps?&lt;br /&gt;During startup the steam traps will bypass turbine drains.&lt;br /&gt;20. What do the term sensible heat and latent heat mean?&lt;br /&gt;Sensible heat: We can measure the rise in temperature. When we add more heat to a&lt;br /&gt;substance. Example – heat that added to water from 0º C to 100º C. This added heat&lt;br /&gt;is measured as sensible heat.&lt;br /&gt;Latent heat: Though there is addition of heat there will be no rise in temperature.&lt;br /&gt;This is latent heat. Example – when water boils at 100º C though we added more&lt;br /&gt;heat the temperature remains at 100º C till all water becomes steam.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 95 -&lt;br /&gt;21. How are the generator rotor and stator cooled?&lt;br /&gt;Passing highly DM water through the hollow conductor of the generator cools&lt;br /&gt;generator stator and rotor is cooled by hydrogen.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 96 -&lt;br /&gt;22. What is function of seal oil system?&lt;br /&gt;Seal oil prevents the leakage of hydrogen from the generator casing to the&lt;br /&gt;atmosphere, where it can form explosive mixture. Seal oil is at higher pressure than&lt;br /&gt;hydrogen.&lt;br /&gt;23. What are the base load and peak load power stations?&lt;br /&gt;During certain periods the load demands are very high. Example the morning when&lt;br /&gt;all factories operate. During these time certain power plants like thermal plants gives&lt;br /&gt;this extra power required. These are the Peak load stations, which operates at certain&lt;br /&gt;periods.&lt;br /&gt;But during the rest of period that is when there is no peak power demand there are&lt;br /&gt;some power stations, which cater to the base load always runs giving power to the&lt;br /&gt;grid. These stations are producing power at constant rate. These stations can not be&lt;br /&gt;easily stopped or restated. Nuclear power station comes under Base load power&lt;br /&gt;station category.&lt;br /&gt;24. What are two types of governing system.&lt;br /&gt;Throttle governing system: In this a valve (just like tap water controlling) which&lt;br /&gt;reduces the steam pressure controls the steam flow. This has very less efficiency.&lt;br /&gt;Nozzle governing: In this the steam floe is reduced but the pressure remains the&lt;br /&gt;same. This is achieved by four valves in which when one is closed to 25% of steam&lt;br /&gt;is reduced. This is efficient way of governing.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 97 -&lt;br /&gt;Conventional system&lt;br /&gt;1. How turbine oil purification is achieved?&lt;br /&gt;Oil purification is achieved by centrifugal operation.&lt;br /&gt;2. Why morpholine is used?&lt;br /&gt;Morpholine is used for pH control.&lt;br /&gt;3. By which material condenser tubes are made?&lt;br /&gt;Condenser tubes are made up of aluminium brass.&lt;br /&gt;4. How boiler level is controlled?&lt;br /&gt;Feed water control valves controls boiler level.&lt;br /&gt;5. Where magnetic filter is used?&lt;br /&gt;Magnetic filter is used in stator water lines to remove magnetic particles from the&lt;br /&gt;DM water.&lt;br /&gt;6. What is the purpose of accelerator governer?&lt;br /&gt;The purpose of accelerator governer is to cut of steam momentarily when large&lt;br /&gt;electrical loads are taken to prevent turbine speeding up.&lt;br /&gt;7. What is the use of jacking oil pump?&lt;br /&gt;Jacking oil pump is used to initial lifting of turbine rotor by hydrostatic lubrication.&lt;br /&gt;8. What is the use of supplementary oil tank?&lt;br /&gt;Supplementary oil tank is used to collect the oil drains from the CIES valves.&lt;br /&gt;9. How dearator pressure is maintained?&lt;br /&gt;Dearator pressure is normally maintained by extraction steam.&lt;br /&gt;10. How dearator pressure is maintained after turbine trip?&lt;br /&gt;Pegging steam is used to maintain dearator pressure after turbine trip.&lt;br /&gt;11. Where trust bearing is provided?&lt;br /&gt;Trust bearing is provided between HP turbine and LP turbine rotor.&lt;br /&gt;12. How dissolved oxygen control is achieved in feed water system?&lt;br /&gt;Hydrazine is added to feed water system to control dissolved oxygen.&lt;br /&gt;13. How seal oil pressure is maintained?&lt;br /&gt;Differential pressure regulator maintains the seal oil pressure at 0.7 kg / cm2 higher&lt;br /&gt;than H2 pressure.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 98 -&lt;br /&gt;14. What is used to purge hydrogen from the generator casing?&lt;br /&gt;During generator purging CO2 is used to purge out H2 from the casing.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 99 -&lt;br /&gt;15. Why class B trip is provided?&lt;br /&gt;Class B trip is provided to prevent damage and over speeding of the turbine.&lt;br /&gt;16. How lub oil supply is maintained?&lt;br /&gt;Lubrication oil is supply is maintained by outlet oil from turbine oil pumps during&lt;br /&gt;normal operation and jacking oil pump during startup.&lt;br /&gt;17. What is the function of speeder gear?&lt;br /&gt;Speed raising beyond governor takeover speed upto full speed is achieved by raising&lt;br /&gt;and lowering the speeder gear.&lt;br /&gt;18. How gland-sealing steam is supplied?&lt;br /&gt;Gland sealing speed is supplied from main steam line.&lt;br /&gt;19. Why exhaust sprays are provided?&lt;br /&gt;Over heating of last stage LP blades is avoided by exhaust sprays by CEP.&lt;br /&gt;20. What is the use of vacuum breaker?&lt;br /&gt;In case of loss of seal oil to generator seals vacuum breaker is used to bring TG to&lt;br /&gt;rest very quickly.&lt;br /&gt;21. How relay oil is supplied?&lt;br /&gt;Relay oil is supplied from the main oil pump for the operation of governing system.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 100 -&lt;br /&gt;Electrical system&lt;br /&gt;1. What are the main two divisions of MAPS electrical system and what do you&lt;br /&gt;understand by it?&lt;br /&gt;The two main divisions of MAPS electrical system are&lt;br /&gt;a. Main output system. Output system supplies power to the grid. Generated voltage&lt;br /&gt;is stepped up to 220 kV from 16.5 kV and supplied to grid.&lt;br /&gt;b. Station service system. This system supplies the load inside the power station.&lt;br /&gt;The generated voltage is stepped down to 6.6 kV and 415 V from 16.5 kV and&lt;br /&gt;supplies to auxiliary loads.&lt;br /&gt;2. List out the components of station output system.&lt;br /&gt;Main generator, Generator transformer, PT, CT, CVT, lightning arrestor, wave trap,&lt;br /&gt;main 220 kV bus, transfer bus, SF6 circuit breakers and isolators, line protection&lt;br /&gt;scheme, GT and Generator protection scheme, bus bar protection scheme etc.&lt;br /&gt;3. Why earth switches are provided in 220 kV bays?&lt;br /&gt;When bay CB trips, both end (station and grid) CB will trip. The earth switches are&lt;br /&gt;provided because the grid will always be alive so to prevent any shocks to the&lt;br /&gt;operator or maintenance personnel who is working on the line or bay due to&lt;br /&gt;accidental energizing of the bus.&lt;br /&gt;4. What is the purpose of CVT (capacitance voltage transformer)?&lt;br /&gt;Purposes of CVT are&lt;br /&gt;a. To indicate if line is charged or not.&lt;br /&gt;b. To synchronize grid with generator.&lt;br /&gt;c. For power line communication and carrier tripping.&lt;br /&gt;5. What are the protections provided for 220 kV lines and bus bars?&lt;br /&gt;a. Bus bar differential protection.&lt;br /&gt;b. Distance protection.&lt;br /&gt;c. Over current protection.&lt;br /&gt;d. Earth fault protection.&lt;br /&gt;6. What are the main sources of power supply to 6.6 kV buses?&lt;br /&gt;a. Unit transformer which steps down the generated voltage to 6.6 kV from the&lt;br /&gt;generator.&lt;br /&gt;b. Start up transformer, which steps down the grid voltage to 6.6 kV.&lt;br /&gt;7. List some important loads to 6.6 kV buses.&lt;br /&gt;a. Auxiliary transformers.&lt;br /&gt;b. PHT motors.&lt;br /&gt;c. BFP motors.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 101 -&lt;br /&gt;d. CEP motors.&lt;br /&gt;e. CCW motors.&lt;br /&gt;f. Chiller motors.&lt;br /&gt;g. Pressuring pump motors.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 102 -&lt;br /&gt;8. What type breakers are provided in 6.6 kV buses?&lt;br /&gt;ABB. Make, SF6 gas, 1250A and 2000A capacity circuit breakers are provided in&lt;br /&gt;6.6 kV buses.&lt;br /&gt;9. What is the difference in action of lock out pressure signal on 6.6 kV and 220 kV&lt;br /&gt;breakers?&lt;br /&gt;When lock out signal comes to 6.6 kV breakers the breaker will trip. Where as in&lt;br /&gt;case of 220 kV breakers the breaker will not trip. If the breaker is open it will be&lt;br /&gt;open only and can not be closed. If it is in closed condition it will be closed.&lt;br /&gt;10. For how long 220 V DC batteries can supply power UPS?&lt;br /&gt;220 V DC batteries can supply Power UPS for 30 minutes. Within this time class III&lt;br /&gt;power supply should be restored by DG’s.&lt;br /&gt;11. What do you understand by station black out?&lt;br /&gt;When class IV and class III power supply fails and DG’s cannot be started and also&lt;br /&gt;this condition prevails for 5 minutes then it is called station black out condition.&lt;br /&gt;12. What are the sources of power supply to class I bus?&lt;br /&gt;a. Through control UPS 240 V AC.&lt;br /&gt;b. Through control UPS 220 V DC backed by 220 V batteries.&lt;br /&gt;c. Through control UPS 48 V DC backed by 48 V batteries.&lt;br /&gt;13. What are the lighting systems adopted in KGS?&lt;br /&gt;There are two systems.&lt;br /&gt;a. Normal lighting with class IV power supply.&lt;br /&gt;b. Emergency lighting with class II power supplies and in control room with class I&lt;br /&gt;power supplies.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 103 -&lt;br /&gt;Measuring instruments&lt;br /&gt;1. What are the two main classifications of analog instruments?&lt;br /&gt;The two main classifications of instruments are,&lt;br /&gt;a. Absolute instruments. Example tangent galvanometer.&lt;br /&gt;b. Secondary instruments. Example ammeter, voltmeter. Analog instruments are&lt;br /&gt;classified according to their electrical quantity they measure. Example frequency&lt;br /&gt;meter, voltmeter, etc. Principles they work are moving coil, induction.&lt;br /&gt;2. What are three types of secondary instruments?&lt;br /&gt;The three types of secondary instruments are,&lt;br /&gt;a. Indicating type: It only indicates the electrical quantity measured. Example:&lt;br /&gt;Ammeter, Voltmeter, Frequency meter etc.&lt;br /&gt;b. Integrating type: It integrates (sums up) the quantity being measured. Example:&lt;br /&gt;Energy meter.&lt;br /&gt;c. Recording meter: It records as well as indicates the electrical quantity being&lt;br /&gt;measured. Example: 3 pen graphical recorder.&lt;br /&gt;3. Give three operating forces acting on indicating instruments.&lt;br /&gt;a. Deflecting force.&lt;br /&gt;b. Controlling force.&lt;br /&gt;c. Damping force.&lt;br /&gt;4. What are the advantages of digital instruments over analog instruments?&lt;br /&gt;a. Human errors are avoided (comparative error) because the output is displayed in&lt;br /&gt;form of numbers.&lt;br /&gt;b. Power consumption of digital meters are low as compared to analog meters.&lt;br /&gt;5. What is the range of resistances that can be measured using following.&lt;br /&gt;a. Wheatstone bridge – 1 milli Ω to 11 MΩ.&lt;br /&gt;b. Kelvins double bridge – 0.2 micro Ω to 11 Ω.&lt;br /&gt;c. Megger – Insulation resistances more than 100 kΩ&lt;br /&gt;6. What do you understand by tan delta for a insulating material?&lt;br /&gt;Tan delta measurement is done to find the qualities of insulating material. Tan delta&lt;br /&gt;is angle between current due to surface leakage or current due to capacitance and the&lt;br /&gt;capacitive current. That is Tan δ = Ir / Ic.&lt;br /&gt;7. For what purposes transformer ratio meter can be used?&lt;br /&gt;Transformer ratio meter can be used for,&lt;br /&gt;a. To find the ratio of a transformer.&lt;br /&gt;b. To find the phase angle deviation of primary and secondary voltage of&lt;br /&gt;transformer.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 104 -&lt;br /&gt;c. To find the magnitude of magnetizing currents.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 105 -&lt;br /&gt;8. Draw connection diagram of ammeter, voltmeter, energy meter, and wattmeter.&lt;br /&gt;9. Illustrate how can you use a single-phase wattmeter to measure 3 phase reactive&lt;br /&gt;power in a circuit?&lt;br /&gt;We can measure reactive power of 3 phase circuit by dingle phase wattmeter by&lt;br /&gt;connecting the current coil in series with a line or load and connecting the pressure&lt;br /&gt;coil across the other two lines.&lt;br /&gt;Reactive power = 3√ V * I * sinϕ Watts.&lt;br /&gt;10. Draw the basic block diagram of digital meter and explain the function of each&lt;br /&gt;block.&lt;br /&gt;Alternator A/D converter BCD counter decoder &amp;amp; LCD display&lt;br /&gt;Vx&lt;br /&gt;Alternator: It reduces the unknown voltage to a small value. Because the reference&lt;br /&gt;voltage is very less and the unknown voltage is maximum.&lt;br /&gt;A/D converter: It converts the analog signal from alternator to digital signals.&lt;br /&gt;BCD counter: It counts the number of pulses (binary counter).&lt;br /&gt;Decoder and display: It decodes the binary code to decimal form and gives a visual&lt;br /&gt;display of it.&lt;br /&gt;11. Draw a neat sketch and explain the use of CT and PT for measurement of power in a&lt;br /&gt;single-phase circuit?&lt;br /&gt;If wattmeter of proper range is not available or if voltage and current ranges are high&lt;br /&gt;we can usr CT and PT of suitable ratio. Connect the CT and PT as shown in figure.&lt;br /&gt;The reading of wattmeter can be multiplied by the ratio to get the actual power.&lt;br /&gt;CT PT&lt;br /&gt;CC&lt;br /&gt;WATT METER&lt;br /&gt;PC&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 106 -&lt;br /&gt;12. Explain the construction and working of moving coil instrument.&lt;br /&gt;Construction: The moving part is a coil wound on a light aluminium frame,&lt;br /&gt;mounted on a shaft made of stainless steel which is pivoted at either ends on jewel&lt;br /&gt;bearing made of sapphire. The coil is placed between poles of a permanent magnet.&lt;br /&gt;Moving system is made light as far as possible to have high torque and weight ratio.&lt;br /&gt;There are two phosphor bronze springs of very less resistance. This is used as&lt;br /&gt;terminals for the current to pass through the coil and out of coil. It is also serves the&lt;br /&gt;purpose of control force.&lt;br /&gt;Aluminium coil former acts as a damping device by eddy current damping. There is&lt;br /&gt;a knife edge pointer and a counter weight to avoid its sagging.&lt;br /&gt;Working: When ever a current carrying conductor is placed in a magnetic field a&lt;br /&gt;force is experiences by the conductor. Moving coil meters work on this principle.&lt;br /&gt;Force = BINL&lt;br /&gt;As the BNL is constant, force (F) is directly proportional to current (I).&lt;br /&gt;That is FαI. Where B is magnetic flux, N is number of turns and L is length of coil.&lt;br /&gt;13. Explain the procedure for measurement of earth resistance.&lt;br /&gt;14. Explain the working principle of wheat stone’s bridge along with equations under&lt;br /&gt;balanced condition. B&lt;br /&gt;P kG Q&lt;br /&gt;I1 I1&lt;br /&gt;A I2 G&lt;br /&gt;I2 D&lt;br /&gt;X S&lt;br /&gt;C&lt;br /&gt;Wheat stone’s bridge works on kirchoff’s law. It is used to measure medium range&lt;br /&gt;resistances. P and Q are fixed standard resistances. S is standard variable resistances.&lt;br /&gt;X is the unknown resistance. G is galvanometer, kG is galvanometer switch and kB&lt;br /&gt;is battery switch. No current will flow through galvanometer if the potentials across&lt;br /&gt;its terminals are equal. So there will be no deflection of galvanometer. This condition&lt;br /&gt;is called the balanced condition.&lt;br /&gt;This is achieved by varying S and also by varying P/Q ratio.&lt;br /&gt;At balanced condition VAB = VAC And VBD = VCD&lt;br /&gt;I1&lt;br /&gt;*&lt;br /&gt;P = I2*X &amp;amp; I1*Q = I2*S&lt;br /&gt;Dividing both I1&lt;br /&gt;*&lt;br /&gt;P = I2*X&lt;br /&gt;I1*Q = I2*S&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 107 -&lt;br /&gt;= P/Q = X/S&lt;br /&gt;Unknown resistance (X) = P/Q * S Ω&lt;br /&gt;15. Explain the working principle of Kelvins double bridge and procedure for the&lt;br /&gt;measurement of terminal resistance.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 108 -&lt;br /&gt;Protective relays and application&lt;br /&gt;1. What you mean by accuracy limit factor?&lt;br /&gt;The ratio between the accuracy limited primary current to rated primary current is&lt;br /&gt;called the accuracy limit factor.&lt;br /&gt;2. What is the characteristic of inverse time over current relay?&lt;br /&gt;If the fault current increases the time of the operation of the relay will be decreases.&lt;br /&gt;3. What are the two errors in instrument transformer?&lt;br /&gt;a. Ratio error.&lt;br /&gt;b. Phase angle error.&lt;br /&gt;4. Where core balance CT is used?&lt;br /&gt;Core balance CT is used in earth fault protection.&lt;br /&gt;5. Define knee point voltage of a CT.&lt;br /&gt;When the primary of a CT is open circuited and supply (variable) of system&lt;br /&gt;frequency is given to secondary, then a 10% increase in voltage constitutes 50%&lt;br /&gt;increase in current. That voltage is the knee point voltage.&lt;br /&gt;At this point the core is saturated and a little increase in voltage constitutes a great&lt;br /&gt;increase in current. kpv decides the opening range of the CT. Above kpv the ratio of&lt;br /&gt;transformer will not be applicable.&lt;br /&gt;kpv = RCT + RLEADS + RRELAY&lt;br /&gt;6. What do you mean by the term 5P10?&lt;br /&gt;This indicates the type of relay, Its % error and accuracy limit factor.&lt;br /&gt;5 – composite error (Phase angle error + ratio error) 5%.&lt;br /&gt;P – Protection CT.&lt;br /&gt;10 – Accuracy limit factor.&lt;br /&gt;7. Mention the important properties of relay contacts.&lt;br /&gt;a. Should be robust in construction.&lt;br /&gt;b. Self-cleaning (oxides easily breakdown).&lt;br /&gt;c. Corrosion resistant.&lt;br /&gt;d. Bounces free and striction free (low contact resistance).&lt;br /&gt;e. Able to carry rated continuous current and short time rated current.&lt;br /&gt;8. What is a composite error and write down the formula for composite error?&lt;br /&gt;Basically composite error = Ratio error + Phase angle error. It is the ratio error&lt;br /&gt;integrated over one cycle at steady state of operation.&lt;br /&gt;Composite error =100 * 1 oςT (kn * Is – Ip)2 dt&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 109 -&lt;br /&gt;T Ip&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 110 -&lt;br /&gt;9. Define pickup value and reset value.&lt;br /&gt;Pickup value: It is the smallest value of actuating quantity when its value is increased&lt;br /&gt;from zero to pickup value, the relay will energise.&lt;br /&gt;Drop out value: It is the largest value of the actuating quantity when its value is&lt;br /&gt;decreased from pickup value, the relay will reset or de-energize.&lt;br /&gt;10. Draw the circuit diagram for finding out the knee point voltage and explain the&lt;br /&gt;procedure.&lt;br /&gt;0 – 5 A&lt;br /&gt;A CT&lt;br /&gt;V 0 – 300V Sec Primary&lt;br /&gt;240 V AC&lt;br /&gt;Variac V Saturation&lt;br /&gt;kpv = RCT + RLEADS + RRELAY&lt;br /&gt;Knee point&lt;br /&gt;Ankle point A&lt;br /&gt;Connect the circuit as shown. O/P of variac should be zero. Increase it to 5 Volts and&lt;br /&gt;take down the value of current from the ammeter. Now increase the voltage by 10%&lt;br /&gt;(5 + 10% = 5.5 V) and take the current reading. Now increase the voltage by 10%&lt;br /&gt;(5.5 V +0.55 V =6.05 V) and note down the current. Now keep on increasing voltage&lt;br /&gt;by 10% and note down current reading. At some value there will be 50% increase in&lt;br /&gt;current for 10% increase in voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Example 40 V􀃆 0.2 A&lt;br /&gt;40.4 V􀃆 0.3 A (0.2 + 50% = 0.3 A).&lt;br /&gt;That point is the knee point voltage of that particular CT. From this point onwards a&lt;br /&gt;little increase in voltage will lead to a large increase in current, because the core is&lt;br /&gt;saturated fully. When we plot all the values on a graph taking current as X-axis and&lt;br /&gt;voltage as Y-axis, we will get the above graph. Protective relays operate between&lt;br /&gt;ankle point and knee point. Above this they cannot detect the fault correctly.&lt;br /&gt;Measuring CT operate in the ankle region.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 111 -&lt;br /&gt;11. Explain the procedure for finding out the polarity and ratio test in a CT with circuit&lt;br /&gt;diagram.&lt;br /&gt;Polarity test: Connect the circuit as shown in figure with a battery, switch and&lt;br /&gt;AVOmeter. Now momentarily close the switch S and see the deflection in the&lt;br /&gt;AVOmeter. If it is in the direction as shown in the figure, then the polarity of the CT&lt;br /&gt;is correct. If it is in opposite direction the polarity of CT is not correct. Polarity test is&lt;br /&gt;very important because if polarity is not correct in differential protection the relay&lt;br /&gt;will fail to act when fault occurs.&lt;br /&gt;Ratio test: Connect circuit as shown in figure (2). Slowly increase the current. Take&lt;br /&gt;down the readings of A1 and A2. Then see whether it confirms to reading of&lt;br /&gt;nameplate. Ratio = A1/A2.&lt;br /&gt;SECONDARY INJECTION KIT&lt;br /&gt;+AVO - A A1&lt;br /&gt;0 – 30 A&lt;br /&gt;+ - 240 V AC&lt;br /&gt;S1 S2&lt;br /&gt;P1 P2&lt;br /&gt;+ -&lt;br /&gt;S B&lt;br /&gt;POLARITY TEST (FIG 1) Fig – 2 Ratio test&lt;br /&gt;Ratio – A1 : A2 A2&lt;br /&gt;A 0 – 15A&lt;br /&gt;12. Explain the principle of operation of attracted armature relay with equation and&lt;br /&gt;characteristics curve.&lt;br /&gt;Principle: It works on the principle that when a current is passed through a coil&lt;br /&gt;magnetic lines of force develop and the coil behaves like a magnet. When we place a&lt;br /&gt;magnetic material inside the coil it is attracted.&lt;br /&gt;In attracted armature type of relays there is a spring that keeps the contact open, a&lt;br /&gt;plunger that tends to close the contact and a coil through which current is passed.&lt;br /&gt;The spring force and magnetic force oppose each other. When these both are equal&lt;br /&gt;the relay will pickups.&lt;br /&gt;At verge (time) of pickup Instantaneous select&lt;br /&gt;k1 I2 = k2&lt;br /&gt;f = k1 I2 = k2 Time Time delay select&lt;br /&gt;I = k2 / k1&lt;br /&gt;Where f – force.&lt;br /&gt;k1 – magnetic force constant.&lt;br /&gt;k2 – spring tension constant. current&lt;br /&gt;I – current in the coil.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 112 -&lt;br /&gt;We can see the inverse characteristics from the above formulae. Usually attracted&lt;br /&gt;armature relays are instantaneous. That is there is no intentional (fixed) time delay. If&lt;br /&gt;we want a time delay we can add a slug in the armature core.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 113 -&lt;br /&gt;13. Mention the initial commissioning checks on CT’s, PT’s and relays.&lt;br /&gt;Commissioning checks on&lt;br /&gt;CT&lt;br /&gt;a) Terminal marking correctness.&lt;br /&gt;b) Polarity of terminals.&lt;br /&gt;c) Insulation resistance between primary and secondary.&lt;br /&gt;d) Insulation resistance between primary to earth and secondary to earth.&lt;br /&gt;e) Magnetization characteristic and knee point voltage test.&lt;br /&gt;f) Ratio test.&lt;br /&gt;PT&lt;br /&gt;a) Terminal markings.&lt;br /&gt;b) Polarity checks of terminals.&lt;br /&gt;c) Insulation resistance between primary and secondary.&lt;br /&gt;d) Insulation resistance between primary to earth and secondary to earth.&lt;br /&gt;e) Ratio test.&lt;br /&gt;f) Whether PT can supply as per the burden of load check.&lt;br /&gt;RELAYS&lt;br /&gt;a) Pickup and dropout value check.&lt;br /&gt;b) Insulation resistance of contacts and relay coil.&lt;br /&gt;c) Time delay (if relay is not instantaneous), operating time value check of relay.&lt;br /&gt;d) See that the correct circuit breaker trips on energisation of the particular relay.&lt;br /&gt;e) Continuity checks of contacts after energisation of relay.&lt;br /&gt;f) See if plug-shorting contacts are correct.&lt;br /&gt;g) See if CT’s and PT’s are corrected in correct polarity.&lt;br /&gt;h) Burden check of relay.&lt;br /&gt;i) Primary injection test.&lt;br /&gt;j) Secondary injection test.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 114 -&lt;br /&gt;14. Explain with simple diagram the core balance CT.&lt;br /&gt;In core balance CT all the three phases go through the core and the resultant&lt;br /&gt;magnetic flux is zero. Because the flux of three phases cancel each other. So the&lt;br /&gt;secondary output of CT is zero and the relay will not energise.&lt;br /&gt;When there is a earth fault in one of the phase the fluxes cannot balance each other&lt;br /&gt;and there is a voltage induced in secondary of the CT and the relay is energised to&lt;br /&gt;trip the circuit. Saturation is no problem because the core size is very big.&lt;br /&gt;+R&lt;br /&gt;Ground fault&lt;br /&gt;R R Y&lt;br /&gt;Relay dropped Relay pickup&lt;br /&gt;B R&lt;br /&gt;R Y B R Y B - R&lt;br /&gt;Normal operation. During earth fault. Resultant diagram.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 115 -&lt;br /&gt;Logics and circuits&lt;br /&gt;1. Give the definition of following.&lt;br /&gt;27C Closing circuit supervisory relay&lt;br /&gt;27T Tripping circuit supervisory relay&lt;br /&gt;3C Interposing relay (closing coil)&lt;br /&gt;3T Tripping coil&lt;br /&gt;52 AC circuit breaker&lt;br /&gt;88 Auxillary motor (spring charging motor)&lt;br /&gt;52Y Anti-pumping relay&lt;br /&gt;86.1 Lockout relay&lt;br /&gt;42 Main contactor&lt;br /&gt;50 Instantaneous over current relay&lt;br /&gt;50N Earth fault relay&lt;br /&gt;94 Trip or Trip free relay&lt;br /&gt;49 Thermal overload relay&lt;br /&gt;49S Stalling protection relay&lt;br /&gt;27 Supervisory relay&lt;br /&gt;64 Ground protection relay&lt;br /&gt;2. What is the operating voltage of 3C?&lt;br /&gt;48V DC.&lt;br /&gt;3. DC relay coil or contactor coils must be connected to which side?&lt;br /&gt;Negative side of the DC supply to avoid galvanic effect on the coil, which will corrode the coil.&lt;br /&gt;4. How special current limiting resistance is connected with the seal in contact?&lt;br /&gt;Special current limiting resistance is connected in series with the seal in contact.&lt;br /&gt;5. How you will connect start and stop push button to control the motor from two different places?&lt;br /&gt;Start push button should be connected in parallel and stop push button in series in the circuit.&lt;br /&gt;6. What are the basic principles of ED?&lt;br /&gt;Basic principles of ED are,&lt;br /&gt;a) All the contacts of corresponding relays and contactors are shown in de-energised condition.&lt;br /&gt;b) Control circuit gives us idea about ON / OFF selection of motor, fuse rating, forward reverse&lt;br /&gt;control, seal in protections etc.&lt;br /&gt;c) Power circuits are drawn in thick lines and control circuits are drawn in thin lines.&lt;br /&gt;d) When relay or contactor energises normally open contact closes and normally closed contact&lt;br /&gt;opens.&lt;br /&gt;e) Auxillary contacts acts with main device such as contactors and relay.&lt;br /&gt;7. What is anti pumping?&lt;br /&gt;When a breaker is closed on fault condition there will be continuous tripping and closing of the&lt;br /&gt;breaker because 3C is energized. Anti pumping in circuit avoids frequent tripping and closing of&lt;br /&gt;circuit breaker when the breaker is closed in fault condition.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 116 -&lt;br /&gt;Switchgear&lt;br /&gt;1. Mention the commissioning tests on breaker and bus bars.&lt;br /&gt;Breaker&lt;br /&gt;a. Milli volt drops test between the interrupting contacts and between the isolator&lt;br /&gt;contacts.&lt;br /&gt;b. Closing and opening timing of the breaker for 5 times.&lt;br /&gt;c. Checking whether the breaker trips or closes when the logics are fulfilled.&lt;br /&gt;Bus bars&lt;br /&gt;a. Milli volts drop test for the contact resistance value.&lt;br /&gt;b. Tightness of the joints.&lt;br /&gt;c. IR values between phase to phase and phase to ground.&lt;br /&gt;2. Explain clearly the three positions in 415 V breaker.&lt;br /&gt;a. Service position: Power connections and control connections are available to the&lt;br /&gt;breaker.&lt;br /&gt;b. Test position: Power connections are cut off but control connections are available&lt;br /&gt;to the breaker and it can be tested.&lt;br /&gt;c. Disconnect position or rack out position: This is for maintenance of the breaker&lt;br /&gt;and in this positions both the control and power connections are not available.&lt;br /&gt;3. What do mean by trip free system in breaker?&lt;br /&gt;In trip free the breaker is free to trip at any time. If both close and trip signal is&lt;br /&gt;present at same time (instant) the breaker will attempt to close and positively trip.&lt;br /&gt;When the breaker trips it will not close again even if closing signal exists because of&lt;br /&gt;anti pumping feature.&lt;br /&gt;4. What is the purpose of spring charging in 415 V breaker?&lt;br /&gt;If the breaker is to be closed and tripped manually the closing time and tripping time&lt;br /&gt;would vary from person to person. Also it would not be very fast. So spring charging&lt;br /&gt;is provided. It gives uniform timings irrespective of the operator and its action is fast&lt;br /&gt;and closing and tripping time is very less.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 117 -&lt;br /&gt;5. What are the built in protections provided in 415 V breaker?&lt;br /&gt;a. DINF (making current magnetic release)&lt;br /&gt;This consists of a laminated magnetic circuit. This is placed under the lower&lt;br /&gt;current terminal pole. This is provided for all the three poles. It has a core that&lt;br /&gt;rotates in the air gap. It is held by spring. During protection the magnetic forces&lt;br /&gt;developed overcome the spring tension and the core is attracted. The mechanical&lt;br /&gt;force developed is used to trip the breaker. This protection acts during the closing&lt;br /&gt;of breaker if any fault exists. The current is set to 5 times the rated current.&lt;br /&gt;b. DIRS (short time magnetic release)&lt;br /&gt;The construction is same as DINF, but it has a mechanical timer, which can be set&lt;br /&gt;accordingly. This protection acts when any fault comes during breaker in service.&lt;br /&gt;The current rating is set to 3 to 8 times the rated current.&lt;br /&gt;c. DIT – S (thermal over load protection)&lt;br /&gt;This consists of a three bimetallic strip, which gets heated up when over loaded&lt;br /&gt;and trips the breaker by a lever. It is placed in front of the breaker. Setting range&lt;br /&gt;is 60% to 100%.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 118 -&lt;br /&gt;MCC&lt;br /&gt;1. What are the advantages of MCC?&lt;br /&gt;a. Starters and contactors all will be a standard size.&lt;br /&gt;b. Spares inventory will be less.&lt;br /&gt;c. Cost of cables will be less because same size of cable is used for all capacity and&lt;br /&gt;gland holes can be provided before hand.&lt;br /&gt;d. Maintenance and trouble shooting is easier in MCC.&lt;br /&gt;2. What type of motor starting adopted in MCC?&lt;br /&gt;DOL (direct on line) starter.&lt;br /&gt;3. What is the purpose of grounding secondary of the control transformer?&lt;br /&gt;To protect the operating personnel from high induced voltage.&lt;br /&gt;4. Based on what factors will you select rating of components for a starter cell?&lt;br /&gt;Factors for selecting rating of components are,&lt;br /&gt;a. Capacity of load.&lt;br /&gt;b. Type of starting.&lt;br /&gt;c. Duty (continuous or intermittent).&lt;br /&gt;d. Type of protection.&lt;br /&gt;e. Nature of starting (acceleration time is slow or fast).&lt;br /&gt;5. What maintenance checks you will do for an MCC cells and MCC panel?&lt;br /&gt;Maintenance checks on MCC cells&lt;br /&gt;a. Ensure that the load is tripped from control room and switch is in off position.&lt;br /&gt;Switch off the isolator at MCC cell.&lt;br /&gt;b. Open the door and rack out the cell into isolation position.&lt;br /&gt;c. Check the tightness of terminal of contactor, 3C, control transformer, control&lt;br /&gt;fuses, wipe in contacts, power cables, etc.&lt;br /&gt;d. Check the tightness of component mounted.&lt;br /&gt;e. Look for any charred components or terminals.&lt;br /&gt;f. Check the IR value of 3C, contactor, control transformer, isolator etc.&lt;br /&gt;g. Check the isolator double switch feature.&lt;br /&gt;h. Check the OLR and calibrate the OLR.&lt;br /&gt;i. Check the pick and drop out value of contactor, 3C.&lt;br /&gt;j. Check the fuses for healthiness and fuse carriers for proper contacts.&lt;br /&gt;k. Clean the arc-chutes of the contactor and clean all the components of the MCC&lt;br /&gt;cell properly.&lt;br /&gt;l. Check the resistances of control transformer, contactor, 3C etc.&lt;br /&gt;m. Check the tightness of control cable at main TB compartment.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 119 -&lt;br /&gt;Maintenance on MCC panel.&lt;br /&gt;a. Ensure the permit and all isolations.&lt;br /&gt;b. Open the bus bar chamber and discharge the bus bar.&lt;br /&gt;c. Disconnect the cables connected to bus bar and take the IR value of bus bar and&lt;br /&gt;cable individually. Connect it properly and tight it to proper torque.&lt;br /&gt;d. Check the tightness of nut and bolts and cables connected to buses.&lt;br /&gt;e. Open the main TB compartment and check the tightness of all cables and clean it.&lt;br /&gt;f. See the tightness of power terminal compartment and clean it.&lt;br /&gt;g. Check that cables are supported properly.&lt;br /&gt;h. Do checks on CT, PT used for indication purposes.&lt;br /&gt;i. Clean the entire MCC panel properly and take the IR value.&lt;br /&gt;j. Carry the checks on relays, which are used in the MCC panel.&lt;br /&gt;k. See for proper earthing connection and tightness of the earthing connections.&lt;br /&gt;l. See for proper house keeping.&lt;br /&gt;6. What is the difference between an auto reset and manual reset overload relay?&lt;br /&gt;a. Auto reset relay closes its contacts when the bimetallic strip gets cooled. In&lt;br /&gt;manual reset relay we have to manually reset the relay because even though&lt;br /&gt;bimetallic strip cools its contacts are not closing without manual reset. L &amp;amp; T type&lt;br /&gt;OLR have only manual reset and siemens type has both manual and auto facility.&lt;br /&gt;b. Auto reset over load relay is reset by switching OFF the respective had switch&lt;br /&gt;and again switching it ON.&lt;br /&gt;c. Manual over load relay is reseted by pushing the reset button provided on the&lt;br /&gt;MCC cell.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 120 -&lt;br /&gt;Batteries and charger&lt;br /&gt;1. How you will prepare electrolyte for a lead acid battery?&lt;br /&gt;While preparing electrolyte for lead acid battery sulphuric acid is added to distilled&lt;br /&gt;water.&lt;br /&gt;2. How battery capacity is expressed?&lt;br /&gt;Always battery capacity is expressed in Ampere – hour.&lt;br /&gt;3. What is the instrument used to measure the specific gravity?&lt;br /&gt;The instrument used to measure the specific gravity is called Hydrometer.&lt;br /&gt;4. What you mean by SCR?&lt;br /&gt;SCR is meant for silicon controlled rectifier.&lt;br /&gt;5. Define specific gravity and mention the specific gravity of a fully charged lead acid&lt;br /&gt;battery?&lt;br /&gt;Specific gravity of a substance is the comparison of density of the substance with the&lt;br /&gt;density of pure water.&lt;br /&gt;Specific gravity = Density of the substance / density of pure water.&lt;br /&gt;= kg / cm2&lt;br /&gt;kg / cm2&lt;br /&gt;= (No unit)&lt;br /&gt;Specific gravity is only number. It has no unit.&lt;br /&gt;Specific gravity of pure water is one.&lt;br /&gt;Specific gravity of fully charged lead acid battery is 1.215. Specific gravity should&lt;br /&gt;always be corrected to 27°C.&lt;br /&gt;Corrected specific gravity is equal to indicated specific gravity ± (t - 27°C)*0.0007.&lt;br /&gt;Indicated specific gravity = 1.205 and ‘t’ means electrolyte temperature.&lt;br /&gt;6. What are the parts of the battery?&lt;br /&gt;Parts of the battery are&lt;br /&gt;a. Battery container.&lt;br /&gt;b. Battery cover.&lt;br /&gt;c. Positive plate (Pb o2).&lt;br /&gt;d. Negative plate (Pb).&lt;br /&gt;e. Cell connector.&lt;br /&gt;f. Grid.&lt;br /&gt;g. Cell separator (porous material).&lt;br /&gt;h. Sediment chamber.&lt;br /&gt;i. Positive and negative terminals.&lt;br /&gt;j. Vent plugs.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 121 -&lt;br /&gt;k. Dilutes sulphuric acid (electrolyte).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 122 -&lt;br /&gt;7. What are the indications of a fully charged cell?&lt;br /&gt;a. The colour of the + ve plates will be dark brown. This can be seen only if the&lt;br /&gt;battery has transparent cover.&lt;br /&gt;b. Voltage per cell will be a 2.15 volts.&lt;br /&gt;c. Gassing in the will electrolyte will indicate. But the current is splitting up water to&lt;br /&gt;H2 and O2. Because the positive and negative plates are fully converted to their&lt;br /&gt;original constituents.&lt;br /&gt;8. What are the difference between primary cell and secondary cell?&lt;br /&gt;Primary cell: The electrolyte in primary cell is chemically irreversible. That is once&lt;br /&gt;the cell is discharged it cannot be recharged. It should be replaced with a new cell.&lt;br /&gt;The cells can supply only low currents and have low efficiency. They supply&lt;br /&gt;intermittent current. Their internal resistance is more. These cells are comparatively&lt;br /&gt;cheap.&lt;br /&gt;Secondary cell: These cells are chemically reversible. They can be discharged and&lt;br /&gt;charged. They can supply large currents because their internal resistance is less.&lt;br /&gt;These have high efficiency compare to primary cells. These can supply constant&lt;br /&gt;current. These are comparatively costly.&lt;br /&gt;9. What do you mean by sulphation? And what are the effects of sulphation?&lt;br /&gt;Sulphation: During normal discharge of battery Pb so4 is formed. This Pb so4 is&lt;br /&gt;chemically reversible by passing current. These split up to their original constituents.&lt;br /&gt;But under certain condition crystalline lead sulphate is formed (Example: under&lt;br /&gt;charging after some time without trickle charging). This Pb so4 is chemically&lt;br /&gt;irreversible. So if the sulphation occurs the battery life decreases. Efficiency&lt;br /&gt;decreases and the active material starts falling of the grid.&lt;br /&gt;10. Write down the equation for Nickel cadmium battery.&lt;br /&gt;Equation for Nickel cadmium battery.&lt;br /&gt;Ni (OH4) + Cd +2 kOH 􀃆Ni (OH2) + Cd OH2 + kOH (during charging)&lt;br /&gt;(Nickel hydrate + cadmium + potassium hydroxide 􀃆 Nickel hydroxide + cadmium&lt;br /&gt;hydroxide + potassium hydroxide.)&lt;br /&gt;Ni (OH2) + Cd OH2 + kOH 􀃆 Ni (OH4) + Cd +2 kOH (during discharge)&lt;br /&gt;We see that there is no change in electrolyte. It just acts as a catalyst. So there is no&lt;br /&gt;need to change the electrolyte.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 123 -&lt;br /&gt;11. Write down the theory of lead acid battery.&lt;br /&gt;A simple lead acid battery consists of positive and negative electrodes Immersed in&lt;br /&gt;an electrolyte. The positive electrodes are Pbo2 (lead oxide) and the negative&lt;br /&gt;electrodes are Pb (spongy lead). The electrolyte is dilute sulphuric acid.&lt;br /&gt;On discharging the battery&lt;br /&gt;Pbo2 + Pb +2 H2 so4 􀃆Pbso4 + Pbso4 + 2 H2o&lt;br /&gt;Lead acid is converted into lead sulphate. Spongy lead is also converted into lead&lt;br /&gt;sulphate and H2 so4 used up in the process. Only water is remain. So the specific&lt;br /&gt;gravity of the cell comes down.&lt;br /&gt;On charging the battery&lt;br /&gt;Pbso4 + Pbso4 + 2 H2o 􀃆 Pbo2 + Pb +2 H2 so4&lt;br /&gt;Here the products are converted to their original constituents and the acid is released.&lt;br /&gt;So the specific gravity rises as the cell is charged. How much ever larger be the cell&lt;br /&gt;the voltage of each cell will be approx. 2.15 V when fully charged.&lt;br /&gt;The positive plate is made of a paste lead oxide, lead sulphate that is fitted in a mesh&lt;br /&gt;like material and is connected to grid. All positive plates are made common and&lt;br /&gt;connected to a grid.&lt;br /&gt;The negative plate is made of spongy lead also it is in mesh and connected to grid.&lt;br /&gt;These are also grouped together.&lt;br /&gt;These plates are separated by a micro porous separator for the diffusion of&lt;br /&gt;electrolyte.&lt;br /&gt;The electrolyte is prepared by adding sulphuric acid to distilled water drops by drop&lt;br /&gt;and stirring it until the reasoned specific gravity is attained.&lt;br /&gt;Every thing is placed in a container of hard rubber. The cells of a battery are&lt;br /&gt;connected by a cell connector. The container is leak proof.&lt;br /&gt;12. What are the parts of a 48V DC charger?&lt;br /&gt;Main transformer: This steps down the 3Φ 415V supply to the require value of&lt;br /&gt;voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Synchronizing transformer for phase sequence: This gives the synchronizing signal&lt;br /&gt;to the firing card. That is, the pulses from this card if fed to the firing card. The firing&lt;br /&gt;card gives pulses to the SCR of R or Y or B depending upon which phase is positive&lt;br /&gt;maximum.&lt;br /&gt;Half control module: This has a diode and a SCR for each phase. The firing card&lt;br /&gt;controls the firing angle of SCR.&lt;br /&gt;Firing card: This gives the firing pulses to SCR depending on phase sequence and&lt;br /&gt;the feed back from output.&lt;br /&gt;Controller card: This card monitors the output and gives signal to firing card to&lt;br /&gt;conduct at certain angle to maintain constant output voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Power supply card: This gives power supply for the controller card, firing card and&lt;br /&gt;protection.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 124 -&lt;br /&gt;13. Explain the operation of 48 V battery charger.&lt;br /&gt;The supply for the charger is from MCC. The supply is tapped for power supply to&lt;br /&gt;control card, PF correction capacitor. LC filter is used for suppressing surge voltage.&lt;br /&gt;The main supply is stepped down and given to the half control rectifier module. The&lt;br /&gt;SCR conducts only when gate gets positive pulse. This pulse is given by pulse&lt;br /&gt;transformer, which gets pulses from firing card. Firing card gives pulse to the&lt;br /&gt;respective RYB SCR only when their phases are positive maximum. The freewheel&lt;br /&gt;diode is incorporated to protect the SCR and diodes from back emf when supply to&lt;br /&gt;coils is cut off due to collapsing magnetic field.&lt;br /&gt;The filter is provided to smoothen the ripple output and the bleeder is used for&lt;br /&gt;voltage regulation. It gives improved voltage regulation and acts as a minimum load.&lt;br /&gt;Also it keeps the SCR in conducting state by drawing the minimum current which is&lt;br /&gt;higher than the SCR holding current. Thus there is always output voltage irrespective&lt;br /&gt;of load.&lt;br /&gt;DC CT is used for limiting output current. It works on principle of magnetic&lt;br /&gt;amplifier. There is also provision for smooth rising of output voltage.&lt;br /&gt;14. What is purpose of freewheeling diode and DC filter circuit in the charger?&lt;br /&gt;Freewheeling diode is used to protect the semiconductor components used in the&lt;br /&gt;charger from the back emf, which is induced in the inductive coils of relays when the&lt;br /&gt;supply to the relays is cut off. The magnetic field in the relays collapses and induces&lt;br /&gt;high voltage in reverse direction. This emf is shunted by the freewheeling diode,&lt;br /&gt;which is connected in reverse bios with the output.&lt;br /&gt;DC filter is used to smoothen the output, which has ripple. Ripple frequency is same&lt;br /&gt;as system frequency for half wave rectifier and 2 times of system frequency for full&lt;br /&gt;wave rectifier. The filter, which is a capacitor, will oppose any change in voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Thus the ripple will not be allowed to come to zero.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 125 -&lt;br /&gt;Electrical equipment fundamental&lt;br /&gt;1. Why indoor switchyard is provided in MAPS?&lt;br /&gt;The salt contamination in the switchyard is avoided by providing indoor switchyard&lt;br /&gt;in MAPS. Because the plant is just 300 metres away from the seashore and the&lt;br /&gt;atmosphere is saline. This salt will get deposited on the insulators and on the&lt;br /&gt;conductors used in the switchyard. Due to this deposition insulators may fail to&lt;br /&gt;unnecessary trip the system and conductor used must be copper for better&lt;br /&gt;performance instead of low cost aluminum. So to avoid unnecessary trip and to have&lt;br /&gt;low cost of installation and spare parts of aluminium indoor switchyard is used.&lt;br /&gt;2. What do ABCB and ACB mean?&lt;br /&gt;ABCB – Air blast circuit breaker.&lt;br /&gt;ACB – Air circuit breaker.&lt;br /&gt;3. What do you mean by frequency?&lt;br /&gt;The number of cycles per second is called the frequency.&lt;br /&gt;4. State the voltage and current relation in star and delta connection.&lt;br /&gt;In star connection line current is equal to the phase current and line voltage is √3&lt;br /&gt;times that of phase voltage.&lt;br /&gt;In delta connection line voltage is equal to the phase voltage and line current is √3&lt;br /&gt;times that of phase current.&lt;br /&gt;5. In DC motor what is the relation between speed and field flux?&lt;br /&gt;Speed of a DC motor is inversely proportional to the field flux.&lt;br /&gt;6. What is the difference between self-excited and separately excited DC generator?&lt;br /&gt;Self-excited generator: In a self-excited generator the field winding is excited by an&lt;br /&gt;external DC source like a battery etc.&lt;br /&gt;Separately excited generator: In a separately excited generator the field poles have&lt;br /&gt;some residual magnetism. When the armature is rotated a small emf is induced in it.&lt;br /&gt;This is fed to the field winding and if the current direction is such that it adds the&lt;br /&gt;residual magnetic flux to the field winding and the field strength is increased. The&lt;br /&gt;more emf in the armature, which is again fed to the field winding and goes on till the&lt;br /&gt;generator builds up voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 126 -&lt;br /&gt;Power and control cables.&lt;br /&gt;1. Define conductor.&lt;br /&gt;Conductor: A material of low resistance used to transmit electrical energy. Examle&lt;br /&gt;wires, cables, bus bars etc.&lt;br /&gt;2. Define unprotected insulated wire.&lt;br /&gt;Unprotected insulated wire: Unprotected insulated wire is which the insulation of the&lt;br /&gt;wire is not covered by a protective sheathing to prevent it from mechanical damage.&lt;br /&gt;3. Define cable.&lt;br /&gt;Cable: One or more insulated conductor enclosed in a protective mechanical&lt;br /&gt;sheathing of either GI wire or GI strip or aluminium to protect the insulation from&lt;br /&gt;mechanical damage.&lt;br /&gt;4. Define insulated wire.&lt;br /&gt;Insulated wire: A conductor or multi-stranded conductor which has a insulating&lt;br /&gt;material on it is called a insulated wire.&lt;br /&gt;5. Explain briefly about armouring for an under grounded cable.&lt;br /&gt;Armouring is required to protect the cores from mechanical damage.&lt;br /&gt;6. Explain briefly about grounding of cable trays.&lt;br /&gt;Cable trays are grounded because to avoid any shocks to personnel incase of leakage.&lt;br /&gt;A grounding wire runs at the side of tray through a parallel groove clamp through out&lt;br /&gt;the length of the cable tray. If trays are one above another we can loop up the&lt;br /&gt;grounding wire to the tray below. This saves extra ground wire.&lt;br /&gt;7. What are the differences between the power and control cable?&lt;br /&gt;Power cable: It is used for supplying current to load. It is of larger current carrying&lt;br /&gt;capacity available in single core, 2 cores, 3 cores, 3 cores, and 4 cores. Single core&lt;br /&gt;is available upto 1000 mm2. Usually power cables are of aluminium. These cables&lt;br /&gt;are graded for higher voltages and possess more cross section area.&lt;br /&gt;Control cable: Control cables are used for control purposes for logics, indication or&lt;br /&gt;annunciation etc. These are of lower current carrying capacity and voltage grading is&lt;br /&gt;also less. These are of less cross sectional area are available in pairs of 2,5,10,25,50&lt;br /&gt;etc.&lt;br /&gt;8. What is the purpose of using corrosion inhibiting compound?&lt;br /&gt;It is used for aluminium conductors while crimping to a lug or ferrule. It prevents&lt;br /&gt;corrosion of aluminium conductor due to oxidation and due to saline atmosphere.&lt;br /&gt;9. Why aluminium armouring for single core 1000 mm2 is used?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 127 -&lt;br /&gt;Aluminium armouring for single core 1000 mm2 is used so that heating will not take&lt;br /&gt;place due to the flux around the conductor, as the aluminium is a non-magnetic&lt;br /&gt;material.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 128 -&lt;br /&gt;10. What is resistance of copper compare to the aluminium?&lt;br /&gt;Copper is less resistive than aluminium.&lt;br /&gt;11. What is applied over the steel tape armour of PILC cable as serving?&lt;br /&gt;Bituminous covered jute.&lt;br /&gt;12. What is used as insulation for PILC cable?&lt;br /&gt;Impregnated paper.&lt;br /&gt;13. A small quantity of impurity reduces how much of conductivity of copper?&lt;br /&gt;35% of conductivity will be reduced due a small impurity in the conductor.&lt;br /&gt;14. Why cast aluminium tri-foil clamp is used in single core cables laying?&lt;br /&gt;When three conductors are clamped together the fluxes around the conductors are get&lt;br /&gt;cancelled&lt;br /&gt;15. What are the parts of a cable gland?&lt;br /&gt;a. Check nut.&lt;br /&gt;b. Nipple.&lt;br /&gt;c. Metal washer.&lt;br /&gt;d. Neoprene rubber.&lt;br /&gt;e. Metal washer.&lt;br /&gt;f. Compression nut.&lt;br /&gt;16. What are the advantages of PVC insulated cable?&lt;br /&gt;a. Plumbing is not required. Joints can be made easily.&lt;br /&gt;b. As PVC is light the injury caused to it while laying is less.&lt;br /&gt;c. It is corrosion resistant.&lt;br /&gt;d. It has high fire retarding property.&lt;br /&gt;e. It does not break down even if moisture enters.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 129 -&lt;br /&gt;Basic electronics&lt;br /&gt;1. How many types of logic gates are there?&lt;br /&gt;a. OR gate.&lt;br /&gt;b. AND gate.&lt;br /&gt;c. NAND gate.&lt;br /&gt;d. NOR gate.&lt;br /&gt;e. Inverter gate.&lt;br /&gt;f. Exclusive OR gate.&lt;br /&gt;g. Equivalent gate.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 130 -&lt;br /&gt;Mechanical equipment fundamentals&lt;br /&gt;1. Why feed valves are used?&lt;br /&gt;Feed valves are used to prevent back flow.&lt;br /&gt;2. What are the functions of a heat exchanger?&lt;br /&gt;The function of heat exchanger is to transfer heat efficiently and economically&lt;br /&gt;between two fluids. Heat is transferred from the fluid, which has higher temperature&lt;br /&gt;to the fluid, which has lower temperature. The modes of heat transfer are,&lt;br /&gt;a. Conduction – Heat transfer in solids by momentum of molecules.&lt;br /&gt;b. Convection – Heat transfer in liquids by movement of molecules.&lt;br /&gt;c. Radiation – Heat transfer by energy waves.&lt;br /&gt;There are three types of flow in heat exchangers&lt;br /&gt;a. Parallel flow.&lt;br /&gt;b. Counter flow.&lt;br /&gt;c. Transverse flow.&lt;br /&gt;3. Why baffle plates are used in heat exchanger?&lt;br /&gt;Baffle plates are used in heat exchanger so that the maximum heat can be transferred&lt;br /&gt;and to avoid tube sagging.&lt;br /&gt;4. How pumps are classified?&lt;br /&gt;A. Centrifugal pumps – a. Single volute&lt;br /&gt;b. Double volute&lt;br /&gt;c. Diffuser type&lt;br /&gt;d. Mixed flow&lt;br /&gt;e. Axial flow&lt;br /&gt;f. Turbine or regenerative type&lt;br /&gt;B. Rotating pumps a. Screw type&lt;br /&gt;b. Gear type&lt;br /&gt;c. Vane type&lt;br /&gt;C. Reciprocating pumps a. Piston&lt;br /&gt;b. Plunger&lt;br /&gt;c. Bucket&lt;br /&gt;5. What you mean by cavitation and NPSH?&lt;br /&gt;Cavitation: Bubbles form in the liquids whenever there is pressure reduction inside&lt;br /&gt;the pump. These bubbles collapse when they approach high-pressure areas damaging&lt;br /&gt;pump internals. This is called the cavitation.&lt;br /&gt;NPSH: Net Positive Suction Heat. It is the head available at the eye of the impeller&lt;br /&gt;corrected to vapour pressure.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 131 -&lt;br /&gt;6. Name the functions of the valve?&lt;br /&gt;a. ON and OFF service.&lt;br /&gt;b. Throttling or regulating liquid flow.&lt;br /&gt;c. Avoid back flow.&lt;br /&gt;d. Regulating pressure.&lt;br /&gt;e. Relieving pressure.&lt;br /&gt;7. What are the advantages of butterfly valve?&lt;br /&gt;a. Less holdup.&lt;br /&gt;b. No support needed.&lt;br /&gt;c. Any actuator can be used.&lt;br /&gt;d. Quick opening and closing.&lt;br /&gt;e. Less space required.&lt;br /&gt;f. Used for low-pressure low temperature and large pipelines.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 132 -&lt;br /&gt;Instrumentation fundamentals&lt;br /&gt;1. What are the classifications of industrial instrumentation?&lt;br /&gt;a. Information gathering instrumentation.&lt;br /&gt;b. Regulating instrumentation.&lt;br /&gt;c. Protective instrumentation.&lt;br /&gt;2. What are the units of pressure?&lt;br /&gt;Pounds / inch2 and kg / cm2.&lt;br /&gt;3. What is the use of BAROMETER?&lt;br /&gt;Barometer is used to measure atmospheric pressure.&lt;br /&gt;4. What are the methods used to measure the flow?&lt;br /&gt;Mechanical (float) type and ultrasonic type methods are used to measure the flow.&lt;br /&gt;5. What is the equivalent of atmospheric pressure?&lt;br /&gt;One atmospheric pressure is equal to 10 meters of water column or 760 mm of&lt;br /&gt;mercury.&lt;br /&gt;6. What method is used to measure the level?&lt;br /&gt;Bubbler method is used to measure the level.&lt;br /&gt;7. State some elements of pressure measurement.&lt;br /&gt;Manometer, Diaphragm gauges, Bellows, Strain gauges etc.&lt;br /&gt;8. State some elements of flow measurement.&lt;br /&gt;Orifice, Venturi tubes, flowrator (rotameter) etc.&lt;br /&gt;9. State some thermocouple.&lt;br /&gt;Copper – constantan, Iron – constantan.&lt;br /&gt;10. What is the purpose of instruments?&lt;br /&gt;The purpose of instruments is to measure, safeguard the process for efficient plant&lt;br /&gt;operation.&lt;br /&gt;Instruments are very accurate and fast acting. This accuracy and speed is not possible&lt;br /&gt;by human. Also in some places there may be too much heat for man to work or some&lt;br /&gt;where there may high radiation field. In such cases instruments provide remote&lt;br /&gt;operation.&lt;br /&gt;11. What is primary element and what should be its response?&lt;br /&gt;Primary element is one, which senses the condition of process, and converts it to&lt;br /&gt;some other form, which can be measured accurately. Example in a bourden gauge&lt;br /&gt;the pressure if changed to the uncoiling (displacement), which can be measured.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 133 -&lt;br /&gt;The response of primary element is that it should convert the condition in to some&lt;br /&gt;other form, which can be interpreted and measured easily.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 134 -&lt;br /&gt;12. Name some process variables, which are appropriate for our plant with examples.&lt;br /&gt;Process variables with examples, which are appropriate to our plant, are&lt;br /&gt;a. Flow – flow of D2O in PHT system.&lt;br /&gt;b. Temperature – temperature of coolant in PHT system.&lt;br /&gt;c. Level – moderator level.&lt;br /&gt;d. Speed – speed of turbine.&lt;br /&gt;e. Voltage – voltage generated by main generator.&lt;br /&gt;f. Neutron flux – number of neutrons produced in reactor during operation.&lt;br /&gt;g. pH – pH of moderator.&lt;br /&gt;13. What is use of 2/3 logic in our plant?&lt;br /&gt;All our protection instruments (system) are triplicated to have following uses.&lt;br /&gt;a. To increase system integrity.&lt;br /&gt;b. To decrease faulty trips.&lt;br /&gt;c. Maintenance can be done on one protective instrument without shutting down the&lt;br /&gt;whole system.&lt;br /&gt;We don’t want our plant (reactor) to trip just because one instrument failed. So we&lt;br /&gt;have triplication (2/3 logics) in protection instruments. The trip signal will pass if&lt;br /&gt;only two out of three switches operate. Of only one operates there will be no trip.&lt;br /&gt;This logic is used to trip the reactor in our plant.&lt;br /&gt;14. What is resistance temperature detector (RTD) and mention some examples?&lt;br /&gt;Resistance temperature detector is an instrument, which is used to measure&lt;br /&gt;temperature. This uses the property that the resistance of a metal changes (increases&lt;br /&gt;of decreases) with temperature. This is very accurate. These will be a wire, which&lt;br /&gt;will senses the temperature and changes its resistance as the temperature changes.&lt;br /&gt;This varying in resistances if measures by an external electronic or electrical circuit&lt;br /&gt;calibrated to measure temperature.&lt;br /&gt;Different types of RTD’s are Platinum, copper, nickel.&lt;br /&gt;15. What is recorder and how it is useful to our plant?&lt;br /&gt;Recorder is an instrument, which gives instantaneous values as well as records the&lt;br /&gt;values.&lt;br /&gt;Recorder can show us where a fault has occurred if reactor trips. It also gives us past&lt;br /&gt;information recorded in it. It saves human effort because an operator cannot sit and&lt;br /&gt;record the information required and it is very difficult task to an operator.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 135 -&lt;br /&gt;Fire fighting&lt;br /&gt;1. How combustion takes place?&lt;br /&gt;For combustion to take place three elements are needed. They are fuel, heat and&lt;br /&gt;oxygen. This is called the triangle fire. Combustion can not survive without these&lt;br /&gt;three. Remove any one of them, combustion ceases to take place. So wherever fuel,&lt;br /&gt;oxygen and heat is there together combustion takes place.&lt;br /&gt;2. How many types of extinction media’s are used in fire fighting?&lt;br /&gt;a. Sand.&lt;br /&gt;b. Water.&lt;br /&gt;c. Foam.&lt;br /&gt;d. Carbon – di – oxide.&lt;br /&gt;e. Dry chemical powder.&lt;br /&gt;f. Halons.&lt;br /&gt;3. What are the classifications in fire?&lt;br /&gt;a. Class A – Ordinary fire like burning of paper, wood etc.&lt;br /&gt;b. Class B – Oil fire like burning of petrol, diesel, LPG etc.&lt;br /&gt;c. Class C – Gas and dust fire like burning of butane, acetone, natural gas etc. and&lt;br /&gt;burning of dust like uranium dust, sodium dust etc.&lt;br /&gt;d. Class D – Metal fire like burning of uranium, thorium, sodium etc.&lt;br /&gt;e. Class E – electric fire example transformer or switchgear fire etc.&lt;br /&gt;4. How many types of fire extinguishers are there and state their suitability?&lt;br /&gt;a. Soda acid type – suitable for Class A type of fires.&lt;br /&gt;b. Foam type – suitable for Class A and Class B type of fires.&lt;br /&gt;c. Carbon-di-oxide type – suitable for Class B, Class C and for Class E type of fires.&lt;br /&gt;d. Dry chemical powder – suitable for Class B, Class C, Class D and Class E fires.&lt;br /&gt;e. Halons BCF (bromo chloro difluoro methane) – suitable for Class A, Class B,&lt;br /&gt;Class C and Class E types of fires.&lt;br /&gt;5. At what areas of risk the Co2 flooding system, mulsifyre systems are provided?&lt;br /&gt;Co2 flooding system is provided in diesel generator and turbine oil tank area.&lt;br /&gt;Mulsifyre system is provided in generator transformer, start up transformer and unit&lt;br /&gt;transformer areas.&lt;br /&gt;6. What are the equipments kept inside the hose boxes?&lt;br /&gt;a. Double female adapter (1 No).&lt;br /&gt;b. Delivery hose pipe (50 feet – 2 Nos).&lt;br /&gt;c. Branch pipe (1 No).&lt;br /&gt;d. Valve wheel (1 No).&lt;br /&gt;e. A hose box key (situated in a cabinet at side of hose box).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 136 -&lt;br /&gt;7. How water is used in a fire?&lt;br /&gt;Water is used as a cooling effect in a fire.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 137 -&lt;br /&gt;8. How foam is used in a fire?&lt;br /&gt;Foam is used as a blanketing effect in a fire.&lt;br /&gt;9. Which extinguisher you use for electronic equipment fire?&lt;br /&gt;Co2 or DCP type fire extinguisher can be used on fire involving electronic&lt;br /&gt;equipments.&lt;br /&gt;10. What you mean by starvation method?&lt;br /&gt;Starvation method means elimination of fuel from the fire.&lt;br /&gt;11. What is the name of powder used in Dry Chemical Powder extinguisher?&lt;br /&gt;Sodium-bi-carbonate.&lt;br /&gt;12. What you mean by cooling method?&lt;br /&gt;Cooling method means elimination of heat from the fire.&lt;br /&gt;13. What you mean by blanketing method?&lt;br /&gt;Blanketing method means elimination of oxygen from the fire.&lt;br /&gt;14. Why Co2 is used on Class E fire?&lt;br /&gt;Co2 is a non-conductor of electricity.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 138 -&lt;br /&gt;First aid&lt;br /&gt;1. What is the golden rule of first aid?&lt;br /&gt;Do first thing first, artificial respiration, stop bleeding and treat shock. Do not&lt;br /&gt;attempt too much, reassurance, avoid crowing and transfer.&lt;br /&gt;2. What do you mean by diagnosis?&lt;br /&gt;Determining the nature and courage of a disease.&lt;br /&gt;3. For a bleeding what is the first aid?&lt;br /&gt;Take care to stop the bleeding by giving pressure.&lt;br /&gt;4. What is the first aid for bone injury?&lt;br /&gt;Support the injured part and painkillers.&lt;br /&gt;5. What is the first aid for burn cases?&lt;br /&gt;Water, warm fluids should be given when the victim is conscious.&lt;br /&gt;6. How we can differentiate the bleeding from artery and vein?&lt;br /&gt;By the colour of the blood which is bleeding.&lt;br /&gt;7. What is the first aid for chlorine inhaled victims?&lt;br /&gt;Remove the victim from the source, fresh air and artificial respiration if necessary.&lt;br /&gt;8. What is the first aid for dog bite?&lt;br /&gt;Suck the wound and spite out.&lt;br /&gt;9. What is the first aid for snakebite?&lt;br /&gt;Bath the wound and constrictive bandage. Give warm drinks and rest to the patient&lt;br /&gt;and artificial breathing if necessary.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 139 -&lt;br /&gt;D20 handling&lt;br /&gt;1. What is the instrument name used for accurate measurement of IP?&lt;br /&gt;Infra red spectro photometer.&lt;br /&gt;2. How D20 vapour is recovered?&lt;br /&gt;Dryer recovers D20 vapour.&lt;br /&gt;3. What is the amount of D20 used in moderator?&lt;br /&gt;140 tonnes.&lt;br /&gt;4. Name the heavy water plants in India.&lt;br /&gt;a. Nangal.&lt;br /&gt;b. Kota.&lt;br /&gt;c. Baroda.&lt;br /&gt;d. Tuticorn.&lt;br /&gt;e. Talcher.&lt;br /&gt;f. Thal (under construction).&lt;br /&gt;g. Hazira (under construction).&lt;br /&gt;h. Malugum (under construction).&lt;br /&gt;5. Define reactor grade and down graded D20.&lt;br /&gt;Reactor grade D20: If the isotopic purity of a given D20 is more than or equal to&lt;br /&gt;99.7% then the D20 is reactor grade D20.&lt;br /&gt;Down grade D20: If the isotopic purity of a given D20 is less than 99.7% then the&lt;br /&gt;D20 is downgraded.&lt;br /&gt;6. What precautions should be taken while working in high tritium areas?&lt;br /&gt;Use respirators, plastic suits, VP suits if concentration of tritium is very high. Avoid&lt;br /&gt;getting hurt while working because tritium may go through the skin by sweat to the&lt;br /&gt;blood. If by chance there is tritium intake in the body drink lots of fluids.&lt;br /&gt;7. Why spillage of D20 is to be avoided?&lt;br /&gt;Cost consideration: D20 very costly and very valuable. Cleaning of spillage also cost&lt;br /&gt;and extra manpower to be deployed.&lt;br /&gt;Tritium hazard: D20 contains tritium, which when spilled becomes tritiated vapour&lt;br /&gt;and finds access through human body. Tritium is a radioactive material. It is a beta&lt;br /&gt;emitter.&lt;br /&gt;8. What is ice plugging?&lt;br /&gt;If there is a need to repair a valve of D20 PHT system, there are no other valves to&lt;br /&gt;shut of D20. So we use plastic bags on pipes and it has dry ice. Then liquid nitrogen&lt;br /&gt;is poured inside the bag. Due to the low temperature the D20 inside pipeline&lt;br /&gt;solidifies preventing any flow of D20 when valve is removed. This is called the ice&lt;br /&gt;plugging.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 140 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 141 -&lt;br /&gt;9. Name the methods by which D20 leak can be detected.&lt;br /&gt;a. By beetles.&lt;br /&gt;b. D20 losses through stack monitoring.&lt;br /&gt;c. Tritium monitoring.&lt;br /&gt;d. In heat exchangers the leakage can be found by taking samples of process water&lt;br /&gt;from all heat exchanges and counting the tritium activity.&lt;br /&gt;10. Name the D20 recovery methods.&lt;br /&gt;a. Manual mopping and vacuum cleaning.&lt;br /&gt;b. Active drainage recovery.&lt;br /&gt;c. Vacuum mopping recovery.&lt;br /&gt;d. Dryers recovery.&lt;br /&gt;e. Vapour recovery.&lt;br /&gt;11. Name the features for reducing D20 leaks.&lt;br /&gt;a. Reduce valves and fittings in the pipelines.&lt;br /&gt;b. Use welded joints instead of flanged joint.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 142 -&lt;br /&gt;Nuclear reactor theory&lt;br /&gt;1. State the law of conservation of mass and energy.&lt;br /&gt;Mass and energy are interchangeable. When mass is lost there is a substantial gain in&lt;br /&gt;energy and when energy is lost there is a increase in mass.&lt;br /&gt;Energy = mass*C2&lt;br /&gt;E = MC2&lt;br /&gt;Where C is the conversion factor = 3*1010 (velocity of light)&lt;br /&gt;C2 = 9*1020&lt;br /&gt;2. Which of the following material is good moderator? Why?&lt;br /&gt;a. H2 b. D2 c. H2O d. D2O e. Beryllium f. Graphite.&lt;br /&gt;The functions of a good moderator are&lt;br /&gt;a. It has to thermalise neutrons effectively.&lt;br /&gt;b. There should be only a minimum absorption of neutrons.&lt;br /&gt;c. It should not be toxic.&lt;br /&gt;d. It should not be inflammable.&lt;br /&gt;In case of Hydrogen (H2) though it is a effective sheatherer it cannot be used as a&lt;br /&gt;moderator because it is a gas and there is a lot of distance between atoms. A neutron&lt;br /&gt;cannot meet the nucleus in a definite manner.&lt;br /&gt;For D2 also the same problem as this is also gas and it cannot be used as a moderator.&lt;br /&gt;In case of H2O it is a good scatterer but is absorbs neutrons. Its moderation ratio is&lt;br /&gt;72. So it cannot be used as a moderator.&lt;br /&gt;In case of D2O though it is not as effective scatterer as that of H2O it has minimum&lt;br /&gt;absorption of neutrons. It has a moderating ratio of 21000. This is an ideal&lt;br /&gt;moderator.&lt;br /&gt;In case of Beryllium it is a toxic material. Therefore cannot be used.&lt;br /&gt;Graphite absorbs neutrons and is inflammable and therefore cannot be used.&lt;br /&gt;So from the above statements the D2O is the good moderator material.&lt;br /&gt;3. The activity of an Iodine – 131 is 10 curies. After how many half-lives will it come&lt;br /&gt;down to 625 millicuries?&lt;br /&gt;Activity of an Iodine – 131 = 10 curies&lt;br /&gt;To find number of half-lives for coming it to 625 millicuries,&lt;br /&gt;10 * 1st  = 5 (1st half-life)&lt;br /&gt;5*  = 2.5 (2nd half-life)&lt;br /&gt;2.5 *  = 1.25 (3rd half-life)&lt;br /&gt;1.25 *  = 0.625 (4th half-life)&lt;br /&gt;So during 4th half-life the Iodine – 131 reduces to 625 millicuries.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 143 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 144 -&lt;br /&gt;4. What do Atomic number and mixture mean?&lt;br /&gt;Atomic number: The atomic number of an atom is the number of protons in that&lt;br /&gt;atom.&lt;br /&gt;Example – Hydrogen has one proton and its atomic number is one (1).&lt;br /&gt;– Uranium has 92 protons and its atomic number is 92.&lt;br /&gt;Mixture: It is a substance formed by different elements and these elements can be&lt;br /&gt;separated by physical methods.&lt;br /&gt;Example – Air is a mixture of oxygen and nitrogen and these can be separated by&lt;br /&gt;physical methods.&lt;br /&gt;5. What is the weight of a proton?&lt;br /&gt;1.00759 amu (atomic mass unit)&lt;br /&gt;6. What is the energy of a thermal neutron?&lt;br /&gt;0.025 eV (energy volt)&lt;br /&gt;7. What is the charge of an alpha particle?&lt;br /&gt;2+.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 145 -&lt;br /&gt;Nuclear system&lt;br /&gt;1. What is the purpose of moderator D2O?&lt;br /&gt;The purposes of moderator D2O are,&lt;br /&gt;a. To thermalise neutrons to maintain criticality.&lt;br /&gt;b. Emergency core cooling when PHT fails.&lt;br /&gt;c. Structural cooling.&lt;br /&gt;2. What is the cooling water used in moderator heat exchanger during normal&lt;br /&gt;operation? And during class IV failure?&lt;br /&gt;During normal operation process LP water is used in moderator heat exchangers,&lt;br /&gt;which transfers heat to seawater. During class IV failure firewater is used for the&lt;br /&gt;moderator heat exchanger.&lt;br /&gt;3. During loca how the cooling of fuel bundle is achieved?&lt;br /&gt;During loca there is provision for taking D2O from the moderator system, which is&lt;br /&gt;connected to PHT system for fuel cooling and there is one more option for the&lt;br /&gt;cooling of the fuel from the fire water system.&lt;br /&gt;4. How coolant flow is maintained in the event of loss of power to the PHT system?&lt;br /&gt;When the PHT power fails, it takes two minutes for DG to come to full power. The&lt;br /&gt;circulation is maintained by flywheel, which increases the de-acceleration and&lt;br /&gt;maintains the flow for two minutes.&lt;br /&gt;If there is a station blackout the flow is maintained by thermo-symphoning by which&lt;br /&gt;more denser cold water comes down and less denser hot water goes up by convection&lt;br /&gt;method.&lt;br /&gt;5. What are the materials in contact with PHT system?&lt;br /&gt;Piping – carbon steel.&lt;br /&gt;Pressure tubes – zircalloy-2&lt;br /&gt;Fuel cladding – zircalloy-2&lt;br /&gt;End shield – stainless steel. Etc.&lt;br /&gt;6. What are the main futures of PHT system?&lt;br /&gt;a. Impeller – To reduce the water flow.&lt;br /&gt;b. Self-injection Hx – Cools the water in case of leakage.&lt;br /&gt;c. Gland supply – Cools the seals.&lt;br /&gt;d. Primary and secondary seals – sealing the pump.&lt;br /&gt;e. Thrust bearing – To take the axial thrust.&lt;br /&gt;7. What are the purposes of bleed condenser?&lt;br /&gt;The purposes of bleed condenser are,&lt;br /&gt;a. To cool the bleed water, which goes to bleed cooler.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 146 -&lt;br /&gt;b. To provide cool hot water to the PHT purification system.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 147 -&lt;br /&gt;8. What is header level control?&lt;br /&gt;For the purpose of maintenance of PHT pipe valves, boiler inlet valve the level of the&lt;br /&gt;coolant should be below the valve to prevent the coolant coming out of the system.&lt;br /&gt;This is called the header level control and achieved by means of manual operation of&lt;br /&gt;valves and shutdown cooling pump.&lt;br /&gt;9. In MAPS Unit # 1 end-shield cooling system has got heaters. Why?&lt;br /&gt;Unit # 1 end-shield is made of nickel steel, which had a nil ductility temperature of&lt;br /&gt;-100°C while commissioning. After 30 years of operation this will rise to +32°C,&lt;br /&gt;because of radiation exposure. To avoid the failure of end shield of MAPS Unit # 1&lt;br /&gt;the temperature of the end-shield should be maintained at 68°C always. MAPS 1&lt;br /&gt;end-shield cooling system is operating at elevated temperature. But in MAPS Unit #2&lt;br /&gt;this problem is not existed because in this unit end-shields are made up of stainless&lt;br /&gt;steel.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 148 -&lt;br /&gt;Reactor general&lt;br /&gt;1. What are V1 and V2? How they are connected? What is the harm in opening F/M&lt;br /&gt;vault door during reactor operation?&lt;br /&gt;The reactor building is divided into two areas. They are V1 and V2.&lt;br /&gt;V1 – Dry volume area.&lt;br /&gt;V2 – Wet volume area.&lt;br /&gt;V1 area includes F/M vault, boiler room, and entire dome area. Rest of the areas in&lt;br /&gt;the reactor building is V2 area. V1 and V2 are connected by vent shaft through&lt;br /&gt;suppression pool.&lt;br /&gt;F/M vault is a V1 area and F/M maintenance bay is a V2 area. Usually when there is&lt;br /&gt;an accident in F/M vault the pressure is relieved through boiler room through&lt;br /&gt;suppression pool and the uncondensed gases to V2 area. When the reactor is in&lt;br /&gt;operation and if we open the F/M vault door, suppose of there is an accident in F/M&lt;br /&gt;vault the pressure released directly goes to F/M maintenance area, which is a V2&lt;br /&gt;area. Thus pressurizing the entire building.&lt;br /&gt;2. What is the purpose of inlet manifold inside calandria? What is the material used for&lt;br /&gt;that?&lt;br /&gt;The purpose of inlet manifold is to introduce heavy water to the calandria with low&lt;br /&gt;velocity to avoid mixing. That is stratified flow of D2O is obtained b inlet manifold.&lt;br /&gt;Thus the temperature is kept minimum. It is made of zircalloy.&lt;br /&gt;3. Why bi-directional flow is chosen for PHT system?&lt;br /&gt;Bi-directional flow is chosen for PHT system because,&lt;br /&gt;a. Uniform temperature gradient is facilitated so there will be no differential thermal&lt;br /&gt;expansion.&lt;br /&gt;b. It facilitates fuelling even when the reactor is working, which facilitates uniform&lt;br /&gt;neutron flux and this intern gives rise to maximum fuel burns up.&lt;br /&gt;4. What is the purpose of end-shield?&lt;br /&gt;The purposes of end-shield are,&lt;br /&gt;a. To permit access to F/M vault during shut down.&lt;br /&gt;b. To provide tight clamping for fuelling machines.&lt;br /&gt;c. To support the calandria tubes and also system.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 149 -&lt;br /&gt;Station grounding&lt;br /&gt;1. What is grounding?&lt;br /&gt;It is an electrical connection with the general mass of earth through an earth&lt;br /&gt;electrode.&lt;br /&gt;2. What is difference between earthing and grounding?&lt;br /&gt;Both have same meaning. The term earthing is used in U.K. and grounding in U.S.A.&lt;br /&gt;ground means earth.&lt;br /&gt;3. What are types of grounding?&lt;br /&gt;There are two types&lt;br /&gt;a. System grounding.&lt;br /&gt;b. Equipment grounding.&lt;br /&gt;4. What does mean by system?&lt;br /&gt;Grounding of neutral point of equipment is called system grounding. For instance&lt;br /&gt;grounding of generator neutral, transformer neutral etc.&lt;br /&gt;5. What does mean by equipment grounding?&lt;br /&gt;Grounding of non-current carrying metallic parts is called equipment grounding. For&lt;br /&gt;instance no-current carrying parts include the following:&lt;br /&gt;a. Motor body, switchgear metal enclosure, transformer tank, conduits of wiring etc.&lt;br /&gt;b. Support structures, tower, poles etc. in the neighborhood of electrical circuits.&lt;br /&gt;c. Sheath of cables.&lt;br /&gt;d. Body of portable equipment such as iron, oven, etc.&lt;br /&gt;6. What is the important of system grounding?&lt;br /&gt;It is important because:&lt;br /&gt;a. Earth fault protection is based on the method of neutral earthing.&lt;br /&gt;b. System voltage during earth fault depends on neutral earthing.&lt;br /&gt;c. It is a protection against arcing grounds, unbalanced voltages with respect to earth&lt;br /&gt;and lighting.&lt;br /&gt;7. What is the important of equipment grounding?&lt;br /&gt;Equipment earthing ensures safety.&lt;br /&gt;8. How safety could be ensured by equipment grounding?&lt;br /&gt;In order to enumerate this, let us first find out the effects of current and voltage&lt;br /&gt;developed during fault condition.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 150 -&lt;br /&gt;9. What is the permissible body current limit?&lt;br /&gt;The magnitude and duration of current conducted through a human body at 50 Hz&lt;br /&gt;should be less than those did that cause ventricular fibrillation.&lt;br /&gt;(Ventricular fibrillation is considered to be the main cause of death due to electrical&lt;br /&gt;shock). These below given data are also applicable for current limits to human body.&lt;br /&gt;Current magnitude Physiological effect Description&lt;br /&gt;1 mA Threshold of&lt;br /&gt;perception&lt;br /&gt;A current at which a person is just able to&lt;br /&gt;detect a slight tingling in his hand or finger&lt;br /&gt;1 – 6 mA Unpleasant to sustain This is often termed as let go currents. Do not&lt;br /&gt;impair the ability of a person holding an&lt;br /&gt;energised object to control his muscles and&lt;br /&gt;release it.&lt;br /&gt;6 – 9 mA Threshold of muscular&lt;br /&gt;contraction.&lt;br /&gt;These are threshold values, since 10.5 mA&lt;br /&gt;current and 16 mA current are the let go values&lt;br /&gt;for women and man respectively.&lt;br /&gt;9 – 25 mA Muscular contraction May be painful and can make it hard or&lt;br /&gt;impossible to release energised objects grasped&lt;br /&gt;by the hand.&lt;br /&gt;25 – 60 mA Muscular contraction Make breathing difficult.&lt;br /&gt;60 – 100 mA Ventricular fibrillation Ventricular fibrillation, stoppage of heart or&lt;br /&gt;inhibition of respiration might occur and cause&lt;br /&gt;injury or death if time is more than 1 sec.&lt;br /&gt;Hence the grounding equipment shock current can be kept below the value sufficient&lt;br /&gt;to cause injury or death by lowering the step and touch potential.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 151 -&lt;br /&gt;10. How fibrillation current functions?&lt;br /&gt;Fibrillation current is actually function of individual body weight.&lt;br /&gt;For 50 kgs body weight: fibrillation current (IB) = 0.116/ª ts (Limited to 0.03 – 3&lt;br /&gt;sec. Range)&lt;br /&gt;Where ts = duration of current exposure in sec.&lt;br /&gt;Note = Above equation results = 116 mA for 1 sec. and 367 mA for 100 sec.&lt;br /&gt;For 70 kgs body weight: fibrillation current (IB) = 0.157/ª ts&lt;br /&gt;Note = Above equation results = 157 mA for 1 sec. and 496 mA for 100 sec.&lt;br /&gt;Above times are very - very important from the point view of clearing the fault.&lt;br /&gt;Above limit dictates that grounding should e such that current magnitude through&lt;br /&gt;human body should not increase the specified values.&lt;br /&gt;In order to ensure above following have been done.&lt;br /&gt;1. Current conductor have been burried in ground&lt;br /&gt;a. At the depth of 600 mm in switchyard. Depth 600 mm is normally selected&lt;br /&gt;because of freezing or drying out, the Resistivity of upper layers could vary&lt;br /&gt;with seasons, while the Resistivity of lower soil layers remains nearly&lt;br /&gt;constant.&lt;br /&gt;b. Horizontal grid conductors are more effective in reducing the danger of high&lt;br /&gt;step and touch voltages on the earth surface by creating equipotential surface&lt;br /&gt;during fault conditions.&lt;br /&gt;c. At the depth of 800 mm else where. Here depth is kept more because to care&lt;br /&gt;for under grounding services. Example laying of power cables, drainage etc.&lt;br /&gt;2. 25-mm dia copper rod electrodes have been driven in soil.&lt;br /&gt;a. Upto 5 meters depth in 220 kV switchyard.&lt;br /&gt;b. Upto 3 meters elsewhere.&lt;br /&gt;Why only 5 meters and 3 meters depths have been selected is that the&lt;br /&gt;resistance is diminishes rapidly with the first few feet of driving, but less so at&lt;br /&gt;depths greater than 2 to 3 meters in soil of uniform resistivity.&lt;br /&gt;These lengths are adopted in selecting the ground electrodes.&lt;br /&gt;3. 4-inch layer of gravel in 220 kV switchyard has been used. Purpose of using&lt;br /&gt;gravel is by doing steps 1,2 above tough and step potential are computed and&lt;br /&gt;compared with tolerable potential and found as given below.&lt;br /&gt;Potential Computed value Tolerable value&lt;br /&gt;Tough 550 V 665V&lt;br /&gt;Step 2.a switchyard with crushed rock surface 230V 2165 V&lt;br /&gt;Step 2.b elsewhere with natural soil 166V 168.5 V&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 152 -&lt;br /&gt;11. Why grounding is necessary?&lt;br /&gt;The purpose of grounding is to maintain the surface under and around a station ate as&lt;br /&gt;nearly zero potential as possible with reference to absolute earth so that operating&lt;br /&gt;staff who walk in the station yard and tough equipments are ate earth potential and&lt;br /&gt;when faults occur there is safety to staff and equipments.&lt;br /&gt;12. What are the harms of under grounded system?&lt;br /&gt;a. Step and tough potential will increase more than maximum tolerable value.&lt;br /&gt;b. Under single line to ground fault the voltage to earth of the two healthy phases&lt;br /&gt;rises from their normal phase to neutral voltage to full line voltage, which may&lt;br /&gt;result in insulation break down.&lt;br /&gt;c. The capacitive current in two healthy phases increases ª3 times the normal value.&lt;br /&gt;d. The capacitive current in the faulty phase is 3 times its normal value.&lt;br /&gt;e. Experience shows that capacitive current in excess of 4 amps may be sufficient to&lt;br /&gt;maintain an arc in the ionized path of the fault and this persistent arc phenomenon&lt;br /&gt;is called ARCING GROUND, which ultimately cause high voltage build up.&lt;br /&gt;Some time these voltage builds up to 5 to 6 times its normal value, which results&lt;br /&gt;in break down of insulation.&lt;br /&gt;f. Being fault current low, it is difficult to isolate fault.&lt;br /&gt;13. How system grounding and equipment grounding achieved?&lt;br /&gt;System grounding is obtained by grounding the neutral through resistance, through&lt;br /&gt;transformer and through effective or solidly grounding.&lt;br /&gt;Equipment grounding is obtained by Grounding of non-current carrying metallic&lt;br /&gt;parts equipment. For instance no-current carrying parts include the following:&lt;br /&gt;a. Motor body, switchgear metal enclosure, transformer tank, conduits of wiring etc.&lt;br /&gt;b. Support structures, tower, poles etc. in the neighborhood of electrical circuits.&lt;br /&gt;c. Sheath of cables.&lt;br /&gt;d. Body of portable equipment such as iron, oven, etc.&lt;br /&gt;14. What does mean by grounding electrode, grounding system, and grounding&lt;br /&gt;resistance?&lt;br /&gt;Grounding electrode: A conductor driven in the earth and used for collecting ground&lt;br /&gt;current from or dissipating ground current into the earth.&lt;br /&gt;Grounding system: Comprises all interconnected grounding facilities in a specific&lt;br /&gt;area.&lt;br /&gt;Grounding resistance: The resistance offered by the ground when power frequency&lt;br /&gt;current is discharged to the ground through a particular grounding electrode or&lt;br /&gt;grounding system.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 153 -&lt;br /&gt;15. How grounding resistance could be measured?&lt;br /&gt;There are few methods, which can give approximately true value. These are&lt;br /&gt;described below.&lt;br /&gt;a. Fall of potential method: This method is applicable for small grid or sub station&lt;br /&gt;where induction effect of voltage is less.&lt;br /&gt;b. Measurement of earth resistance by 61.8% distance rule:&lt;br /&gt;c. Alternate – 1 of fall of potential method: This method is influenced by induction&lt;br /&gt;effect.&lt;br /&gt;d. Alternate – 2 of fall of potential method:&lt;br /&gt;16. How value of grounding resistance could be kept constant?&lt;br /&gt;While measuring of grounding resistance is more than computed design value 0.11Ω,&lt;br /&gt;then following are recommended to reduce it. Add in water the following highly&lt;br /&gt;conductive substances and pour into treated pit.&lt;br /&gt;a. Sodium chloride (Nacl), known as common salt.&lt;br /&gt;b. Calcium chloride (Ca CL2)&lt;br /&gt;c. Sodium carbonate (Na2 CO3)&lt;br /&gt;d. Copper sulphate (Cu SO4)&lt;br /&gt;e. Soft choke and&lt;br /&gt;f. Salt and charcoal in suitable proportions.&lt;br /&gt;17. What is the effect of moisture content on earth resistivity?&lt;br /&gt;The moisture content is expressed in percent by weight of dry soil. Dry earth weights&lt;br /&gt;about 1440 kg per cubic meter and thus 10% moisture content is equivalent to 144 kg&lt;br /&gt;of water per cubic meter of dry soil. So about 20% moisture, the resistivity is very&lt;br /&gt;little affected. Below 20%, the resistivity increases very abruptly with the decrease in&lt;br /&gt;moisture.&lt;br /&gt;18. What is the effect of salt content in moisture on resistivity?&lt;br /&gt;The resistivity decreases and the salt content is expressed in percent by weight of the&lt;br /&gt;contained moisture. It will be noted that the curve flattens off at about 5% salt&lt;br /&gt;content and a further increase in salt content gives little decrease in the soil&lt;br /&gt;resistivity.&lt;br /&gt;19. What is the effect of temperature on earth resistivity?&lt;br /&gt;The temperature co-efficient of resistivity for soil is negative, but it is negligible for&lt;br /&gt;temperature above freezing point. Below 0°C the water in the soil begins to freeze&lt;br /&gt;and introduces a tremendous increase in the temperature co-efficient, so that as the&lt;br /&gt;temperature becomes lower the resistivity rises enormously.&lt;br /&gt;20. What does mean by neutral floating or neutral displacement?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 154 -&lt;br /&gt;When a ground fault occurs, there is a tendency of neutral shift with consequent&lt;br /&gt;change in voltage on the un-faulted phases. This phenomenon is called neutral&lt;br /&gt;floating or neutral displacement.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 155 -&lt;br /&gt;21. Why grounding of power cable is needed? How it should be done?&lt;br /&gt;a. The magnetic fluxes produced by the three phases in a multi core power cable&lt;br /&gt;almost cancel put each other, since the vector sum of these currents at any instant&lt;br /&gt;is zero and practically there is no residual magnetic flux around the cable.&lt;br /&gt;In case of single core cable, the magnetic flux induces the voltage in the metallic&lt;br /&gt;sheath.&lt;br /&gt;b. When the cable conductor is carrying alternating current, for safe and reliable&lt;br /&gt;operation, the metallic sheath must be grounded. If the metallic sheath is at one&lt;br /&gt;end the potential of the unearthed end could be much above the earth potential. If&lt;br /&gt;both ends are grounded, a circulating current is induced in the metallic sheath.&lt;br /&gt;c. The maximum acceptable induced voltage under normal load current operation is&lt;br /&gt;limited by corrosion and safety considerations.&lt;br /&gt;d. Code of practice of earthing (IS 3043) as well as electricity council London&lt;br /&gt;recommended permissible induced voltage level of 65 Volts.&lt;br /&gt;Hence keeping above all points in mind metallic sheath and armour of all multi core&lt;br /&gt;power cables shall be earthed at both end equipment and switchgear end. Sheath and&lt;br /&gt;armour of single core power cable shall be earthed ate switchgear end only. The&lt;br /&gt;sheaths of shielded control cables should be grounded at both ends to eliminate&lt;br /&gt;induced potentials.&lt;br /&gt;22. In 220 kV switchyard why lightning arrestor should be properly grounded?&lt;br /&gt;a. During lightning, surges should be discharged to ground, otherwise it will&lt;br /&gt;puncture the equipment insulation and it is possible only when lightning arrestor&lt;br /&gt;is grounded properly.&lt;br /&gt;b. In order to make it effective, the ground terminal of lighting arrestor should be&lt;br /&gt;connected direct to the tank of transformer. This will eliminate voltage build up&lt;br /&gt;due to earth resistance. For example for each ohm of earth resistance the voltage&lt;br /&gt;build up for 5000 Amps discharge current is 5 kV. Soil resistivity a should be&lt;br /&gt;minimum and may be it is 3.5 ohm per meter.&lt;br /&gt;23. Why grounding mat is important near ground switch operating handle and&lt;br /&gt;disconnecting switch operating handle?&lt;br /&gt;Equipment operating handles deserve special attention because of the higher&lt;br /&gt;probability for co-incidence of adverse factors. For example,&lt;br /&gt;a. Hand operation equipment such as grounding switches and disconnecting&lt;br /&gt;switches requires the presence of operator near a grounded structure at a point&lt;br /&gt;where opening of an energised circuit can some times result in an arc to the&lt;br /&gt;structure or perhaps mechanical failure and electrical break down of a switch&lt;br /&gt;insulator. A large percentage of fatal accidents from voltage gradients are in fact&lt;br /&gt;associated with operating handles. Hence in order to avoid above problems&lt;br /&gt;following should be an additional safety factors:&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 156 -&lt;br /&gt;1. Use closer mesh in the vicinity of operating handle area (150-mm approx.) and&lt;br /&gt;operating handle shall be directly connected to the earthing mat.&lt;br /&gt;2. Use higher resistance surfacing such as crushed rock or both in order to bring&lt;br /&gt;down the values of touch potential and step potential.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 157 -&lt;br /&gt;24. Why fences grounding are important?&lt;br /&gt;Because the most dangerous touch contacts involves and outside the fence are&lt;br /&gt;usually accessible to the general public. In order to minimise the effect of step&lt;br /&gt;potential and touch potential following two philosophies could be adopted.&lt;br /&gt;a. Inclusion of the fence within the ground grid area and&lt;br /&gt;b. Placement of fence outside the ground grid area – not safe to use.&lt;br /&gt;With this effective area is increased and reduces ground grid resistance substantially&lt;br /&gt;and maximum ground – grid voltage rise as well. In this case the perimeter conductor&lt;br /&gt;of grid normally either follow the fence line, or parallel to it at a short distance about&lt;br /&gt;0.5 m – 1.5 m outside. In either case, the perimeter ground conductor and fence are&lt;br /&gt;bonded electrically at frequent intervals.&lt;br /&gt;25. What are the specifications for procurement of grounding conductor and grounding&lt;br /&gt;rods?&lt;br /&gt;Grounding conductor, pad, rods etc. should have following specifications:&lt;br /&gt;a. Copper : 91.8 to 94.9%&lt;br /&gt;b. Zinc : 2.0 to 3.0%&lt;br /&gt;c. Tin : 0.8 to 1.5%&lt;br /&gt;d. Lead : 2.0 to 2.5%&lt;br /&gt;e. Iron : 0.5 to 1.0%&lt;br /&gt;Impurities must be limited to the percentage specified below:&lt;br /&gt;a. Nickel : 0.3% maximum.&lt;br /&gt;b. Antimony : 0.3% maximum.&lt;br /&gt;c. Manganese : 0.04% maximum.&lt;br /&gt;d. Phosphorous : 0.04% maximum.&lt;br /&gt;26. Why copper is only preferred as material for grounding?&lt;br /&gt;An advantage of use of copper is in addition to their high conductivity, has the&lt;br /&gt;advantage of being resistant to underground corrosion. Copper is cathodic with&lt;br /&gt;respect to other metals that are likely to be burried in the vicinity.&lt;br /&gt;Disadvantages of use of copper are,&lt;br /&gt;a. Grid of copper forms a galvanic cell with burried steel structures, pipes and any&lt;br /&gt;of the lead based alloys that might be present in cable sheaths, it is likely be&lt;br /&gt;hasten the corrosion of the latter.&lt;br /&gt;b. Use of tinned copper conductor accelerates and concentrates the natural corrosion&lt;br /&gt;of metal in small area however cell potential with respect to steel and zinc&lt;br /&gt;reduces by about 50% and practically eliminates this potential with respect to&lt;br /&gt;lead.&lt;br /&gt;27. What should be the frequency of measurement of earth resistivity?&lt;br /&gt;As per IS: 3043, 1987, measurement of earth resistivity should be carried out&lt;br /&gt;annually or biannually and value should be recorded.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 158 -&lt;br /&gt;28. What should the statutory provision of earthing?&lt;br /&gt;a. Earthing shall generally be carried out in accordance with the requirement of&lt;br /&gt;India electricity rule 1956, as amended from time to time and the relevant&lt;br /&gt;regulations of the electricity supply authority concerned.&lt;br /&gt;b. All medium voltage equipment shall be earthed by two separate and distinct&lt;br /&gt;connections with earth. In the case of high and extra high voltages, the neutral&lt;br /&gt;points shall be earthed by not less than two separate and distinct connections with&lt;br /&gt;earth, each having its own electrodes at the generating station or substation and&lt;br /&gt;may be earthed at any other point provided no interference is caused by such&lt;br /&gt;earthing. If necessary, the neutral may be earthed through suitable impedance.&lt;br /&gt;c. As for as possible all earth connections shall be visible for inspection.&lt;br /&gt;d. All connections shall be carefully made. If they are poorly made or inadequate for&lt;br /&gt;the purpose for which they are intended, loss of life or serious personal injury&lt;br /&gt;may result.&lt;br /&gt;e. Each earth system shall be so devised that the testing of individual earth electrode&lt;br /&gt;is possible. It is recommended that the value of any earth system resistance shall&lt;br /&gt;be such as to confirm with the degree of shock protection desired.&lt;br /&gt;f. It is recommended that a drawing showing the main earth connection and earth&lt;br /&gt;electrodes be prepared for each installation.&lt;br /&gt;g. No addition to the current carrying system, either temporary or permanent shall&lt;br /&gt;be made which will increase the maximum available earth fault or its duration&lt;br /&gt;until it has been ascertained that the existing arrangement of earth electrodes,&lt;br /&gt;earth bus-bar etc. are capable of carrying the new value of earth fault current&lt;br /&gt;which may be obtained by this addition.&lt;br /&gt;h. No cut-out link or switch other than a linked switch arranged to operate&lt;br /&gt;simultaneously on the earthed or earthed neutral conductor and the live&lt;br /&gt;conductors, shall be inserted on any supply system. This however, does not&lt;br /&gt;include the case of a switch for use in controlling a generator or a transformer or a&lt;br /&gt;link for test purposes.&lt;br /&gt;i. All materials fittings, etc. used in earthing shall conform to Indian standard&lt;br /&gt;specifications, wherever these exist.&lt;br /&gt;29. What maintenance of earth electrodes should be done?&lt;br /&gt;The neighbouring soil to the earth electrode shall be kept moist where necessary, by&lt;br /&gt;periodically pouring water through a pipe where fitted along with it or by pouring&lt;br /&gt;water in the immediate vicinity of the earth electrode.&lt;br /&gt;Periodical visual inspection of all earth electrodes connection wherever available,&lt;br /&gt;shall be carried out to ensure their rigidity and other signs of deterioration.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 159 -&lt;br /&gt;30. In case new installation is to be done, what basic guidelines should be followed for&lt;br /&gt;grounding?&lt;br /&gt;a. Earthing conductors in outdoor areas shall be burried 500 mm below finished&lt;br /&gt;grade level unless stated otherwise.&lt;br /&gt;b. Minimum 6000 mm spacing between rod pipe electrode shall be provided unless&lt;br /&gt;stipulated otherwise.&lt;br /&gt;c. Earthing conductor around the building shall be burried in earth at a minimum&lt;br /&gt;distance of 1500 mm from the outer boundary of building.&lt;br /&gt;d. Earthing conductors embedded in the concrete floor of the building shall have&lt;br /&gt;approximately 100-mm concrete cover.&lt;br /&gt;e. Earthing conductors along their run on columns, beams, walls etc. shall be&lt;br /&gt;supported by suitable cleats at intervals of 750 mm.&lt;br /&gt;f. Earthing conductors crossing the road shall be either installed in hume pipes or&lt;br /&gt;laid at greater depth to suit the site conditions.&lt;br /&gt;g. Whenever earthing conductors cross underground service ducts, pipes, trenches,&lt;br /&gt;under ground service ducts, pipes, trenches, tunnels, railway track etc. it shall be&lt;br /&gt;laid 800 mm below them.&lt;br /&gt;h. Earthing conductor shall be burried 1000 mm outside the switchyard fence. Every&lt;br /&gt;alternate post of the fence and gates shall be connected to earthing loop by one&lt;br /&gt;lead.&lt;br /&gt;i. Each earthing lead from the neutral of the power transformer shall be directly&lt;br /&gt;connected to a rod or pipe or plate electrode treated earth pit, which in turn shall&lt;br /&gt;be connected to station earthing.&lt;br /&gt;31. How much resistance human body has?&lt;br /&gt;Resistance of internal body tissues (Not including skin) : 300 Ω.&lt;br /&gt;Resistance of body including skin : 500 to 3000 Ω.&lt;br /&gt;32. What is the effect of voltage frequency and current on resistance of the human body?&lt;br /&gt;a. For touch voltages upto approximately 50V the value of impedance of the skin&lt;br /&gt;varies widely with surface area of contact, temperature, respiration etc. even for&lt;br /&gt;one person.&lt;br /&gt;b. For higher touch voltages in order of approximately 50V to 100V the skin&lt;br /&gt;impedance decreases considerably and becomes negligible when the skin breaks&lt;br /&gt;down.&lt;br /&gt;c. Wet hand contact resistance becomes very low at any voltage.&lt;br /&gt;d. With increase in frequency, impedance of skin decreases.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 160 -&lt;br /&gt;33. What are the paths of current through the body?&lt;br /&gt;A value of 1000 Ω is selected for the calculations that follows as representing the&lt;br /&gt;resistance of a human body from hand to both feet and also from hand to hand or&lt;br /&gt;from one foot to other foot.&lt;br /&gt;Above paths includes vital organs such as heart.&lt;br /&gt;a. Path from hand to foot is much more dangerous than foot to foot, since current&lt;br /&gt;flow through heart during foot to foot current flow will be much less than the&lt;br /&gt;current flow from hand to foot approximate ratio is 25:1&lt;br /&gt;b. However deaths have occurred during foot to foot current flow. Hence can not be&lt;br /&gt;ignored.&lt;br /&gt;34. What are the effects of re-closure shock?&lt;br /&gt;During re-closure, when fault is persisting a person might be subjected to the first&lt;br /&gt;shock which would not permanently injure him, but would upset and disturb him&lt;br /&gt;temporarily.&lt;br /&gt;Next, a single fast automatic re-closure could in a second shock initiated within less&lt;br /&gt;than 500 ms from the start of first. It is this second shock, occurring after a relatively&lt;br /&gt;short interval of time before the person has recovered, that might cause a serious&lt;br /&gt;accident. With manual re-closure the possibility of exposure to a second shock is&lt;br /&gt;reduced since the time interval may be substantially greater.&lt;br /&gt;35. State DC/AC equivalent factor (K).&lt;br /&gt;Ratio of direct current (DC) to its equivalent rms value of alternating current (AC)&lt;br /&gt;having the same probability of inducting ventricular fibrillation.&lt;br /&gt;K = I DC fibrillation / I AC fibrillation (rms).&lt;br /&gt;K = 3000 mA / 100 mA&lt;br /&gt;K = 30 mA&lt;br /&gt;Threshold of let-go is unlike AC there is no definable threshold of let-go for DC for&lt;br /&gt;current magnitude below approximately 300 mA. Only the making and breaking of&lt;br /&gt;current leads to painful and cramp like contractions of muscles.&lt;br /&gt;Above approximately 300 mA, let-go may be impossible or only possible after&lt;br /&gt;several seconds or minutes of shock duration. Below approximately 300 mA a&lt;br /&gt;sensation of warmth is felt in the extremities during the flow of current. Above 300&lt;br /&gt;mA unconsciousness frequently occurs.&lt;br /&gt;36. Why AC is more dangerous than DC?&lt;br /&gt;Because the excitatory action of current (stimulation of nerves and muscle, induction&lt;br /&gt;of cardiac atrial or ventricular fibrillation) are linked to the changes of current&lt;br /&gt;magnitude especially when making and breaking of the current. To produce the same&lt;br /&gt;excitatory effects the magnitude of direct current flow of constant strength in 2 to 4&lt;br /&gt;times greater than that of alternating current.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 161 -&lt;br /&gt;Transformer oil tests&lt;br /&gt;1. What are the characteristics of transformer oil?&lt;br /&gt;Characteristics Requirement Method of testing Remarks&lt;br /&gt;Appearance The oil shall be clear&lt;br /&gt;and transparent and&lt;br /&gt;free from suspended&lt;br /&gt;matter of sediments&lt;br /&gt;A representative sample&lt;br /&gt;of the oil shall be&lt;br /&gt;examined in a 100-mm&lt;br /&gt;thick layer at 27°C.&lt;br /&gt;Density at 29.5°C&lt;br /&gt;max.&lt;br /&gt;0.89 gm / cm3 IS-1448(P:16):1977 See note 1&lt;br /&gt;Kinematic viscosity&lt;br /&gt;max. at&lt;br /&gt;a. 27°C&lt;br /&gt;b. 40°C&lt;br /&gt;27 cSt&lt;br /&gt;under consideration&lt;br /&gt;IS-1448(P:25):1976&lt;br /&gt;Interfacial tension at&lt;br /&gt;27°C minimum&lt;br /&gt;0.04 N/m IS- 6104:1971&lt;br /&gt;Flash point penskymarten&lt;br /&gt;(closed)&lt;br /&gt;minimum&lt;br /&gt;140°C IS-1448(P:21):1970&lt;br /&gt;Pour point max. -6°C IS-1448(P:10):1970&lt;br /&gt;Neutralization value&lt;br /&gt;a. Total acidity max&lt;br /&gt;b. Inorganic&lt;br /&gt;acidity/alkalinity&lt;br /&gt;0.03 mg KOH/g&lt;br /&gt;nil&lt;br /&gt;IS-1448(P:2):1967&lt;br /&gt;IS-1448(P:2):1967&lt;br /&gt;Alcoholic&lt;br /&gt;potassium&lt;br /&gt;hydroxide&lt;br /&gt;solution of&lt;br /&gt;0.02 N&lt;br /&gt;should be&lt;br /&gt;in place of&lt;br /&gt;0.1 N&lt;br /&gt;indicated&lt;br /&gt;in test&lt;br /&gt;method&lt;br /&gt;Corrosive sulphur Non-corrosive&lt;br /&gt;Electric strength&lt;br /&gt;(Breakdown voltage)&lt;br /&gt;a. New unfiltered&lt;br /&gt;oil minimum.&lt;br /&gt;b. After filtration&lt;br /&gt;minimum&lt;br /&gt;30 kV (rms)&lt;br /&gt;If the above value is&lt;br /&gt;not attained the oil&lt;br /&gt;shall be filtered 60 kV.&lt;br /&gt;IS-6792:1972&lt;br /&gt;See note 2&lt;br /&gt;Dielectric dissipation&lt;br /&gt;factor (tan δ) at 90°C&lt;br /&gt;max.&lt;br /&gt;0.002 IS-6262:1971 See note 2&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 162 -&lt;br /&gt;Specific resistance&lt;br /&gt;(resistivity)&lt;br /&gt;a. At 90°C min.&lt;br /&gt;b. At 27°C min.&lt;br /&gt;35 * 1012 Ω-cm&lt;br /&gt;1500* 1012 Ω-cm&lt;br /&gt;IS-6103:1971 See note 2&lt;br /&gt;Oxidation stability&lt;br /&gt;a. Neutralization&lt;br /&gt;value after&lt;br /&gt;oxidation max.&lt;br /&gt;b. Total sludge,&lt;br /&gt;after oxidation&lt;br /&gt;max.&lt;br /&gt;0.4 mg KOH/g&lt;br /&gt;0.1% by weight.&lt;br /&gt;Ageing&lt;br /&gt;characteristics after&lt;br /&gt;accelerated ageing&lt;br /&gt;(open beaker method&lt;br /&gt;with copper catalyst)&lt;br /&gt;a. Specific resistance&lt;br /&gt;at 27°C minimum &amp;amp;&lt;br /&gt;at 90°C minimum.&lt;br /&gt;b. Tan δ at 90°C&lt;br /&gt;max.&lt;br /&gt;c. Total acidity max&lt;br /&gt;d. Total sludge max.&lt;br /&gt;2.5 * 1012Ω-cm&lt;br /&gt;0.2 * 1012Ω-cm&lt;br /&gt;0.20&lt;br /&gt;0.05 mg KOH/g&lt;br /&gt;0.05% by weight.&lt;br /&gt;IS-12177:1987&lt;br /&gt;IS-6103:1971&lt;br /&gt;IS-6262:1971&lt;br /&gt;IS-1448(P:2):1967&lt;br /&gt;IS-12177&lt;br /&gt;Presence oxidation&lt;br /&gt;inhibitor&lt;br /&gt;The oil shall contain&lt;br /&gt;antioxidant additives&lt;br /&gt;IS-13631:1992 See note 3&lt;br /&gt;Water content max. 50 ppm IS-13567:1992&lt;br /&gt;SK value Under consideration&lt;br /&gt;Notes:&lt;br /&gt;1. Density of the oil may be measured at ambient temperature and converted to 29.5°C&lt;br /&gt;using the following equation.&lt;br /&gt;29.5ρ = ρt {1+X (t-29.5)}&lt;br /&gt;Where t = Ambient temperature (in °C)&lt;br /&gt;ρt = Density measured at temperature t&lt;br /&gt;X = Correction factor (Equal to 65 * 10-5).&lt;br /&gt;2. As a consequence of the tendency for water absorption to occur due to breathing on&lt;br /&gt;storage even when drums are sealed the oil shall be filtered to remove moisture and&lt;br /&gt;particulate contaminates present in the original sample before the test as follows.&lt;br /&gt;a. A sufficient quantity of oil is heated to 90 ± 2°C, then filtered hot under vacuum&lt;br /&gt;corresponding to an absolute pressure of about 2.5 kPa through a sintered glass&lt;br /&gt;filter of porosity grade 4’.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 163 -&lt;br /&gt;b. A portion of filtered is cooled in a desiccator and used immediately to measure&lt;br /&gt;electric strength, if required, and specific resistance at 27°C. The remaining hot&lt;br /&gt;filtrate is immediately used for measuring dielectric dissipation factor at 90°C and&lt;br /&gt;specific resistance at 90°C.&lt;br /&gt;3. For both phenol and amine types of indicators, qualitative methods shall be adopted.&lt;br /&gt;In case of ambiguity (marginal cases) in finding the intensity of colour, a quantitative&lt;br /&gt;method shall be adopted. Value of 0.5 (max.) shall be treated as absence of DBPCPhenolic&lt;br /&gt;type inhibitor (quantitative method for amine is under consideration).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 164 -&lt;br /&gt;2. What are the permissible limits for the transformer oil?&lt;br /&gt;Test&lt;br /&gt;required&lt;br /&gt;Equipment&lt;br /&gt;voltage&lt;br /&gt;Permissible&lt;br /&gt;limits&lt;br /&gt;Importance&lt;br /&gt;Electric&lt;br /&gt;strength&lt;br /&gt;(breakdown&lt;br /&gt;voltage)&lt;br /&gt;min.&lt;br /&gt;Above 145 kV&lt;br /&gt;145 – 72.5 kV&lt;br /&gt;50 kV&lt;br /&gt;40 kV&lt;br /&gt;30 kV&lt;br /&gt;The electric strength does not give a&lt;br /&gt;true indication of the deteriorated&lt;br /&gt;condition of the oil. An oil which is&lt;br /&gt;significantly oxidised under high&lt;br /&gt;temperature may show a high dielectric&lt;br /&gt;strength in the absence of moisture. The&lt;br /&gt;presence of oil deterioration particles,&lt;br /&gt;water and foreign contaminants results&lt;br /&gt;in general overall reduction in the&lt;br /&gt;efficiency of the equipment. A normal&lt;br /&gt;method of oil filteration and&lt;br /&gt;dehydration only maintain the electric&lt;br /&gt;strength but does not improve the&lt;br /&gt;deteriorated oil. It is therefore not&lt;br /&gt;advisable to rely solely on the electric&lt;br /&gt;strength of the oil by periodic tests&lt;br /&gt;without verifying its other&lt;br /&gt;characteristics.&lt;br /&gt;Water&lt;br /&gt;content&lt;br /&gt;(max.)&lt;br /&gt;Above 145 kV&lt;br /&gt;Below 145 kV&lt;br /&gt;25 PPM&lt;br /&gt;35 PPM&lt;br /&gt;The presence of water in oils is harmful&lt;br /&gt;as it lowers the electric strength and&lt;br /&gt;resistivity. And it reacts with solid&lt;br /&gt;insulating materials particularly paper.&lt;br /&gt;Dielectric&lt;br /&gt;dissipation&lt;br /&gt;factor (Tan&lt;br /&gt;δ delta) at&lt;br /&gt;90°C max.&lt;br /&gt;Above 145 kV&lt;br /&gt;Below 145 kV&lt;br /&gt;0.2 max.&lt;br /&gt;1.0 max.&lt;br /&gt;This characteristic is very sensitive to&lt;br /&gt;the presence in the oil of soluble&lt;br /&gt;contaminants and ageing products. This&lt;br /&gt;test is therefore of special interest. If tan&lt;br /&gt;delta increases resistivity decreases.&lt;br /&gt;This is highly influenced by&lt;br /&gt;temperature, voltage, and frequency of&lt;br /&gt;the equipment.&lt;br /&gt;Resistivity&lt;br /&gt;(min) 90°C&lt;br /&gt;All voltages 0.1 * 1012&lt;br /&gt;Ω - cm.&lt;br /&gt;The specific resistance is another&lt;br /&gt;important test for the quality of oil.&lt;br /&gt;High resistivity reflect low contents of&lt;br /&gt;free ions and ion forming particles and&lt;br /&gt;normally indicates low concentration of&lt;br /&gt;conducting contaminants. Water&lt;br /&gt;contents and cold precipitable materials&lt;br /&gt;can reduce the resistivity.&lt;br /&gt;Neutralizati All voltages 0.5 mg The acid products formed by the&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 165 -&lt;br /&gt;-on value&lt;br /&gt;(max.)&lt;br /&gt;KOH/g oxidation of the oil activity encourage&lt;br /&gt;deterioration of insulating paper and&lt;br /&gt;pressboard. It is therefore essential to&lt;br /&gt;detect and monitor this process. The test&lt;br /&gt;is required to be performed more&lt;br /&gt;frequently if value exceeds 0.3 mg&lt;br /&gt;KOH/g.&lt;br /&gt;Sediment&lt;br /&gt;and&lt;br /&gt;precipitable&lt;br /&gt;sludge&lt;br /&gt;All voltages No&lt;br /&gt;sediments&lt;br /&gt;of sludge&lt;br /&gt;should be&lt;br /&gt;detectable&lt;br /&gt;The presence of those particle normally&lt;br /&gt;reduces the electric strength of the oil&lt;br /&gt;and in addition deposits hinder heat&lt;br /&gt;exchange, thus encouraging from the&lt;br /&gt;deterioration of the insulating material.&lt;br /&gt;Flash point All voltages 125°C The test is for finding lower&lt;br /&gt;hydrocarbons which formed due to&lt;br /&gt;some incipient fault in the equipment&lt;br /&gt;such as electrical discharge, excessively&lt;br /&gt;high internal temperature core fault etc.&lt;br /&gt;this test should be made more&lt;br /&gt;frequently if the oil has been subjected&lt;br /&gt;to high temperature or shows any sign&lt;br /&gt;of unusual odour.&lt;br /&gt;Interfacial&lt;br /&gt;tension at&lt;br /&gt;27°C (min.)&lt;br /&gt;All voltages 0.018 N/m The interfacial value of oil against&lt;br /&gt;water provided a very sensitive means&lt;br /&gt;of determining the degree of oil&lt;br /&gt;contamination. We can measure the&lt;br /&gt;concentration. A low interfacial value&lt;br /&gt;indicates that the oil is damaged.&lt;br /&gt;Dissolved&lt;br /&gt;gases&lt;br /&gt;(max.) PPM&lt;br /&gt;All voltages IS :10593&lt;br /&gt;1983&lt;br /&gt;Under normal service conditions only&lt;br /&gt;small amount of CO, CO2 and very&lt;br /&gt;small quantity of H2 and hydrocarbons&lt;br /&gt;are found. Large amount of these gases&lt;br /&gt;is an indication of an incipient due to&lt;br /&gt;overheating, sparking, hotspot, arcing,&lt;br /&gt;selector breaking current, solid&lt;br /&gt;insulation deterioration etc.&lt;br /&gt;Knowledge of the effect of such faults&lt;br /&gt;in operation and safety of the power&lt;br /&gt;apparatus is of great importance, as&lt;br /&gt;transformers are required to opesrate&lt;br /&gt;over a long period of time.&lt;br /&gt;To obtain such information and rectify&lt;br /&gt;the faults at regular intervals (using&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 166 -&lt;br /&gt;dissolved gas analysis method) ensures&lt;br /&gt;trouble free operation and safety of&lt;br /&gt;equipment.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 167 -&lt;br /&gt;Recommended or permissible values for 220 kV switchyard.&lt;br /&gt;1. Rated voltage of equipment = 220 (Nominal system voltage) * 1.1&lt;br /&gt;= 245 kV&lt;br /&gt;2. Permissible duration of short circuit in network 220 kV nominal voltage = 180 ms.&lt;br /&gt;3. Permissible over voltage factors for 220 kV nominal voltage system&lt;br /&gt;a. = 220 * 6.5&lt;br /&gt;3&lt;br /&gt;= 825 kV (Approx.)&lt;br /&gt;b. Power frequency flash over (wet) voltage&lt;br /&gt;= 220 * 3.0&lt;br /&gt;3&lt;br /&gt;= 380 kV (Approx.)&lt;br /&gt;4. Cable charging breaking current requirement:-&lt;br /&gt;The CB for opening high voltage cable or cable networks should be capable of&lt;br /&gt;interrupting the charging currents of cables successfully with the over voltage within&lt;br /&gt;specified limits. The recommended value of rated cable charging breaking current&lt;br /&gt;for 220 kV (Nominal voltage) is 250 A.&lt;br /&gt;5. Impulse and power frequency with stand levels for various system voltages&lt;br /&gt;(Applicable at 20°C 760 mm of Hg pressure and 11-g/m3 humidity).&lt;br /&gt;Impulse withstand kV&lt;br /&gt;crest&lt;br /&gt;One minute power&lt;br /&gt;frequency test voltage kV&lt;br /&gt;(rms)&lt;br /&gt;Nominal&lt;br /&gt;system&lt;br /&gt;voltage&lt;br /&gt;(L-L) kV&lt;br /&gt;(rms)&lt;br /&gt;Highest&lt;br /&gt;Rated voltage&lt;br /&gt;(L-L) kV&lt;br /&gt;(rms) Full&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;(kV)&lt;br /&gt;Reduced&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;(kV)&lt;br /&gt;Full&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;(kV)&lt;br /&gt;Reduced&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;(kV)&lt;br /&gt;220 245 1050 900 460 395&lt;br /&gt;Note: Reduced insulation value – applies where internal insulation is mire important.&lt;br /&gt;Full insulation value – applies where external insulation is more important.&lt;br /&gt;6. Standard clearances:-&lt;br /&gt;For rated nominal system voltages of the order of 220 kV&lt;br /&gt;Minimum clearance to earth = 117.8 cms.&lt;br /&gt;Minimum clearance between phase in air = 205.8 cms.&lt;br /&gt;Note: clearances indicated above are applicable for effectively earthed system.&lt;br /&gt;7. Duty cycle for 220 kV ABCB:&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 168 -&lt;br /&gt;0 – 3” – CO – 3” – CO.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 169 -&lt;br /&gt;8. Operating time for 220 kV breaker:&lt;br /&gt;Opening time - 19 to 23 m sec.&lt;br /&gt;Closing time - 45 to 54 m sec.&lt;br /&gt;Blast time - 26 to 40 m sec.&lt;br /&gt;9. mV drop across the arc chambers:&lt;br /&gt;Acceptance limit – 35 mV.&lt;br /&gt;10. 220 kV isolators:&lt;br /&gt;a. mV drop test for the main contact – 11 mV for 1250 A isolators.&lt;br /&gt;7.5 mV for 2000 A isolators.&lt;br /&gt;b. Interrupting capacity of magnetising current – 0.8 A at 0.15 PF (lag)&lt;br /&gt;c. Interrupting capacity for line charging current – can interrupt charging currents of&lt;br /&gt;bus bars and cables of upto 20 – 220 kV bays.&lt;br /&gt;11. 220 kV transformers:&lt;br /&gt;Arcing horns settings for 220 kV transformer having BIL = 900 kV should be 1200&lt;br /&gt;mm.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 170 -&lt;br /&gt;Electrical or electronic equipment design factors&lt;br /&gt;1. Explosion protection&lt;br /&gt;A source of energy along with the concentration of the following factors in the&lt;br /&gt;atmosphere is all that required to trigger off an Explosion in hazardous locations.&lt;br /&gt;a. Flammable substances such as gas, vapour, mist and dust.&lt;br /&gt;b. Air / Oxygen present in the atmosphere.&lt;br /&gt;c. Ignition level.&lt;br /&gt;The factors leading to explosion also depends upon the inherent properties of gas and&lt;br /&gt;its concentration in the atmosphere.&lt;br /&gt;Developing and designing of electrical or electronic products for explosion&lt;br /&gt;protection is very much vital for safety purpose of human life as well as for plant&lt;br /&gt;sites. For design and selection of an equipment for hazardous area, it is very much&lt;br /&gt;essential to know the parameters or characteristics of the atmosphere. Measures have&lt;br /&gt;to be taken to prevent formation of explosive atmosphere and restricting the&lt;br /&gt;explosion to a safe level. Those hazardous locations are classified in to zones and&lt;br /&gt;areas as per NEC and IEC classifications.&lt;br /&gt;Types of protection.&lt;br /&gt;Areas where explosive atmospheres can occur despite the explosion protection&lt;br /&gt;measures employed, only explosion protected electrical equipment may be used.&lt;br /&gt;Explosion protected electrical equipment can be manufactured to following&lt;br /&gt;protection type levels.&lt;br /&gt;Protection&lt;br /&gt;type&lt;br /&gt;Basic principal Principal application&lt;br /&gt;Flame –&lt;br /&gt;proof&lt;br /&gt;enclosure d&lt;br /&gt;Part which can ignite an explosive&lt;br /&gt;atmosphere are placed in an enclosure&lt;br /&gt;which, if there is an ignition of an&lt;br /&gt;explosive mixture internally, will&lt;br /&gt;withstand the pressure and prevent the&lt;br /&gt;explosion being transmitted to the&lt;br /&gt;atmosphere around the enclosure.&lt;br /&gt;Switchgear and switching&lt;br /&gt;installations, control and&lt;br /&gt;display units, control&lt;br /&gt;boards, motors,&lt;br /&gt;transformers, heating&lt;br /&gt;devices, light fittings.&lt;br /&gt;Increased&lt;br /&gt;safety e&lt;br /&gt;Additional measures are taken to&lt;br /&gt;achieve a higher level of safety and&lt;br /&gt;avoid the risk of impermissibly high&lt;br /&gt;temperature and the occurrence of&lt;br /&gt;electrical equipment, which in normal&lt;br /&gt;use produce neither sparks arcs or&lt;br /&gt;dangerous temperature.&lt;br /&gt;Terminal and connected&lt;br /&gt;boxes, control boxes for&lt;br /&gt;the installation of&lt;br /&gt;excomponents (which are&lt;br /&gt;protected in another&lt;br /&gt;protection call), squirrel&lt;br /&gt;cage motors, light fittings.&lt;br /&gt;Pressurised&lt;br /&gt;apparatus p&lt;br /&gt;The formation of an explosive&lt;br /&gt;atmosphere inside an enclosure is&lt;br /&gt;prevented by using a protective gas to&lt;br /&gt;maintain an internal overpressure&lt;br /&gt;Switching and control&lt;br /&gt;cabinets, analysis devices,&lt;br /&gt;large motors.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 171 -&lt;br /&gt;relative to the surrounding atmosphere,&lt;br /&gt;and if necessary, the interior of the&lt;br /&gt;enclosure is permanently supplied with&lt;br /&gt;protective gas so that there is dilution of&lt;br /&gt;flammable mixtures.&lt;br /&gt;Intrinsic&lt;br /&gt;safety i&lt;br /&gt;The equipment placed in the hazardous&lt;br /&gt;are contains only intrinsically safe&lt;br /&gt;circuits. A circuit is intrinsically safe if&lt;br /&gt;no sparks or thermal effects occur under&lt;br /&gt;established test conditions (including&lt;br /&gt;the normal operating and certain fault&lt;br /&gt;conditions), which could lead to the&lt;br /&gt;ignition of a given explosive&lt;br /&gt;atmosphere.&lt;br /&gt;Measurement and control&lt;br /&gt;equipment,&lt;br /&gt;communications&lt;br /&gt;equipments, sensors,&lt;br /&gt;actuators.&lt;br /&gt;Oil&lt;br /&gt;immersion&lt;br /&gt;(o)&lt;br /&gt;Electrical equipment or parts of&lt;br /&gt;electrical equipment are immersed in a&lt;br /&gt;protective liquid in such a way that an&lt;br /&gt;explosive atmosphere above the surface&lt;br /&gt;or outside the enclosure cannot be&lt;br /&gt;ignited.&lt;br /&gt;Transformers, starting&lt;br /&gt;resistors.&lt;br /&gt;Powder&lt;br /&gt;filling q&lt;br /&gt;Type of protection by which the&lt;br /&gt;equipment parts that could become and&lt;br /&gt;ignition source are fixed in position and&lt;br /&gt;completely surrounded by finely ground&lt;br /&gt;solids, so as to prevent ignition of an&lt;br /&gt;external explosive atmosphere.&lt;br /&gt;Electronic devices&lt;br /&gt;Moulding m Parts, which can ignite an explosive&lt;br /&gt;atmosphere, are embedded in a casing&lt;br /&gt;compound so that the explosive&lt;br /&gt;atmosphere cannot be ignited.&lt;br /&gt;Switchgear for low&lt;br /&gt;powers, control gear and&lt;br /&gt;indicating equipment,&lt;br /&gt;display equipments,&lt;br /&gt;sensors.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 172 -&lt;br /&gt;2. Index of protection (IP)&lt;br /&gt;IP (index of protection) for enclosures of electrical equipment as per IS: 13947&lt;br /&gt;(Part-1): 1993 are as following.&lt;br /&gt;Protection against solids Protection against liquids Mechanical protection&lt;br /&gt;IP Principal IP Principal IP Principal&lt;br /&gt;0 No protection. 0 No protection. 0 No protection&lt;br /&gt;1 Protected against solid&lt;br /&gt;bodies larger than 50&lt;br /&gt;mm (eg:- accidental&lt;br /&gt;contact with the hand).&lt;br /&gt;1 Protected against&lt;br /&gt;vertically falling&lt;br /&gt;drops of water&lt;br /&gt;(condensation).&lt;br /&gt;1 Impact energy 0.225&lt;br /&gt;joule.&lt;br /&gt;2 Protected against solid&lt;br /&gt;bodies larger than 12&lt;br /&gt;mm (eg:- finger of the&lt;br /&gt;hand).&lt;br /&gt;2 Protected against&lt;br /&gt;drops of water&lt;br /&gt;falling at upto 15°&lt;br /&gt;from the vertical.&lt;br /&gt;2 Impact energy 0.375&lt;br /&gt;joule.&lt;br /&gt;3 Protected against solid&lt;br /&gt;bodies larger than 2.5&lt;br /&gt;mm (eg:- tools, wires).&lt;br /&gt;3 Protected against&lt;br /&gt;drops of rain water&lt;br /&gt;at upto 60° from the&lt;br /&gt;vertical.&lt;br /&gt;3 Impact energy 0.500&lt;br /&gt;joule.&lt;br /&gt;4 Protected against solid&lt;br /&gt;bodies larger than 1&lt;br /&gt;mm (fine tools and&lt;br /&gt;small wires).&lt;br /&gt;4 Protected against&lt;br /&gt;projections of water&lt;br /&gt;from all directions.&lt;br /&gt;5 Impact energy 2.00&lt;br /&gt;joule.&lt;br /&gt;5 Protected against dust&lt;br /&gt;(no harmful deposit).&lt;br /&gt;5 Protected against jets&lt;br /&gt;of water from all&lt;br /&gt;directions.&lt;br /&gt;7 Impact energy 6.00&lt;br /&gt;joule.&lt;br /&gt;6 Completely protected&lt;br /&gt;against dust.&lt;br /&gt;6 Protected against jets&lt;br /&gt;of water of similar&lt;br /&gt;force to heavy seas.&lt;br /&gt;9 Impact energy 20.00&lt;br /&gt;joule.&lt;br /&gt;7 Protected against the&lt;br /&gt;effects of immersion.&lt;br /&gt;8 Protected against&lt;br /&gt;prolonged effects of&lt;br /&gt;immersion under pressure.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 173 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 174 -&lt;br /&gt;Thyristor engineering&lt;br /&gt;Introduction&lt;br /&gt;Thyristor is the name of a large family of semiconductor devices, which includes the&lt;br /&gt;following.&lt;br /&gt;a. Silicon controlled rectifier (SCR).&lt;br /&gt;b. Triac.&lt;br /&gt;c. Diac.&lt;br /&gt;d. Silicon controlled switch (SCS).&lt;br /&gt;e. Light activated switch (LAS) etc.&lt;br /&gt;But in general the silicon controlled rectifier is referred to as thyristor. This device finds&lt;br /&gt;extensive applications in industrial equipments such as rectifiers, inverters, choppers&lt;br /&gt;etc. In our station thyristors are used in the following equipments.&lt;br /&gt;a. Main generator static excitation system.&lt;br /&gt;b. Power UPS.&lt;br /&gt;c. Control UPS.&lt;br /&gt;d. Diesel generator excitation system and etc.&lt;br /&gt;Construction of thyristor&lt;br /&gt;The thyristor is a four-layer P-N-P-N semiconductor device. The biasing at the three&lt;br /&gt;junctions J1, J2, J3 determine the state of the thyristor. Ohmic connections are made to&lt;br /&gt;the P, P, N regions and these terminals thus formed are called Anode, Gate, and&lt;br /&gt;Cathode respectively. This is shown in the figure below.&lt;br /&gt;J1 J2 J3&lt;br /&gt;A C&lt;br /&gt;A P N P N C&lt;br /&gt;G&lt;br /&gt;G&lt;br /&gt;Difference between diode and thyristor&lt;br /&gt;Diode is an uncontrolled rectifier device whereas a thyristor is a controlled rectifier&lt;br /&gt;device. The condition for the conduction of a diode is that the anode must be positive&lt;br /&gt;with respect to the cathode. In case of a thyristor in addition to the above condition a&lt;br /&gt;positive gate pulse should also be applied to the gate terminal. By controlling the instant&lt;br /&gt;of the pulse release the conduction of the thyristor can be controlled.&lt;br /&gt;A C&lt;br /&gt;AC input DC output&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 175 -&lt;br /&gt;V – I characteristics of thyristor&lt;br /&gt;The thyristor characteristics are divided into four regions of operation. They are as&lt;br /&gt;follows.&lt;br /&gt;a. Forward blocking region.&lt;br /&gt;b. Forward conduction region (Useful region of operation).&lt;br /&gt;c. Reverse blocking region.&lt;br /&gt;d. Reverse conduction or breakdown region.&lt;br /&gt;a. Forward blocking region: When an external voltage is applied to the thyristor&lt;br /&gt;making anode positive with respect to the cathode, the thyristor is said to be ‘forward&lt;br /&gt;biased’. In this conditions&lt;br /&gt;1. Junctions J1 &amp;amp; J3 are forward biased.&lt;br /&gt;2. Junction J2 is reverse biased.&lt;br /&gt;3. A small forward leakage current flows which increases with the applied voltage.&lt;br /&gt;The thyristor is in the ‘off state’ since the voltage applied is less than the break over&lt;br /&gt;voltage of the device. This is represented by region OA in the characteristic graph.&lt;br /&gt;b. Forward conduction region: As the forward voltage is increased, a point is reached&lt;br /&gt;where the junction J2 gets forward biased and allows a large current to flow through&lt;br /&gt;the device. This voltage is known as the ‘forward break over voltage’. Above this&lt;br /&gt;point the voltage across the device falls to a low value and the current is limited only&lt;br /&gt;by the external load resistance. This is represented ‘purpose of gate triggering’.&lt;br /&gt;As seen above thyristors can conduct even in the absence of gate pulses provided the&lt;br /&gt;forward voltage across them is more than the break over voltage. The application of&lt;br /&gt;the positive gate pulse reduces the break over voltage and the thyristor starts&lt;br /&gt;conducting at a much lower forward voltage. This characteristics of the thyristor&lt;br /&gt;makes it possible to control its conducting period in each cycle of the applied voltage&lt;br /&gt;by the release of gate pulses at the desired instant. The firing circuit or the pulse&lt;br /&gt;generator generates the firing pulses, the position (with reference to the voltage&lt;br /&gt;across the thyristor) of which depends on the DC voltage signal given to it by the&lt;br /&gt;controller (voltage, current regulator). This is shown in the diagram given below.&lt;br /&gt;AC Input&lt;br /&gt;Synchronizing Voltage&lt;br /&gt;Thyristor&lt;br /&gt;V ref&lt;br /&gt;Controller Pulse Gen. Pulse&lt;br /&gt;V feed back (AVR) (Firing ckt) amplifier&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 176 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 177 -&lt;br /&gt;c. Reverse blocking region: When a reverse voltage is applied across the thyristor in&lt;br /&gt;such a way that the anode is at a negative potential with respect to the cathode the&lt;br /&gt;thyristor is said to be ‘reversed biased’. Under this condition,&lt;br /&gt;1. Junctions J1 and J3 are reversed biased.&lt;br /&gt;2. Junction J2 is forward biased.&lt;br /&gt;Only a small leakage current flows through the device, which increases with the&lt;br /&gt;applied voltage. This is indicated by region OD in the characteristics.&lt;br /&gt;d. Reverse conduction region: When the reverse voltage across the thyristor is&lt;br /&gt;increased a point is reached when the junctions J1 and J3 breakdown causing heavy&lt;br /&gt;current to flow through the device. The voltage at this point is known as the ‘reverse&lt;br /&gt;breakdown voltage’. This is indicated by region DE in the characteristics.&lt;br /&gt;Current C&lt;br /&gt;Forward conduction region&lt;br /&gt;IL&lt;br /&gt;IH&lt;br /&gt;A&lt;br /&gt;B IG1 IG=0&lt;br /&gt;O&lt;br /&gt;D VBO Voltage&lt;br /&gt;Reverse blocking&lt;br /&gt;region Forward blocking region&lt;br /&gt;Reverse conduction&lt;br /&gt;region&lt;br /&gt;IL – latching current.&lt;br /&gt;IH – holding current.&lt;br /&gt;VBO – break over voltage.&lt;br /&gt;IG – gate current.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 178 -&lt;br /&gt;Some important technical terms&lt;br /&gt;a. Latching current: It is the minimum ON state current required to keep the thyristor in&lt;br /&gt;the ON state after the triggering pulse has been removed. In control and power&lt;br /&gt;ACVR’s this has been achieved by bleeder or dummy load resistances connected&lt;br /&gt;across the output terminals (DC side).&lt;br /&gt;b. Holding current: It is the value of anode current below, which the thyristor in&lt;br /&gt;conduction (ON state) turns OFF. Thus holding current is ON state to OFF state&lt;br /&gt;current where as latching current is OFF state to ON state current.&lt;br /&gt;c. Firing angle: The instant at which the gate pulse is released expressed in electrical&lt;br /&gt;degrees with reference to the applied voltage across the thyristor is known as ‘firing&lt;br /&gt;angle’. For rectifier mode of operation the firing angle will be between 0° to 90°.&lt;br /&gt;Greater the firing angle lesser will be the output voltage of the rectifier. This is&lt;br /&gt;illustrated in the figure given below.&lt;br /&gt;Firing angle 30° Firing angle 70°&lt;br /&gt;0° 180° 360° 0° 180° 360°&lt;br /&gt;30° 70°&lt;br /&gt;VDC VDC&lt;br /&gt;V VDC V VDC&lt;br /&gt;d. Triggering: The process of switching the thyristor ON by the application of the gate&lt;br /&gt;pulse is known as triggering.&lt;br /&gt;e. Ripple: The AC components in the DC output of any rectifier are called the ripple. In&lt;br /&gt;control and power ACVR’s on no load the ripple voltage is about 80 V AC at a DC&lt;br /&gt;output voltage of 260 V. This AC voltage indicates the conduction of all the&lt;br /&gt;thyristors in the bridge. For example the ripple voltage of ACVR’s rise to about 140&lt;br /&gt;V AC if one thyristor of the bridge does not conduct.&lt;br /&gt;f. Filter: Filters are used to remove the ripple components from the output of any&lt;br /&gt;rectifier so that it does not reach the load circuit. Inductors and capacitors are used as&lt;br /&gt;filters in the output of rectifiers.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 179 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 180 -&lt;br /&gt;Protection of thyristors&lt;br /&gt;The thyristor is a very sensitive semiconductor device and it needs to be protected for&lt;br /&gt;the following abnormal conditions while in service.&lt;br /&gt;a. High dv/dt.&lt;br /&gt;b. High di/dt&lt;br /&gt;c. Short circuit / over current.&lt;br /&gt;High dv/dt: This indicates the rate of rise of anode voltage. This rating specified for a&lt;br /&gt;particular thyristor should not be exceeded because it would lead to spurious triggering&lt;br /&gt;(switching ON) of the thyristor. The ‘snubber circuit’ (a resistance and a capacitance in&lt;br /&gt;series) connected across the thyristor as shown below provides the protection against&lt;br /&gt;high dv/dt.&lt;br /&gt;R C&lt;br /&gt;Thyristor&lt;br /&gt;High di/dt: This rating of the thyristor indicates the maximum rate of rise of ON-state&lt;br /&gt;current. When a thyristor is turned ON conduction starts at one or more places near the&lt;br /&gt;gate. Small area of conduction then spreads from these points to the whole crystal.&lt;br /&gt;Sudden rise of current causes ‘hot spots’ in the junctions and subsequent failure of the&lt;br /&gt;device due to melting. Connecting an inductor in series with the thyristor shown below&lt;br /&gt;provides protection against high di/dt.&lt;br /&gt;R C&lt;br /&gt;L&lt;br /&gt;Thyristor&lt;br /&gt;Short circuit protection: A semi conductor fuse in series with the thyristor provides&lt;br /&gt;protection against short circuits. The semi conductor fuses operate very fast with prearcing&lt;br /&gt;time less than 0.5 m-sec and arcing time of about 3 m-sec. Hence the fault&lt;br /&gt;current will be interrupted by these fuses before it reaches its maximum value.&lt;br /&gt;R C Isc&lt;br /&gt;L S.C. Fuse&lt;br /&gt;Thyristor&lt;br /&gt;Arcing time&lt;br /&gt;Clearing time&lt;br /&gt;Melting time&lt;br /&gt;Semi conductor fuse characteristics&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 181 -&lt;br /&gt;Testing of thyristor&lt;br /&gt;1. Resistance checks: The anode – cathode resistance and gate – cathode resistance of&lt;br /&gt;the thyristor should be as follows.&lt;br /&gt;Anode – cathode resistance for power thyristors&lt;br /&gt;In the forward direction – about 1 MΩ.&lt;br /&gt;In the reverse direction – about 1 MΩ.&lt;br /&gt;Gate – cathode resistance about 25Ω in both the directions.&lt;br /&gt;In case of fused thyristor these resistances will be zero Ω.&lt;br /&gt;2. Current deflection test: The thyristor should be connected to a power supply as&lt;br /&gt;shown below.&lt;br /&gt;A K Ammeter&lt;br /&gt;G&lt;br /&gt;R Switch&lt;br /&gt;Power supply&lt;br /&gt;The moment the switch is closed the thyristor conducts and the ammeter reads the&lt;br /&gt;current. If there is no deflection in the meter it shows that the thyristor is faulty. This&lt;br /&gt;is a foolproof method for testing any thyristor. The above testing can also be done&lt;br /&gt;with the help of a motwane analog multimeter. The arrangement for the same is as&lt;br /&gt;follows.&lt;br /&gt;A K&lt;br /&gt;G&lt;br /&gt;(+)&lt;br /&gt;Ammeter&lt;br /&gt;Switch&lt;br /&gt;(–)&lt;br /&gt;Motwane ammeter selected in resistance range.&lt;br /&gt;Switch open high resistance.&lt;br /&gt;Switch closed zero resistance.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 182 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 183 -&lt;br /&gt;Miscellaneous (Tests on power cables)&lt;br /&gt;1. What are precautions to be taken while doing maintenance or repair work on power&lt;br /&gt;cables?&lt;br /&gt;A research organised by EPRI (electric power research institute) on medium voltage&lt;br /&gt;XLPE cables found that DC high potential at 80% of the factory value&lt;br /&gt;a. Subsequently reduces the life of the cable and&lt;br /&gt;b. It did not identify significantly weakened cable.&lt;br /&gt;Based on above research recommended maintenance proof test voltage = 60% of the&lt;br /&gt;factory test voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Maintenance and repair:&lt;br /&gt;Before attempting for any corrective maintenance on power cables like replacement&lt;br /&gt;of lugs or jointing of cables following should be taken care&lt;br /&gt;a. IR value should be good and it should be comparable to the previous values.&lt;br /&gt;b. The quality of joints should be such that it dies not add any resistance to the&lt;br /&gt;circuit. Before jointing is commenced it is advisable that IR of both sections of&lt;br /&gt;cable to be jointed be checked.&lt;br /&gt;c. Before jointing a paper insulating cable (for PVC cables this step is not required),&lt;br /&gt;the paper insulation should be tested for the presence of moisture by immersion in&lt;br /&gt;hot compound for paraffin wax at a temperature between 120°C and 140°C. the&lt;br /&gt;presence of moisture indicated by the formation of bubbles when a piece of the&lt;br /&gt;paper is immersed in hot compound. Use only single strip of the paper.&lt;br /&gt;d. In case dia of die to be used for crimping is slightly more than dia of cables, then&lt;br /&gt;use some loose strand before doing crimping of lug. While crimping it should be&lt;br /&gt;ensured that homogeneity of cramped conductor strands is achieved otherwise it&lt;br /&gt;will add resistance and create over heating.&lt;br /&gt;2. What are the tests to be carried out during DC high voltage test on power cables?&lt;br /&gt;DC high voltage testing.&lt;br /&gt;During DC high voltage testing flow of following currents will take place.&lt;br /&gt;a. Capacitance charging current.&lt;br /&gt;b. Dielectric absorption current.&lt;br /&gt;c. Surface leakage current.&lt;br /&gt;d. Partial discharge current (corona).&lt;br /&gt;e. Volumetric leakage current.&lt;br /&gt;a. Capacitance charging current.&lt;br /&gt;The capacitance charging current is high as the DC high potential is applied and can&lt;br /&gt;be calculated by the formula&lt;br /&gt;ig = E – t where ig – capacitance charging current.&lt;br /&gt;rc / R E – voltage in kilovolts.&lt;br /&gt;r – resistance in mega ohms.&lt;br /&gt;c – capacitance in micro farads.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 184 -&lt;br /&gt;t – time in seconds.&lt;br /&gt;The charging current is a function of time and will decrease as the time of the&lt;br /&gt;application of voltage increases. It is the initial charging current when voltage is&lt;br /&gt;applied and therefore not of any value for test evaluation. Test readings should be&lt;br /&gt;taken until this current has decreased to a sufficiently low value.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 185 -&lt;br /&gt;b. Dielectric absorption current.&lt;br /&gt;The Dielectric absorption current is also high as the test voltage is applied and&lt;br /&gt;decreases as the voltage applicable time increases. This current can be calculated by&lt;br /&gt;the formula&lt;br /&gt;ia =VCDT-n&lt;br /&gt;Where ia – dielectric absorption current.&lt;br /&gt;V – test voltage in kilovolts.&lt;br /&gt;C – capacitance in micro farads.&lt;br /&gt;D – proportionately constant.&lt;br /&gt;T – time in seconds.&lt;br /&gt;n – constant.&lt;br /&gt;Again time should be allowed before recording test readings so that this current has&lt;br /&gt;decreased sufficiently.&lt;br /&gt;c. Surface leakage.&lt;br /&gt;The surface leakage current is due to the conduction on the surface of the insulation&lt;br /&gt;and not desired in test results and should therefore be eliminated by carefully&lt;br /&gt;cleaning the surface.&lt;br /&gt;d. Partial discharge current.&lt;br /&gt;The partial discharge current, also known as corona current is caused b ionization of&lt;br /&gt;air due to high-test voltage. This current is not desirable and same is normally&lt;br /&gt;controlled by providing semi-conducting tape to separate the conductor from&lt;br /&gt;insulation.&lt;br /&gt;Semi-conducting tape is used to separate the conductor from the insulation to prevent&lt;br /&gt;possible damage of the insulation from the corona and ionization. The voltage may&lt;br /&gt;develop between stranded conductor and insulation, thereby causing the ionization of&lt;br /&gt;air and breakdown of cable insulation. The application of semi-conducting smoothes&lt;br /&gt;the voltage stress and keeps such voltage stress constant and to a minimum.&lt;br /&gt;e. Volumetric leakage current.&lt;br /&gt;The volumetric leakage current flows through the insulation volume itself. This is the&lt;br /&gt;current that is used to evaluate the condition of the insulation under test. Sufficient&lt;br /&gt;time should be allowed for the volumetric current to stabilize before test readings are&lt;br /&gt;recorded.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 186 -&lt;br /&gt;Predictive (preventive) maintenance on Induction Motor.&lt;br /&gt;1. What are the reasons for high current in motor?&lt;br /&gt;a. High frequency – at 51 Hz current will be 105% of the normal current.&lt;br /&gt;b. Low frequency – at 47.8 Hz current will be 102% of the normal current.&lt;br /&gt;c. High voltage.&lt;br /&gt;d. Under voltage.&lt;br /&gt;e. Mechanical over loading.&lt;br /&gt;f. Process requirement.&lt;br /&gt;2. What are the reasons for unbalanced current in motor?&lt;br /&gt;a. Loose power cable connection.&lt;br /&gt;b. Voltage unbalance.&lt;br /&gt;c. Short-circuited turns of coils of winding.&lt;br /&gt;3. What are the reasons for vibration in the motor?&lt;br /&gt;Vibration could be because of mechanical faults and electrical faults.&lt;br /&gt;1. Mechanical faults.&lt;br /&gt;a. Wrong alignment of the motor on foundation.&lt;br /&gt;b. Wrong installation.&lt;br /&gt;c. Improper fitting of bearing and cooling fans.&lt;br /&gt;d. Periodic impulse loads such as reciprocating compressors.&lt;br /&gt;e. Pulley of heavy weight which cause bending of motor shaft resulting in non&lt;br /&gt;uniform air gap.&lt;br /&gt;f. Damage of bearing or bad bearing.&lt;br /&gt;g. Bad coupling.&lt;br /&gt;h. If the axial alignment of the motor and the driven machine is incorrect and&lt;br /&gt;rotor is allowed to contact its axial stops, high axial vibrations may occur,&lt;br /&gt;together with high bearing temperature high and even bearing failure.&lt;br /&gt;i. Machine base and foundation problem.&lt;br /&gt;j. Under sized bearing.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 187 -&lt;br /&gt;2. Electrical faults.&lt;br /&gt;a. Air gas dissymetry.&lt;br /&gt;b. Broken rotor bars.&lt;br /&gt;c. Slackened stator core.&lt;br /&gt;d. Slackened rotor core.&lt;br /&gt;e. Interturn short in the rotor winding in the two-pole machine.&lt;br /&gt;f. Unbalance in rotor winding.&lt;br /&gt;g. Unbalance power supply voltages.&lt;br /&gt;If the vibration is because of electrical fault, de-energise the machine and&lt;br /&gt;watch the vibration as it runs down.&lt;br /&gt;The possible vibration frequencies observed are&lt;br /&gt;a. Twice the power supply frequency – it indicates that the vibration is developed&lt;br /&gt;by unbalanced power supply voltages, unbalanced air gap, unbalance in rotor&lt;br /&gt;winding, slackened stator core etc.&lt;br /&gt;b. Multiple of power frequency – the stator and rotor slots co-ordinate to develop&lt;br /&gt;radial lines of force to deform and pulsate the cores.&lt;br /&gt;c. Twice the slip frequency – magnetic unbalance due to unbalance air gaps,&lt;br /&gt;slackened rotor core, interturn short in the rotor-winding etc. of two-pole&lt;br /&gt;machine.&lt;br /&gt;d. Beat (Humming) – in case of two-pole machine the beat is developed when&lt;br /&gt;the vibration of twice as much as power frequency developed between the&lt;br /&gt;stator and rotor is superimposed on the vibration of twice the slip frequency&lt;br /&gt;developed due to irregular air gap.&lt;br /&gt;4. What are the reasons for winding temperature high in the motor?&lt;br /&gt;For motors having class – B insulation the temperature should not be more than&lt;br /&gt;110°C and for motors having class – F insulation the temperature should not be more&lt;br /&gt;than 130°C. In case temperature is more, then the following could be the possible&lt;br /&gt;reasons.&lt;br /&gt;1. Electrical overloads.&lt;br /&gt;a. Over and under voltage.&lt;br /&gt;b. Over and under frequency.&lt;br /&gt;c. Voltage unbalance. Voltage unbalance create unbalance of currents and&lt;br /&gt;increase in temperature which will be 2*(% voltage unbalance)* (% voltage&lt;br /&gt;unbalance)*.&lt;br /&gt;(% Voltage unbalance) = 100 * maximum deviation from average voltage&lt;br /&gt;average voltage.&lt;br /&gt;For instance if voltages are 390V, 410V &amp;amp; 440V,&lt;br /&gt;% Voltage variation = 100*(440-390+410+440) (440-390+410+440) = 6.45%.&lt;br /&gt;3 3&lt;br /&gt;Therefore increase in temperature rise = 2*(6.45)*(6.45) = 83°C (approximately).&lt;br /&gt;d. Voltage transients and interruptions.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 188 -&lt;br /&gt;e. Loose connection at motor terminals.&lt;br /&gt;f. Unbalance current.&lt;br /&gt;g. Single phasing (if OLR protection is not working).&lt;br /&gt;h. Long acceleration cycle.&lt;br /&gt;i. Unusual system grounding conditions.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 189 -&lt;br /&gt;2. Mechanical overloads.&lt;br /&gt;a. Locked rotor.&lt;br /&gt;b. Heavy starting.&lt;br /&gt;c. Bearing problem.&lt;br /&gt;d. Overload in continuous duty and intermittent duty.&lt;br /&gt;3. Environmental overloads.&lt;br /&gt;a. Excessive temperature of cooling medium or ambient temperature.&lt;br /&gt;b. Restricted flow of cooling.&lt;br /&gt;c. Reduction in the density of cooling medium.&lt;br /&gt;d. Heat transfer from machine parts connected to the motor.&lt;br /&gt;4. Others.&lt;br /&gt;a. Excessive number of switching operations.&lt;br /&gt;5. What are the reasons for bearing temperature high?&lt;br /&gt;Temperature of bearing should not be more than 90°C. In case temperature is higher&lt;br /&gt;than the 90°C the following could be the possible reasons.&lt;br /&gt;a. Inadequate lubricants inside the bearing.&lt;br /&gt;b. Faulty bearing.&lt;br /&gt;c. Bearing is jammed.&lt;br /&gt;d. Over greasing.&lt;br /&gt;e. Improper grade of lubricant.&lt;br /&gt;6. What are the reasons for abnormal sound or noise?&lt;br /&gt;Motors in general should run very quietly and no abnormal noise is desired.&lt;br /&gt;However if noise is there, it could be because of following reasons.&lt;br /&gt;a. Windage noise – the noise due to ventilating system, (whistling noise).&lt;br /&gt;b. Bearing noise – the noise due to its rolling contact.&lt;br /&gt;c. Unusual noise – some defects inside the motor (example – motor bar failure).&lt;br /&gt;d. Deep heavy growling noises – some electrical fault.&lt;br /&gt;For permissible limits of noise levels for rotating electrical machines IS: 12065:1987&lt;br /&gt;is being reffered.&lt;br /&gt;7. What are the reasons for harmonics in the motor?&lt;br /&gt;Generally even harmonics are not expected to be present in three phase motors.&lt;br /&gt;Triple-n harmonics like 3rd, 9th, 15th etc. are also not expected. The dominant odd&lt;br /&gt;harmonics expected are 5th, 7th, 11th and 13th etc.&lt;br /&gt;Presence of strong 2nd harmonics indicates unbalance voltage, unbalance winding&lt;br /&gt;impedance, rotor defects, magnetic imbalance, faulty rotor skewing etc.&lt;br /&gt;Very strong 3rd harmonics indicates magnetic saturation, ground leak currents,&lt;br /&gt;overloads etc. Overloading causes overheating, resulting in non-linear magnetization&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 190 -&lt;br /&gt;which gives high 3rd harmonic winding faults, short circuits. Hot spots in rotor or&lt;br /&gt;stator also may indicate higher harmonics.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 191 -&lt;br /&gt;8. What are the possible reasons for not coming of rated speed during start?&lt;br /&gt;In case motor does not come to its rated speed then following could be the probable&lt;br /&gt;causes.&lt;br /&gt;a. Starting load is too high.&lt;br /&gt;b. Broken rotor bars (look for cracks near rings).&lt;br /&gt;c. Open primary circuit.&lt;br /&gt;d. Voltage is too low.&lt;br /&gt;9. What are the possible reasons for motor to take long acceleration time?&lt;br /&gt;Following may the possible reasons for motor to take long acceleration time.&lt;br /&gt;a. Excess loading.&lt;br /&gt;b. May be rewound motor with poor quality of winding conductor having high&lt;br /&gt;resistance.&lt;br /&gt;c. Defective squirrel cage rotor.&lt;br /&gt;d. Applied voltage is too low.&lt;br /&gt;10. What are the points contributes in insulation resistance of the motor?&lt;br /&gt;If the measured insulation resistance of the motor is less than 1 MΩ / kV with a&lt;br /&gt;minimum of 1MΩ, when the machine is cold it is to be dried out before full voltage&lt;br /&gt;is applied to the terminals of the motors and the drying out is to be continued as long&lt;br /&gt;as the insulation resistance rises or until a sufficiently high value that is not less than&lt;br /&gt;1 MΩ / kV with minimum of I MΩ at 75°C is reached.&lt;br /&gt;While proceeding for point as above said, following factors are to be kept in mind&lt;br /&gt;which affect the insulation resistance measurement. They are,&lt;br /&gt;a. Surface condition.&lt;br /&gt;b. Moisture.&lt;br /&gt;c. Temperature.&lt;br /&gt;d. Magnitude of test voltage.&lt;br /&gt;e. Duration of application of test voltage.&lt;br /&gt;f. Residual charge in the winding.&lt;br /&gt;g. Ageing of the insulation.&lt;br /&gt;h. Mechanical stresses.&lt;br /&gt;11. What are the minimum recommended PI values for AC and DC rotating machines?&lt;br /&gt;Following minimum recommended PI values criteria is to be followed.&lt;br /&gt;a. 1.5 for class – A insulation.&lt;br /&gt;b. 2.0 for class – B insulation.&lt;br /&gt;c. 2.5 for class – F insulation.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 192 -&lt;br /&gt;12. What is the minimum recommended absorption coefficient value for AC and DC&lt;br /&gt;rotating machines?&lt;br /&gt;Absorption coefficient = IR value for 60 seconds = 1.3 (minimum recommended value)&lt;br /&gt;IR value for 15 seconds&lt;br /&gt;Tips:&lt;br /&gt;a. IR value decreases some what with an increase I applied voltage. However for&lt;br /&gt;machines in good condition substantially the same IR is obtained for any test&lt;br /&gt;voltage up to the peak value of the rated operating voltage.&lt;br /&gt;b. If the IR value decreases significantly with an increase in applied voltage it is an&lt;br /&gt;indication of imperfections or fractures of the insulation aggravated by the&lt;br /&gt;presence of dirt or moisture or may be due to the effects of dirt or moisture alone,&lt;br /&gt;or may result from numerous other phenomena not necessarily associated with&lt;br /&gt;any defect or weakness.&lt;br /&gt;c. IR value for good dry winding continue to increase for hours with constant test&lt;br /&gt;voltage continuously applied, however a fairly steady value is usually reached in&lt;br /&gt;10 to 15 minutes. If the winding is wet or dry or dirty the steady value is usually&lt;br /&gt;reached in 1 or 2 minutes after the test voltage is applied.&lt;br /&gt;d. The recommended minimum IR value for AC and DC machines is determined by&lt;br /&gt;the following empirical relationship.&lt;br /&gt;IR = kV + 1&lt;br /&gt;Where IR = recommended minimum IR in mega ohms at 40°C of the entire&lt;br /&gt;machine winding and kV = rated machine voltage in kilo volts.&lt;br /&gt;Temperature correction is to be applied, if winding is not at a temperature of&lt;br /&gt;40°C.&lt;br /&gt;e. IR of the one phase of three phases winding with other two phases earthed, is&lt;br /&gt;approximately twice that of the entire winding. Therefore when the three phases&lt;br /&gt;are tested separately, the observed insulation resistance of each phase should be&lt;br /&gt;divided by two to obtain a value which after correction for temperature, may be&lt;br /&gt;compared with the recommended minimum value of IR.&lt;br /&gt;13. What is use of Tan – Delta test? And what are the recommended values?&lt;br /&gt;The very purpose of this test is to detect moisture content, voids, cracks and&lt;br /&gt;deterioration in the insulation and same is to be conducted on HT motors.&lt;br /&gt;Based on the guidelines given in the article ‘Diagmistic testing on the winding&lt;br /&gt;insulation’ by J. S. Simon (IEE vol. 127 may 1980) the contamination level of motor&lt;br /&gt;winding is to be assessed from the given Tan – Delta value.&lt;br /&gt;Starting Tan – Delta values Degree of contamination&lt;br /&gt;0 – 4%. Low void content.&lt;br /&gt;4 – 6%. Clean.&lt;br /&gt;6 – 10%. Some dirt.&lt;br /&gt;10 – 14%. Dirt and moisture.&lt;br /&gt;14 – 16%. Gross contamination.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 193 -&lt;br /&gt;16 – 20%. Heavy deposit of oil dirt.&lt;br /&gt;Above 20%. Severe oil and carbon contamination.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 194 -&lt;br /&gt;14. What are important guidelines for conducting HV test?&lt;br /&gt;Based on the recommendations given in IS: 4029:1977 decided DC test voltage&lt;br /&gt;= (2E+1kV) 1.6 * M&lt;br /&gt;Where E = rated voltage.&lt;br /&gt;2.6 = AC to DC conversion factor.&lt;br /&gt;M = derator factor which is a function to be decided on the basis of the age and&lt;br /&gt;condition of equipment.&lt;br /&gt;The DC voltage applied in steps and the leakage current recorded at each step. A plot&lt;br /&gt;leakage current Vs test voltage is to be plotted as the test progress.&lt;br /&gt;Some recommendations of IS : 4029 : 1977.&lt;br /&gt;a. The HV test made on the windings on acceptance shall as far as possible not be&lt;br /&gt;repeated. If however a second test to be made at 80% of the voltage given by the&lt;br /&gt;empirical formula given above.&lt;br /&gt;b. Test voltage for completely rewound motor = full test voltage for new motor.&lt;br /&gt;c. Partially rewound or overhauled motor = 75% * full test voltage for a new motor.&lt;br /&gt;d. Before the test for the old parts of the winding shall be carefully cleaned and&lt;br /&gt;dried.&lt;br /&gt;e. Before attempting of HV DC test a minimum PI value of motor should be&lt;br /&gt;obtained.&lt;br /&gt;15. What are the uses of high voltage surge test?&lt;br /&gt;This test gives distinct wave forms giving indications of various defects such as,&lt;br /&gt;a. Turn to turn short in same phases.&lt;br /&gt;b. Coil to coil short in same phases.&lt;br /&gt;c. Partial phase to phase short.&lt;br /&gt;d. Complete phase to phase short.&lt;br /&gt;e. Improper coil connections.&lt;br /&gt;f. Reverse coil connections.&lt;br /&gt;g. Open coil connections.&lt;br /&gt;h. Short to ground partial.&lt;br /&gt;i. Short to ground complete.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 195 -&lt;br /&gt;16. What is the thumb rule for motor current?&lt;br /&gt;Thumb rule for NO LOAD current of motors.&lt;br /&gt;Type of enclosure No. of poles % No Load current of rated current&lt;br /&gt;TEFC 2 15 – 20&lt;br /&gt;TEFC 4 30 – 35&lt;br /&gt;SPDP 2 25 – 30&lt;br /&gt;SPDP 4 35 – 40&lt;br /&gt;SPDP 6 to 8 50 – 55&lt;br /&gt;SPDP 10 80&lt;br /&gt;Note: TEFC (Totally enclosed fan cooled) motors are low inductive having low&lt;br /&gt;active material in comparison to SPDP(Screen protected drip proof) motors.&lt;br /&gt;Thumb rule for calculating positive sequence and negative sequence current in&lt;br /&gt;motors.&lt;br /&gt;a. Positive sequence current: Average of all three phases currents.&lt;br /&gt;b. Negative sequence current: Maximum deviation of any of the phase currents from&lt;br /&gt;the average.&lt;br /&gt;17. How you evaluate the insulation condition based on PI value?&lt;br /&gt;Evaluation of insulation condition based on PI value&lt;br /&gt;PI value Insulation condition Recommendation&lt;br /&gt;1.0 – 1.5 Bad Drying is mandatory&lt;br /&gt;1.5 – 2.0 Doubtful Drying is recommended&lt;br /&gt;2.0 – 3.0 Adequate No drying is needed&lt;br /&gt;3.0 – 4.0 Good No drying is needed&lt;br /&gt;&gt; 4.0 Excellent No drying is needed&lt;br /&gt;18. What are the conditions monitoring for the motor bearings?&lt;br /&gt;Bearing oil analysis is a useful tool in determining bearing performance and possible&lt;br /&gt;deterioration. Periodic checks for oil colour, viscosity and acidity can aid in&lt;br /&gt;preventing or anticipating bearing failure.&lt;br /&gt;Oil analysis tests&lt;br /&gt;Symptoms Possible cause Test Cost&lt;br /&gt;Viscosity Water or high Water content Low&lt;br /&gt;temperature ASTM 445 viscosity Low&lt;br /&gt;ASTM 974 neutralization number Low&lt;br /&gt;ASTM 664 neutralization number Moderate&lt;br /&gt;Viscosity change&lt;br /&gt;colour change&lt;br /&gt;Oxidation&lt;br /&gt;ASTM 2296 neutralization number Moderate&lt;br /&gt;Spectroscopy Low&lt;br /&gt;Particle count Moderate&lt;br /&gt;Direct reading ferrography Moderate&lt;br /&gt;Particles Bearing&lt;br /&gt;deterioration or&lt;br /&gt;foreign matter&lt;br /&gt;Analytical ferrography High&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 196 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 197 -&lt;br /&gt;Important test on electrical equipments&lt;br /&gt;1. Tests on transformer.&lt;br /&gt;Test Purpose Item Required condition of machine&lt;br /&gt;IR value&lt;br /&gt;And&lt;br /&gt;PI value.&lt;br /&gt;Detects serious flaws,&lt;br /&gt;moisture absorption and&lt;br /&gt;cleanliness of winding.&lt;br /&gt;Winding. Winding has to be isolated.&lt;br /&gt;Tan delta or&lt;br /&gt;dielectric&lt;br /&gt;loss or&lt;br /&gt;power factor&lt;br /&gt;or HV test.&lt;br /&gt;Indicates insulation&lt;br /&gt;deterioration,&lt;br /&gt;contamination and&lt;br /&gt;physical damage.&lt;br /&gt;Winding,&lt;br /&gt;oil and&lt;br /&gt;bushings.&lt;br /&gt;Winding has to be isolated, oil&lt;br /&gt;sample should be collected.&lt;br /&gt;Excitation&lt;br /&gt;current at&lt;br /&gt;high voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Indicates defects in the&lt;br /&gt;magnetic core structure,&lt;br /&gt;shifting or windings,&lt;br /&gt;failures in turn to turn&lt;br /&gt;insulation.&lt;br /&gt;Winding Winding has to be isolated.&lt;br /&gt;Turns ratio Indicates short circuited&lt;br /&gt;turns and internal&lt;br /&gt;connections&lt;br /&gt;Winding Winding has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Winding&lt;br /&gt;resistance&lt;br /&gt;Detects poor&lt;br /&gt;connections and&lt;br /&gt;conductor shorts&lt;br /&gt;Winding Winding has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Core IR and&lt;br /&gt;inadvertent&lt;br /&gt;grounds&lt;br /&gt;Indicates deterioration&lt;br /&gt;of core insulation&lt;br /&gt;system&lt;br /&gt;Core Winding has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Water&lt;br /&gt;contents&lt;br /&gt;Indicates moisture level&lt;br /&gt;in oil&lt;br /&gt;Oil Oil sample has to be collected&lt;br /&gt;Total acidity,&lt;br /&gt;neutralization&lt;br /&gt;number&lt;br /&gt;Measures organic and&lt;br /&gt;inorganic acids&lt;br /&gt;Oil Oil sample has to be collected&lt;br /&gt;Dissolved&lt;br /&gt;gas analysis&lt;br /&gt;Indicates specific gases&lt;br /&gt;generated&lt;br /&gt;Oil and&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Oil sample has to be collected&lt;br /&gt;Furanite&lt;br /&gt;compounds&lt;br /&gt;Indicates cellulose&lt;br /&gt;degradation&lt;br /&gt;Winding Oil sample has to be collected&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 198 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 199 -&lt;br /&gt;2. Test on Circuit breakers&lt;br /&gt;Test Purpose Item Required condition of machine&lt;br /&gt;IR value Detects serious flaws,&lt;br /&gt;moisture absorption and&lt;br /&gt;cleanliness.&lt;br /&gt;Overall&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;system&lt;br /&gt;CB has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Dielectric&lt;br /&gt;loss or tan δ&lt;br /&gt;Indicates insulation&lt;br /&gt;deterioration,&lt;br /&gt;contamination and&lt;br /&gt;physical damage&lt;br /&gt;Overall&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;system&lt;br /&gt;CB has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;DC HV test&lt;br /&gt;(optional)&lt;br /&gt;Determines condition of&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;Overall&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;system&lt;br /&gt;CB has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Contact&lt;br /&gt;resistance&lt;br /&gt;measurement&lt;br /&gt;Detects poor contacts Contacts CB has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Timings Detects faulty dashpots,&lt;br /&gt;faulty adjustments,&lt;br /&gt;weak accelerating&lt;br /&gt;springs, defective shock&lt;br /&gt;absorbers, buffers and&lt;br /&gt;closing mechanisms, or&lt;br /&gt;broken parts&lt;br /&gt;Overall&lt;br /&gt;breaker&lt;br /&gt;CB has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;3. Tests on power cables&lt;br /&gt;Test Purpose Component Required condition of machine&lt;br /&gt;IR value Detects serious flaws,&lt;br /&gt;moisture absorption&lt;br /&gt;and cleanliness&lt;br /&gt;Overall&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;system&lt;br /&gt;Cable has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Dielectric&lt;br /&gt;loss or tan δ&lt;br /&gt;Shows insulation&lt;br /&gt;deterioration,&lt;br /&gt;contamination and&lt;br /&gt;physical damage&lt;br /&gt;Overall&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;system&lt;br /&gt;Cable has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;DC step&lt;br /&gt;voltage test&lt;br /&gt;Determines condition&lt;br /&gt;of insulation&lt;br /&gt;Overall&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;system&lt;br /&gt;Cable has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Resistance&lt;br /&gt;of bolted&lt;br /&gt;connection&lt;br /&gt;Detects poor&lt;br /&gt;connections&lt;br /&gt;Bolted&lt;br /&gt;connection&lt;br /&gt;Cable has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 200 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 201 -&lt;br /&gt;4. Tests on surge arrestor&lt;br /&gt;Test Purpose Component Required condition of machine&lt;br /&gt;IR value Detects serious flaws,&lt;br /&gt;moisture absorption&lt;br /&gt;and cleanliness&lt;br /&gt;Overall&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;system&lt;br /&gt;Arrestor has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Watts loss&lt;br /&gt;test&lt;br /&gt;Shows insulation&lt;br /&gt;deterioration,&lt;br /&gt;contamination and&lt;br /&gt;physical damage&lt;br /&gt;Overall&lt;br /&gt;condition&lt;br /&gt;Arrestor has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Resistance&lt;br /&gt;of bolted&lt;br /&gt;connection&lt;br /&gt;Detects poor&lt;br /&gt;connections&lt;br /&gt;Bolted&lt;br /&gt;connection&lt;br /&gt;Arrestor has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;5. Tests on HV motors&lt;br /&gt;Test Purpose Item Required condition of machine&lt;br /&gt;IR and PI&lt;br /&gt;value&lt;br /&gt;Detects serious flaws,&lt;br /&gt;moisture absorption and&lt;br /&gt;cleanliness of winding&lt;br /&gt;Stator and&lt;br /&gt;field&lt;br /&gt;Winding has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Tan delta&lt;br /&gt;or power factor&lt;br /&gt;test&lt;br /&gt;Evaluation of stress&lt;br /&gt;grading, dielectric losses&lt;br /&gt;and homogeneity of the&lt;br /&gt;winding insulation&lt;br /&gt;Stator&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Winding has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;DC Winding&lt;br /&gt;resistance&lt;br /&gt;Detects poor connections&lt;br /&gt;and conductor shorts&lt;br /&gt;Stator and&lt;br /&gt;field winding&lt;br /&gt;Winding has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;AC Impedance&lt;br /&gt;on poles test&lt;br /&gt;Detects the presence of&lt;br /&gt;short circuit turns&lt;br /&gt;Field&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Winding has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;DC HV step&lt;br /&gt;voltage or&lt;br /&gt;leakage current&lt;br /&gt;test&lt;br /&gt;Detects insulation&lt;br /&gt;weakness and possibility&lt;br /&gt;or warning of breakdown&lt;br /&gt;of incipient fault&lt;br /&gt;Stator&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Winding has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Surge voltage Determines healthiness of&lt;br /&gt;turn insulation&lt;br /&gt;Stator&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Winding has to be isolate&lt;br /&gt;Partial&lt;br /&gt;discharge or&lt;br /&gt;corona or TVA&lt;br /&gt;probe.&lt;br /&gt;Evaluation of stress&lt;br /&gt;grading system and&lt;br /&gt;location of partial&lt;br /&gt;discharge sites&lt;br /&gt;Stator&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Winding has to be isolated and rotor&lt;br /&gt;has to be threaded out&lt;br /&gt;ELCID test&lt;br /&gt;(optional)&lt;br /&gt;Determines healthiness of&lt;br /&gt;stator core inter&lt;br /&gt;lamination insulation&lt;br /&gt;Stator core Rotor has to be threaded out&lt;br /&gt;Online motor&lt;br /&gt;current&lt;br /&gt;signature&lt;br /&gt;analysis&lt;br /&gt;To determine the&lt;br /&gt;healthiness of the motor&lt;br /&gt;by giving all the electrical&lt;br /&gt;parameters, harmonic&lt;br /&gt;analysis, rotor bar heath&lt;br /&gt;and bearing problems&lt;br /&gt;Motor Online condition&lt;br /&gt;Wear debris Bearing condition Bearing Bearing oil or grease sample has to&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 202 -&lt;br /&gt;analysis for oil&lt;br /&gt;or grease&lt;br /&gt;assessment be collected&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 203 -&lt;br /&gt;6. Tests on HV generator&lt;br /&gt;Test Purpose Item Required condition of machine&lt;br /&gt;IR and PI Detects serious flaws,&lt;br /&gt;moisture absorption and&lt;br /&gt;cleanliness of winding&lt;br /&gt;Stator and&lt;br /&gt;field&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Bus bar and neutral connection&lt;br /&gt;has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Tan delta or&lt;br /&gt;power factor&lt;br /&gt;test&lt;br /&gt;Evaluation of stress&lt;br /&gt;grading, dielectric&lt;br /&gt;losses and homogeneity&lt;br /&gt;of the winding&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;Stator&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Bus bar and neutral connection&lt;br /&gt;has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;DC winding&lt;br /&gt;resistance&lt;br /&gt;Detects poor&lt;br /&gt;connections and&lt;br /&gt;conductor shorts&lt;br /&gt;Stator and&lt;br /&gt;field&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Bus bar and neutral connection&lt;br /&gt;has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;DC step&lt;br /&gt;voltage or&lt;br /&gt;leakage&lt;br /&gt;current test&lt;br /&gt;Detects insulation&lt;br /&gt;weakness and&lt;br /&gt;possibility of warning of&lt;br /&gt;breakdown of incipient&lt;br /&gt;fault&lt;br /&gt;Stator&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Bus bar and neutral connection&lt;br /&gt;has to be isolated&lt;br /&gt;Partial&lt;br /&gt;discharge or&lt;br /&gt;corona or&lt;br /&gt;TVA probe&lt;br /&gt;Evaluation of stress&lt;br /&gt;grading system and&lt;br /&gt;location of Partial&lt;br /&gt;Discharge sites&lt;br /&gt;Stator&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Bus bar and neutral connection&lt;br /&gt;has to be isolated. Stator slot&lt;br /&gt;exits are be accessible and if&lt;br /&gt;necessary rotor has to be&lt;br /&gt;threaded out&lt;br /&gt;ELCID test Determines healthiness&lt;br /&gt;of stator core inter&lt;br /&gt;laminar insulation&lt;br /&gt;Stator core&lt;br /&gt;insulation&lt;br /&gt;Rotor has to be threaded out in&lt;br /&gt;TG’s, where as rotor poles has to&lt;br /&gt;be removed minimum in case of&lt;br /&gt;HG’s.&lt;br /&gt;Wedge&lt;br /&gt;tightness&lt;br /&gt;check&lt;br /&gt;Determines wedge&lt;br /&gt;tightness&lt;br /&gt;Stator&lt;br /&gt;wedge&lt;br /&gt;Rotor has to be threaded out&lt;br /&gt;AC&lt;br /&gt;impedance&lt;br /&gt;test&lt;br /&gt;Detects the presence of&lt;br /&gt;short circuit turns&lt;br /&gt;Field&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Rotor winding should be isolated&lt;br /&gt;from the excitation system&lt;br /&gt;Recurrent&lt;br /&gt;surge&lt;br /&gt;oscillograph&lt;br /&gt;Detects interturn and&lt;br /&gt;earth faults in winding&lt;br /&gt;Field&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Rotor winding should be isolated&lt;br /&gt;from excitation system. Test can&lt;br /&gt;be carried out without threading&lt;br /&gt;out the rotor also&lt;br /&gt;O.C.C Detects shorted turns Field&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;Online test&lt;br /&gt;Thermal&lt;br /&gt;sensitivity&lt;br /&gt;test&lt;br /&gt;Detects vibration cause Rotor Online test&lt;br /&gt;Partial&lt;br /&gt;discharge&lt;br /&gt;To assess de-lamination,&lt;br /&gt;stress control and slot&lt;br /&gt;Stator&lt;br /&gt;winding&lt;br /&gt;PDA coupling coils has to be&lt;br /&gt;fixed to the machine&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 204 -&lt;br /&gt;analysis support tightness&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 205 -&lt;br /&gt;ELECTRICAL SYSTEM&lt;br /&gt;• What are the design objectives of Electrical System?&lt;br /&gt;a. To evacuate generated electrical power.&lt;br /&gt;b. To provide required power to SUT, UT, DG, UPS, and CUPS.&lt;br /&gt;c. To provide required emergency power from onsite DG, UPS &amp;amp; CUPS.&lt;br /&gt;d. To provide Fast transfer in event of Class IV failure. Emergency transfer in&lt;br /&gt;events of Class III and Class II failure.&lt;br /&gt;e. Load shedding in event of one DG available.&lt;br /&gt;f. To provide un-interruptible or few milli seconds interrupted power supply by&lt;br /&gt;UPS and un-interruptible power supply by CUPS.&lt;br /&gt;g. To provide operational flexibility by providing required qualities of requirement.&lt;br /&gt;h. To provide isolation, Alarms, indication, protection of the system.&lt;br /&gt;i. To provide fire protection.&lt;br /&gt;j. To provide surge and lightning protection.&lt;br /&gt;k. To provide adequate lighting.&lt;br /&gt;l. To provide equipment earthing, system earthing, and personnel protection.&lt;br /&gt;m. To provide necessary electrical and physical isolation of electrical equipments.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the design guidelines for electrical system?&lt;br /&gt;a. All safety related equipments are in control building, SRPH and are designed for&lt;br /&gt;SSE conditions. As per studies seismic condition is not there within 5 kms and&lt;br /&gt;nearest zone is away from 20 kms.&lt;br /&gt;b. Safety related equipments are separated from suitable fire barriers of 3 hrs rating&lt;br /&gt;by horizontal and vertical clearances and from turbine building which are houses&lt;br /&gt;high energy rotating equipments and where potential for fire is exist.&lt;br /&gt;c. Separate switchyard control is provided in case of non-availability of main&lt;br /&gt;control room with line and bus coupler protection and bus bar protections.&lt;br /&gt;Control room posses SUT, UT, GT, Generator and all classes of power supply&lt;br /&gt;control and protections.&lt;br /&gt;d. Protection panels of Generator, GT, and UT are separated from SUT in physical&lt;br /&gt;to have system flexibility.&lt;br /&gt;e. SCADA is provided in CER, TB and in switchyard separately.&lt;br /&gt;f. EMTR for each A and B groups are separated.&lt;br /&gt;g. Control supply for switchyard is separated from operating island.&lt;br /&gt;h. To reduce fault level in lighting circuits separate 280-kVA transformer is&lt;br /&gt;provided.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 206 -&lt;br /&gt;MAIN GENERATOR AND IPBD&lt;br /&gt;• How output of the generator is depends?&lt;br /&gt;Output of the generator is the function of volume, length, dia, airgap, and speed.&lt;br /&gt;• What you mean by Gas pickup method?&lt;br /&gt;Sucking cooled hydrogen gas from the air gap, circulating in canals and removing&lt;br /&gt;the heat from the rotor. While sucking the gas, gas comes through the stator parts&lt;br /&gt;also and removes the heat from the stator parts. The heated gas circulated to the&lt;br /&gt;hydrogen for cooling purpose by the fans installed at rotor shaft. Thus the stator and&lt;br /&gt;rotor of the generator is cooled. This method is called Gas pickup method.&lt;br /&gt;• When the hydrogen explosion will take place in main generator?&lt;br /&gt;When hydrogen concentration in air is more than 4% and less than 74% causes the&lt;br /&gt;explosion.&lt;br /&gt;• Can we excite generator without hydrogen? No&lt;br /&gt;• What are the advantages of stator water?&lt;br /&gt;a. High thermal capacity&lt;br /&gt;b. Low electrical conductivity (Good insulator)&lt;br /&gt;c. Low viscosity&lt;br /&gt;d. Free of fire risk and non-toxic&lt;br /&gt;e. Simple heat exchanger i.e. it can be circulate easily and cooled by heat exchanger&lt;br /&gt;• How rotor windings are held in position against centrifugal force?&lt;br /&gt;Rotor windings are held by duraluminium wedges and by non-magnetic steel&lt;br /&gt;retaining rings in the overhang portion.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of current carrying bolts in rotor?&lt;br /&gt;Feeding DC current from slip ring to rotor winding.&lt;br /&gt;• How rotor cooled?&lt;br /&gt;Hydrogen picked up from stator core backspace, passes through ventilation canals on&lt;br /&gt;rotor and comes out through adjacent canals. Shaft fans aid the hydrogen flow. Heat&lt;br /&gt;from the hydrogen removed by 4 nos. of hydrogen coolers. (NAPW)&lt;br /&gt;• What is rotor E/F relay setting?&lt;br /&gt;1.0 mA&lt;br /&gt;• Are we using DCCB in the plant?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 207 -&lt;br /&gt;Yes, generator field breaker&lt;br /&gt;• How arc is quenched in Generator Field Breaker?&lt;br /&gt;By magnetic blow out coils, arc is elongated very fastly, so resistance of arc&lt;br /&gt;increases, soon becoming unstable and quenched by arc chutes.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 208 -&lt;br /&gt;• How generator is protected from switching surges and lightning surges?&lt;br /&gt;Surge capacitor and lightning arrestor.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the use of generator PT’s?&lt;br /&gt;AVR, Protection &amp;amp; Metering.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the difference between PT and normal transformer?&lt;br /&gt;Burden of PT is less and burden of normal transformer is high.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the % overload allowed for TG and DG?&lt;br /&gt;For TG nil&lt;br /&gt;For DG 110% for 2 hours.&lt;br /&gt;• When TG works as induction generator?&lt;br /&gt;When excitation alone lost.&lt;br /&gt;• Why motoring should be prevented in TG and DG?&lt;br /&gt;In TG motoring prevented due to the turbine limitation otherwise last stage blade&lt;br /&gt;will fails.&lt;br /&gt;In DG motoring prevented, because of unburned fuel catches fire in DG.&lt;br /&gt;• Why GFB closed only after reaching rated speed?&lt;br /&gt;To prevent over fluxing of transformers or generator.&lt;br /&gt;Emf = 4.44 f φ Z A&lt;br /&gt;If f frequency is reduced due to less speed,&lt;br /&gt;φ = V / f Z A&lt;br /&gt;And flux will be more to saturate the core of transformers or generator.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protective parameters to changeover AVR auto to manual?&lt;br /&gt;a. PT supply fail.&lt;br /&gt;b. Auto pulse fail.&lt;br /&gt;c. Supply of limiter fail.&lt;br /&gt;d. Supply of auto channel fail.&lt;br /&gt;e. Regulated supply fail.&lt;br /&gt;f. High auto reference.&lt;br /&gt;• Why AVR changes over to manual on AVR PT fuse failure?&lt;br /&gt;Because loss of feedback to voltage corrector.&lt;br /&gt;• Will main generator differential relay pick up for generator earth faults?&lt;br /&gt;No earth fault current limited to 5A, while differential setting is 10%.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 209 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why generator differential provided?&lt;br /&gt;For generator phase to phase faults and 3 phase faults.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 210 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the effect of loss of excitation on generator?&lt;br /&gt;Large induced currents in rotor leads to rotor end part over heating.&lt;br /&gt;Leading VAR taken from grid leads to severe voltage dips in grid, if grid is weak.&lt;br /&gt;Stability of machine lost.&lt;br /&gt;Stator overheating.&lt;br /&gt;Machine speed rises slightly.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the limiters provided in excitation system?&lt;br /&gt;a. Rotor current limiter (3000 A)&lt;br /&gt;b. Rotor angle limiter (75° lag)&lt;br /&gt;c. Under excitation limiter.&lt;br /&gt;d. Stator current limiter (lead 10000 A)&lt;br /&gt;e. Stator current limiter (lag 10000 A)&lt;br /&gt;f. N – 2 limiter.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the effect of unbalance currents in generator?&lt;br /&gt;Double frequency currents are induced in metal parts of rotor and overheating of&lt;br /&gt;retaining rings and non-magnetic wedges.&lt;br /&gt;• Why low forward power relay used in parallel to reverse power relay?&lt;br /&gt;A small steam leak through CIES valves will keep the machine floating on to grid at&lt;br /&gt;low power. So even if turbine trip, relay picks up, there is no trip actually. So low&lt;br /&gt;forward power relay (0.54%) used to detect the condition.&lt;br /&gt;• Why earth fault current of generator should not be reduced below 5A?&lt;br /&gt;To limit over voltage due to neutral shift.&lt;br /&gt;• Why not high resistance for earth fault than using grounding transformer &amp;amp; resistor&lt;br /&gt;0.45 ohms?&lt;br /&gt;It is mechanically unwide. Difficult to manufacture.&lt;br /&gt;• Why starting resistor is provided in barring gear motor?&lt;br /&gt;Starting resistance at stator reduces voltage at stator terminals and accelerates the&lt;br /&gt;motor very slowly so as to allow smooth gear engagement.&lt;br /&gt;Other methods are&lt;br /&gt;a) Auto transformer.&lt;br /&gt;b) Star-delta starter.&lt;br /&gt;• Will rotor earth fault relay operate for earth fault in main exciter winding or RCU&lt;br /&gt;Diode Bridge also?&lt;br /&gt;Yes.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 211 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why neoprene rubber bellows in generator IPBD?&lt;br /&gt;Prevent vibrations transmitted from generator to IPBD.&lt;br /&gt;• How moisture entry is prevented into bus duct?&lt;br /&gt;Silicagel breathers at either end.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 212 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why aluminium bus duct is used?&lt;br /&gt;Aluminium is nonmagnetic material.&lt;br /&gt;Short circuit forces are less.&lt;br /&gt;• Where fault level is more, whether in generator bus duct or UT bus duct? Why?&lt;br /&gt;Fault level is more in UT bus duct. Because the fault currents fed by the both&lt;br /&gt;generator and GT adds up within UT bus duct in case there is a fault in UT bus duct.&lt;br /&gt;• Which is better, whether&lt;br /&gt;a) Phase segregated bus duct or&lt;br /&gt;b) Common bus duct?&lt;br /&gt;Phase segregated bus duct is better, since phase to phase faults are avoided.&lt;br /&gt;• Why cannot we have cables instead of bus duct in main generator?&lt;br /&gt;Very large number of cables in parallel required problems of sealing the&lt;br /&gt;terminations.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the material of slip ring?&lt;br /&gt;Alloy steel&lt;br /&gt;• Why rotor impedance testing done during static and running condition?&lt;br /&gt;To detect rotor earth fault.&lt;br /&gt;• Which parameter indicates the rotor short-circuited turns (Not involving earthfault)?&lt;br /&gt;Vibration increases.&lt;br /&gt;• How stator water purity is held?&lt;br /&gt;Filters, Vacuum pumps, Expansion tank, and magnetic filter.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the routines checks on slip rings?&lt;br /&gt;a. Correct mV drops brush to be used.&lt;br /&gt;b. Brush tension adjustment.&lt;br /&gt;c. Air cleaning to reduce leakage current.&lt;br /&gt;d. Brush bedding before use.&lt;br /&gt;e. Field polarity change every 6 months.&lt;br /&gt;• Can we trip GFB from control room during unit operation?&lt;br /&gt;No only if generator breaker is off.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the voltage and frequency limit of generator?&lt;br /&gt;±5%, ±5%&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 213 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the negative sequence capability?&lt;br /&gt;I2 = 5% max,&lt;br /&gt;I2&lt;br /&gt;2 t = 7&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 214 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why should we keep the brushes released during long shutdown?&lt;br /&gt;Brushes wear out unevenly, when run on barring gear speed.&lt;br /&gt;• How hydrogen purity reduces?&lt;br /&gt;Due to seal oil vapour mixing.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of back up impedance protection in main generator?&lt;br /&gt;Covers inter-phase faults both externals to the GT and in GT. This also covers&lt;br /&gt;partially faults inside generator, time delayed to coordinate with 230 kV-distance&lt;br /&gt;protection.&lt;br /&gt;• Why alternator rotor is made of solid iron?&lt;br /&gt;Because, rotor flux = DC continuous&lt;br /&gt;No iron loss problems.&lt;br /&gt;• Why 50 Hz chosen?&lt;br /&gt;Earlier 25 Hz generally used.&lt;br /&gt;After developing of the high-speed turbine, 50/60 Hz standardized.&lt;br /&gt;• Why oil cannot be used instead of water in generator stator?&lt;br /&gt;Oil has high thermal capacity than gas, but low thermal capacity than water. Ability&lt;br /&gt;to absorb heat is also less than waters.&lt;br /&gt;High viscosity of oil causes linear flow and poor surface heat transfer in small ducts.&lt;br /&gt;Large pumping power required.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of JOP?&lt;br /&gt;Lifts the rotor by injection of oil at high pressure, when BGM is in service. Outlet&lt;br /&gt;pressure of JOP is 140 kg/cm2.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of lubrication oil?&lt;br /&gt;Keep oil film in bearings, avoid metal to metal contact between bottom of journal&lt;br /&gt;and bearings avoid damage to bearings by lubricating the bearings. This also&lt;br /&gt;removes heat from that part.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the purposes of barring gear?&lt;br /&gt;Start rotor from rest.&lt;br /&gt;Eliminates sag in rotor - straighten and avoid rubbing at glands.&lt;br /&gt;Avoid direct contact journals and bearings.&lt;br /&gt;Avoid differential temp between top and bottom of cylinder due to convection of&lt;br /&gt;Steam or hot air inside turbine cylinders.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 215 -&lt;br /&gt;• How shaft voltage produced by turbine?&lt;br /&gt;Due to un-symmetry in the flux path of core, non-uniform air gap, un-symmetry in&lt;br /&gt;the rotor magnetic field during short circuit in the rotor winding, causes voltage to&lt;br /&gt;develop across the ends of rotor shaft.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 216 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why shaft-earthing brush is different from normal brush?&lt;br /&gt;The contact resistance should be very low for shaft earthing brush, to prevent even&lt;br /&gt;small current through the oil film, so used copper magnite brush or silver carbon&lt;br /&gt;brush.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the necessity of shaft voltage measurement?&lt;br /&gt;It is to observe insulation of bearing 6 &amp;amp; 7 and hydrogen seal assembly. It requires&lt;br /&gt;minimum leakage current (&lt;100mA) through bearings and shaft seals to avoid pitting&lt;br /&gt;of bearings.&lt;br /&gt;If the leakage current &gt;100mA, clean the insulation provided between bearing&lt;br /&gt;pedestal and seal housing with earth.&lt;br /&gt;• Why generator stator having alternate arrangements of hollow and solid conductor?&lt;br /&gt;It ensures an optimum solution for increasing current and to reduce losses.&lt;br /&gt;• What type of insulation is done for stator bars?&lt;br /&gt;Bar insulation is done with epoxy mica thermosetting insulation. This insulation is&lt;br /&gt;void free and possesses better mechanical properties. This insulation is more reliable&lt;br /&gt;for higher voltages. Conductors are provided with glass lapped strand insulation.&lt;br /&gt;After curing the insulation the epoxy resin (glue) fill all voids in the insulation.&lt;br /&gt;• How carona discharge is prevented in generator insulation?&lt;br /&gt;To prevent carona discharges between insulation and the wall of the slot, the&lt;br /&gt;insulation in slot portion is coated with semi conducting varnish. This eliminates the&lt;br /&gt;formation of creepage sparks during operation and during HV test.&lt;br /&gt;• Why Generator should run within capability region?&lt;br /&gt;Operating the Generator in excess of the capability curves will causes increase in&lt;br /&gt;copper temperature, thermal expansion and higher insulation stresses.&lt;br /&gt;• How cooling is done for slip ring and brush gear?&lt;br /&gt;A centrifuge fan is mounted on the shaft in between two slip rings for ventilation of&lt;br /&gt;the slip rings and brush gear.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the type of brush used in brush gear?&lt;br /&gt;Low co-efficient of friction and self-lubricating morganite grade carbon HM100.&lt;br /&gt;Now a day we are using LFC554 for economical reasons.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the name of instrument used to measure conductivity?&lt;br /&gt;Gas chromato graph.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 217 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the need of staggering of brushes and helical grooves?&lt;br /&gt;The need of staggering is for uniform wear of brush and slip rings. The helical&lt;br /&gt;grooved are provided to improve the brush performance by breaking air pockets. The&lt;br /&gt;forced ventilation fan removes carbon dust from the helical grooves.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 218 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of shaft earthing and bearing insulation?&lt;br /&gt;The voltage generated in the shaft due to the leakage fluxes can circulate current&lt;br /&gt;through the shaft. If shaft earthing is not done the leakage current will flow through&lt;br /&gt;the bearings to ground and pitting of bearings will result. Hence bearing foundation&lt;br /&gt;and pipelines are insulated.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of POLARIZATION INDEX (PI) value?&lt;br /&gt;It is used to assess the degree of dryness of windings. It depends on free ions in&lt;br /&gt;insulating material. Initially for a new insulator free ions are less and hence more&lt;br /&gt;resistance will be more. For old insulation initially free ions will be more depends on&lt;br /&gt;age and material and hence resistance will be less. So the PI value for new insulation&lt;br /&gt;will be more and for old insulation it will be less.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the requirement of stator water electrical conductivity?&lt;br /&gt;The cooling water must have an electrical conductivity less than 2.5 micro mho/cm.&lt;br /&gt;One portable polishing unit consisting of mixed bed is also provided in the system to&lt;br /&gt;remove impurities and maintain stator water conductivity at a less value.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the necessity of Seal oil system?&lt;br /&gt;The annular gap between stator and rotor of the generator are to be sealed to prevent&lt;br /&gt;hydrogen leak from the casing.&lt;br /&gt;Type of seal – ring type shaft seals&lt;br /&gt;Pressure of seal oil – 4 kg/cm2&lt;br /&gt;• What is the pressure of rotor gas (hydrogen)?&lt;br /&gt;3.5 kg/cm2&lt;br /&gt;• What is the paint used in the surface and interior of enclosure and why it is?&lt;br /&gt;Matt black paint, for efficient heat dissipation.&lt;br /&gt;• What is type of nut and bolts are used in IPBD?&lt;br /&gt;Non-magnetic stainless steel nut and bolts are used in IPBD to restrict magnetic&lt;br /&gt;effect at joints.&lt;br /&gt;• Why flexible expansion joints are used in IPBD?&lt;br /&gt;To cater thermal expansion and contraction due to heating and to eliminate&lt;br /&gt;mechanical vibrations to the equipment.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 219 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the salient features of IPBD?&lt;br /&gt;a. This for a vital link between generator, GT, UAT, SPPT, SET and neutral&lt;br /&gt;grounding transformer.&lt;br /&gt;b. The continuous enclosure operating at ground potential limits the leakage flux&lt;br /&gt;outside the enclosure to a very low value thereby eliminating the problem of&lt;br /&gt;inductive heating of magnetic materials in the vicinity of the busduct.&lt;br /&gt;c. Shielding effect of the enclosure reduced the electromagnetic forces under fault&lt;br /&gt;conditions between bus to bus to a great.&lt;br /&gt;d. The IPBD consists of high purity aluminium alloy bus supported by high strength&lt;br /&gt;porcelain insulator (24 kV class) within enclosure separates adjacent conductor&lt;br /&gt;by air. This eliminates phase to phase faults to a great extent.&lt;br /&gt;e. Practically negligible inductive heating on adjacent steel structure.&lt;br /&gt;f. High current carrying capacity. Because the conductors are of circular type&lt;br /&gt;having very little skin effect and has a very large cooling surface.&lt;br /&gt;g. Conductors are painted with epoxy Matt black paint results in heat dissipation and&lt;br /&gt;the temperature rise is small and current carrying capacity is improved.&lt;br /&gt;h. High dielectric strength as conductors are supported on porcelain insulators.&lt;br /&gt;i. Air tight, watertight and dust free bus conductors. Hence maintenance is nil.&lt;br /&gt;j. Separate parts erected IPBD. Hence changing parts makes it easy.&lt;br /&gt;• Why neoprene rubber bellows are used in IPBD?&lt;br /&gt;Neoprene rubber bellows are used near the terminals of the equipment and also at&lt;br /&gt;building wall from indoor to outdoor area to allow thermal expansion and to&lt;br /&gt;minimise vibrations.&lt;br /&gt;• Why aluminium bus bars are silver-plated in IPBD?&lt;br /&gt;Aluminium bus bars are silver-plated at flexible connection to prevent the galvanic&lt;br /&gt;corrosion ant also for low contact resistance.&lt;br /&gt;• Why seal-off bushings are used in IPBD?&lt;br /&gt;To prevent interchange of air at different temperature and leakage of hydrogen or&lt;br /&gt;infiltration of dust into the bus duct.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the precautions to be taken while working at SPPT?&lt;br /&gt;PT trolley should be isolated very carefully so as to isolate secondary terminals first&lt;br /&gt;and primary (HT) terminals next. When primary isolated the arrangement in the&lt;br /&gt;trolley make ground connection and HT terminal will be discharged at the drawn-out&lt;br /&gt;position.&lt;br /&gt;When fuse is blown the temporary earth should be done at the HT side of the fuse to&lt;br /&gt;replace the fuse. Because PT may be energised through secondary side.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 220 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is use of hot air blower in IPBD?&lt;br /&gt;To remove moisture and to prevent moisture condensation inside the duct at&lt;br /&gt;commissioning time or in long shutdown periods.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 221 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the temperature limits for UAT and SPPT bus bar?&lt;br /&gt;2 kA (UAT) &amp;amp; 1 kA&lt;br /&gt;Ambient temp 45°C 45°C&lt;br /&gt;Maximum temp 60°C 60°C&lt;br /&gt;Short circuit for 1 second temp 200°C (max load) 200°C(max load)&lt;br /&gt;Bus material Al alloy Al alloy&lt;br /&gt;Thickness 15 mm 6 mm&lt;br /&gt;Dia 12.7 cm&lt;br /&gt;• Specification of NGT &amp;amp; NGR.&lt;br /&gt;NGT – 1 phase, natural cooled, indoor dry type, 16.5 kV / 250V, 50 kVA.&lt;br /&gt;NGR – natural cooled, stainless steel grid type, 0.5Ω, 250V, 288A (continuous) and&lt;br /&gt;temperature rise allowed to 375 °C.&lt;br /&gt;• Surge protector and potential transformer cubicle specification.&lt;br /&gt;Surge protector – non-inflammable, synthetic liquid impregnated and hermetically&lt;br /&gt;sealed, 24KV, 0.25μ f (micro farad).&lt;br /&gt;PT – 16500/√3 /110/√3 volts. Fuse – 24kv, 3.15A.&lt;br /&gt;• How the power of the Generator can be varied?&lt;br /&gt;Injecting inlet steam to the prime mover can vary active power. Reactive power can&lt;br /&gt;vary by the Generator main field voltage variation. An excitation change PF at which&lt;br /&gt;load is delivered.&lt;br /&gt;Active power is produced by source and used effectively. VAR is the power used for&lt;br /&gt;magnetization of core of transformers, motors, generators, overhead transmission&lt;br /&gt;lines (capacitive), household appliances etc.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the protection for IPBD?&lt;br /&gt;Generator – GT overall differential protection.&lt;br /&gt;• How the liquid in generator can be detected?&lt;br /&gt;There are three liquid detection devices provided for the same purpose.&lt;br /&gt;• Why and where the magnetic filter is provided in stator water circuit?&lt;br /&gt;Magnetic filter is provided to catch the metal particles in stator water circuit, which&lt;br /&gt;are produced in the pipelines. This is mounted at the end of the circuit nearer to the&lt;br /&gt;inlet of the generator.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the isolations required for working on IPBD/ Generator?&lt;br /&gt;a. Generator field breaker open and tagged.&lt;br /&gt;b. GT breaker open and earth switch closed.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 222 -&lt;br /&gt;c. Barring gear motor stopped and tagged.&lt;br /&gt;d. Generator PT’s isolated and tagged.&lt;br /&gt;e. CB 472 and CB 474 open and PT’s are isolated and tagged.&lt;br /&gt;f. Before doing any work on brush gear 64F1 relay to be taken out.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 223 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the futures of turbine generator?&lt;br /&gt;a. Low heat drop&lt;br /&gt;b. Moisture control (HP-0.26%, LP-3%.)&lt;br /&gt;c. Turbine governing system&lt;br /&gt;d. 70% steam dumping to the condenser to avoid reactor trip.&lt;br /&gt;e. Gland sealing&lt;br /&gt;f. LP exhaust hood cooling&lt;br /&gt;g. Generator stator and rotor cooling&lt;br /&gt;h. Hydrogen sealing&lt;br /&gt;i. Static excitation&lt;br /&gt;• What are the intervals for generator overhauling?&lt;br /&gt;a. 1st inspection after 8000 hrs of working&lt;br /&gt;b. 2nd inspection after 8000 hrs of 1st inspection&lt;br /&gt;c. 3rd inspection after 24000 hrs of 1st inspection&lt;br /&gt;d. 4th inspection after 48000 hrs of 1st inspection&lt;br /&gt;• Write nameplate details of the main generator.&lt;br /&gt;Type THW-235&lt;br /&gt;kW 237700&lt;br /&gt;kVA 264000&lt;br /&gt;Voltage 16500 V&lt;br /&gt;Amps 9240 A&lt;br /&gt;Power factor 0.9 lag.&lt;br /&gt;Field voltage 326 V&lt;br /&gt;Field current 2755 A&lt;br /&gt;Insulation Class-F&lt;br /&gt;Speed 3000 rpm&lt;br /&gt;50 Hz, 3, double star connection.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the torque settings used in IPBD connection?&lt;br /&gt;M12 (Nut bolt) 4506 100 kg-cm or 55 NM&lt;br /&gt;M16 (Nut bolt) 9006 250 kg-cm or 80 NM&lt;br /&gt;M20 (Nut bolt) 18006300 kg-cm or 100 NM&lt;br /&gt;• Write critical speeds of turbine generator?&lt;br /&gt;Generator rotor&lt;br /&gt;1st critical speed 1283 rpm&lt;br /&gt;2nd critical speed 3600 rpm&lt;br /&gt;Combined turbine generator&lt;br /&gt;1st critical speed 1938 rpm&lt;br /&gt;2nd critical speed 2120 rpm&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 224 -&lt;br /&gt;3rd critical speed 2385 rpm&lt;br /&gt;4th critical speed 2837 rpm&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 225 -&lt;br /&gt;• What type of governing system used in turbine and what are the purposes of the&lt;br /&gt;system?&lt;br /&gt;Hydraulic governing system of centrifugal (speed) governer type is adopted in&lt;br /&gt;turbine.&lt;br /&gt;Sensitive oil pressure to actuate centrifugal governer is 6.1 kg/cm2 (max). At 6.7&lt;br /&gt;kg/cm2 relief valve is attached for on load testing.&lt;br /&gt;Relay oil at pressure 21 kg/cm2 (max) is used to actuate HP CIES valve, governer&lt;br /&gt;valve, LP CIES valve and LP governer valves.&lt;br /&gt;At speed of 2560-rpm governer system becomes effective and starts draining of&lt;br /&gt;sensitive oil to 2.81 kg/cm2 as speed is 2760 rpm and this is the governer take over&lt;br /&gt;speed. Once the speed takes over by governer, governer valves position comes to&lt;br /&gt;closing side and then CIES valves are opening fully. At this stage further opening of&lt;br /&gt;CIES valve does not change any speed of system and the speed depends only on&lt;br /&gt;governer valve opening position and speeder gear system.&lt;br /&gt;HP speeder gear controls HP governer valves and LP speeder gear controls LP&lt;br /&gt;governer valves and closes fully when 6% over speed which starts when 3% over&lt;br /&gt;speeding.&lt;br /&gt;The main purposes are as follows.&lt;br /&gt;a. Bring the TG to rated (synchronous speed) speed from rest.&lt;br /&gt;b. Loading and unloading when synchronised.&lt;br /&gt;c. Responding with grid frequency variations within design rage and loading and&lt;br /&gt;unloading the machine so that grid frequency remains stable.&lt;br /&gt;d. Limiting the load as per reactor load.&lt;br /&gt;e. Protecting the machine from over speed and from sudden large load thrown off or&lt;br /&gt;trip.&lt;br /&gt;f. Tripping the machine and bringing it on barring gear when event for not operation&lt;br /&gt;happens.&lt;br /&gt;g. When synchronised the speed is regulated by speeder gear from BPC signal. Once&lt;br /&gt;synchronised the grid frequency and speeder gear controls the speed.&lt;br /&gt;• Why inter-turn protection is provided along with differential protection in generator?&lt;br /&gt;Inter-turn protects two separate windings from the fault of the generator.&lt;br /&gt;• How patina formation is done.&lt;br /&gt;By injecting low excitation current of 50 Amps for half an hour interval to 250&lt;br /&gt;Amps. (Epoxy insulation in the stator winding absorbs no moisture).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 226 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the tests to be carried during PM checks of IPBD?&lt;br /&gt;a) Physical inspection of bus for any spark or overheating or discoloration.&lt;br /&gt;b) Physical inspection of copper braided flexibles for discoloration.&lt;br /&gt;c) Physical inspection of inspection window gaskets, seal off bushings, supporting&lt;br /&gt;insulators, CT’s, painting of IPBD.&lt;br /&gt;d) Torque tightness of flexibles.&lt;br /&gt;e) Connection tightness of CT’s, SPPT cubicle, NGT cubicle, CT’s master JB, and&lt;br /&gt;Generator terminal bushing connection.&lt;br /&gt;f) Tightness of supporting insulator, seal off bushing, inspection windows&lt;br /&gt;g) Inspection of rubber bellows&lt;br /&gt;h) Electrical checks on SPPT, NGT, CT, mVDT of copper flexible connection.&lt;br /&gt;i) Capacitance measurement of surge capacitor.&lt;br /&gt;j) Healthiness checks of lightning arrestor.&lt;br /&gt;k) HV test of IPBD&lt;br /&gt;l) Tan-delta test of IPBD&lt;br /&gt;m) IR value measurement&lt;br /&gt;n) Cleanliness checks entire IPBD.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the works to be done in generator in major overhauling?&lt;br /&gt;Works on stator&lt;br /&gt;a) Hydro test (DM water at 5 kg/cm2 pressure, leak acceptable is 5% for 24 hrs).&lt;br /&gt;b) Hydro test of H2 coolers (DM water at 4 kg/cm2 for 30 seconds no leak is&lt;br /&gt;allowed)&lt;br /&gt;c) Pneumatic test with mask air.&lt;br /&gt;d) Drying out of stator conductor. Hot air blower is used.&lt;br /&gt;e) IR value check.&lt;br /&gt;f) Stator overhang portion inspection.&lt;br /&gt;g) Inspection of Teflon tubes and rubber grummets.&lt;br /&gt;h) Stator wedge tightness test with 200 grams hammer.&lt;br /&gt;i) Inspection of RTD’s.&lt;br /&gt;j) Maintenance of end shields.&lt;br /&gt;k) Hot air and hot water test of stator conductors to check whether flow through all&lt;br /&gt;stator conductors is uniform.&lt;br /&gt;l) Measurement of IR and PI value.&lt;br /&gt;m) Capacitance and tan-delta measurements.&lt;br /&gt;n) Partial discharge test.&lt;br /&gt;o) Winding resistance measurement.&lt;br /&gt;p) DC step voltage.&lt;br /&gt;q) ELCID (electromagnetic core imperfection detection) test.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 227 -&lt;br /&gt;Works on Rotor&lt;br /&gt;a) Nitrogen leak tightness test of CC bolts at 4 kg/cm2.&lt;br /&gt;b) Inspection of rotor slots.&lt;br /&gt;c) Purge test of rotor ventillation canals.&lt;br /&gt;d) DP test on slip-ring hub to detect micro crack.&lt;br /&gt;e) DP and Ultrasonic test on retaining rings to detect any cracks.&lt;br /&gt;f) Measurement of IR and PI value.&lt;br /&gt;g) Impedance measurement.&lt;br /&gt;h) Recurrence surge oscillograph.&lt;br /&gt;i) Winding resistance measurement.&lt;br /&gt;j) Slip-ring groove cutting and machining.&lt;br /&gt;k) Patina formation. Then OCC test.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of tan-delta measurement?&lt;br /&gt;Insulation in electrical system has parameters such as Capacitance, Die-electric loss,&lt;br /&gt;and Power factor. By detecting the changes in these parameters failures can be&lt;br /&gt;revealed. In this tan-delta test measured quantities are dissipation factor, power&lt;br /&gt;factor, capacitance and dielectric power loss.&lt;br /&gt;The very purpose of this test is to detect moisture content in the insulation. This&lt;br /&gt;detects moisture and void in the insulation. This indicates amount of ionization.&lt;br /&gt;• What is meant by partial discharge? How can be tested?&lt;br /&gt;Partial discharges are electrical sparks, which occur in gas voids within the insulation&lt;br /&gt;when the voltage is high enough. The discharges are partial since there is some&lt;br /&gt;insulation remaining to prevent a complete breakdown. Partial discharge can erode&lt;br /&gt;the insulation and therefore contribute to insulation ageing.&lt;br /&gt;This can be tested by electromagnetic probe, which is a detector that is sensitive to&lt;br /&gt;the radio frequency signals produced by the partial discharges within the winding.&lt;br /&gt;With this probe test it is possible to locate specific sites of deterioration within the&lt;br /&gt;winding when the winding is energized.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 228 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of HV / leakage current test on stator?&lt;br /&gt;This is to find out weakness in the stator winding. If the ambient conditions are right,&lt;br /&gt;and the insulation is weak, the leakage current will increase non-linearly.&lt;br /&gt;The record of voltage versus leakage current provides the condition of the winding&lt;br /&gt;for present and future use and may permit prediction of breakdown voltage whether&lt;br /&gt;it is within or slightly above the test voltage.&lt;br /&gt;HV test voltage = 1.5 * rated voltage for AC&lt;br /&gt;And DC voltage = (2E + 1 kV) 1.6&lt;br /&gt;Where E – rated voltage.&lt;br /&gt;1.6 – AC/DC conversion factor.&lt;br /&gt;Application of HV voltage also depends on the age factor or condition of the&lt;br /&gt;machine.&lt;br /&gt;Following are the findings of HV test.&lt;br /&gt;a) Capacitance charging current.&lt;br /&gt;b) Dielectric absorption current.&lt;br /&gt;c) Surface leakage current.&lt;br /&gt;d) Partial discharge current.&lt;br /&gt;e) Volumetric discharge current.&lt;br /&gt;In HV test starting leakage current should be more than switching off current in&lt;br /&gt;􀀜 Amps.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Recurrent Surge Oscillograph (RSO) Test?&lt;br /&gt;RSO test is performed to detect faults in rotor windings. The electrical faults in&lt;br /&gt;generator rotors fall into two main categories. The faults from the winding to the&lt;br /&gt;body and the faults between the parts of the winding (inter-turn faults). The existence&lt;br /&gt;of the faults will frequently display excessive mechanical vibration and cause serious&lt;br /&gt;concern.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of rotor AC Impedance measurement?&lt;br /&gt;Periodic measurement of rotor impedance using an AC power supply is another&lt;br /&gt;means of detecting the presence of shorted turns in a rotor winding. Impedance&lt;br /&gt;measurement is more sensitive than the resistance measurement for the detection of&lt;br /&gt;shorted turns. This is because the induced backward current in a single shorted turn&lt;br /&gt;opposes the MMF of the entire coil, thus greatly reducing the reactance.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 229 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is IR and PI value? Why it is measured?&lt;br /&gt;IR It is the ratio of the DC voltage applied between the terminals and ground to the&lt;br /&gt;resultant current. When the DC voltage applied three components flow,&lt;br /&gt;a) A charging component flows into the capacitance of the winding.&lt;br /&gt;b) A polarization or absorption current involving in the insulation molecular&lt;br /&gt;mechanism.&lt;br /&gt;c) A leakage component over the surface between exposed conductor and ground&lt;br /&gt;which is highly dependent on the state of dryness of the winding.&lt;br /&gt;The first two current components decay with time. The third component is&lt;br /&gt;determined by the presence of moisture or ground fault and relatively constant with&lt;br /&gt;time. Moisture may be with in the insulation or condensed on the end windings or&lt;br /&gt;connection surfaces, which are often dirty. If this leakage current is larger than the&lt;br /&gt;first two components then the total charging current will not change significantly&lt;br /&gt;with time. Thus to determine how dry and clean the winding, IR is measured after&lt;br /&gt;one minute and after 10 minutes. The ration of the 10 minutes reading over the oneminute&lt;br /&gt;reading is called the PI (Polarization Index).&lt;br /&gt;PI value detects relative condition of insulation with respect to moisture and other&lt;br /&gt;contaminants.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the generator IR value when generator is filled with stator water and&lt;br /&gt;hydrogen?&lt;br /&gt;Generator IR when filled with stator water and hydrogen is about 100 kΩ only. That&lt;br /&gt;is because most of the gases and liquids are self-restoring insulators. As we are&lt;br /&gt;measuring insulation with 1 kV or 5 kV megger, the ionic current or leakage current&lt;br /&gt;will be same and the IR value will be approximately same. As we are increasing the&lt;br /&gt;test voltage to higher value say to 100 kV the breakdown point will occur as in the&lt;br /&gt;graph and insulators will breakdown or puncture.&lt;br /&gt;Ionic current&lt;br /&gt;Leakage&lt;br /&gt;Current&lt;br /&gt;Saturation region&lt;br /&gt;Voltage (kV)&lt;br /&gt;Water and hydrogen are self-restoring insulators. First we are measuring insulation&lt;br /&gt;on 1 kV voltage i.e. 100 kΩ. As the field voltage and stator voltage raises the heat&lt;br /&gt;produced in the stator and rotor will increase the IR value of the machine in running&lt;br /&gt;condition.&lt;br /&gt;So ionic current region needs 1 kV/cm, saturation region moderate voltage (1 kV to&lt;br /&gt;70 kV), and breakdown region is above 70 kV voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 230 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of DC winding resistance test?&lt;br /&gt;To detect the shorting of winding and loose or poor connection of the windings.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 231 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the types of Grounding?&lt;br /&gt;Equipment grounding is the grounding on non-current carrying metal parts. This is&lt;br /&gt;done for personnel safety of the operator and for the equipment safety by blowing&lt;br /&gt;the fuse when earth fault current flows through the fuse.&lt;br /&gt;Neutral Grounding is done to protect the equipment against arcing grounds, to&lt;br /&gt;protect system from lightning surges by passing surge current through the earth and&lt;br /&gt;to protect against unbalanced voltage with grounds. When fault occurs the system&lt;br /&gt;voltage increases ♦3 times. This gives stress on the system and failure of the&lt;br /&gt;insulation if the neutral grounding not designed properly.&lt;br /&gt;Mainly there are three types of neutral earthing&lt;br /&gt;a) Directly&lt;br /&gt;b) Resistance&lt;br /&gt;c) Reactance&lt;br /&gt;• What is Arcing Grounds?&lt;br /&gt;When earth faults occurs, arc with the ground and phase will occur. The arc&lt;br /&gt;extinguishes and restrikes as a repeated and regular manner. This is called Arcing&lt;br /&gt;Ground.&lt;br /&gt;• How neutral grounding adopted?&lt;br /&gt;For above 3.3 kV and below 22 kV resistance grounding is preferred. In this voltage&lt;br /&gt;level capacitive ground current is not large, so reactance grounding is not used.&lt;br /&gt;For below 3.3 kV that for 415 V external resistance earthing is not necessary.&lt;br /&gt;Because normal earthing (plate earthing) gives 1.5Ω resistance. This limits current to&lt;br /&gt;E (R∅)&lt;br /&gt;Ω&lt;br /&gt;230/1.5=153A(Current limit without resistance).&lt;br /&gt;For above 22 kV solid or direct grounding is used.&lt;br /&gt;Reactance grounding is used where capacitive currents are large instead of resistance&lt;br /&gt;grounding in transmission lines, generators etc. to neutralize capacitive current by&lt;br /&gt;adding reactive current.&lt;br /&gt;• How main generator earthing is done?&lt;br /&gt;Generator neutral earthing is done through transformer and earth fault current is&lt;br /&gt;limited through resistance, which is connected across the secondary of the&lt;br /&gt;transformer. Generator 16.5 kV earth fault current is isolated from 220 kV through&lt;br /&gt;GT. Only star point of the generator is grounded.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 232 -&lt;br /&gt;• How generator earth fault relay works?&lt;br /&gt;100% earth fault relay works on the principle involving monitoring of neutral side&lt;br /&gt;and line side components of 3rd harmonic voltages produced by generator in service.&lt;br /&gt;Since the machine is grounded with reactance XL (transformer), a flow of 3rd&lt;br /&gt;harmonic current is there in between ground and the machine neutral. Under healthy&lt;br /&gt;condition the line and neutral impedance Z are fixed. Thus the 3rd harmonic voltage&lt;br /&gt;(Vs) at machine line (VL3) and neutral end (VN3) should bear a constant ratio. When a&lt;br /&gt;fault occurs in the machine winding the distribution of VL3 and VN3 undergoes a&lt;br /&gt;change from that a healthy condition. In the extreme case if a fault occurring on the&lt;br /&gt;machine neutral side, VN3 becomes zero and VL3 becomes Vs and vice versa.&lt;br /&gt;The fault in Blind zone will be detected by VL3 neutral displacement module,&lt;br /&gt;which is tuned to find frequency.&lt;br /&gt;Blind zone&lt;br /&gt;Neutral Line&lt;br /&gt;Fault&lt;br /&gt;Earth&lt;br /&gt;• How generator protections are classified in nuclear power station?&lt;br /&gt;Classification of generator protection in nuclear power station.&lt;br /&gt;1. MAIN Protection 2. BACKUP Protection&lt;br /&gt;Stator E/f Back up Impedance&lt;br /&gt;Loss of Excitation Over Voltage&lt;br /&gt;Pole slipping Under Freq.&lt;br /&gt;Differential Over freq.&lt;br /&gt;Inter turn 4. EXCITATION Protection&lt;br /&gt;Unbalance current Excitation transformer over current&lt;br /&gt;3. START UP Protection Rotor E/f. and Rotor o/v&lt;br /&gt;Phase o/c during startup 48 V DC fail&lt;br /&gt;E/F during startup more than 3 Bridge fail (¾ logic)&lt;br /&gt;Manual channel fails&lt;br /&gt;Transformer over temperature (Class –B)&lt;br /&gt;• State torque formula.&lt;br /&gt;Torque (T) = kT *S *IR *COSθ&lt;br /&gt;Where T = Torque in pound – feet&lt;br /&gt;kT = Torque constant.&lt;br /&gt;S = stator flux&lt;br /&gt;IR = Rotor current&lt;br /&gt;cosθ = Rotor power factor&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 233 -&lt;br /&gt;• How main generator protection grouped?&lt;br /&gt;The various protections associated with the generator, Generator transformer and Unit&lt;br /&gt;transformer are connected to a trip unit through trip relays 86A, 86B and 86C.&lt;br /&gt;The protective levels of generator are in three classified groups Class A, Class B and&lt;br /&gt;Class C protections which involve fault in the generator, Generator transformer and&lt;br /&gt;requires high speed clearance are grouped under Class A. These are routed through&lt;br /&gt;trip relays 86A. This trips generator transformer HV side breaker, generator field&lt;br /&gt;breaker, and LV side breaker of UT and Turbine simultaneously.&lt;br /&gt;Certain protections such as loss of excitation, negative sequence protection, overfluxing&lt;br /&gt;etc., can tolerate sequential tripping of turbine followed by the generator such&lt;br /&gt;that the entrapped steam in the turbine is fully spent before generator is tripped and&lt;br /&gt;reduces the risk of over speeding of the turbine. These protections are classified as&lt;br /&gt;Class B. These are connected to operate on trip relay 86BG. This relay initiates the&lt;br /&gt;tripping of turbine (closure of stop valves) and also the LV side breaker of UT through&lt;br /&gt;trip relay 86B1 and 86B2. After turbine stop valves are closed and the entrapped&lt;br /&gt;steam is spent, the output power of the generator will come down and is sensed by&lt;br /&gt;under power relay 32A and 32B. These interlocks are wired in series with the Class B&lt;br /&gt;trip relay 86B, which is wired to trip the generator breaker, generator field. Obtaining&lt;br /&gt;better security, the Under Power interlock circuits are duplicated. Some protections&lt;br /&gt;such as Bus bar differential, generator under frequency etc, requires tripping only of&lt;br /&gt;the 220 kV side of the generator transformer to isolate the external fault. These are&lt;br /&gt;classified as Class C. These protections are wired to trip relay 86C, which initiate&lt;br /&gt;only the tripping of the generator transformer HV side breaker. During Class C trip,&lt;br /&gt;the generator will come on House load mode of operation.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 234 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the generator protection parameters?&lt;br /&gt;Generator protection parameters are as follows.&lt;br /&gt;GENERATOR PROTECTION SCHEME&lt;br /&gt;CLASS A1 CLASS A2&lt;br /&gt;Gen. rotor earth fault (64F2) Stator O/C during start (50S ABC)&lt;br /&gt;100% stator earth fault (64A) Stator E/F during start (64 C)&lt;br /&gt;GT restricted earth fault (64 GT) Stator backup E/F (64 B)&lt;br /&gt;UT restricted earth fault LV A (64 UT A) GT backup O/C (50/51 GT)&lt;br /&gt;UT restricted earth fault LV B (64 UT B) GT backup E/F (51 N GT)&lt;br /&gt;Gen. differential (87 G) Gen. backup impedance (21G – 1 ABC)&lt;br /&gt;Gen. interturn (87 IT) Gen. field fail with U/V (27/40G)&lt;br /&gt;GT overall differential (87 GT) UT backup O/C (51 UT ABC)&lt;br /&gt;UT differential (87 UT A/B/C) UT backup E/F LV-A (51N LV-A)&lt;br /&gt;Reverse power (37 G) UT backup E/F LV-B (51N LV-B)&lt;br /&gt;GT buchholz, OLTC oil surge, fire (30 A/G/D) LBB protection (50 Z)&lt;br /&gt;UT buchholz, fire (30 A/D)&lt;br /&gt;Excitation O/C stage – 2&lt;br /&gt;Rotor + &amp;amp; - ve over voltage&lt;br /&gt;Excitation 48 V DC fail&lt;br /&gt;More than 3 bridge fails (3/4 logic)&lt;br /&gt;CLASS B CLASS C&lt;br /&gt;Gen. field failure without U/V (40 G) Gen. backup impedance stage – 2(21G – 2)&lt;br /&gt;Gen. negative phase sequence (46 G/GT) Gen. pole slip (78G)&lt;br /&gt;Gen. over frequency (81 – 3) Gen. under frequency (81 – 1 / 2)&lt;br /&gt;GT over fluxing protection (99 GT) GT backup earth fault (51N GT)&lt;br /&gt;GT oil temp / winding temp high (30 C/E)&lt;br /&gt;UT oil temp / winding temp high (30 C/E)&lt;br /&gt;Low forward power (32 B/A)&lt;br /&gt;Turbine process parameter trip (86 BG)&lt;br /&gt;Excitation transformer temp high&lt;br /&gt;Manual channel fails&lt;br /&gt;Excitation transformer O/C stage – 1&lt;br /&gt;Regulation under test&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 235 -&lt;br /&gt;• State class – B process side trip parameters.&lt;br /&gt;Sl Parameter Normal Value Low Value High Value Trip Value&lt;br /&gt;1. Reactor trip + 200 milli sec&lt;br /&gt;2. Reheater steam Pr. High 5.4 kg/cm2 c 5.75 kg/cm2&lt;br /&gt;3. Exhaust hood steams temp. 93°C 149°C&lt;br /&gt;4. Lub. oil Pressure low [0.35 kg/cm2&lt;br /&gt;5. Relay oil pressure low 21 kg/cm2 17.38 kg/cm2 [ 3.5 kg/cm2&lt;br /&gt;6. Trust bearing &lt;P high !9.114 kg/cm2&lt;br /&gt;7. Condenser vacuum low 696.5 mm Hg 660 mm Hg 559 mm Hg&lt;br /&gt;8. Stator water cond. High 5 μ Mho / cm 13.3μ Mho 20 μ Mho&lt;br /&gt;9. Stator water flow low 30 M3 / hr 21 M3 / hr 17 M3 / hr&lt;br /&gt;10. Boiler level high 2/3 trip&lt;br /&gt;• What are the manual trips required from the generator side?&lt;br /&gt;Quantity 1st ann. Action/2nd ann. Action&lt;br /&gt;Bearing babbitt temp. high 75°C 80°C &gt;80°C manual trip&lt;br /&gt;Bearing outlet oil temp. high 60°C 65°C &gt;65°C manual trip&lt;br /&gt;Generator seal oil inlet temp 45°C &gt;45°C manual trip&lt;br /&gt;Presence of liquid in Gen. Manual trip&lt;br /&gt;DM water outlet temp 85°C Unload &gt;85°C Rundown trip&lt;br /&gt;Stator winding temp high 75°C Unload &gt;75°C Rundown trip&lt;br /&gt;Hot gas temp high 75°C Unload &gt;75°C Rundown trip&lt;br /&gt;Stator core temp high 95°C Unload &gt;105°C Rundown trip&lt;br /&gt;Rotor winding temp high 110°C Unload &gt;110°C Rundown trip&lt;br /&gt;Temp of cold hydrogen gas 55°C Unload &gt;55°C Rundown trip&lt;br /&gt;Temp of inlet water to gas coolers 37-48°C Unload &gt;48°C Rundown trip&lt;br /&gt;Temp of inlet water to stator winding 44-48°C Unload &gt;48°C Rundown trip&lt;br /&gt;Generator seal oil outlet temp 65°C &gt;65°C manual trip&lt;br /&gt;Purity of hydrogen in casing &lt;97% &lt;95% &lt;95% manual trip&lt;br /&gt;*Unload – Decreasing load to a lower value manually&lt;br /&gt;*Rundown – Reducing load to no-load condition (manually/automatic)&lt;br /&gt;• Why boiler level high trip has been provided in turbine?&lt;br /&gt;In condition of boiler level high moisture contents in the steam will rise and rise in&lt;br /&gt;moisture content is harmful to turbine.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 236 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the characteristics of protection system?&lt;br /&gt;CHARACTERISTICS OF PROTECTIVE SYSTEM&lt;br /&gt;Protective relaying is an important requirement in power generation, transmission and&lt;br /&gt;distribution, which identifies the exact location of the fault and give command for&lt;br /&gt;isolating the faulty portion very close to the fault by sensing variations in electrical&lt;br /&gt;quantities for ensuring safe operation. The protective relay should have the following&lt;br /&gt;characteristics:&lt;br /&gt;a) Reliability&lt;br /&gt;The protective relay should operate positively and isolate the faulty portion of the&lt;br /&gt;power system as and when required.&lt;br /&gt;b) Selectivity&lt;br /&gt;Protection is arranged in zone, which should cover the power system completely,&lt;br /&gt;having no part unprotected. When a fault occurs the protection is required to select&lt;br /&gt;and trip the only the nearest circuit breaker.&lt;br /&gt;c) Stability&lt;br /&gt;This term, applied to protection on distinct from power network, refers to the ability of&lt;br /&gt;the system to remain inert to all load conditions and fault external to the relevant zone.&lt;br /&gt;d) Speed&lt;br /&gt;The function of automatic protection is to isolate fault from the power system in a very&lt;br /&gt;much shorter time than could be isolated manually, even with great deal of&lt;br /&gt;supervision.&lt;br /&gt;e) Sensitivity&lt;br /&gt;Sensitivity is a term frequently used when referring to the minimum operating limit of&lt;br /&gt;a complete protective system. A protective system is said to be sensitive, if the&lt;br /&gt;primary operating current is low.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 237 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the working principles of generator main protections?&lt;br /&gt;GENERATOR START UP PROTECTIONS&lt;br /&gt;SUPPLEMENTARY PROTECTION OF GENERATOR&lt;br /&gt;The generator is normally expected to run rated speed before excitation power is applied&lt;br /&gt;by closing the field breaker. However the residual magnetism in the field circuit may&lt;br /&gt;provide small voltage build up even when the machine is run upto its rated speed without&lt;br /&gt;excitation. At this stage fault if any in the generator stator circuit may not be sensed by&lt;br /&gt;the regular protection, as must of the relays are having higher current ranges. Hence&lt;br /&gt;separate protection (Phase &amp;amp; Ground) are provided with low current ranges.&lt;br /&gt;a) PHASE OVER CURRENT PROTECTION&lt;br /&gt;The CT current is stepped down by an internal CT and converted to voltage signal. The&lt;br /&gt;signal is compared with the internal reference. The protection is interlocked with the&lt;br /&gt;auxiliary relay for the generator transformer breaker closed position to ensure that the&lt;br /&gt;protection is inoperable when the machine is synchronized to grid.&lt;br /&gt;b) GROUND FAULT PROTECTION DURING START UP&lt;br /&gt;The generator neutral current as measure in series with the resistance of the secondary of&lt;br /&gt;the earthing transformer is fed to the relay through CT. CT current is converted to a&lt;br /&gt;voltage. This is compared with the internal resistance references. This protection also&lt;br /&gt;interlocked with generator breaker position to ensure that the protection is inoperable&lt;br /&gt;when the machine is connected to grid.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 238 -&lt;br /&gt;OTHER PROTECTIONS&lt;br /&gt;a) STATOR EARTH FAULT PROTECTION (64A, 64B, 64C)&lt;br /&gt;The conventional unit type generator has the neutral earthed through a resistance loaded&lt;br /&gt;distribution type transformer. For a single ground fault near the neutral end of the&lt;br /&gt;winding, there will be proportionately less voltage available to drive the current through&lt;br /&gt;the ground, resulting in a lower fault current and lower neutral bus displacement voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Low magnitude of fundamental ground current may flow under normal conditions,&lt;br /&gt;possibly due to generator winding imbalance or due to fault on HV side of generator&lt;br /&gt;transformer or on the secondary of generator PT. Under these conditions, the generator&lt;br /&gt;should not be removed from service. To allow for these low magnitude earth fault&lt;br /&gt;current, trip setting of the overvoltage ground relay are set to detect neutral displacement&lt;br /&gt;voltage in excess of 5-10% of the phased neutral voltage.&lt;br /&gt;If an earth fault occurs and undetected because of its location or otherwise, the probability&lt;br /&gt;of second earth fault occurring is much greater. The second earth fault may result from&lt;br /&gt;insulation deterioration caused by transient over voltage due to erratic, low current,&lt;br /&gt;unstable arcing at first fault point. The second point may yield current of larger&lt;br /&gt;magnitude.&lt;br /&gt;A 100% stator earth fault protection is designed to detect earth fault occurring in the&lt;br /&gt;region of the machine windings close to the neutral end. Composite static modular relay&lt;br /&gt;that gives 100% earth fault protection of the machine, whose neutral is directly earthed. It&lt;br /&gt;works on the principle of monitoring the neutral side and the line side of the component&lt;br /&gt;of third harmonic voltage produced by the generator in service.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 239 -&lt;br /&gt;OPERATING PRINCIPLE&lt;br /&gt;Alternating Current generator in service produces a certain magnitude of third harmonic&lt;br /&gt;voltage in their winding. However no third harmonic voltage appear across the star/delta&lt;br /&gt;connected generator, though there will be a certain magnitude of third harmonic voltage&lt;br /&gt;between each phase and ground of the machine output. This voltage in case of machine&lt;br /&gt;earth through high impedance can cause the flow of third harmonic current between the&lt;br /&gt;ground and the neutral. In fact under normal healthy operating condition the third&lt;br /&gt;harmonic voltage generated in the machine is shared between the phase to ground&lt;br /&gt;capacity impedance at the machine terminal and neutral to ground impedance at the&lt;br /&gt;machine neutral.&lt;br /&gt;The figure-1 shows the third harmonic voltage distribution during normal working&lt;br /&gt;conditions.&lt;br /&gt;V3 = Generated third harmonic voltage.&lt;br /&gt;VL3 = Third harmonic voltage at machine line end.&lt;br /&gt;VN3 = Third harmonic voltage at machine neutral end&lt;br /&gt;V3&lt;br /&gt;VN3 VL3&lt;br /&gt;Fig (1)&lt;br /&gt;Whenever fault occurs at the point (Figure-2) say F on the machine winding, the voltage&lt;br /&gt;distribution VN3 / VL3 undergoes a change from that during the running condition. In the&lt;br /&gt;extreme case of a fault occurring on the machine neutral, the VN3 becomes zero and VL3&lt;br /&gt;=V3. Similarly when the fault occurs on the phase terminal, VN3 become equal to V3.&lt;br /&gt;The change in 3rd harmonic voltage will sense the relay and trip the generator.&lt;br /&gt;N Line&lt;br /&gt;Fault&lt;br /&gt;V3&lt;br /&gt;VN3&lt;br /&gt;Faulty&lt;br /&gt;VL3 Healthy&lt;br /&gt;VN3 VL3 Faulty&lt;br /&gt;Healthy&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 240 -&lt;br /&gt;Fig (2) 3rd harmonic voltage distribution during healthy and faulty condition.&lt;br /&gt;Figure-3 shows the VN3 Vs VL3 plot under healthy condition, it is clear that in order to&lt;br /&gt;remain stable under healthy condition, the relay should restrain within the two lines L1 &amp;amp;&lt;br /&gt;L2. The slopes of two lines are suitably set to ensure stability.&lt;br /&gt;Line 1&lt;br /&gt;Fault on neutral Healthy condition&lt;br /&gt;VL3 Line 2&lt;br /&gt;Fault on phase&lt;br /&gt;VN3&lt;br /&gt;The fault scheme of main generator is having first relay 64A, covers 100% of the stator&lt;br /&gt;winding, the 2nd relay 64B covers 0-90% of stator winding from phase terminals. The 3rd&lt;br /&gt;relay 64C used for the protection of stator earth fault during start-up.&lt;br /&gt;Variation of neutral and line side&lt;br /&gt;3rd harmonic voltage at load&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 241 -&lt;br /&gt;b) GENERATOR UNBALANCE PROTECTION (46)&lt;br /&gt;Negative phase sequence current in the stator of generator due to unbalance load, fault,&lt;br /&gt;induces double frequency eddy currents in the rotor. This current if allowed to persist,&lt;br /&gt;can cause serious over heating. The unbalance protection relay disconnects the machine&lt;br /&gt;before such excess over heat. In order to avoid unnecessary tripping of the machine, the&lt;br /&gt;time characteristics of the relay should match the heating characteristics of the machine.&lt;br /&gt;The neg. phase sequence current creates magnetic flux wave in the air gap, which induces&lt;br /&gt;current in the rotor body iron. These currents with twice rated frequency tend to flow in&lt;br /&gt;the non-magnetic rotor wedges and retaining rings. Heating occurs in these areas due to&lt;br /&gt;watt loss and quickly raises the temp.&lt;br /&gt;DESCRIPTION&lt;br /&gt;Figure-1 shows the block diagram of the unbalance protection relay. The input from the&lt;br /&gt;CT which are connected in the each phase of the generator supply (Fig-2) are fed to a&lt;br /&gt;negative sequence filter (Fig-3) which gives an a.c. output voltage proportional to the&lt;br /&gt;negative sequence current. This voltage is rectified, smoothened and fed to the squaring&lt;br /&gt;unit of the main measuring element, the time delay circuit and the alarm unit.&lt;br /&gt;The output of the squaring circuit is proportional to the square of the input voltage and is&lt;br /&gt;applied directly to the main timing circuit to give the required relation ship between I2t&lt;br /&gt;and relay operating time (t).&lt;br /&gt;The voltage upto, which the timing capacitor charge depends upon the voltage, applied&lt;br /&gt;from the squaring circuit. This means that even when the negative current is less than the&lt;br /&gt;relay setting, the timer circuit will partially charges and reduces the relay operating time&lt;br /&gt;when the current exceeds the setting value.&lt;br /&gt;When the output exceeds the reference voltage it provides one of the input to a 2-input&lt;br /&gt;AND gate. The other input comes from the 0.3-sec timer, which is activated by the timer&lt;br /&gt;starter unit when the relay setting exceeds the relay setting. When the both inputs to the&lt;br /&gt;AND gate are present the relay will operate and trip the generator from fault.&lt;br /&gt;OPERATING PRINCIPLE&lt;br /&gt;The negative sequence filter shown in Figure-2 is connected in delta to eliminate the&lt;br /&gt;effect of zero sequence currents. A fourth auxiliary transformer is provided to get a phase&lt;br /&gt;shift of 180o Ic – A in figure–3. Vector diagram of both positive and negative sequence&lt;br /&gt;current in the filter are shown in figure-4&amp;amp;5. It can be seen that the output produced&lt;br /&gt;when negative sequence current is present, but zero when the current are of positive&lt;br /&gt;sequence.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 242 -&lt;br /&gt;c) GENERATOR FIELD FAILURE PROTECTION (40)&lt;br /&gt;Loss of field supply to a synchronous generator can be caused by a fault in the excitation&lt;br /&gt;circuit or by incorrect opening of field breaker. On loss of field, the machine operates as&lt;br /&gt;an induction generator excited by the reactive power drawn from the system to which it&lt;br /&gt;connected. This could result in instability of power in the system and overheating the&lt;br /&gt;rotor.&lt;br /&gt;One parameter which changes significantly when the machine is subject to severe loss of&lt;br /&gt;excitation is the impedance measured at the terminals and it move into the negative&lt;br /&gt;reactance area. The relay is set to detect this abnormal operating condition using its&lt;br /&gt;circular impedance characteristics, which lies in the negative reactance area.&lt;br /&gt;OPERATION&lt;br /&gt;Figure-1 shows the fundamental block diagram of the relay vector V and I are voltage&lt;br /&gt;and current input to relay terminal. The input to the relay current circuit is through a CT&lt;br /&gt;(T1), which is tapped on the both the primary, and the secondary windings to give a&lt;br /&gt;course (K3) and medium reach (K2) setting of the relay. The relay characteristic angle is&lt;br /&gt;continuously variable from 45o to 75o lagging by means of a potentiometer (Q). The&lt;br /&gt;forward reach of the relay (Z) is continuously variable by means of potentiometer (K1) in&lt;br /&gt;the voltage-restrained circuit of mixing transformer (T3).&lt;br /&gt;Output vector S2 proportional to the vector V ± I Z of the voltage mixing transformer (T2)&lt;br /&gt;forms the second input signal of the phase angle comparator. The comparator is a 2-input&lt;br /&gt;block average comparator and operates by comparing the signal vector S1 &amp;amp; S2. The&lt;br /&gt;output of the comparator is fed into a squaring amplifier whose output switches ON for a&lt;br /&gt;positive input and OFF for a negative input. The output waveforms of the amplifier are&lt;br /&gt;varying mark/space square wave, mark/space being equal for 90o-phase angle difference&lt;br /&gt;between two inputs. The squared output is averaged by an auxiliary element set to just to&lt;br /&gt;operate for an equal mark/space ratio. The current build up in the inductive auxiliary coil&lt;br /&gt;to reach the operate level only if the ON period are longer than the OFF period. The L/R&lt;br /&gt;ratio of the auxiliary coil and pick up level are accurately set. The output auxiliary relay&lt;br /&gt;then picks up if the phase angle between the signal vector S1 &amp;amp; S2 are 90o or more as&lt;br /&gt;shown in figure-2. Fig-3 shows the typical circuit connection for field failure protection&lt;br /&gt;of generator.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 243 -&lt;br /&gt;d) GENERATOR POLE SLIPPING PROTECTION (78)&lt;br /&gt;Sudden occurrence in the electrical grid such as rapid load changes, short circuit&lt;br /&gt;interruptions, which destroy the equilibrium of the energy balance are usually followed by&lt;br /&gt;oscillations. If the system stability is retained, the stationary stage will take over. If the&lt;br /&gt;oscillations are not stable, a loss of synchronism of one or more machine will result. If&lt;br /&gt;the angular displacement of the rotor exceeds the stable limit, the rotor will slip a pole&lt;br /&gt;pitch. Pole slip occurs and excitation is maintained the machine will oscillate strongly on&lt;br /&gt;reactive and active power side.&lt;br /&gt;This relay operates on the principle of measuring impedance course on R-X diagram and&lt;br /&gt;operates to trip on pole slipping condition. The scheme consists of two numbers angle&lt;br /&gt;impedance relay and a timer to distinguish between pole slipping and power swing&lt;br /&gt;blocking condition. When gen. Losses synchronism the resulting high current picks and&lt;br /&gt;off freq. Operation can cause winding stresses, pulsating torque and mechanical&lt;br /&gt;resonance that have potential of damaging the Turbine Generator.&lt;br /&gt;X&lt;br /&gt;Blinder Directional&lt;br /&gt;Load Area&lt;br /&gt;Q2 Q1 R&lt;br /&gt;Operate Restrain&lt;br /&gt;B Operate&lt;br /&gt;A&lt;br /&gt;Generator pole slipping protection&lt;br /&gt;e) GENERATOR DIFFERENTIAL PROTECTION (87G)&lt;br /&gt;This is a high-speed differential protection, the relay of high impedance is provided for&lt;br /&gt;this protection. The high impedance principle is used for thorough fault stability even&lt;br /&gt;under current transformer saturation.&lt;br /&gt;This protection has an operating time of 25 millisecond at 5 time’s current setting. A&lt;br /&gt;non- linear resistance is connected across the relay to limit the over voltage during&lt;br /&gt;internal fault.&lt;br /&gt;This protection covers phase to phase and 3-phase faults. It does not cover phase to&lt;br /&gt;ground fault as the ground fault current is limited to a very low value. This protection&lt;br /&gt;energizes Class-A trip.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 244 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 245 -&lt;br /&gt;f) GENERATOR INTER TURN DIFFERENTIAL PROTECTION: (87 GI)&lt;br /&gt;This protection is by means of a differential current relay connected across crossconnected&lt;br /&gt;CT on the two parallel winding of each of the phase of the generator as shown&lt;br /&gt;in figure-2. The relay which is used for t he protection is of high impedance circulating&lt;br /&gt;current type with an operating speed of 25 millisecond at 5 times the current setting. A&lt;br /&gt;non-linear resistance is connected across the relay to limit the over voltage during the&lt;br /&gt;internal fault. This protection energizes Class-A trip.&lt;br /&gt;PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION (DIFFERENTIAL)&lt;br /&gt;Fig-3 shows the simplified diagram of differential current protection of generator&lt;br /&gt;winding, the CT’s of both end of the generator winding will sense the current which is&lt;br /&gt;flowing through the stator winding. During normal balanced condition the current vector&lt;br /&gt;I1 &amp;amp; I2 are equal and opposite so the resultant forces experiences in the coil of the relay R&lt;br /&gt;is zero.&lt;br /&gt;When the fault ‘F’ occurs on the stator winding, the differential current will be sensed by&lt;br /&gt;the CT and these differential current passes through the operating coil of the relay which&lt;br /&gt;gives trip signal to the circuit breaker of the generator.&lt;br /&gt;Ground To load&lt;br /&gt;Fault&lt;br /&gt;I1 I2&lt;br /&gt;I1 I3 I2&lt;br /&gt;I1 + I2 = 0 Normal condition&lt;br /&gt;I1 + I2 = I3 Faulty condition&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 246 -&lt;br /&gt;GENERATOR BACK UP PROTECTIONS&lt;br /&gt;a) UNDER FREQUENCY PROTECTION (81)&lt;br /&gt;The U/F limitations however are less restrictive than the limitations on the turbine. A&lt;br /&gt;turbine blade is designed to have its natural frequencies sufficiently displaced from rated&lt;br /&gt;speed and multiples of N (speed) to avoid a mechanical resonant condition that could&lt;br /&gt;result in excessive mechanical Stresses in blades&lt;br /&gt;This is a three stage under frequency protection, which consists of a time delay unit and 3&lt;br /&gt;timer. The three stages of frequencies are ranging from 47 to 50 Hz. The timer which&lt;br /&gt;gives the cumulative operating time of turbine during under frequency which calls for&lt;br /&gt;turbine inspection/maintenance as per the design formula.&lt;br /&gt;(48.5-F) t &lt; 3.&lt;br /&gt;Where F is the frequency,&lt;br /&gt;t is the timer duration in seconds.&lt;br /&gt;From the above formula, it can be seen that the turbine can be operable at 48.5 Hz&lt;br /&gt;continuously at rated load. The cumulative timer which gives alarm in Data acquisition&lt;br /&gt;system then call for turbine inspection.&lt;br /&gt;OPERATING PRINCIPLE:&lt;br /&gt;The operating principle of the relay is the comparison of the incoming frequency with that&lt;br /&gt;of a pre-set value of time derived from the oscillator of the relay.&lt;br /&gt;The incoming frequency signal is connected to an input circuit, which then drive an&lt;br /&gt;impulse generator to produce pulse at the beginning of each period of the input voltage.&lt;br /&gt;The preset time interval is obtained from an oscillator and counter, adjustment is achieved&lt;br /&gt;using selector switches, which drives the decoder circuit.&lt;br /&gt;A comparator compares the two-time interval and this triggers an adjustable timer, which&lt;br /&gt;then operate the output voltage. An under voltage detector inhibits the relay when the&lt;br /&gt;incoming signal drops below the preset value.&lt;br /&gt;b) OVER FREQUENCY PROTECTION (81)&lt;br /&gt;Generator over frequency protection is provided to limit the over speeding of turbine,&lt;br /&gt;which leads to greater vibration due to resonance. The over speeding and vibration leads&lt;br /&gt;to mechanical damage of turbine bearings and blades. This protection schemes also&lt;br /&gt;similar to under frequency. The preset time of over frequency operation is more than the&lt;br /&gt;preset time of under frequency protection.&lt;br /&gt;c) GENERATOR OVER VOLTAGE ALARM (59)&lt;br /&gt;This protection give time delayed alarm for continuous operation of the generator at more than&lt;br /&gt;permissible voltage of AVR failure or during manual control of excitation.&lt;br /&gt;d) GENERATOR ANTIMOTORING PROTECTION (32)&lt;br /&gt;Motoring results from low prime mover input to generator. While generator is still in line. When this&lt;br /&gt;input is less than no load losses deficiency is supplied by absorbing real power from the system. Since&lt;br /&gt;the field excitation should remain same, The same reactive power would flow as before the motoring and&lt;br /&gt;generator will operate as a synchronous motor driving the turbine. Generator will not be harmed by this&lt;br /&gt;action but turbine can be harmed through over heating. It is detected by low forward power relay.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 247 -&lt;br /&gt;EXCITATION SYSTEM PROTECTIONS&lt;br /&gt;The generator is provided with static excitation, which obtains the necessary excitation&lt;br /&gt;power from the excitation transformer, which rectifies and feed the AC power through&lt;br /&gt;controlled rectifier circuits.&lt;br /&gt;a) EXCITATION TRANSFORMER OVER CURRENT PROTECTION:&lt;br /&gt;Time delayed over current protection with instantaneous high set unit is provided for the&lt;br /&gt;short circuit protection of the excitation transformer, which trips the field breaker by&lt;br /&gt;energizing class-B trip.&lt;br /&gt;b) ROTOR OVER VOLTAGE PROTECTION:&lt;br /&gt;This protection is envisaged to limit over voltage occurring in the field circuit during&lt;br /&gt;excitation of the field an air gap arrestor with a series resistor is connected across the&lt;br /&gt;field. On overvoltage the gap flasher over and the arrestor connects the resistor directly&lt;br /&gt;across the field.&lt;br /&gt;This over voltage is not due to the field forcing. Field forcing will happen only when PT&lt;br /&gt;actual voltage value comes down due to the PT fuse drop or due to any other reason. At&lt;br /&gt;that time PT voltage is 110 V – drop. That is actual voltage value is less and field forced&lt;br /&gt;to increase the voltage. Field forcing value is twice the actual value after looking the&lt;br /&gt;system healthiness. Means in some earth faults in the grid, the voltages may come down&lt;br /&gt;to 110 kV and PT will sense this voltage as the generator is synchronised with the grid.&lt;br /&gt;This will force the field of the generator to match the generator actual voltage. If the fault&lt;br /&gt;not cleared the generator will trip after some time delay. This is generator field forcing.&lt;br /&gt;But in some grid disturbances or power swing conditions the stator and rotor voltage and&lt;br /&gt;current changes. This will induce some voltage in rotor. This protection is used to protect&lt;br /&gt;machine from this type of over voltage.&lt;br /&gt;c) ROTOR 1ST EARTH FAULT PROTECTION&lt;br /&gt;A single earth fault is not in itself dangerous since it does not cause fault current, but a&lt;br /&gt;second earth fault effectively short circuits parts or all of the field system and the&lt;br /&gt;unbalancing of the magnetic forces causes. That force may be sufficient to spring the&lt;br /&gt;shaft and make it eccentric. If the condition were allowed to persist, however it might&lt;br /&gt;lead to severe mechanical damage.&lt;br /&gt;The method of detecting rotor first earth fault using the principle of negative biasing,&lt;br /&gt;where by an earth fault anywhere in the field circuit can be detected. The dc injection&lt;br /&gt;supply establishes a small bias on the alternator field circuit so that all points are negative&lt;br /&gt;with respect to earth.&lt;br /&gt;The rectified output of the supply provides a biasing potential of approximately 65V.&lt;br /&gt;This is connected with a positive terminal to earth and negative terminal to the positive&lt;br /&gt;terminal of the field circuit through a relay. When the fault occurs, the current flows&lt;br /&gt;through the relay coil which intern operate the circuit breaker. This relay will not operate&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 248 -&lt;br /&gt;on auxiliary supply failed condition, during that time the relay will give annunciation in&lt;br /&gt;main control room.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 249 -&lt;br /&gt;d) ROTOR 2ND EARTH FAULT (64F)&lt;br /&gt;While the machine is continuous in service with one earth fault, appearance of 2nd earth&lt;br /&gt;fault will severely affect the magnetic balance in the air gap and result in rotor distortion&lt;br /&gt;and severe damage. Hence it is advisable that the machine taken out of service as early as&lt;br /&gt;possible after appearance of 1st earth fault. However, to take care of the situation of 2nd&lt;br /&gt;earth fault appearing immediately after 1st stator earth fault before the machine is taken&lt;br /&gt;out, 2nd rotor earth fault protection is provided. This protection system normally&lt;br /&gt;disconnect the field effect and has top be switched ON when 1st earth fault appears.&lt;br /&gt;The scheme consists of a bridge circuit which to be balanced manually with the 1st rotor&lt;br /&gt;earth fault in the machine. This balance is disturbed when the 2nd earth fault appears and&lt;br /&gt;the bridge null deflector initiate tripping of the circuit.&lt;br /&gt;It can be seen in the below diagram the protection of the field winding on either side of&lt;br /&gt;the first earth fault and the balancing potentiometer forms a dc bridge with 64F2 (Relay)&lt;br /&gt;connected across the pair of opposite modes.&lt;br /&gt;64F2&lt;br /&gt;1st E/F Balancing potentiometer&lt;br /&gt;Field 2nd E/F Excitation supply&lt;br /&gt;E Fig (1)&lt;br /&gt;Fig (1)&lt;br /&gt;Discharge resistor -ve&lt;br /&gt;-ve Field winding&lt;br /&gt;Excitation supply&lt;br /&gt;+ve +ve&lt;br /&gt;64 F1 Trip and alarm&lt;br /&gt;Relay&lt;br /&gt;Current limiting resistor&lt;br /&gt;AC&lt;br /&gt;Supply&lt;br /&gt;Fig (2)&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 250 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 251 -&lt;br /&gt;TRANSFORMER PROTECTIONS&lt;br /&gt;a) OVERALL DIFFERENTIAL PROTECTION (87 GT)&lt;br /&gt;This protection which is used as the differential protection of the transformer, also covers&lt;br /&gt;the generator and unit transformer. The differential transformer protection measuring&lt;br /&gt;circuit is based on the well-known MERZ-PRICE circulating current principle.&lt;br /&gt;Fig-1 shows the relay functional block diagram. The output from each bias resistance&lt;br /&gt;transformer T3 to T5 proportional to the appropriate primary line currents, are rectified&lt;br /&gt;and summed to produce a bias resistance voltage. Any resulting difference current is&lt;br /&gt;circulated through the transformer T1 &amp;amp; T2. The output from T1 is rectified and combined&lt;br /&gt;with the bias voltage to produce a signal, which is applied to the amplitude comparator.&lt;br /&gt;The comparator output is in the form of pulses which vary in width depending on the&lt;br /&gt;amplitude of the combined bias and difference voltages where the measurement of the&lt;br /&gt;interval between these pulse indicate less than a preset time, an internal fault is indicated&lt;br /&gt;and a trip signal initiated after a short time delay (1/f sec), level set by the bias.&lt;br /&gt;An unrestrained high set circuit, which monitors the differential current, will over ride the&lt;br /&gt;amplitude comparator circuit and operate the relay output element when the difference&lt;br /&gt;current is above the high set settings.&lt;br /&gt;Fig-2 shows the basic circuit diagram of the differential protection and fig-3 shows the&lt;br /&gt;current direction of the restraint/differential transformers in the relay. The currents I1, I2,&lt;br /&gt;&amp;amp; I3 are the output of generator CT, UT CT and GT CT respectively. These currents is&lt;br /&gt;passing through the star connected restraint transformer, the algebraic sum of vector&lt;br /&gt;(I1+I2+I3 = I4) is passing through the differential transformer, which will give the output&lt;br /&gt;for operating the relay (87).&lt;br /&gt;b) OVER FLUXING PROTECTION (59V/F)&lt;br /&gt;This is designed to protect the transformer from damages caused by the flux density in the&lt;br /&gt;core exceeds the designed value. The excessive flux can cause serious overheating of&lt;br /&gt;metallic parts and in extreme case can cause localized rapid melting of generator and&lt;br /&gt;transformer core laminations. Over fluxing can be caused by regulator failure, load&lt;br /&gt;reduction or excessive excitation with generator off-line it can also result from decreasing&lt;br /&gt;speed while the regulator or the operator attempts to maintain rated stator voltage. Its&lt;br /&gt;main application is to protect the transformers where, unless considerable care is taken,&lt;br /&gt;the flux density can become excessive during the running up or running down sequence.&lt;br /&gt;The flux density in the core depends on the ratio of terminal voltage (V) divided by the&lt;br /&gt;frequency (f). Normally the over fluxing withstand characteristics of the transformer are&lt;br /&gt;120% over fluxing for 2 minutes&lt;br /&gt;135% over fluxing for 1 minutes&lt;br /&gt;140% over fluxing for 5 seconds.&lt;br /&gt;Whenever the v/f ratio of the transformer exceeds the pre-set time, the relay will operate&lt;br /&gt;and initiate&lt;br /&gt;• Running down the AVR if the machine is off the bus bar.&lt;br /&gt;• Tripping the GT breaker.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 252 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 253 -&lt;br /&gt;OPERATING PRINCIPLE:&lt;br /&gt;The basic principle of the relay is to produce an alternating voltage, which is proportional&lt;br /&gt;to the ratio of voltage &amp;amp; frequency, and to compare this with a fixed voltage. When the&lt;br /&gt;peak of the alternating voltage exceeds the fixed dc reference, the first timer is started. At&lt;br /&gt;the end of the fixed timer cycle the second adjustable timer is initiated.&lt;br /&gt;To obtain the correct measuring quantity the applied voltage V is converted to a current&lt;br /&gt;by means of a resistor R. This V/R is arranged to flow through a capacitor C to produce&lt;br /&gt;an output voltage&lt;br /&gt;V/2 π f RC.&lt;br /&gt;Over fluxing relay which consists of Voltage/Frequency measuring circuit, which output&lt;br /&gt;is given to a comparator, compares with dc reference and to give an output after a fixed&lt;br /&gt;time delay of 0.5 to 1.0 seconds. After the end of fixed time delay, the 2nd variable timer&lt;br /&gt;initiates. The fixed time auxiliary has one of its two pairs of contact wired out which is&lt;br /&gt;normally arranged to operate a follower.&lt;br /&gt;c) GENERATOR TRANSFORMER RESTRICTED EARTH FAULT PROTECTION (64)&lt;br /&gt;In addition to overall differential protection, a restricted earth fault protection covering&lt;br /&gt;the transformer HV winding only is provided. The zone of protection extends from CT&lt;br /&gt;provided on the transformer neutral end to the CT provided on the transformer bushings.&lt;br /&gt;The relay is high impedance type and high speed of operation. A non-linear resistance is&lt;br /&gt;connected across the relay terminal to limit the voltage developed during serial internal&lt;br /&gt;fault. This protection energizes Class-A trip of the turbo-generator.&lt;br /&gt;REF relay&lt;br /&gt;Transformer&lt;br /&gt;SCHEME OF RESTRICTED E/F PROTECTION&lt;br /&gt;d) GENERATOR TRANSFORMER BACK-UP OVER CURRENT PROTECTION FOR PHASE FAULT (51)&lt;br /&gt;This protection consists of a 3 phase over current relay. The relay is 3-pole version of&lt;br /&gt;very inverse time over current relay plus high set instantaneous over current relay. This&lt;br /&gt;will act as the back up protection for the transformer fault due to the fault current flowing&lt;br /&gt;from system side. This may also serve limited back up protection function for fault&lt;br /&gt;external to the transformer. This will energize Class-A trip.&lt;br /&gt;R&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 254 -&lt;br /&gt;e) GENERATOR TRANSFORMER BACK UP EARTH FAULT PROTECTION (51N)&lt;br /&gt;This is a simple inverse type over current relay connected to the neutral CT of&lt;br /&gt;transformer. This relay provided back up function for fault both internal and external to&lt;br /&gt;the transformer, This protection energizes Class-A trip.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 255 -&lt;br /&gt;f) OVER LOAD MONITORING (49)&lt;br /&gt;Measuring oil temperature and winding temperature indirectly monitors the loading of the&lt;br /&gt;generator transformer. The oil and winding temperature indicators are provided with&lt;br /&gt;contacts for initiating alarms as a first stage and tripping as the second stage whenever the&lt;br /&gt;oil and winding temperature limits are exceeded. The oil temperature /winding&lt;br /&gt;temperature trips are routed through Class-C trip.&lt;br /&gt;g) GAS PROTECTION (63)&lt;br /&gt;A Buchholz relay is supplied along with the transformer. The relay has two contacts one&lt;br /&gt;closes on slow gas formation and initiate alarm. The second contact closes of sudden&lt;br /&gt;surge of oil flow in case of severe internal fault and this contact is wired for tripping the&lt;br /&gt;unit in Class-A trip.&lt;br /&gt;The relay consists of two float switches contained in a closed housing, which is located in&lt;br /&gt;the pipe from transformer to conservator tank. Any internal fault in the transformer&lt;br /&gt;comes, the oil decomposes and the generating gases which passes up the pipe towards the&lt;br /&gt;conservator and is trapped in the relay. In this two float relay the top float responds the&lt;br /&gt;slow accumulation of gas due to mild and incipient fault, the lower float being deflected&lt;br /&gt;by the oil surges caused by a major fault. The float control contacts, in the first stage give&lt;br /&gt;an alarm and second case to isolate the transformer.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 256 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the set values of generator protection?&lt;br /&gt;TYPE OF PROTECTION AND ITS SET VALUES&lt;br /&gt;No. Type of Protection Set Values CT/PT Ratio Time Delay Class&lt;br /&gt;1. Generator differential 0.5A(10%) 10000/5 Inst. Class-A1&lt;br /&gt;2. Generator Inter turn 0.5A(10%) 5000/5 Inst. Class-A1&lt;br /&gt;3 Generator reverse power 0.5% 10000/5 5 sec Class-A1&lt;br /&gt;(stage 2 Tx trip)&lt;br /&gt;4. 100% Stator Earth Fault ND = 5V(3r&lt;br /&gt;harmonic 70&lt;br /&gt;100%)&lt;br /&gt;16.5 kV/110V 1.0 sec Class-A1&lt;br /&gt;5. 2nd Rotor Earth Fault 1.0 mA --- --- Class-A1&lt;br /&gt;6. Over Frequency 51.5 Hz 16.5 kV/110V 0.1 sec 86 BG&lt;br /&gt;7. Over Voltage 120% 16.5 kV/110V 2.0 sec Class-A&lt;br /&gt;8. Overall Differential 1.0A 10000/5A Inst. Class-A1&lt;br /&gt;9. GT Restricted E/F 0.1A 800/1A Inst. Class-A1&lt;br /&gt;10. GT Gas Protection --- ---- Inst. Class-A1&lt;br /&gt;11. GT Fire --- --- Inst. Class-A1&lt;br /&gt;12. GT Over Current PSM-1.0&lt;br /&gt;Inst. – 8.0&lt;br /&gt;800/1 A TMS=0.4 Class-A1&lt;br /&gt;13. GT Earth Fault PSM-0.2&lt;br /&gt;TMS-0.52&lt;br /&gt;800/1A 2.0 sec Class-A1&lt;br /&gt;14. Impedance Protection&lt;br /&gt;Stage-1&lt;br /&gt;--- 10000/5A 2.0 sec Class-A2&lt;br /&gt;15. Generator Over Current&lt;br /&gt;During Starting&lt;br /&gt;50 mA 10000/5A Inst. Class-A2&lt;br /&gt;16. Generator Back-up Earth&lt;br /&gt;Fault&lt;br /&gt;PSM-5.4V 16.5 kV/110V TMS =0.3 Class-A2&lt;br /&gt;17. Stator Earth Fault During Starting 100 mA 300/1A Inst. Class-A2&lt;br /&gt;18. Low Forward Power 0.5% of FP 10000/5A 2.5 sec Class-B1&lt;br /&gt;19. GT Over Fluxing Stage-1 120% --- 2 min Class-B&lt;br /&gt;20. GT Over Fluxing Stage-2 135% --- 1 min Class-B&lt;br /&gt;21. Negative Sequence 5% 10000/5A Inverse Class-B&lt;br /&gt;22. Field Failure --- 10000/5A Inverse Class-A2&lt;br /&gt;23. Under Frequency 47.77 Hz 16.5 kV/110V 4 sec Class-C&lt;br /&gt;24. GT Winding Temp. High 130O C --- --- Class-C&lt;br /&gt;25. GT Oil Temp. High 90O C --- --- Class-C&lt;br /&gt;• What is arc and what is spark?&lt;br /&gt;Spark - the heat produced that ignites, due to the rubbing of two metals is called the&lt;br /&gt;spark.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 257 -&lt;br /&gt;Arc – the electrical discharge between two electrodes is called the arc. Arc is the&lt;br /&gt;self-sustained discharge of electricity between electrodes in a gas or vapour, which&lt;br /&gt;has a high voltage discharge at the cathode.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 258 -&lt;br /&gt;• What precautions should be taken while meggering main generator?&lt;br /&gt;All PT’s are racked out.&lt;br /&gt;Earthing transformer grounding terminals disconnected.&lt;br /&gt;Barring gear shall be kept off.&lt;br /&gt;Stator water shall be drained fully and hot air blown through conductors.&lt;br /&gt;Generator flexible lines shall be disconnected to isolate GT/UT.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the speed equation for AC machine?&lt;br /&gt;N = 120 f / P&lt;br /&gt;N – Speed in RPM&lt;br /&gt;f - Frequency in Hz&lt;br /&gt;P – Number of poles&lt;br /&gt;• What is emf equation of alternator?&lt;br /&gt;Emf = 4.44 kc kd f ∅ T volts.&lt;br /&gt;Kd = Distribution factor = sin m β/2&lt;br /&gt;m sin β/2&lt;br /&gt;kc/kp = Coil span factor /Pitch factor = cos α/2&lt;br /&gt;kf = Form factor = 1.11&lt;br /&gt;∴Average emf induced / Cycle = ∅ N P/ 60&lt;br /&gt;= ∅ P ∗120 f&lt;br /&gt;60 * P&lt;br /&gt;=2 f ∅ volt&lt;br /&gt;If Z is the number of conductors = 2T (T = two sides of conductor)&lt;br /&gt;emf induced = 2 f ∅ Z =2 f ∅ 2T = 4 f ∅ T&lt;br /&gt;∴ RMS value of emf induced = form factor * emf&lt;br /&gt;= 1.11 * 4 f ∅ T&lt;br /&gt;= 4.44 f ∅ T volts.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the emf equation for DC generator?&lt;br /&gt;P * ∅ * Z * N&lt;br /&gt;60 * A&lt;br /&gt;A = number of parallel paths. That is for lap winding it is equal to Z and for wave&lt;br /&gt;winding it equal to 2.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the factors, which varies terminal voltage of generator?&lt;br /&gt;a) Voltage drop due to resistance (Ra drop). This is negligible.&lt;br /&gt;b) Voltage drops due to leakage reactance (XL).&lt;br /&gt;c) Voltage drops due to armature reaction.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 259 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is meant by Armature reaction?&lt;br /&gt;The effect of armature flux on the main field flux is called Armature reaction, where&lt;br /&gt;armature flux weakens the main field flux. In Alternator power factor contributes&lt;br /&gt;more importance in Armature reaction.&lt;br /&gt;a) In Unity power factor field strength is average and effect is distortional. So&lt;br /&gt;voltage variation will not be too much.&lt;br /&gt;b) In lagging power factor armature flux is directly opposite to the main field flux.&lt;br /&gt;That is armature flux is lagging 90ο by main field flux. So the result is&lt;br /&gt;demagnetizing the field. Due to less field flux less voltage at the alternator&lt;br /&gt;terminals and excitation required is more.&lt;br /&gt;c) In leading power factor armature flux is leading by 90ο to the main field flux. The&lt;br /&gt;result is additive and main field strength is more and excitation has to be reduced.&lt;br /&gt;Otherwise end parts or overhang portion of the generator will heat.&lt;br /&gt;• What is meant by voltage regulation?&lt;br /&gt;If there is a change in load, there is a change in terminal voltage. This change not&lt;br /&gt;only depends upon the load but also on power factor. The voltage regulation is&lt;br /&gt;termed as the rise in voltage when full load is removed divided by rated terminal&lt;br /&gt;voltage (Excitation and speed remains constant).&lt;br /&gt;∴ Regulation in % = E0 – V&lt;br /&gt;V&lt;br /&gt;In case of leading power factor terminal voltage will fall and regulation is negative.&lt;br /&gt;PF leading&lt;br /&gt;Terminal&lt;br /&gt;Voltage PF unity&lt;br /&gt;PF lagging&lt;br /&gt;Load current&lt;br /&gt;Generator voltage characteristics&lt;br /&gt;• Why double squirrel cage motor used in barring gear? Why?&lt;br /&gt;To have high starting torque.&lt;br /&gt;In AC motors torque is directly proportional to φ (flux), I2 and cosφ2.&lt;br /&gt;i.e T ;φ (flux* I2 * cos φ2.&lt;br /&gt;∴ T = k * φ (flux)* I2 * cos φ2.&lt;br /&gt;Rotor at standstill E2;φ (flux)&lt;br /&gt;∴ T = k * E2 * I2 * cos φ2.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 260 -&lt;br /&gt;In double squirrel cage motor inner cage is low resistive and high inductive. The&lt;br /&gt;outer cage is high resistive and low inductive. In case of inner cage Z (impedance) is&lt;br /&gt;less (XL = 2􀀟 f L). If the rotor is having high inductance at starting I2 will lag E2 by&lt;br /&gt;large and cos φ2 (Rotor PF = R2 / Z2) is very less. So torque&lt;br /&gt;is less.&lt;br /&gt;At staring rotor torque is proportional to the rotor&lt;br /&gt;resistance. At starting inductance is high and the Z is--&lt;br /&gt;--------&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 261 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the logics adopted to close the field breaker?&lt;br /&gt;a) Turbine speed 2880 rpm.&lt;br /&gt;b) Class A, B and BG trip reset.&lt;br /&gt;c) Auto/manual reference minimum.&lt;br /&gt;d) Auto/manual channels supply normal.&lt;br /&gt;e) FB closing circuit healthy.&lt;br /&gt;• What you mean by positive sequence, negative sequence and zero sequence of&lt;br /&gt;voltage?&lt;br /&gt;Positive phase sequence&lt;br /&gt;A system of vectors is said to have positive sequence if they are all of equal&lt;br /&gt;magnitude and are displaced by 120° with same time interval to arrive at fixed axis&lt;br /&gt;of reference as that of generated voltage. The positive phase sequence is represented&lt;br /&gt;below and the vectors arrive along X-axis in order 1, 2, 3 and conscript P has been&lt;br /&gt;used to designate as positive sequence.&lt;br /&gt;E3P&lt;br /&gt;Anti clock direction&lt;br /&gt;120°&lt;br /&gt;E3P&lt;br /&gt;E3P&lt;br /&gt;Negative phase sequence&lt;br /&gt;A system of vectors is said to have a negative phase sequence if they are of equal&lt;br /&gt;magnitude displaced at an angle of 120° but arrive at the axis of reference at the&lt;br /&gt;regular interval same as that of positive phase sequence but in order of 1, 3, 2. That&lt;br /&gt;is the order is reversed.&lt;br /&gt;E3N&lt;br /&gt;Clock direction&lt;br /&gt;120°&lt;br /&gt;E3N&lt;br /&gt;E3N&lt;br /&gt;Zero sequence&lt;br /&gt;A system of vectors in a phase system is said to have zero phase sequence if all the&lt;br /&gt;three vectors are not displaced from each other and there will be no phase sequence&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 262 -&lt;br /&gt;in such cases. The current or voltages in the 3-phase circuit vary simultaneously in&lt;br /&gt;all the 3- phases. Such phase sequence is zero phase sequence.&lt;br /&gt;E1O&lt;br /&gt;E2O&lt;br /&gt;E3O&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 263 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is rotor and stator resistance values?&lt;br /&gt;Rotor resistance = 98.1 m􀀍&lt;br /&gt;Stator winding resistance’s&lt;br /&gt;R φ = 3.1􀀍/3.1􀀍&lt;br /&gt;Y φ = 3.1􀀍/3.1􀀍&lt;br /&gt;B φ = 3.1􀀍/3.1􀀍&lt;br /&gt;• What is the rating of generator PT fuse?&lt;br /&gt;24 kV, 3.15 Amps.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the wearing rate of generator Slipring?&lt;br /&gt;Generator Slipring wearing rate is 0.025 mm /1000 hrs.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the brush pressure on Slipring?&lt;br /&gt;Recommended brush pressure in the Slipring is 150 to 200 gms/cm2 (0.9 to 1 kg).&lt;br /&gt;• What are the properties of hydrogen and DM water?&lt;br /&gt;Hydrogen&lt;br /&gt;a. Windage losses are less. Hence efficiency increased.&lt;br /&gt;b. Heat transfer is more. Hence output per volume is increased.&lt;br /&gt;c. No corona discharge, which makes insulation life long.&lt;br /&gt;d. Lesser denser and penetration and cooling more.&lt;br /&gt;e. No fire risk at purity 4% to 74%.&lt;br /&gt;DM Water&lt;br /&gt;a. Non toxic and low viscosity.&lt;br /&gt;b. High thermal conductivity.&lt;br /&gt;c. Low conductivity.&lt;br /&gt;d. Freedom from fire risk.&lt;br /&gt;e. External heat exchanger used.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the chemical tests on hydrogen and DM water?&lt;br /&gt;Hydrogen&lt;br /&gt;a) Hydrogen purity in % (volume/volume).&lt;br /&gt;b) Relative humidity in % (30% is nominal).&lt;br /&gt;DM water&lt;br /&gt;a) PH of DM water (less than 6.5 is acidic and more than 7 is alkaline where oxygen&lt;br /&gt;is not forming). PH is also called IP (isotopic purity).&lt;br /&gt;b) Conductivity.&lt;br /&gt;c) Copper traces.&lt;br /&gt;d) Dissolved oxygen (to trace corrosion and 1.2% is more).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 264 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 265 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the logic’s adopted in barring gear motor?&lt;br /&gt;For start permission&lt;br /&gt;a) Local or remote start.&lt;br /&gt;b) JOP is running.&lt;br /&gt;c) Motor hand barring is permissive.&lt;br /&gt;d) 42 contactor in MCC is off.&lt;br /&gt;e) Turbine speed is &lt;100 rpm.&lt;br /&gt;Start permission (42S of MCC)&lt;br /&gt;a) All above&lt;br /&gt;b) Bearing oil pressure is &gt;0.35 kg/ cm2.&lt;br /&gt;c) No thermal over load of 42S.&lt;br /&gt;d) No one-DG condition.&lt;br /&gt;Start permission (42 of MCC)&lt;br /&gt;a) Start permissive of 42S.&lt;br /&gt;b) Barring gear engage or motor speed reached to 1475 rpm.&lt;br /&gt;c) Turbine speed is &lt;100 rpm.&lt;br /&gt;d) Bearing oil pressure is &gt;0.35 kg/ cm2.&lt;br /&gt;e) No thermal over load of 42.&lt;br /&gt;f) No one-DG condition.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the equation for resistance measurement of PT 100 thermocouple?&lt;br /&gt;°C = (R-100) / 0.39&lt;br /&gt;• What are the requirements for synchronization and setting for generator?&lt;br /&gt;a) Same phase sequence.&lt;br /&gt;b) Voltage should in-phase and angle should not be more than 10°.&lt;br /&gt;c) Voltage value must be same and difference of 5% is allowed.&lt;br /&gt;d) Frequency should be same and difference of 0.1% i.e. 0.05 Hz is allowed.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the recommended IR value for generator?&lt;br /&gt;Main generator is class B insulated machine. Without stator water recommended&lt;br /&gt;insulation value for the generator is R60 = kV + 1 MΩ&lt;br /&gt;R60 – minimum recommended IR in MΩ of entire winding at 40°C of 60 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;kV – rated voltage.&lt;br /&gt;For the IR measurement 1 kV megger should be used.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the type turbine installed in KGS?&lt;br /&gt;Tandem compounded to expansion of steam, impulse reaction type.&lt;br /&gt;• State HP &amp;amp; LP turbine steam values.&lt;br /&gt;HP LP&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 266 -&lt;br /&gt;Pressure Flow Temp Pressure Flow Temp&lt;br /&gt;I/L 40 kg/cm2 1333 t/h 250°C I/L 5.664 kg/cm2 232.9°C&lt;br /&gt;O/L 6.02 kg/cm2 O/L&lt;br /&gt;Wetness (I/L) 0.26% Wetness (I/L)&lt;br /&gt;Wetness (O/L) 11.058% Wetness (O/L)&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 267 -&lt;br /&gt;• State turbine governor setting.&lt;br /&gt;On 2560 rpm turbine governor becomes effective and on 2760 rpm is turbine&lt;br /&gt;governor take over speed.&lt;br /&gt;• What is requirement of speeder gear assembly?&lt;br /&gt;To bring the turbine to synchronous speed and get tight lock with grid by grid&lt;br /&gt;frequency. BPC signal is given in Auto mode to the speeder gear motor.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of LLG?&lt;br /&gt;To ensure that the turbine load never exceed the reactor output, to incorporate&lt;br /&gt;turbine follow reactor feature governing system.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of OSLG?&lt;br /&gt;This gear mainly used to control the steam flow so as to limit the machine from over&lt;br /&gt;speeding. On following occasions the over speed limiting gear acts.&lt;br /&gt;a) When the flow of steam corresponds to load is 2/3 and&lt;br /&gt;b) Electrical power on generator falls 1/3 of full load.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the logic in lubrication oil pump system?&lt;br /&gt;Normally main oil pump (MOP) will feed the required lub oil to turbine governor&lt;br /&gt;and lubrication. If the pressure drops to 5.3 kg/cm2 6.6 kV 373 kW Aux. Oil Pump&lt;br /&gt;will start. If further pressure falls to &lt;0.65 kg/cm2 Flushing Oil Pump will start. If&lt;br /&gt;further pressure drops &lt;0.35 kg/cm2 Emergency Oil Pump will start.&lt;br /&gt;Lubricating oil inlet temperature will be 40°C and outlet temperature will be 70°C.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of TOPP (turbine oil purification plant)?&lt;br /&gt;The purpose of TOPP is to remove the water ingress in turbine oil system from the&lt;br /&gt;gland leaks, cooler leakage, and solid metal particles, which are produced due to rust,&lt;br /&gt;wear of bearings and to normalize the low quality oil.&lt;br /&gt;The remove capacity of TOPP is, for solids – 5 microns and for water – 300 to 500&lt;br /&gt;parts per milli.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 268 -&lt;br /&gt;RELAYS&lt;br /&gt;• Write down the relay numbers and their designation.&lt;br /&gt;1 MASTER ELEMENT 51 AC TIME OVER CURRENT RELAY&lt;br /&gt;2 TIME DELAY STARTING OR CLEARING 52 AC CIRCUIT BREAKER&lt;br /&gt;3 CHECK OR INTERPOSING RELAY 53 EXCITER OR DC GENERATOR&lt;br /&gt;4 MASTER CONTACTOR 54 SPARE&lt;br /&gt;5 STOPPING DEVICE 55 POWER FACTOR RELAY&lt;br /&gt;6 STARTING CIRCUIT BREAKER 56 FIELD APPLICATION RELAY&lt;br /&gt;7 ANODE CIRCUIT BREAKER 57 SHORT CIRCUITING DEVICE&lt;br /&gt;8 CONTROL POWER DISCONNECT DEVICE 58 RECTIFICATION FAILURE RELAY&lt;br /&gt;9 REVERSING DEVICE 59 OVER VOLTAGE RELAY&lt;br /&gt;10 UNIT SEQUENCE RELAY 60 VOLTAGE OR CURRENT BALANCE RELAY&lt;br /&gt;11 SPARE 61 SPARE&lt;br /&gt;12 OVER SPEED RELAY 62 TIME DELAY STOPPING OR OPENING DEVICE&lt;br /&gt;13 SYNCHRONISING SPEED DEVICE 63 LIQUID OR GAS OR VACCUM RELAY&lt;br /&gt;14 UNDER SPEED DEVICE 64 GROUND PROTECTION RELAY&lt;br /&gt;15 SPEED OR FREQUENCY MATCHING DEVICE 65 GOVERNOR&lt;br /&gt;16 SPARE 66 NOTCHING OR JOGGING RELAY&lt;br /&gt;17 SHUNTING OR DISCHARGE SWITCH 67 AC DIRECTIONAL OVER CURRENT RELAY&lt;br /&gt;18 ACCELERATING OR DE-ACCELERATING DEVICE 68 BLOCKING RELAY&lt;br /&gt;19 STARTING OR RUNNING TRANSITION DEVICE 69 PERMISSIVE CONTACT DEVICE&lt;br /&gt;20 ELECTRICALLY OPERATED VALVE 70 RHEOSTAT, ELECTRICALLY OPERATED&lt;br /&gt;21 DISTANCE PROTECTION RELAY 71 LIQUID OR GAS LEVEL RELAY&lt;br /&gt;22 EQUALIZER CIRCUIT BREAKER 72 DC CIRCUIT BREAKER&lt;br /&gt;23 TEMPERATURE CONTROL DEVICE 73 LOAD RESISTOR CONTACTOR&lt;br /&gt;24 SPARE 74 ALARM RELAY&lt;br /&gt;25 SYNCHRONISING DEVICE 75 POSITION MECHANISM&lt;br /&gt;26 APPARATUS THERMAL DEVICE 76 DC OVER CURRENT RELAY&lt;br /&gt;27 UNDER VOLTAGE RELAY 77 PULSE TRANSMITTER&lt;br /&gt;28 FLAME DETECTOR 78 PHASE ANGLE OR OUT OF STEP RELAY&lt;br /&gt;29 ISOLATING CONTACTOR 79 AC RECLOSING RELAY&lt;br /&gt;30 ANNUNCIATER RELAY 80 SUPPLY FAIL&lt;br /&gt;31 SEPARATE EXCITATION DEVICE 81 FREQUENCY RELAY&lt;br /&gt;32 DIRECTIONAL POWER RELAY 82 DC RECLOSING RELAY&lt;br /&gt;33 POSITION SWITCH 83 AUTOMATIC SELECTION&lt;br /&gt;34 MASTER SEQUENCE DEVICE 84 OPERATING MECHANISM&lt;br /&gt;35 SLIP RING SHORT CIRCUIT DEVICE 85 CARRIER OR PILOT WIRE RECEIVER RELAY&lt;br /&gt;36 POLARITY OR POLARIZING VOLTAGE DEVICE 86 LOCK OUT RELAY&lt;br /&gt;37 UNDER CURRENT OR UNDER POWER RELAY 87 DIFFERENTIAL PROTECTION RELAY&lt;br /&gt;38 BEARING PROTECTIVE DEVICE 88 AUXILIARY MOTOR OR MOTOR GENERATOR&lt;br /&gt;39 MECHANICAL CONDITION MONITOR 89 LINE SWITCH&lt;br /&gt;40 FIELD RELAY 90 REGULATING DEVICE&lt;br /&gt;41 FIELD CIRCUIT BREAKER 91 VOLTAGE DIRECTIONAL RELAY&lt;br /&gt;42 RUNNING CIRCUIT BREAKER 92 VOLTAGE &amp;amp; POWER DIRECTIONAL RELAY&lt;br /&gt;43 MANUAL TRANSFER OR SELECTOR DEVICE 93 FIELD CHANGING RELAY&lt;br /&gt;44 UNIT SEQUENCE STARTING RELAY 94 TRIPPING OR TRIP FREE RELAY&lt;br /&gt;45 ATMOSPHERIC CONDITION MONITOR 95 SUPERVISION RELAY&lt;br /&gt;46 CURRENT UNBALANCE RELAY 96 SPECIAL APPLICATION&lt;br /&gt;47 POLE DISCREPANCY 97 FUSE FAIL RELAY&lt;br /&gt;48 INCOMPLETE SEQUENCE RELAY 98 SPECIAL APPLICATION&lt;br /&gt;49 THERMAL OVER LOAD RELAY 99 OVER FLUXING RELAY&lt;br /&gt;50 INSTANTANEOUS OVER CURRENT RELAY 100 SPECIAL APPLICATION&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 269 -&lt;br /&gt;General Description of Relays&lt;br /&gt;NOMENCLATURE FOR ENGLISH ELECTRIC RELAY&lt;br /&gt;FIRST LETTER – OPERATING QUANTITY&lt;br /&gt;A PHASE ANGLE COMPARISON SECOND LETTER – MOVEMENT&lt;br /&gt;B BALANCED CURRENT A ATTRACTED ARMATURE&lt;br /&gt;C CURRENT B BUCHHOLZ&lt;br /&gt;D DIFFERENTIAL C INDUCTION CUP&lt;br /&gt;E DIRECTION D INDUCTION DISC&lt;br /&gt;F FREQUENCY G GALVANOMETER (MOVING COIL)&lt;br /&gt;I DIRECTIONAL CURRENT T TRANSISTOR&lt;br /&gt;K RATE OF RISE OF CURRENT&lt;br /&gt;N MANUAL&lt;br /&gt;O OIL PRESSURE&lt;br /&gt;P POLY PHASE VA&lt;br /&gt;R REACTIVE VA&lt;br /&gt;S SLIP FREQUENCY&lt;br /&gt;T TEMPERATURE&lt;br /&gt;V POTENTIAL&lt;br /&gt;W WATTS (POWER)&lt;br /&gt;Y ADMITTANCE&lt;br /&gt;Z IMPEDANCE&lt;br /&gt;THIRD LETTER – APPLICATION&lt;br /&gt;A AUXILIARY R RE CLOSING&lt;br /&gt;B TESTING S SYNCHRONISING&lt;br /&gt;C CARRIER (COUNTING) T TIMER OR TRANSFORMER&lt;br /&gt;D DIRECTIONAL U DEFINITE TIME&lt;br /&gt;E EARTH (GROUND) V VOLTAGE TIME&lt;br /&gt;F FLAG &amp;amp; ALARM INDICATOR W PILOT WIRE&lt;br /&gt;G GENERAL OR GENERATOR WA INTERPOSING&lt;br /&gt;H HARMONIC RESTRAINT WJ INTER TRIPPING&lt;br /&gt;I INTERLOCK OR INDUSTRIAL X SUPERVISORY&lt;br /&gt;J TRIPPING Y FLASH BACK (BACK FIRE)&lt;br /&gt;JE TRIPPING (ELECT. RESET) Z SPECIAL APPLICATION&lt;br /&gt;JH TRIPPING (HAND RESET) ZS ZERO SEQUENCE&lt;br /&gt;JS TRIPPING (SELF RESET)&lt;br /&gt;JC CONTROL&lt;br /&gt;K CHECK ALARM&lt;br /&gt;L LIMITING&lt;br /&gt;M SEMAPHORE OR MOTOR&lt;br /&gt;N NEGATIVE SEQUENCE&lt;br /&gt;O OUT OF STEP&lt;br /&gt;P POTENTIAL FAILURE&lt;br /&gt;Q ALARM&lt;br /&gt;FOURTH LETTER&lt;br /&gt;M – SPECIAL VARIATION&lt;br /&gt;Sl. No. E E Relay Application&lt;br /&gt;1 CTM Motor protection&lt;br /&gt;2 CTU Locked rotor. Thermal alarm&lt;br /&gt;3 CDG I.D.M.T. over current or earth fault of transformer&lt;br /&gt;4 CAG Instantaneous over current or earth faults.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 270 -&lt;br /&gt;5 VAGM Under voltage&lt;br /&gt;6 WDG Under /Over power for DG set&lt;br /&gt;7 FTG Under frequency&lt;br /&gt;8 VAPM Fuse failure&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 271 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is Knee point voltage?&lt;br /&gt;EMF applied to secondary of current transformer (CT) which, when increased by&lt;br /&gt;10% voltage causes the excitation current to increase by 50%.&lt;br /&gt;• What is I.D.M.T?&lt;br /&gt;Inverse time relay with definite minimum time is called IDMT.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Negative sequence reactance?&lt;br /&gt;Negative sequence can arise whenever there is any unbalance present in the system.&lt;br /&gt;Their effect is to setup a field rotating in opposite direction to the main field.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Zero sequence reactance?&lt;br /&gt;If a machine is operating with an earthed neutral, a system earth fault will give rise to&lt;br /&gt;zero sequence current in the machine.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of over current relay (Inverse); type- CDG&lt;br /&gt;It is a self powered inverse time over current and earth fault relay, used for selective&lt;br /&gt;phase and earth fault protection in time graded systems for A.C. machines,&lt;br /&gt;transformers, feeders etc. A non-directional heavily damped induction disc relay,&lt;br /&gt;which has an adjustable inverse time/current characteristic with a definite minimum&lt;br /&gt;time. The relay has a high torque movement combined with low burden and low&lt;br /&gt;overshoot. The relay disc is so shaped that as it rotates the driving torque increases&lt;br /&gt;and offsets the changing restraining torque of the control spring.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Directional inverse Over current &amp;amp; earth fault relay; type- CDD&lt;br /&gt;Directional phase or earth fault protection of ring-mains, parallel transformers,&lt;br /&gt;transformer feeders, parallel feeders etc., employing the time graded principle.; This&lt;br /&gt;relay comprises an inductive disc over current unit with wound shading coils and a&lt;br /&gt;directional high speed induction cup unit. The cup-unit contact is wired across the&lt;br /&gt;shading coils so that no torque is exerted on the disc of the over current unit until the&lt;br /&gt;cup unit contact closes. The inductive disc unit is thus directionally controlled and it&lt;br /&gt;operates only when the current flows in the tripping direction. The directional unit is&lt;br /&gt;a high speed, low inertia four pole induction cup movement designed to give a high,&lt;br /&gt;steady and non-vibrating torque. its current coil is connected in series with the&lt;br /&gt;operating coil of the induction disc unit. The directional unit is normally provided&lt;br /&gt;with voltage polarising coils.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Over current &amp;amp; earth fault relay; type- CAG&lt;br /&gt;This relays are designed for instantaneous phase or earth fault protection and&lt;br /&gt;instantaneous high set over current protection.; A standard hinged-armature unit&lt;br /&gt;forms the basic movement for this relay. It consists an operating coil mounted on a&lt;br /&gt;cylindrical iron core bolted to a frame at one end. This frame extends along the side&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 272 -&lt;br /&gt;of the coil, with its end forming a knife-edge on which the armature is pivotally&lt;br /&gt;mounted. The armature is &#39;L&#39; shaped and pivoted at its corner so that one arm can be&lt;br /&gt;attracted to the end of the core while the other arm to operate a set of contacts.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 273 -&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Local breaker back-up relay; type -CTIG&lt;br /&gt;To safe guard against the drastic consequences of failure to clear faults rapidly, many&lt;br /&gt;power supply authorities install 2 independent systems of protection for major&lt;br /&gt;transmission lines. There remains however the possibility of the circuit breaker itself&lt;br /&gt;failing to operate and this hazard is traditionally covered by remote breaker back-up.;&lt;br /&gt;CTIG relay is a 3 phase or 2 phase and earth fault instantaneous over current unit&lt;br /&gt;intended for use with a time delay to give back-up protection in the event of a circuit&lt;br /&gt;breaker failure. A particular feature of the CTIG relay is a fast reset, which enables&lt;br /&gt;the time delay to be set closer to the breaker trip-time.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Battery earth fault relay; type- CAEM-21&lt;br /&gt;The battery earth fault relay is used to detect earth faults and deterioration of wiring&lt;br /&gt;insulation in either pole of battery. The scheme consists of a centre tapped resistor, a&lt;br /&gt;measuring relay, plug setting bridge, auxiliary relay and rectifier bridge to provide&lt;br /&gt;unidirectional supply to the measuring relay coil. For different battery voltages&lt;br /&gt;different values of centre tapped resistors are used. Variable sensitivities are&lt;br /&gt;provided by means of the tapped coil whose taps are connected to the plug setting&lt;br /&gt;bridge. The centre tap of resistor is brought to one terminals of the relay and this&lt;br /&gt;terminal is either directly earthed or earthed through a centre zero milli&lt;br /&gt;ammeter. Under healthy condition no current flows through the measuring relay coil&lt;br /&gt;and in any pole of the battery or wiring insulation failure, current flows through the&lt;br /&gt;measuring relay coil and the relay operates.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Rotor earth fault relay (type- CAEM-33)&lt;br /&gt;When a single E/F is detected in the DC field circuit of a machine, the machine has&lt;br /&gt;to be taken out of service at the first opportunity. This is because, if allowed to run&lt;br /&gt;with an E/F on the rotor, a subsequent second E/F can cause severe damage to the&lt;br /&gt;machine. However, a relay like CAEM-33 which can detect such a second E/F and&lt;br /&gt;trip out the machine can make it possible to run the machine even with a single E/F,&lt;br /&gt;without any such risks, thus helping to preserve the generation capacity. The start of&lt;br /&gt;the second rotor earth fault detection scheme is a very sensitivity transductor&lt;br /&gt;element. The AC winding of the transductor is connected in series with a rectified&lt;br /&gt;AC voltage relay. The Dc winding of the transductor on the other hand is connected&lt;br /&gt;in series with the rotor E/F circuit. Under normal conditions- i.e. with no DC&lt;br /&gt;flowing, the AC wining of the transductor presents a high impedance, and the AC&lt;br /&gt;voltage applied is mostly dropped across this winding. Hence the relay remains deenergised.&lt;br /&gt;When a second rotor E/F occurs, a DC current flows through the&lt;br /&gt;transductor dc winding which causes the impedance of the AC winding to reduce&lt;br /&gt;considerably by driving the transductor core into saturation. Hence, the applied&lt;br /&gt;voltage is fully available across the relay and it operates.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 274 -&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Sensitive earth fault relay (type - CTUM-15 &amp;amp; CTIGM-15&lt;br /&gt;It may not be always possible to detect high resistance faults by convectional earth&lt;br /&gt;fault relaying. In such cases a very sensitive current relay will be required for this&lt;br /&gt;purpose. It can be connected residually since it has an adjustable definite time delay&lt;br /&gt;provided to take care of transient spills in the residual circuit due to CT mismatch.&lt;br /&gt;Also, its low burden enables it to be used with existing CT&#39;s/ Relays without&lt;br /&gt;affecting the performance.; The incoming current is stepped down by an internal&lt;br /&gt;current transformer and converted to a voltage by a variable resistor network. The&lt;br /&gt;signal is compared with an internal reference. When this reference level is exceeded,&lt;br /&gt;a time delay is initiated, after the time delay has elapsed, a relay operates.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Negative phase sequence current relay; Type- CTN/CTNM&lt;br /&gt;Negative phase sequence current in the stator of a generator, caused due to&lt;br /&gt;unbalanced loads or faults, it induces double frequency eddy current in the rotor.&lt;br /&gt;These currents, if allowed to persist, can cause serious overheating and the purpose&lt;br /&gt;of this relay is to disconnect the machine before such excess temperature is reached.&lt;br /&gt;The inputs from the current transformers, which are connected in each phase of the&lt;br /&gt;generator supply, are fed to a negative sequence filter which gives an AC output&lt;br /&gt;voltage proportional to the negative sequence current. This voltage is rectified and&lt;br /&gt;smoothed and fed into the squaring circuit of the main measuring element, the&lt;br /&gt;definite time delay circuit and the alarm element. The output from the squaring&lt;br /&gt;circuit is proportional to the square of the input voltage and is applied directly to the&lt;br /&gt;main timing circuit to give the required relationship between I2&lt;br /&gt;2t and the relay&lt;br /&gt;operates time t.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of definite time Over current &amp;amp; earth fault relay: Type-CTU&lt;br /&gt;This relay can be used for definite time over current protection against phase and&lt;br /&gt;Earth faults on medium and low voltage distribution systems. The definite time relay&lt;br /&gt;offers a considerable advantage over inverse time relays in instances where there ia a&lt;br /&gt;wide variation in line impedance. Another application is in the field of stalling&lt;br /&gt;protection of motors. When the thermal overload relay does not provide protection&lt;br /&gt;against stalling, separate definite time O/C relay type CTU can be used to provide&lt;br /&gt;the same. This relay comes in following nomenclature: CTU-12/22/32/52/62/15.&lt;br /&gt;CTU relay combines the advantage of complete static measurements with&lt;br /&gt;characteristic of the robust, well proved attracted armature unit. These relays&lt;br /&gt;measure current and time accurately, imposes low burden on CT&#39;s. Each phase&lt;br /&gt;comprises a static overload detector and timer, which is accurate over a 10:1 time&lt;br /&gt;setting range. When the positive peak of the input signal exceeds the reference level,&lt;br /&gt;the time delay circuit starts and after a preset time, drives the output relay.&lt;br /&gt;Instantaneous high set unit when fitted uses alternate half cycle for measurement and&lt;br /&gt;through a separate level detector drives a separate output relay.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 275 -&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Motor protection relay: Type- CTMM/CTMFM&lt;br /&gt;This relay contains all the protection factors to protect the motor, from Thermal&lt;br /&gt;overload (Ith), Instantaneous over current (I1), Instantaneous or time delayed&lt;br /&gt;unbalance element, Earth fault Element (I0) &amp;amp; Stalling protection (I1(t))&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 276 -&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Overfluxing Relay: Type-GTTM&lt;br /&gt;Transformers need protection against the risk of damage, which may be caused when&lt;br /&gt;the transformers are operated at flux density levels significantly greater than the&lt;br /&gt;design values. The overfluxing withstand time is generally found to be varying&lt;br /&gt;inversely with the working flux density in the core, having higher withstand times&lt;br /&gt;during extreme overfluxing conditions.&lt;br /&gt;The overfluxing condition can occur during system over voltage or under frequency&lt;br /&gt;conditions.&lt;br /&gt;The basic operating principle is to produce an ac voltage, which depends upon the&lt;br /&gt;ratio between AC input voltage and the frequency. The AC input voltage is fed to a&lt;br /&gt;step-down transformer, which also provides isolation and the stepped down voltage&lt;br /&gt;is fed to a V/F ratio detector circuit. This circuit is a simple operational amplifier&lt;br /&gt;integrator with the provision for V/F pickup adjustment. The AC voltage is rectified&lt;br /&gt;by true RMS. to dc converter. This circuit gives a frequency output and this&lt;br /&gt;frequency increases rapidly with the increase in voltage. The frequency output is&lt;br /&gt;given to a curve shaping circuit, which involves counter and comparators. The&lt;br /&gt;counter counts the frequency output and the number of counts required for final trip&lt;br /&gt;condition is changed by the comparator circuits to get the required timing&lt;br /&gt;characteristic.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Biased Differential Relay: Type-MBCH&lt;br /&gt;This relay is suitable for protection of two or three winding power transformers, auto&lt;br /&gt;transformers or generators transformer units.&lt;br /&gt;The differential transformer protection measuring circuit is based on the well-known&lt;br /&gt;Merz-price circulating principle.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Digital frequency relay: Type-MFVUM&lt;br /&gt;This relay is used to monitor the frequency of an electrical system. The relay are&lt;br /&gt;suitable for any application in industrial plants and to generators where definite time&lt;br /&gt;under or over frequency protection is required.&lt;br /&gt;The operating principle of the relay is the comparison of the time interval of the&lt;br /&gt;incoming frequency with that of a preset time derived from an accurate oscillator&lt;br /&gt;within the relay. The incoming frequency signal is connected to an INPUT&lt;br /&gt;CIRCUIT, which then drives an IMPULSE GENERATOR to produce a pulse at the&lt;br /&gt;beginning of each period of the input voltage. The preset time interval is obtained&lt;br /&gt;from an OSCILLATOR and COUNTER and adjustment is achieved using&lt;br /&gt;SELECTOR switches, which drive a DECODER circuit. A COMPARATOR&lt;br /&gt;compares the two-time interval and this triggers an adjustable TIMER which then&lt;br /&gt;operates the output relay and latched light emitting diode (LED) glows.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Stator Earthfault Relay: Type-PVMM&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 277 -&lt;br /&gt;A 100% stator earthfault protection is designed to detect earthfault occurring in the&lt;br /&gt;regions of machine winding close to the neutral end. This relay is a composite&lt;br /&gt;modular relay that gives 100% stator earthfault protection for machines, whose&lt;br /&gt;neutral are not directly earthed. It works on the principle involving monitoring of the&lt;br /&gt;neutral side and line-side components of the third harmonic voltages produced by&lt;br /&gt;AC generators in service.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 278 -&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Voltage regulating relay and line drop compensator: Type-VTJCM &amp;amp; CIJC.&lt;br /&gt;This relay is used with on load transformer tap changers and induction regulators to&lt;br /&gt;provide close and accurate automatic voltage regulation on power systems of any&lt;br /&gt;voltage.&lt;br /&gt;When the regulated voltage moves outside a dead band, set by the sensitivity control,&lt;br /&gt;the volts high or volts low circuits are initiated and after a time delay, determined by&lt;br /&gt;the response characteristic, the appropriate tap changer control auxiliary relay closes&lt;br /&gt;its contact to initiate a tap change.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Directional power relay: Type-MWTU.&lt;br /&gt;This relay setting ranges from 0.25% to 18.56% of rated power. This makes the relay&lt;br /&gt;suitable for sensitive reverse power applications. For example with turbo-generator,&lt;br /&gt;where the detection of 1% or 2% reverse power is necessary to prevent the&lt;br /&gt;synchronous machine from motoring in the event of the power from the prime mover&lt;br /&gt;becoming too low. It is also suitable for low forward power interlock and under&lt;br /&gt;power protection.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Check synchronising relay: Type-SKD/SKE.&lt;br /&gt;This relay is used to prevent interconnection of badly synchronised supplies. Type&lt;br /&gt;SKD relay are used for auto reclosing sequence, type SKE relay are used to&lt;br /&gt;safeguard manual synchronising of generators. Phase measurement is achieved by&lt;br /&gt;algebraically subtracting the 2 supply voltage waveforms and comparing the&lt;br /&gt;resultant modulated beat waveform envelope with a Dc reference voltage. The DC&lt;br /&gt;reference is proportional to the sum of the peaks of the 2 supply voltages to provide&lt;br /&gt;phase measurement independent of supply voltage variation.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Static distance protection: Type-SHPM.&lt;br /&gt;This relay (QUADRAMHO) is a static distance protection relay specially designed&lt;br /&gt;for comprehensive high-speed protection of HV &amp;amp; EHV distribution/transmission&lt;br /&gt;lines. 3 zones of protection are included, each employing separate measuring&lt;br /&gt;elements, one element each for 3 phase-to-phase and 3 phase-to-earth faults. Thus a&lt;br /&gt;total; of 18 elements are provided thereby increasing the reliability of the protection.&lt;br /&gt;Poly phase measuring elements are not used in QUADRAMHO as in some of the&lt;br /&gt;contemporary schemes. The relay is suitable for both three poles &amp;amp; single-and-threepole&lt;br /&gt;tripping of the circuit breaker.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of Static offset MHO relay: Type- YTGM.&lt;br /&gt;This relay is a static single phase, single step, and distance protection with MHO&lt;br /&gt;offset MHO characteristic. With suitable current/voltage input selection, the relay&lt;br /&gt;can be made to have the required characteristic in the R-X plane for various&lt;br /&gt;applications such as Generator Field failure protection, Generator backup impedance&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 279 -&lt;br /&gt;protection and as offset MHO relay for use in conjunction with generator pole&lt;br /&gt;slipping protection.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 280 -&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of sensitive power relay: Type-WCD.&lt;br /&gt;This power relay is a sensitive Poly phase induction cup unit, providing under power,&lt;br /&gt;reverse power and over power protection. This relay detects a reversal of current&lt;br /&gt;flow, caused by insufficient driving power from the prime mover, preventing the&lt;br /&gt;generator operating as a synchronous motor. The electrical quantities energize&lt;br /&gt;windings on an eight pole laminated stator. The moving contact is operated by a cup&lt;br /&gt;shaped Aluminium rotor, which turns on jewelled bearings in an air gap between the&lt;br /&gt;stator and a fixed center core. Only a small arc of rotation is needed to cause contact&lt;br /&gt;closer. Low rotor inertia and very high driving torque ensures a high speed&lt;br /&gt;operations.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of pole slipping relay: Type-ZTO.&lt;br /&gt;This pole slipping relay has been designed to protect synchronous Generators against&lt;br /&gt;the possibility of the machine running in the unstable region of the power angle&lt;br /&gt;curve which would result in power oscillations and pole slip. The relay consists&lt;br /&gt;basically of one directional relay and one blinder relay operating in conjunction with&lt;br /&gt;a 40-80 milli seconds static timer. Intended primarily for installation between the&lt;br /&gt;generator and associated transformer (preferably on the generator terminals)&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of fuse failure relay: Type - VAPM&lt;br /&gt;This relay detects a failure or inadvertent removal of voltage transformer secondary&lt;br /&gt;fuses and prevention of incorrect tripping of circuit breakers. This relay consists of a&lt;br /&gt;rectified AC voltage operated hinged armature unit. Three coils for the three phases&lt;br /&gt;are wound over a single core producing in effect a common relay for the three&lt;br /&gt;phases. Each coil is connected across one of the voltage transformer secondary fuses&lt;br /&gt;and under healthy conditions, this coil is short circuited by the fuse and cannot be&lt;br /&gt;energized. When one or more fuses or are removed the appropriate coil(s) is&lt;br /&gt;energized under relay operates immediately to open the trip circuit.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 281 -&lt;br /&gt;GENERATOR PROTECTION&lt;br /&gt;Sl Des Description CT ratio Type Setting Remarks&lt;br /&gt;1 87G Generator Differential&lt;br /&gt;Protection&lt;br /&gt;10000/5 CAG-34 P/S = 10% or 0.5 A SR = 143 Ohm&lt;br /&gt;2 87GI Generator Inter Turn fault 5000/5 CAG-34 P/S = 10% or 0.5 A SR = 86.72&lt;br /&gt;Ohm&lt;br /&gt;3 32A Low Forward Power&lt;br /&gt;Protection&lt;br /&gt;10000/5 WCD-13 0.5% Fixed&lt;br /&gt;2/32A Timer VTT-11 2.5 Sec&lt;br /&gt;4 32B Low Forward Power Protection 10000/5 WCD-13 0.5% Fixed&lt;br /&gt;2/32B Timer VTT-11 2.5 ec&lt;br /&gt;5 32C Under Power Over speed limit 10000/5 WCD-12 30% Fixed&lt;br /&gt;27 A,B Under Voltage Relay VAGM-22 73.2 V&lt;br /&gt;6 37 Reverse Power Protection 10000/5 WCD-11 0.5% Fixed&lt;br /&gt;2A/37 Timer VTT-11 10 Sec&lt;br /&gt;2B/37 Timer VTT-11 5 Sec&lt;br /&gt;7 21G1 Generator Back-up&lt;br /&gt;Impdence Stage-1&lt;br /&gt;10000/5 YTGM-15 K1=7.0, K2=1.0, K3=2.0,&lt;br /&gt;K4=1.0, K5=1.0, K10= 0&lt;br /&gt;Zf=14.0 Ohm, Zr= NA&lt;br /&gt;2/21G Timer VTT-11 1.5 Sec&lt;br /&gt;8 21G2 Generator Back-up Impdence&lt;br /&gt;Stage-2&lt;br /&gt;10000/5 YTGM-15 K1=1.65, K2=1.0, K3=2.0,&lt;br /&gt;K4=1.0, K5=5, K10= -1&lt;br /&gt;Zf=3.3 Ohm, Zr=10 Ohm&lt;br /&gt;2/21G2 Timer VTT-11 2.0 Sec&lt;br /&gt;9 40G Generator field failure 10000/5 YTGM-15 K1=6.175, K2=1.0, K3=4.0,&lt;br /&gt;K4=1.0, K5=1.06, K10=+1&lt;br /&gt;Zf=24.7.0 Ohm, Zr= 4.24&lt;br /&gt;2A/40G Timer (TDDO) VTT-11 2.5 Sec&lt;br /&gt;2B/40G Timer VTT-11 2.0 Sec&lt;br /&gt;27/40G Under Voltage Relay VAGM-22 73.2 V&lt;br /&gt;10 59G Over voltage Protection VTU - 21 Setting=120% + 2.0 Sec&lt;br /&gt;11 78GY YTGM With pole slipping relay YTGM-15 K1=4.45, K2=1.0, K3=1.0,&lt;br /&gt;10000/5 K4=1.0, K5=5, K10= -1&lt;br /&gt;Zf=4.45 Ohm, Zr=5.0 Ohm&lt;br /&gt;12 78G Pole Slipping Protection ZTO K1=0.98, K2=0.67, K3=4.0&lt;br /&gt;10000/5 Q1=Q2=75 degree,&lt;br /&gt;Timmer =54mSec&lt;br /&gt;Over current Starter CAG-19 Current Setting=5.5A&lt;br /&gt;13 64A 100% Stator E/F Protection PVMM-163 Vs=5.0 V, N=3&lt;br /&gt;Neutral Displacement Module&lt;br /&gt;Third harmonic Module VRL=70% Time=1.0 Sec&lt;br /&gt;Third harmonic comporator unit This is to be set during&lt;br /&gt;commissioning by Alstom engineer&lt;br /&gt;14 64B 95% E/F Protection VDG-14 PSM=5.4 V, TMS=0.3&lt;br /&gt;15 64C Stator E/F during Starting 300/1 CTIGM-15 Setting = 0.1 A&lt;br /&gt;16 46G Gen. Negative phase sequence 10000/5 CTNM-31 I2S=5%, K1=6.7, K3= 1&lt;br /&gt;Alarm=70%&lt;br /&gt;2/46G Timer VTT-11 120.0 Sec&lt;br /&gt;17 50 ABC Instantenuous Over current 10000/5 CAG-39 P/S = 5 A&lt;br /&gt;18 49 G Generator Over load protn. 10000/5 CTMM - 104 Ith=4.4A, Thermal Ref. Curve=2a&lt;br /&gt;19 50 S&lt;br /&gt;ABC&lt;br /&gt;Stator O/C Protn during starting 10000/5 CTIGM-15 Setting = 0.05 A&lt;br /&gt;20 64 F1 First rotor E/F protection VAEM - 21 Setting = 1.1 mA fixed&lt;br /&gt;21 2/64F1 Timer VTT-11 Setting = 2.0 Sec&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 282 -&lt;br /&gt;22 64F2 Second rotor E/F Protection CAEM-33 Setting = 1.0 mA fixed&lt;br /&gt;23 81 - 1 81-1RL1 Under Frequency Stage - 1 MFVUM Setting = 47.96 Hz + 1.1 Sec Window annun&lt;br /&gt;81-1RL2 Under Frequency Stage - 2 Setting = U#1=47.6 Hz&lt;br /&gt;+2Sec,U#2=47.7Hz+3 Sec&lt;br /&gt;SUT breaker trip&lt;br /&gt;Setting = U#1=47.6 Hz +4&lt;br /&gt;Sec,U#2=47.7Hz+ 4sec Sec&lt;br /&gt;86C Operation&lt;br /&gt;24 81 - 2 81-2RL1 Under Frequency Stage - 3 MFVUM Setting = 47.5Hz +0.1Sec SUT breaker trip&lt;br /&gt;Setting = 47.5Hz +0.6 Sec 86C Operation&lt;br /&gt;25 81 - 3 81-3RL1 Over Frequency Stage - 1 MFVUM Setting = 51.0 Hz + 1.1 Sec Window annun&lt;br /&gt;81-3RL2 Over Frequency Stage - 2 Setting = U#1=51.5 Hz + 15&lt;br /&gt;Sec,U#2=51.65 Hz + 15 Sec&lt;br /&gt;86BG Operation&lt;br /&gt;26 81 – 4 Rate of rise of frequency (&lt;br /&gt;df/dt)&lt;br /&gt;MICOM Setting = 50.01+2.0Hz/Sec + 0.2Sec SUT breaker trip&lt;br /&gt;Setting = 50.01+2.0Hz/Sec + 0.5Sec 86C Operation&lt;br /&gt;Over Frequency ( f+t) Setting = 51.5 Hz + 0.2 Sec SUT breaker trip&lt;br /&gt;Setting = 51.5 Hz + 0.5 Sec 86C Operation&lt;br /&gt;GENERATOR TRANSFORMER PROTECTION&lt;br /&gt;Sl Designation Description Type Setting&lt;br /&gt;1 87GT Over all Differential&lt;br /&gt;Protection&lt;br /&gt;MBCH-13 Settings = 20%&lt;br /&gt;2 50/51GT Back-up O/C HV side CDG-63 PSM=1.0, TMS=0.4, Inst = 800%&lt;br /&gt;3 50Z GT Breaker L.B.B. Protn. CTIG-39 Setting = 5%&lt;br /&gt;2/50Z Timer VTT-11 Setting = 250 mSec&lt;br /&gt;4 64GT G.T. H.V. REF CAG-14 Setting = 0.1 A, SR=185 Ohms&lt;br /&gt;5 51 NGT G.T. B/U E/F Protn. CDG-11 PSM=0.2, TMS=0.52&lt;br /&gt;2/51NGT Timer VTT-11 Setting = 1.0 Sec&lt;br /&gt;6 30 FG WTI Alarm WTI Set 90 degree C alarm&lt;br /&gt;7 30EG WTI Trip WTI Set 100 degree C trip&lt;br /&gt;8 30 HG OTI Alarm OTI Set 70 degree C Alarm&lt;br /&gt;9 30GG OTI Trip OTI Set 80 degree C Alarm&lt;br /&gt;10 99G1 GT Over flux Stage-1 GTTM-22 Setting K1=1.1, K2=1.3&lt;br /&gt;2/G1A Timer VTT-11 Setting = 10.0 Sec&lt;br /&gt;11 99G2 GT Over flux Stage-2 GTT-21 Setting V/F=1.15, 99G2A=1.0Sec&lt;br /&gt;99G2T=120 Sec&lt;br /&gt;2/G2A Timer VTT-11 Setting=10.0 Sec&lt;br /&gt;UNIT AUXILIARY TRANSFORMER PROTECTION&lt;br /&gt;Sl.&lt;br /&gt;No&lt;br /&gt;.&lt;br /&gt;Designation Description Relay Type Settings&lt;br /&gt;1 87 UAT UAT Differential Protection MBCH-13 Setting=20%&lt;br /&gt;2 64UAT A /&lt;br /&gt;64UAT B&lt;br /&gt;UAT REF Protection FAC-14 Setting=125 V&lt;br /&gt;3 50/51 UT UAT B/U O/C Protection CDG-63 PSM=1.0, TMS= 0.32, Inst= 600%&lt;br /&gt;4 51SN1/51SN2 B/U E/F UAT LV-A CDG-11 PSM=0.2, TMS= 0.44.&lt;br /&gt;6 WTI Set 88 degree C alarm&lt;br /&gt;7 WTI Trip WTI Set 93 degree C Trip&lt;br /&gt;8 OTI Alarm OTI Set 80 degree C Alarm&lt;br /&gt;9 OTI Trip OTI Set 90 degree C Trip&lt;br /&gt;10 AVR Automatic Voltage Regulator VTJCM-13 1. Regulated voltage=110 V&lt;br /&gt;2. Sensitivity: Dead band=+/- 2.5%&lt;br /&gt;3. Selected Characteristics &quot;c&quot;&lt;br /&gt;11 50 RYB OLTC O/C Protection CAG-39 95% I.e., 0.95A&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 283 -&lt;br /&gt;START-UP TRANSFORMER PROTECTION&lt;br /&gt;Sl.&lt;br /&gt;No.&lt;br /&gt;Designation Description Relay Type Settings&lt;br /&gt;1 87 SUT ABC Differential Protection MBCH-13 Setting = 20%&lt;br /&gt;2 64 HV REF Protn. HV Side FAC-14 Setting = 25V&lt;br /&gt;3 64LVA/LVB REF Protn. LV Sides FAC-14 Setting = 125 V&lt;br /&gt;4 67 ABC Directional O/C Protection CDD-41 PSM=0.75, TMS=0.4, Inst=600%&lt;br /&gt;5 67 N Directional E/F Protection CDD-41 PSM=0.2, TMS=0.4, Inst=200%&lt;br /&gt;6 99SUT Over fluxing Protection GTTM-22 Settings K1=1.1, K2=1.23&lt;br /&gt;7 51SNA/51SNB LV Side B/U E/F Protn. CDG-11 PSM=0.2, TMS=0.4.&lt;br /&gt;8 50Z Local Breaker B/U protn. CTIG-39 Setting=0.2A&lt;br /&gt;2/50Z Timer VTT-11 Setting = 0.25 Sec&lt;br /&gt;9 WTI Winging Temperature 95 degree C Alarm&lt;br /&gt;105 degree C Trip&lt;br /&gt;10 OTI Oil Temperature 85 degree C Alarm&lt;br /&gt;95 degree C Trip&lt;br /&gt;11 AVR Automatic Voltage&lt;br /&gt;Regulator&lt;br /&gt;EMCO EE-&lt;br /&gt;301-M&lt;br /&gt;1. Regulated Voltage = 110 V&lt;br /&gt;2. Nominal Value = 110 V&lt;br /&gt;3. L Setting = 2.75V (2.5%)&lt;br /&gt;4. R Setting = 2.75 V (2.5%)&lt;br /&gt;5. Time delay setting = 20 Sec&lt;br /&gt;12 81-5 SUT Over Frequency Protn. MFVUM-22 52.0 Hz + 20.0 Sec&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 284 -&lt;br /&gt;CT’s, PT’s and PROTECTION&lt;br /&gt;• What is the inrush current peak of the transformer?&lt;br /&gt;6 to 8 time that of full load current.&lt;br /&gt;• Why REF is now is used for HV side also in GT/SUT?&lt;br /&gt;The E/F setting of differential is poor.&lt;br /&gt;• Why IDMT over current relay is always used as backup?&lt;br /&gt;Because setting has to be 200% to emergency loading and TMS be large to grade&lt;br /&gt;with feeder. Therefore very slow for internal faults/terminal faults/uncleared LV&lt;br /&gt;faults.&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of standby E/F protection in SUT/UT?&lt;br /&gt;Back up for LV winding, LV neutral CT- CDG 12 – resistance earthing – relay set&lt;br /&gt;high time delay to discriminate with LV feeder and trip transformer if sustained E/F,&lt;br /&gt;also protects neutral earthing resistor.&lt;br /&gt;• Why do we use O/C &amp;amp; E/F protection on both sides of transformer?&lt;br /&gt;Power in feed exists on both ends.&lt;br /&gt;• Why in DG E/F protection, we do not open class IV CB’s or supply CB’s?&lt;br /&gt;Delta of aux. Transformer prevents E/F currents from grid into DG neutral.&lt;br /&gt;• Why 100% winding protection is felt essential for main generator stator E/F&lt;br /&gt;protection? (Used in NAPS onwards?)&lt;br /&gt;At MAPS 4% of winding is not protected. Earlier felt that the Electro magnetic stress&lt;br /&gt;due high external fault currents near 4% of neutral may not be high to cause E/F&lt;br /&gt;here. But now felt that the mechanical stress can leads to E/F.&lt;br /&gt;• How 100% winding protection is given there?&lt;br /&gt;a) Inject sub harmonic AC current into generator neutral. Monitor its amplitude. E/F&lt;br /&gt;impedance reduces so current drawn increases and trips (Not used).&lt;br /&gt;b) 3rd harmonic voltage monitored on neutral, fault near neutral upto 25% winding.&lt;br /&gt;3rd harmonic voltage reduces to zero. Above this 3rd harmonic voltage increases,&lt;br /&gt;so combined both 3rd harmonic and zero sequence relays for 100% covering, no&lt;br /&gt;blind zone.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the basic purpose of class-B protection?&lt;br /&gt;Class-B avoids load rejection. For modern machines, the inertia is less and easily&lt;br /&gt;gets damaged on overload. Therefore trip only for internal faults.&lt;br /&gt;Low forward interlock prevents the risk of run away if a CIES valve fails to close.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 285 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 286 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the effects of GT over fluxing?&lt;br /&gt;a. Eddy current circulation.&lt;br /&gt;b. Magnetising current increases&lt;br /&gt;c. Winding temp increases&lt;br /&gt;d. Transformer noise/vibration increases.&lt;br /&gt;e. Over heating of non laminated metal parts (affected by stray fluxes)&lt;br /&gt;• Why stabilising resistor in REF or residual E/F scheme?&lt;br /&gt;Required against CT saturation under heavy through fault currents.&lt;br /&gt;• Why in transformer the LV CB also be tripped along with HV CB for a primary side&lt;br /&gt;fault?&lt;br /&gt;Auxiliary transformer 415v delta star transformer, if HV CB alone tripped then back&lt;br /&gt;feeding from LV side (say DG runs parallel with transformer)—arcing voltage at the&lt;br /&gt;fault on primary—fault fed for more time – more damage.&lt;br /&gt;• Why high impedance circulating current differential?&lt;br /&gt;Under through faults, CT’s of different phases saturates differently. Net spill current&lt;br /&gt;will operate low impedance CAG relay, so high impedance scheme with CAG&lt;br /&gt;relay and stabilising resistor used.&lt;br /&gt;• How to reduce the CT error?&lt;br /&gt;Error reduces if load increases.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the advantage of housing CT’s with in bushings?&lt;br /&gt;Bushing acts as a primary insulator for the CT.&lt;br /&gt;• Why the earthing transformer primary voltage is 16.5 kV rated in main generator&lt;br /&gt;even though actual voltage during the E/F is root 3 times less?&lt;br /&gt;The transformer should not saturate during E/F otherwise it will cause&lt;br /&gt;ferroresonance with the GT winding capacitance. Dangerous O/V and neutral&lt;br /&gt;shifting will occur. During loss of load or field forcing conditions, the transformer&lt;br /&gt;voltage increases to cause saturation. Saturation can also occur due to point on wave&lt;br /&gt;of application causing flux doubling.&lt;br /&gt;• Where are the following relays used?&lt;br /&gt;a) Very inverse b) extremely inverse relays c) definite time O/C Relay d)&lt;br /&gt;instantaneous O/C Relay.&lt;br /&gt;a) Very Inverse – Used where inverse protection reduces substantially as distance from&lt;br /&gt;source increases, operating time doubles for a fault current reduction from 7 in to 4 in,&lt;br /&gt;used where the short ckt current is independent of generating conditions.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 287 -&lt;br /&gt;b) Extremely inverse – Used for feeders subjected to peak making currents. Grade with&lt;br /&gt;HRC fuses, e.g. Refrigerator, pumps.&lt;br /&gt;c) Definite time O/C Relay – Where neutral is resistance earthed- fixed ground current.&lt;br /&gt;d) Instantaneous O/C Relay – Used along with inverse O/C relay – to get higher grading&lt;br /&gt;margin. Disadvantage – Under minimum generation it may not operate.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 288 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why delta – delta CT’s are used for star – star transformer differential protection?&lt;br /&gt;Say primary neutral is not solidly earthed. Then for any earthfault on secondary&lt;br /&gt;terminal, the primary current distribution is so for external fault, the differential is&lt;br /&gt;likely to operate if sequence current from flowing into relay. The 2:1:1 distribution is&lt;br /&gt;possibly only for core type or delta tertiary.&lt;br /&gt;• Show the CT characteristics.&lt;br /&gt;Knee point region (Protection characteristics)&lt;br /&gt;Saturation region&lt;br /&gt;Peak flux density&lt;br /&gt;Linear region&lt;br /&gt;Ankle point&lt;br /&gt;(Measuring CT characteristics)&lt;br /&gt;RMS amp turns&lt;br /&gt;• What is knee point?&lt;br /&gt;Knee point is the region, where 10% increase in flux causes 50% increase in exciting&lt;br /&gt;ampere-turns.&lt;br /&gt;• When will you say that the CT is saturated?&lt;br /&gt;When checking the CT with the secondary injection method a 10% increases in the&lt;br /&gt;voltage causes a 50% increase in the current the CT is said to be saturated.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the problem anticipated due to CT saturation?&lt;br /&gt;The CT will not be able to drive the current through the circuit causing nonoperation&lt;br /&gt;of relays. In some other case when the currents in the two phases are&lt;br /&gt;compared for relay operation the relay may operate due to unbalance.&lt;br /&gt;• How can you de-saturate the CT?&lt;br /&gt;Pass ac current through the primary and vary the current from zero to maximum with&lt;br /&gt;secondary in shorted condition.&lt;br /&gt;Pass dc current in the secondary and vary it from zero to maximum.&lt;br /&gt;• Why CT should not be open circuited?&lt;br /&gt;Very high voltage will be induced in secondary due to less back emf resulting in the&lt;br /&gt;failure of the insulation.&lt;br /&gt;• What precaution should be taken while removing a current operated relay when the&lt;br /&gt;equipment is in service?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 289 -&lt;br /&gt;Ensure that the CT is not getting opened by shorting the appropriate terminals.&lt;br /&gt;(Eventhough the terminals are automatically shorted once relay is removed the above&lt;br /&gt;point may carried out to ensure the same)&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 290 -&lt;br /&gt;• What do 10p15 mean?&lt;br /&gt;When the current passed through the CT is 15 times the rated current then the&lt;br /&gt;secondary current will have a composite error of 10%&lt;br /&gt;• Where core balance CT’s are used?&lt;br /&gt;In earth fault protection used. It senses the zero sequence current.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the specifications of CT?&lt;br /&gt;Protection CT - Error. Alf. KpV.&lt;br /&gt;Metering CT - Error. Burden.&lt;br /&gt;Differential CT - Class PS.&lt;br /&gt;Core balance or E/F CT - 5-p type.&lt;br /&gt;Primary current -&lt;br /&gt;Rating of CT - 1. 15 ( full load current )&lt;br /&gt;Short time rating - 1 sec.&lt;br /&gt;• Why differential protection for PHT motors?&lt;br /&gt;For more than 2500 kW motors it is required to provide differential protection. It is&lt;br /&gt;biased Relay against internal phase fault or earth fault very fast. Insensitive to&lt;br /&gt;starting current and stalling current.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the errors of the following CT’ s 5p. 10p. 15p. At rated current?&lt;br /&gt;5p - 1 % Ratio error ± 60 min phase error&lt;br /&gt;10p - 3 % Ratio error ± 60 min phase error&lt;br /&gt;15p - 5 % Ratio error ± 60 min phase error&lt;br /&gt;• What is the operating point in the Magnetising characteristic of protection CT &amp;amp;&lt;br /&gt;measuring CT?&lt;br /&gt;Protection CT – Operation at ankle point only.&lt;br /&gt;Measuring CT – Operation from ankle to knee point&lt;br /&gt;• What is over voltage interturn test for CT?&lt;br /&gt;With secondary open, pass rated current in primary for 1 min. Then check secondary&lt;br /&gt;for insulation.&lt;br /&gt;• A CT has 2 – secondary windings. If we use only one secondary winding can we&lt;br /&gt;keep the unused secondary winding short circuited?&lt;br /&gt;No. If it is short-circuited then the ratio will not get correctly. The turns of primary&lt;br /&gt;winding will be shared between 2 secondary windings. So the unused secondary&lt;br /&gt;winding should kept open.&lt;br /&gt;• But is it advisable to keep the secondary of CT in open conditions? Will not induce&lt;br /&gt;very high voltage?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 291 -&lt;br /&gt;If the CT has only one secondary winding, we should keep it always short cktd for&lt;br /&gt;safety, but if the CT has multiple secondary, then if one secondary voltage is kept&lt;br /&gt;limited by suitable loading, then the other secondary voltage is eventually limited&lt;br /&gt;proportionately.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 292 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why PT fuse fails protection?&lt;br /&gt;Mho relays will mal-operate if PT voltage is lost to the relay, so tripping blocked by&lt;br /&gt;sensing PT fuse failure.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the 2 stage stalling protection for PHT motor?&lt;br /&gt;Because locked rotors withstand time of motor is less than starting time of motor&lt;br /&gt;under reduced voltage conditions.&lt;br /&gt;Stage 1 = 350% 6 sec for starting at rated voltage&lt;br /&gt;(Because starting time = 6 sec + hot stall time = 7 sec)&lt;br /&gt;Stage 2 = 175% 15 sec to permit 14 seconds starting time under reduced voltage&lt;br /&gt;condition&lt;br /&gt;(Since starting current is less, stage 1 will not operate)&lt;br /&gt;• Purpose of start up protection? Is it always in service?&lt;br /&gt;Trips the generator. If generator is excited with internal fault the over current 50s trip&lt;br /&gt;the generator to prevent major damage. The earth fault relay 64c also. The relays are&lt;br /&gt;polarised dc armature type, sensitive to all frequencies, since the frequency need not&lt;br /&gt;to be 50 Hz initially during start up. Start up protection is cutout as soon as generator&lt;br /&gt;CB is closed.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the standard CT polarity?&lt;br /&gt;Primary current enters at P1 and secondary current leaves at S2.&lt;br /&gt;• Does over load relay give 100% guarantee against the single phasing?&lt;br /&gt;No. It depends on the motor load and the motor winding (star or delta).&lt;br /&gt;• What are the effects of single phasing?&lt;br /&gt;a. Current will increase √3 times.&lt;br /&gt;b. More heat in stator and rotor parts.&lt;br /&gt;c. Insulation failure and short circuit &amp;amp; Ground fault may occur.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of CT &amp;amp; PT?&lt;br /&gt;For transformation of current, voltage to a lower level for the purpose of&lt;br /&gt;Measurement, Protection and Control.&lt;br /&gt;• Where CT secondary of 1A we are using?&lt;br /&gt;For long distance current transmission, to reduce the IR drop.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the nomenclature of English electric relay?&lt;br /&gt;a) First letter-operating quantity&lt;br /&gt;b) Second letter-movement&lt;br /&gt;c) Third letter-application&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 293 -&lt;br /&gt;d) Fourth letter-special variation.&lt;br /&gt;• Define knee point voltage.&lt;br /&gt;The voltage applied to secondary of CT keeping the primary open at which&lt;br /&gt;10% increase in voltage causes 50% increase in excitation current.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 294 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is differential protection?&lt;br /&gt;It is the current balance type protection, in which vector difference between current&lt;br /&gt;entering the winding is used for relay operation.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the checks on CT &amp;amp; PT?&lt;br /&gt;a) Polarity checks&lt;br /&gt;b) Insulation checks&lt;br /&gt;c) Ratio checks&lt;br /&gt;d) Knee point voltage (only for PS class CT)- magnetising characteristic test.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Local Breaker Back up protection?&lt;br /&gt;In case of local breaker fails to operate during fault due to mechanical failure this&lt;br /&gt;protection will protect the system from sever damage. It will trip all the other&lt;br /&gt;breakers in that bus after time delay.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 295 -&lt;br /&gt;TRANSFORMERS&lt;br /&gt;• Give transformer nameplate details of GT, SUT, UAT, SET, 415 V Aux transformer&lt;br /&gt;and Lighting transformer.&lt;br /&gt;GT SUT UAT SET 415V Aux trans. L Trans.&lt;br /&gt;USI 5210 5120 5220 4120 5242 5231&lt;br /&gt;Make Telk Telk BHEL BHEL EE Square&lt;br /&gt;Automation&lt;br /&gt;STD IS – 2026 IS– 2026&lt;br /&gt;Type WFOC Oil immersed Oil immersed DRY RESIN&lt;br /&gt;CAST DRY RESIN CAST DRY RESIN CAST&lt;br /&gt;Cooling OFWF ONAF / ONAN ONAF / ONAN AN AN AN&lt;br /&gt;VA 260/260 MVA 35/20/20/12 MVA&lt;br /&gt;24.5/14/14 MVA&lt;br /&gt;35/20/20 MVA&lt;br /&gt;24.5/14/14 MVA&lt;br /&gt;3150 kVA 1800/1200 kVA 250 kVA&lt;br /&gt;Volts 235/16.5 kV 220/6.9/6.9/11&lt;br /&gt;kV&lt;br /&gt;16.5/6.9/6.9&lt;br /&gt;Kv&lt;br /&gt;16500/575&lt;br /&gt;V 6600/435 V 415/415V&lt;br /&gt;Amps 639/9098 A 64/1172/440 A&lt;br /&gt;91/1675/629 A&lt;br /&gt;1266/858A&lt;br /&gt;1676/1172 A 157.5/2400 A 630/250,125A&lt;br /&gt;No of φ 3 3 3 3 3 3&lt;br /&gt;Frequency 50 Hz 50 Hz 50 Hz 50 Hz 50 Hz 50 Hz&lt;br /&gt;Impedance 13.13 (14) % 9.75% / 18.82% 10 ±10% HV&lt;br /&gt;22 ±10% LV&lt;br /&gt;Vector YNd11 Yn yno yno&lt;br /&gt;(d1)&lt;br /&gt;D yn1 yn1 Dyn Dyn11 Dyn11&lt;br /&gt;Oil 42000 Lt. 25260 Lt. 19750 Lt.&lt;br /&gt;Tap change Off load ON load HV ON load HV&lt;br /&gt;Tapchange% 10 steps of 2.5 % ϒ12% in 1.5% steps ϒ12% in 1.5% steps&lt;br /&gt;• What is the use of Tertiary winding?&lt;br /&gt;Star connected circuit, which has an isolated neutral there can be no zero sequence&lt;br /&gt;components. Since the zero sequence components are by definition in time phase&lt;br /&gt;with another their sum can not be zero at the junction point as per kirchoff’s law. It&lt;br /&gt;follows that there are limitations upon the phase loading of a bank of transformers&lt;br /&gt;connected in star – star unless the neutral points are connected to the source of power&lt;br /&gt;in such a manner that the zero sequence components of current have a return path or&lt;br /&gt;unless the transformer are provided with tertiary winding.&lt;br /&gt;• What is E/F current limit for SUT and UT?&lt;br /&gt;400a limited by 10 ohms resistor.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the coverage of differential protection for SUT?&lt;br /&gt;Covers from 230 kV bushing to 6.6 kV breaker end.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the advantages of dry type transformer?&lt;br /&gt;No fire hazard.&lt;br /&gt;It can be mounted indoor.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 296 -&lt;br /&gt;• During unit operation, can we parallel 2 SUT?&lt;br /&gt;No, due to switchgear limitation.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 297 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why 6.6 kV transformer is resistance grounded by 10 ohms and current limited to&lt;br /&gt;400 A?&lt;br /&gt;a) To reduce burning and melting in faulted switchgear or machine.&lt;br /&gt;b) To reduce mechanical stresses in equipment.&lt;br /&gt;c) To reduce the electrical hazards by stray ground fault currents in the ground&lt;br /&gt;return path.&lt;br /&gt;d) To reduce momentary line voltage dip due to ground fault.&lt;br /&gt;e) The current is limited to 400a, that is ¼ th of the load current to reduce the size of&lt;br /&gt;the screen in 6.6 kV XLPE (cross-linked polyethylene). Therefore the cost of the&lt;br /&gt;cable decreases.&lt;br /&gt;• During unit operation can we have one UT feeding both unit 6.6 kV loads?&lt;br /&gt;No, logically prevented.&lt;br /&gt;• During unit operation, can we parallel UT &amp;amp; SUT continuously?&lt;br /&gt;No, due to switchgear limitation.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the design basis of 6.6 kV aluminium bus bars?&lt;br /&gt;a) Temperature rises not exceed 90 ºC.&lt;br /&gt;b) Withstand short ckt stresses.&lt;br /&gt;c) Take care of thermal expansion.&lt;br /&gt;• Why 2 types of earth fault relays in 6.6 kV side of transformers?&lt;br /&gt;I – Trips 6.6 kV breakers only. It gives primary protection for 6.6 kV bus bars.&lt;br /&gt;I1 – Trips the both HT and LT breakers. It acts as a backup to ref and also acts as&lt;br /&gt;backup to bus bar earthfault relay.&lt;br /&gt;• Why core balance CT is preferred over residual connected CT’s to sense earth fault&lt;br /&gt;in 6.6 kV feeders?&lt;br /&gt;a) To avoid relay mal-operation due to CT saturation&lt;br /&gt;b) Better sensitivity is got.&lt;br /&gt;c) High pickup and TMS avoided in IDMT earth fault relay.&lt;br /&gt;• How selection of cooling fluid in GT done?&lt;br /&gt;a) There are 5 factors are there.&lt;br /&gt;b) Density&lt;br /&gt;c) Coefficient of thermal expansion&lt;br /&gt;d) Viscosity&lt;br /&gt;e) Specific heat&lt;br /&gt;f) Thermal conductivity.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the ranges in which each type is effective?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 298 -&lt;br /&gt;ONAN – Natural cooling – up to 15 MVA.&lt;br /&gt;ONAF – Air forced radiators cooling – 10 to 100 MVA depending on availability of&lt;br /&gt;area.&lt;br /&gt;OFWF = oil forced and water forced used in more than 100 MVA.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 299 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why off load tap changer was chosen for GT?&lt;br /&gt;Because our plant works on base load always.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the advantages of OFWF?&lt;br /&gt;Ensure the differential temperature between top and bottom of transformer is&lt;br /&gt;minimum and Effect of ambient air temperature is minimum.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the type of lightning arrestor for GT?&lt;br /&gt;Zn O (zinc oxide) types.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of header breaker in water circuit?&lt;br /&gt;The header breaker ensures oil pressure greater than that of water pressure always.&lt;br /&gt;Therefore there is no leak of water into oil.&lt;br /&gt;• Why thermosyphon filter required?&lt;br /&gt;To keep required dryness/improve dryness of the transformer insulation, internal part&lt;br /&gt;of transformer. When transformer operates, due to pressure head between top and&lt;br /&gt;bottom small quantity of oil flows through filters (absorbent material activated&lt;br /&gt;alumina grade g-80 removes the moisture from oil). Absorbent material remove&lt;br /&gt;slag, acids, peroxides, ionic impurities from oil, which otherwise accelerate&lt;br /&gt;against of oil. Absorbent unit is reactivated at regular intervals.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of pronol conservator (KAPP)?&lt;br /&gt;Flexible separator avoids direct contact with atmosphere. Efficient barrier between&lt;br /&gt;oil and air. Ensures the protection against water vapour, suppression of gas bubbles&lt;br /&gt;formation in the oil.&lt;br /&gt;• Why main generator/UT is not provided with separate overfluxing protection?&lt;br /&gt;Since GT is provided with overfluxing protection, it is adequate to protect main&lt;br /&gt;generator / UT also. Main generator can withstand higher degree of overfluxing. If a&lt;br /&gt;generator CB is used, separate overfluxing protection is essential for main generator.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the advantage of Pressure relief device in TELK type GT over explosion&lt;br /&gt;vent of BHEL, even though in both cases oil will be expelled out during sudden&lt;br /&gt;pressure rise?&lt;br /&gt;During internal fault, the internal pressure rise is relieved by the expelling out of oil&lt;br /&gt;through Pressure relief device /explosion vent. However the Pressure relief device&lt;br /&gt;closes back when the pressure drops. Hence the oil exposure to atmosphere is&lt;br /&gt;minimised, thus saving large quantity of costly transformer oil from oxidation and&lt;br /&gt;moisture absorption. Fire hazard due to transformer oil does not exist after the&lt;br /&gt;closure of Pressure relief device.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 300 -&lt;br /&gt;• To reduce tower-footing resistance, which are better to use a) chemical, b) ground&lt;br /&gt;rods, c) counter poise?&lt;br /&gt;B &amp;amp; C&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 301 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why tap changer is kept at neutral end?&lt;br /&gt;a) To reduce insulation cost of tap changer.&lt;br /&gt;b) But reactance changeover the tap range increases.&lt;br /&gt;• Why guard connection is given for megger?&lt;br /&gt;For true measurement of IR value of HV to earth of a transformer, connect line to&lt;br /&gt;HV, earth to transformer tank and guard to LV. Therefore leakage current from HV&lt;br /&gt;to LV is not included.&lt;br /&gt;• Why lighting isolation transformer is req.?&lt;br /&gt;a) 3 wire to 4 wire conversion, since neutral is required for lighting load.&lt;br /&gt;b) Prevents transfer of E/F currents&lt;br /&gt;c) Reduces the fault level on secondary side and permits use of small sized cables /&lt;br /&gt;CB’s / fuses.&lt;br /&gt;• Why neutrals are solid grounded above 33 kV?&lt;br /&gt;a) Less transient over voltage due to arcing grounds.&lt;br /&gt;b) Voltage of phases are limited to phase to ground voltage. (No neutral shifting)&lt;br /&gt;c) Allows graded insulation of transformer (low cost)&lt;br /&gt;d) Fast E/F protection.&lt;br /&gt;• Why SET is chosen as Dyn 11?&lt;br /&gt;To have smooth commutation in generation in between stator and rotor.&lt;br /&gt;• Why all 415V transformers are chosen Dyn 11? What are the protections provided&lt;br /&gt;for the 415V transformers?&lt;br /&gt;a) To facilitate interchange.&lt;br /&gt;b) To have momentary parallel during changeover.&lt;br /&gt;Protections&lt;br /&gt;a) Door interlock to trip HT and LT breakers.&lt;br /&gt;b) LT breaker can on only after HT breaker is in on position.&lt;br /&gt;c) Instantaneous O/C and inverse O/C (50 + 51).&lt;br /&gt;d) Instantaneous E/F (50N).&lt;br /&gt;e) IDMT E/F and restricted E/F (51N + 64).&lt;br /&gt;f) Winding temp high trip (140°C trip and 130°C alarm)&lt;br /&gt;• What is the instrument name used for thermograph?&lt;br /&gt;Infrared camera.&lt;br /&gt;• Why neutrals are solid grounded below 600v?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 302 -&lt;br /&gt;Human safety&lt;br /&gt;Permits enough E/F current because ground resistance is large in less than 415v,&lt;br /&gt;hence fast fault clearance,&lt;br /&gt;Equipment safety against over voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 303 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the advantages of ungrounded system?&lt;br /&gt;Supply is maintained even with fault on one line&lt;br /&gt;Less interference to communication lines because of absence of zero sequence&lt;br /&gt;currents.&lt;br /&gt;• Why resistance grounding preferred for less than 33 kV and more than 415 V?&lt;br /&gt;a) To limit the earth fault current for equipment safety else, high short ckt forces&lt;br /&gt;dislocate in windings/bus bars etc,&lt;br /&gt;b) Over voltage due to arcing ground reduced&lt;br /&gt;c) Permits earth fault protection (not possible in ungrounded system)&lt;br /&gt;• What is meant by tan-delta measurement?&lt;br /&gt;It is the tan of the angle between the capacitive current and the total current.&lt;br /&gt;Ir&lt;br /&gt;Ic Ic - capacitive current&lt;br /&gt;I Ir - resistive current&lt;br /&gt;I - total current&lt;br /&gt;As the value of tan delta increases the resistive component of the current in&lt;br /&gt;increasing. Hence it shows a weak insulation.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the vector group of GT, UT, SUT?&lt;br /&gt;Yd11&lt;br /&gt;Dy1&lt;br /&gt;Yy0&lt;br /&gt;• Why all the transformers are having different vector group?&lt;br /&gt;UT and SUT are getting paralleled at 6.6 kV bus. Hence they should have voltage of&lt;br /&gt;same phase relationship. This is achieved by assigning different vector group to the&lt;br /&gt;transformers.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the built in protections for transformers?&lt;br /&gt;a) Buchholz relay&lt;br /&gt;b) Explosion vent or relief valve&lt;br /&gt;c) Gas operated relay for on load tap changers.&lt;br /&gt;• Why water pressure is kept below the oil pressure? How it is maintained?&lt;br /&gt;Incase of a heat exchanger tube failure the water should not go inside the&lt;br /&gt;transformer. For this purpose the oil pressure is kept above the water pressure.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 304 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the requirement oil in a transformer?&lt;br /&gt;Oil is used removal of heat produced in the transformer and also as insulating&lt;br /&gt;medium.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 305 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is meant by over fluxing of transformer?&lt;br /&gt;When the voltage is increased and the frequency is reduced the transformer will draw&lt;br /&gt;high magnetising current. This will result in higher core loss and subsequent heating&lt;br /&gt;of core and ultimate failure of transformer. Hence over fluxing protection is provided&lt;br /&gt;for the transformer.&lt;br /&gt;• What type oil pumps are used?&lt;br /&gt;Canned rotor pumps.&lt;br /&gt;• What is oil reclaiming and reconditioning?&lt;br /&gt;In reclaiming process the oil treated to remove all its impurities like acidity, sludge,&lt;br /&gt;sediments, moisture etc. The treated oil will be in par with the new oil. In&lt;br /&gt;reconditioning process (filtering of oil) only moisture and suspended impurities and&lt;br /&gt;sediments are removed.&lt;br /&gt;• Why there is no mixing of oil of tap changer and transformer?&lt;br /&gt;When the tap changing takes place arc is struck between the contacts. Due to this the&lt;br /&gt;oil inside the tap changer will be highly carbonised. If both oil get mixed up the&lt;br /&gt;quality of transformer tank oil will come down. This is not advisable. Hence both&lt;br /&gt;oils are kept separately.&lt;br /&gt;• Why the tap changers are always connected to HV side of the transformer?&lt;br /&gt;During tap changing action the load current has to be shifted from one tap to another&lt;br /&gt;tap. In case HV wining the load current will be less. Hence lesser arcing will take&lt;br /&gt;place.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of conservator?&lt;br /&gt;To accommodate the change in volume of oil during increase in temperature.&lt;br /&gt;• Why the neutral is earthed through earthing resistance in case of UT and SUT?&lt;br /&gt;This is done to limit the earth fault current.&lt;br /&gt;• Why REF is provided in the LV side of SUT and UT?&lt;br /&gt;The LV sides of the two transformers are earthed through the resistance. This will&lt;br /&gt;limit the flow of current in case of LV earth fault. Hence the differential protection&lt;br /&gt;may not act for a LV earth fault. Hence ref protection is provided.&lt;br /&gt;• Why twin secondary SUT?&lt;br /&gt;As per is, the rating single secondary power transformer is limited to 25MVA (6.6&lt;br /&gt;kV) or 40 MVA (11 kV), in order to limit the 3 phase symmetrical fault level with in&lt;br /&gt;26-40 kA (contribution from grid and local machines)&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 306 -&lt;br /&gt;• How 6.6 kV-bus supply was chosen?&lt;br /&gt;11 kV was rejected in view of the high insulation cost with 11 kV motors.&lt;br /&gt;3.3 kV was rejected, since max motor size with 3.3 kV bus is limited to 2 MW. But&lt;br /&gt;we are having the motors having rating more than 2 MW, which cannot suit to 3.3&lt;br /&gt;kV bus. 6.6 kV bus we can start upto 5 mw size motor.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 307 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why oil transformers are out door?&lt;br /&gt;Oil fire point = 170 ºC easy catching of fire.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the I.S used in transformers?&lt;br /&gt;IS – 1866 FOR MAINTENANCE AND SUPERVISION OF OIL&lt;br /&gt;IS – 10593 FOR GAS ANALYSIS&lt;br /&gt;IS – 1886 FOR INSTALLATION AND MAINTENANCE&lt;br /&gt;• When oil filteration is required?&lt;br /&gt;On reweaving oil test results.&lt;br /&gt;Draining of oil for maintenance&lt;br /&gt;Topping up of transformer oil&lt;br /&gt;• Why oil filteration is required?&lt;br /&gt;To remove water, sediments, sludge etc.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the types of oil used for in transformer for cooling?&lt;br /&gt;Paraffin based and naphtha based (in INDIA)&lt;br /&gt;• What are the types of bushing used in transformer?&lt;br /&gt;Condenser type bushing&lt;br /&gt;Porcelain type bushing&lt;br /&gt;• What are the precautions to be taken while terminating the bushings?&lt;br /&gt;Contact surfaces with intermediate plates,&lt;br /&gt;Mating surfaces should be identical.&lt;br /&gt;• How bushings are terminated inside the transformers?&lt;br /&gt;By grooving method or by binding wire method.&lt;br /&gt;• Why ICT are used?(INTERPOSING CT)&lt;br /&gt;To correct the system primary CT errors in case of high current faults out side CT&lt;br /&gt;zone (ICT’s primary CT is 800/1, but in fault current may go to thousands of amps.&lt;br /&gt;This ICT will take care of those errors.&lt;br /&gt;a) Matching the ratios.&lt;br /&gt;b) Matching the phase angle differences.&lt;br /&gt;• How CT is connecting in ckt?&lt;br /&gt;If the primary of CT is delta connected load the CT will be in star connection and&lt;br /&gt;vice versa. This is because to have square root 3 time compensation.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 308 -&lt;br /&gt;• What type of gasket and adhesive are used in transformer?&lt;br /&gt;Gasket – Neoprene based rubberised cork type RC70-C. (IS4253)&lt;br /&gt;Adhesive –Dunlop adhesive S-758&lt;br /&gt;These are recommended by TELK&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 309 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the precautions to store the Gasket?&lt;br /&gt;a) Stress free storage&lt;br /&gt;b) No folding&lt;br /&gt;c) No reuse&lt;br /&gt;d) Replace with same thickness&lt;br /&gt;• What is the in built protection for transformer?&lt;br /&gt;PRV to protect from over pressurization of tank due to the release of gases, oil etc.&lt;br /&gt;This is the replacement for the explosion vent.&lt;br /&gt;• Why UT, SUT secondary is rated for 6.9kV where as bus voltage is 6.6kV?&lt;br /&gt;The no load secondary 6.9kV voltage level adequately takes into account voltage&lt;br /&gt;drop during loaded condition to cater station buses at 6.6kV level.&lt;br /&gt;• Why our GT having off load tap changer?&lt;br /&gt;Because our station is base load station.&lt;br /&gt;• Why vector group of SUT is chosen as Yn-Yo-Yo?&lt;br /&gt;To facilitate momentary paralleling of SUT with UT on 6.6kV buses.&lt;br /&gt;• Grounding of various transformers.&lt;br /&gt;GT HV solidly grounded&lt;br /&gt;LV (delta)&lt;br /&gt;UT HV (delta)&lt;br /&gt;LV cast stainless steel 9.95 ohms 400A for 10 seconds.&lt;br /&gt;SUT HV solidly grounded&lt;br /&gt;LV cast stainless steel 9.95 ohms 400A for 10 seconds.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protections for GENERATOR TRANSFORMER?&lt;br /&gt;a) Differential protection&lt;br /&gt;b) Restricted earthfault protection&lt;br /&gt;c) Backup earthfault protection&lt;br /&gt;d) GT phase back up protection&lt;br /&gt;e) Overfluxing protection&lt;br /&gt;f) Oil surge (gas) protection&lt;br /&gt;g) High winding temperature and oil temperature protection.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protections for SUT?&lt;br /&gt;a) Over current protection for phase and earth fault&lt;br /&gt;b) Differential protection&lt;br /&gt;c) HV and LV restricted earthfault protection&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 310 -&lt;br /&gt;d) HV side directional back up over current protection for phase and earth fault.&lt;br /&gt;e) LV back up over current and earth fault protection&lt;br /&gt;f) Over fluxing protection&lt;br /&gt;g) Buchholz and high oil, winding temperature protection.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 311 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protections for UT?&lt;br /&gt;a) Differential protection&lt;br /&gt;b) LV restricted earthfault protection&lt;br /&gt;c) LV back up earthfault and over current protection&lt;br /&gt;d) Buchholz and high oil, winding temperature protection.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of carona ring?&lt;br /&gt;To minimize the arcing current during switching operations of disconnecting&lt;br /&gt;switches.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the various tests on transformers?&lt;br /&gt;a) Tan delta and capacitance dissipation factor&lt;br /&gt;b) Tests on cooling fans&lt;br /&gt;c) Tests on OLTC&lt;br /&gt;d) Vector group test&lt;br /&gt;e) Short circuit test&lt;br /&gt;f) Open circuit test&lt;br /&gt;g) Insulation resistance test&lt;br /&gt;h) Turns ratio test&lt;br /&gt;i) Winding resistance test.&lt;br /&gt;• Why input transformer of PUPS module 1 is delta-delta and module 2 is delta-star?&lt;br /&gt;With the help of this arrangement, combined DC output from both chargers is&lt;br /&gt;equivalent to that from a 12-pulse rectifier. Advantage of 12-pulse rectifier is that the&lt;br /&gt;mains current is fairly close to sine wave. Harmonics injected into system by rectifier&lt;br /&gt;are low. The phase angle difference 30-degree between module 1 output and module&lt;br /&gt;2 output give 12-pulse output.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 312 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 313 -&lt;br /&gt;MOTORS AND MCC&lt;br /&gt;• What is Motor?&lt;br /&gt;It is a device, which converts electrical energy into mechanical (rotating) energy.&lt;br /&gt;Definition of terms used in Motor:&lt;br /&gt;1) Duty Cycle rating: Most motor has a continuous duty rating to permit continuous&lt;br /&gt;operation at a rated load. However motors may be rated as intermittent duty,&lt;br /&gt;periodic duty or varying duty and must be turned off and allowed to cool after a&lt;br /&gt;fixed operating time.&lt;br /&gt;2) Full- Load current: The current required to produce full-load torque.&lt;br /&gt;3) Jogging: The starting and stopping of a motor at frequent intervals.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Motor controller?&lt;br /&gt;A device that controls some or all of the following functions: starting, stopping,&lt;br /&gt;overload protection, over current protection, reverses, changing of speed sequence&lt;br /&gt;control and running/jogging.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Motor speed?&lt;br /&gt;The shaft speed of the three-phase squirrel cage motor is determined by the&lt;br /&gt;frequency of the supply voltage and the number of poles in the motor. A two-pole&lt;br /&gt;motor runs at a speed of 3000 rpm on 50 cycles per second.&lt;br /&gt;rpm = cycles per second x 60 - slip&lt;br /&gt;Poles&lt;br /&gt;(Where slip is the difference between the speed of the rotating magnetic field and the&lt;br /&gt;speed of the rotor.)&lt;br /&gt;• Why Over current protection used?&lt;br /&gt;A fusible disconnect or circuit breaker used to protect the branch circuit conductors,&lt;br /&gt;control devices and the motor from grounds and short circuits. the over current&lt;br /&gt;protection device must be capable of carrying the starting current to exceed 400% of&lt;br /&gt;the motor full load current.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Overload?&lt;br /&gt;Any excessive amount of current drawn by the motor is called overload. Overloads&lt;br /&gt;on a motor may be mechanical or electrical.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Plugging?&lt;br /&gt;The instant reversal of motor is called plugging. Damage to the driven machinery&lt;br /&gt;can be result if plugging is applied improperly.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Sequence control?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 314 -&lt;br /&gt;The control of separate motors to operate in a predetermined pattern.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 315 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is Service factor?&lt;br /&gt;The amount of overload that may be permitted without causing significant&lt;br /&gt;deterioration of the insulation on a motor. For example, if a 10 hp motor has a&lt;br /&gt;service factor of 1.15, the motor can be safely be subjected to an 11.5 hp load.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Starting current or Locked rotor current?&lt;br /&gt;The current flow in the motor at the instant of starting. This current can be 4-10&lt;br /&gt;times the full load current of the motor. The most common locked rotor current is&lt;br /&gt;about 6 times the full load current. Such a motor will start with a 600% overload.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Torque?&lt;br /&gt;The twisting force produced by the motor is called torque. Its unit is in foot-pounds&lt;br /&gt;(ft-lb.), torque is related to horsepower by the following formula.&lt;br /&gt;Torque = horsepower * 5252&lt;br /&gt;Revolution per minute (rpm)&lt;br /&gt;• Write details MCC construction.&lt;br /&gt;a) MCC are made up of sheet steel enclosure, indoor floor mounting and free&lt;br /&gt;standing, Dust and vermin proof, modular type and of double front and single&lt;br /&gt;front (X1, Y1).&lt;br /&gt;b) Degree of protection is IP 50 as per IS 2147.&lt;br /&gt;c) 0.9 * 0.8 * 2.4 meters size (double front and single front) and top entry of cables.&lt;br /&gt;d) 0.9 * 0.6 * 2.4 meters size (single front) and bottom entry of cables.&lt;br /&gt;e) Parts are incoming panel, Cable entry, TB compartment, MCC module&lt;br /&gt;compartment.&lt;br /&gt;f) MCC modules are fully drawn-out type.&lt;br /&gt;g) Main buses are horizontally mounted and vertical buses are connected to MCC&lt;br /&gt;cells.&lt;br /&gt;h) Stab – in contacts are used for power and wipe – in contacts are used for control&lt;br /&gt;circuits.&lt;br /&gt;i) CT and PT are used for current and voltage measurements.&lt;br /&gt;j) 3φ indication lamps are provided for identification.&lt;br /&gt;k) Voltage meter and ammeter are provided.&lt;br /&gt;l) Panel space heater and emergency push button key operated are provided.&lt;br /&gt;m) Control building and SRPH MCC are safety related and SB, TB, RAB, CWPH,&lt;br /&gt;DM Plant MCC’s are non safety related.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the maximum load on MCC?&lt;br /&gt;3 Phase load upto 90 kW are fed by MCC.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 316 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the types of MCC?&lt;br /&gt;Type Application Protection&lt;br /&gt;A Receptacles, Cranes, Elevators, Local control panels Fuse&lt;br /&gt;B Locally controlled heaters Fuse, 49&lt;br /&gt;C Remote controlled heaters Fuse, 49&lt;br /&gt;D Remote controlled loads &lt;29 kW (49 in control panel) Fuse&lt;br /&gt;F For valve motors Fuse, 49&lt;br /&gt;G Locally controlled loads &lt;29 kW Fuse, 49&lt;br /&gt;H Locally controlled loads &gt;29 kW (RTM installed) Fuse, 49&lt;br /&gt;I DG MCC&lt;br /&gt;J Remote controlled loads &lt;29 kW Fuse, 49&lt;br /&gt;K Remote controlled loads &gt;29 kW (RTM installed) Fuse, 49&lt;br /&gt;L Barring gear motor MCC Fuse, 49&lt;br /&gt;SP For F/M supply and PHT S/D cooling pumps CT, PT Used&lt;br /&gt;• What is the operating life of bearings?&lt;br /&gt;a) Continuous 24 hrs operation – 40000 to 50000 hrs.&lt;br /&gt;b) Affected by load axially or radial.&lt;br /&gt;c) Operating temperature.&lt;br /&gt;• Give the 415 V MCC bus ratings and cable used.&lt;br /&gt;All MCC bus bars are made of aluminium. Short time current is 50 kA/sec and&lt;br /&gt;momentary rating is 105 kA.&lt;br /&gt;Type Bus Rating Class Location Cable Used&lt;br /&gt;K1 1000 A IV TB 111 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;K2 1500 A IV TB 111 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;L1 1000 A IV RAB 108 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;L2 1000 A IV SB 106.5 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;L3 1500 A IV TB 111 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;M1 1000 A IV SB 106.5 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;M2 1500 A IV TB 111 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;N1 1000 A IV TB 111 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;N2 1000 A IV RAB 108 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;W1 1500 A IV CCW PH 98 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;W2 1000 A IV DM plant 98 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;P1 1500 A III CB 100 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;P2 1500 A III CB 106.5 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;Q1 1500 A III CB 100 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;Q2 1500 A III CB 106.5 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;X1 600 A III SRPH 100 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;Y1 600 A III SRPH 100 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;PMCC S 630 A II CB 106.5 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 317 -&lt;br /&gt;PMCC T 630 A II CB 106.5 Mts.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 318 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the types of isolators used?&lt;br /&gt;Isolator Range Loads&lt;br /&gt;32 A ≤ 9.3 kW&lt;br /&gt;63 A &gt; 9.3 kW and ≤19 kW&lt;br /&gt;125 A &gt; 20 kW and ≤ 47 kW&lt;br /&gt;250 A &gt; 48 kW and ≤ 110 kW&lt;br /&gt;400 A &gt; 111 kW and ≤ 134 kW&lt;br /&gt;600 A ≤ 310 kW&lt;br /&gt;• What are the ranges of fuse used?&lt;br /&gt;Fuse Range Loads&lt;br /&gt;2 A 10 to 280 watt&lt;br /&gt;4 A 340 to 440 watt&lt;br /&gt;6 A 500 to 700 watt&lt;br /&gt;10 A 1000 to 1500 watt&lt;br /&gt;16 A 1.8 kW to 2.25 kW&lt;br /&gt;20 A 3 to 4 kW&lt;br /&gt;25 A 5 to 8 kW&lt;br /&gt;32 A 9 to 9.3 kW&lt;br /&gt;50 A 9.6 to 15 kW&lt;br /&gt;63 A 16 to 19 kW&lt;br /&gt;80 A 22 to 24 kW&lt;br /&gt;100 A 25 to 36 kW&lt;br /&gt;125 A 38.6 to 45 kW&lt;br /&gt;160 A 48 to 67.5 kW&lt;br /&gt;200 A 72 to 80 kW&lt;br /&gt;250 A 85 to 90 kW&lt;br /&gt;• What is use of fuse in electric circuit, what are the materials used for fuse and what&lt;br /&gt;are their melting points?&lt;br /&gt;Fuse is a weakest point in an electrical circuit, which breaks the circuit when&lt;br /&gt;abnormal current more than it’s rating flows through it. It works on principle of joule&lt;br /&gt;law (I2Rt). HRC fuse is filled with quartz powder to extinguish the arc generated in&lt;br /&gt;breaking the circuit or when fuse blown.&lt;br /&gt;Current rating is depends on the type of material, cross section area, length and size&lt;br /&gt;of terminal (large size terminal dissipates more heat).&lt;br /&gt;Formulae&lt;br /&gt;H = I2Rt/J&lt;br /&gt;R = ρl/a&lt;br /&gt;a = d2π/4&lt;br /&gt;Material Melting point in °C&lt;br /&gt;Silver 1830&lt;br /&gt;Copper 2000&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 319 -&lt;br /&gt;Aluminium 240&lt;br /&gt;Zinc 787&lt;br /&gt;Tin 436&lt;br /&gt;Lead 624&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 320 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the materials made of thermal overload relay? How OLR are selected?&lt;br /&gt;The bimetallic materials are Invar and brass. These materials having the differential&lt;br /&gt;coefficient of expansion. All bimetallic relays incorporate additional built in single&lt;br /&gt;phasing protection.&lt;br /&gt;The range of the relay provided for the feeders are such that the full load rating of the&lt;br /&gt;feeders is comfortably within the range of the relay (range will be at Centre) except&lt;br /&gt;in very minimum loads ranging from 0.1 – 0.16 A.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the functions of arc chute?&lt;br /&gt;To increase the speed of rise of arc by magnetic action.&lt;br /&gt;It splits the arc by this arc resistance increases.&lt;br /&gt;Diagnosing the arc by cooling.&lt;br /&gt;• What are IP (ingressive protection) and IC?&lt;br /&gt;IP means ingressive protection to the motor against the dust and water entry.&lt;br /&gt;The first digit indicates protection against accidental contact with live or moving&lt;br /&gt;parts (solid particles).&lt;br /&gt;The second digit indicates protection against ingress of water, foreign bodies (liquid&lt;br /&gt;particles).&lt;br /&gt;IC means instrument cooling to the motor (type of cooling)&lt;br /&gt;• What are the classes of AC motors?&lt;br /&gt;Depends on phases&lt;br /&gt;a. 1φ.&lt;br /&gt;b. 3φ.&lt;br /&gt;Depends on construction&lt;br /&gt;a. Squirrel cage induction motor for fixed torque.&lt;br /&gt;b. Wound rotor motor for variable torque.&lt;br /&gt;Depends on voltage&lt;br /&gt;a. LT motor - &lt;200 kW.&lt;br /&gt;b. HT motor - &gt;200 kW.&lt;br /&gt;Depends on torque and current&lt;br /&gt;a. Class – A (Normal torque and normal starting current. E.g. Fractional motors.) .&lt;br /&gt;b. Class – B (Normal torque and low starting current).&lt;br /&gt;c. Class – C (High starting torque and low starting current. E.g. Double sq. cage motor)&lt;br /&gt;d. Class – D (high starting torque and high starting current).&lt;br /&gt;Depends on mechanical characteristics&lt;br /&gt;a. Drip proof (IP 54). Safety against water or dust.&lt;br /&gt;b. Splash proof.&lt;br /&gt;c. TEFC (totally enclosed fan cooled).&lt;br /&gt;d. TEOV (totally enclosed open ventilated).&lt;br /&gt;e. TETV (totally enclosed tube ventilated. Principle is thermosymphony E.g. - CEP).&lt;br /&gt;f. Explosion proof.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 321 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the PI value required for motors?&lt;br /&gt;For class F insulation &gt;2 and for class B insulation 1.5 to 2.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 322 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the enclosures used for HT and LT motors?&lt;br /&gt;LT motors (&lt;200 kW)&lt;br /&gt;a. Open drip proof.&lt;br /&gt;b. TEFC.&lt;br /&gt;c. Totally enclosed air over type.&lt;br /&gt;HT motors (&gt;200 kW)&lt;br /&gt;a. Open drip proof.&lt;br /&gt;b. Weather protected I&lt;br /&gt;c. Weather protected II&lt;br /&gt;d. Totally enclosed water-cooled.&lt;br /&gt;e. Totally enclosed pipe ventilated.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the causes of motor failure?&lt;br /&gt;a. Corrosion or rust.&lt;br /&gt;b. Excessive moisture (winding IR low and bearing lubrication loss).&lt;br /&gt;c. High ambient temperature.&lt;br /&gt;d. Poor ventilation.&lt;br /&gt;e. Inadequate lubrication.&lt;br /&gt;f. Misalignment.&lt;br /&gt;g. Oil and dirt.&lt;br /&gt;h. Excessive starts and repetitive surges.&lt;br /&gt;i. Persistent over loads.&lt;br /&gt;j. Shaft currents (bearing pitting).&lt;br /&gt;k. Mis application.&lt;br /&gt;l. Manufacture defect or wrong design.&lt;br /&gt;m. Deterioration with age.&lt;br /&gt;n. Maintenance improper.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the effects of excessive starts and repetitive surges?&lt;br /&gt;Repetitive surges may give impact to the insulation of the motor and dielectric&lt;br /&gt;capability of the motor.&lt;br /&gt;Excessive starts may subject stator winding to high current for more time.&lt;br /&gt;Subsequently in HT motor due to High Mass rotor bar and rotor short ring may loose&lt;br /&gt;or fail. Bearing also may damage.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the effects of broken rotor bars and broken shaft parts?&lt;br /&gt;Broken rotor bars&lt;br /&gt;a. High stator current and over heat of stator winding.&lt;br /&gt;b. More harmonic currents in end parts.&lt;br /&gt;c. High vibration.&lt;br /&gt;Broken shaft or parts&lt;br /&gt;a. Stator winding loose bracing.&lt;br /&gt;b. Rotor high vibration and bearing vibration.&lt;br /&gt;c. Frame vibration and more harmonics in side bands.&lt;br /&gt;• Give the relation between current and temperature in motors.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 323 -&lt;br /&gt;a. Winding temperature is proportional to square of the current.&lt;br /&gt;b. 10% increase in current gives 30% increase in temperature.&lt;br /&gt;c. 10°C rise in temperature makes 50% life reduced.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 324 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the effects of imbalance stator winding resistance?&lt;br /&gt;If the stator winding resistances are imbalance phase to phase give pulsating fluxes&lt;br /&gt;and pulsating torque on rotor and vibration may increase. For accurate resistance&lt;br /&gt;measurement Kelvin Bridge is used.&lt;br /&gt;• What reflects the change in speed?&lt;br /&gt;a. Supply frequency may vary the speed of the motor.&lt;br /&gt;b. Load on the motor may vary the speed of the motor.&lt;br /&gt;• What is use of BORESCOPE inspection?&lt;br /&gt;BORESCOPE inspection method makes it easy to observe the end winding condition&lt;br /&gt;of the motor. In this inspection winding ties, loose coils, dust etc can be observed.&lt;br /&gt;• What you mean by CRAWLING and COGING?&lt;br /&gt;Crawling&lt;br /&gt;The motor fails to rotate at rated speed or motor rotates at … or 20% speed is called&lt;br /&gt;motor crawling. This may be due to system imbalance or more pulsating torque.&lt;br /&gt;Coging&lt;br /&gt;Motor fail to start atoll is called motor coging.&lt;br /&gt;• Why motor starting current is high compared to transformer charging current?&lt;br /&gt;Transformer charging current is only 1% and that of motor starting current is 30 to&lt;br /&gt;40%. Because of air gap between stator and rotor. If the air gap is more load taking&lt;br /&gt;capacity increases and if air gap is less the load taking capacity reduces.&lt;br /&gt;• State construction details of the motor.&lt;br /&gt;Stator or rotor core&lt;br /&gt;Built from high quality low loss silicon steel laminations and flash enameled on both&lt;br /&gt;the sides made up of close-grained alloy cast iron.&lt;br /&gt;Rotor conductor&lt;br /&gt;Heavy bars of copper or aluminium alloy.&lt;br /&gt;Stator&lt;br /&gt;Copper conductor.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the use of making rotor skewing?&lt;br /&gt;1. To run motor quickly by reducing magnetic hum.&lt;br /&gt;2. It reduces locking tendency with the stator.&lt;br /&gt;• Why under voltage tripping of motor is incorporated in motor feeder breakers?&lt;br /&gt;The under voltage can occur in case of bus fault. If the motors are kept connected&lt;br /&gt;they will feed the fault which may cause the damage. Due to the back feeding from&lt;br /&gt;the motor the motor will slow down very fast. Hence process system will come to&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 325 -&lt;br /&gt;halt very fast. (In case pht motor will not rotate for the designed 3 minute period in&lt;br /&gt;case of bus under voltage).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 326 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the problems in station operation due to grid under voltage?&lt;br /&gt;a) All the HT motors overloaded.&lt;br /&gt;b) VAR load increases on generator leads to heating up of rotor&lt;br /&gt;c) Stator current increases for same power export leads to stator over heating.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the problems in station operation due to grid under frequency?&lt;br /&gt;a) Turbine having under frequency limitation, house load happen if &lt; 48 Hz&lt;br /&gt;b) Due to under frequency PHT flow reduces, therefore reactor power reduces,&lt;br /&gt;generator power reduces&lt;br /&gt;c) If frequency is less than 48 Hz DG cannot be synchronised to grid, therefore DG&lt;br /&gt;kept on isolation running&lt;br /&gt;d) GT overfluxing.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the difference between fixed trip and trip free?&lt;br /&gt;Fixed trip: Breaker will trip only after closing even if trip impulses are existing.&lt;br /&gt;Trip free: Breaker is free to trip at any position.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the making current capacity of a 3-phase breaker as derived from its&lt;br /&gt;symmetrical breaker capacity?&lt;br /&gt;Making capacity = 2.55 times symmetrical breaking capacity.&lt;br /&gt;• Why intermediate contacts in English electric breaker?&lt;br /&gt;To prevent even slightest arcing on main contacts.&lt;br /&gt;• Where preloaded ball bearings used?&lt;br /&gt;If more vibration exists even when machine is not in running conditions.&lt;br /&gt;• Why do we grease the bearings?&lt;br /&gt;a) Grease lubricant gives good protection against ingress of moisture and dirt into&lt;br /&gt;motor.&lt;br /&gt;b) Easy to seal against leakage of grease into motor compared to oil.&lt;br /&gt;c) Low friction torque at starting.&lt;br /&gt;• Which bearings preferred for all large power motor?&lt;br /&gt;Plain bearings&lt;br /&gt;• Which is more dangerous alkali or acid?&lt;br /&gt;It especially exposed alkali is more dangerous, use boric acid powder solution&lt;br /&gt;immediately.&lt;br /&gt;• What FCN was implemented to avoid reactor trip on 220V-DC failure of PHT and&lt;br /&gt;PPP breakers?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 327 -&lt;br /&gt;The breaker close position supervision relay VAA 21 is changed by VAJC type,&lt;br /&gt;contacts position do not change if 220V-DC is lost now.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 328 -&lt;br /&gt;• Where oil lubrication is preferred over grease lubrication?&lt;br /&gt;a) Determined by speed and operating temperature.&lt;br /&gt;b) Oil lubrication recommended.&lt;br /&gt;c) When speed and temperature is high.&lt;br /&gt;d) When heat to be conducted away from bearing.&lt;br /&gt;e) When adjacent machine components are oil lubricated.&lt;br /&gt;f) High viscous oil for low speed machine, low viscous oil for high speed machine.&lt;br /&gt;g) At temp&lt;125 ºC, synthetic oils recommended.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the causes of failure of bearings?&lt;br /&gt;a) Faulty mounting&lt;br /&gt;b) Faulty lubrication&lt;br /&gt;c) Foreign matter in lubrication&lt;br /&gt;d) Water in the bearing arrangement&lt;br /&gt;e) Vibration&lt;br /&gt;f) Inoccurrences of form of shaft or housing seating.&lt;br /&gt;g) Passage of electric current.&lt;br /&gt;h) Metal fatigue.&lt;br /&gt;• What does the bearing number mean?&lt;br /&gt;7318 7 = single row angular contact ball bearings&lt;br /&gt;3 = width of race&lt;br /&gt;18 = 18 x 5 = 90 mm bore diameter.&lt;br /&gt;6310 6 = single row deep groove ball bearings.&lt;br /&gt;3 = width of race&lt;br /&gt;10 =10 * 5=50 mm dia&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of static starter? How current setting adopted?&lt;br /&gt;The static starter limits the starting current of the motor to 2.5 times the motor rated&lt;br /&gt;current instead of 6 times the rated current. If the motor is directly on UPS, the UPS&lt;br /&gt;fuse will blow, since the UPS cannot supply so much starting current. Hence the&lt;br /&gt;static starter is set to limit the starting current. This is achieved by firing angle&lt;br /&gt;control of back to back thyristor.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the speciality of the inverter output transformer? Why it is provided?&lt;br /&gt;a) This eliminates all 3rd harmonics in the output voltage.&lt;br /&gt;b) Solid earthed neutral is required for the inverter output, hence the interconnected&lt;br /&gt;star winding is essential.&lt;br /&gt;c) The primary has to be star (not delta), since 3 separate inverters operates on&lt;br /&gt;isolated primary winding.&lt;br /&gt;d) Delta connection will cause circulating current between inverters during&lt;br /&gt;unbalanced faults. The inverters cannot withstand this.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 329 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 330 -&lt;br /&gt;• Both silver and copper oxidise in air. Then why copper contacts are silver-plated?&lt;br /&gt;The silver plating avoids the oxidation of copper, especially in outdoors. Silver&lt;br /&gt;oxidises very readily. But its oxide is a good electrical conductor but copper oxide&lt;br /&gt;produce a film of insulation.&lt;br /&gt;• When auto transfer is effected?&lt;br /&gt;a) When any one module trips&lt;br /&gt;b) When overload exceeds 175% for more than 40 msec. is existing.&lt;br /&gt;c) When UPS output voltage varies beyond 415v +/- 10%&lt;br /&gt;• When static bypass is fired? Why static bypass is required?&lt;br /&gt;For the same above 3 conditions, static bypass is also simultaneously fired along&lt;br /&gt;with a closing impulse.&lt;br /&gt;• When the static bypass is blocked?&lt;br /&gt;When the phase error is more than 20º.&lt;br /&gt;• What is phase lock mode?&lt;br /&gt;The inverter continuously follows the frequency and phase angle of classIII bus&lt;br /&gt;supply.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the difference between a contactor and a breaker?&lt;br /&gt;Contactor is not designed to open on short circuit condition (fuse will take care of&lt;br /&gt;this situation). Breaker is having complicated mechanism for closing and tripping.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the difference between isolator and contactor?&lt;br /&gt;Contactor is used for on load operation. Because they are fast acting devices. They&lt;br /&gt;posses arc chamber and arc chutes. Arc chamber and arc chute make it easy to&lt;br /&gt;extinguish the arc produced during on load operation.&lt;br /&gt;Isolator is off load devices. Because they are slow acting devices. The arc time is&lt;br /&gt;more in slow acting devices and operated only in off load.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protections provided for motor feeder?&lt;br /&gt;Ith - Thermal over load&lt;br /&gt;I2S - Unbalance load&lt;br /&gt;I0S - Earth fault protection&lt;br /&gt;I1t - Stalling protection&lt;br /&gt;I1Inst. - Short circuit protection&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protections provided in PMCC circuit breakers?&lt;br /&gt;1. IDMT O/C (CDG 34).&lt;br /&gt;2. IDMT E/F (CDG 11).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 331 -&lt;br /&gt;3. Under voltage (40% of 110V).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 332 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is requirement of having DG’s?&lt;br /&gt;To establish class III supply when class IV fails.&lt;br /&gt;Parallel operation with class IV 6.6 kV supply.&lt;br /&gt;DG to DG parallel operation.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the characteristics of CB, OLR and HRC Fuse?&lt;br /&gt;CB characteristics (it is back up fuse)&lt;br /&gt;Current&lt;br /&gt;Fuse characteristics&lt;br /&gt;Margin to avoid fuse operation OLR characteristics&lt;br /&gt;During starting&lt;br /&gt;Minimum fusing current&lt;br /&gt;Staring current&lt;br /&gt;Running current&lt;br /&gt;Time&lt;br /&gt;CB Protection&lt;br /&gt;Fuse Protection&lt;br /&gt;OLR Protection&lt;br /&gt;I&lt;br /&gt;Time&lt;br /&gt;When CB is used the CB characteristics should be below the fuse, because the CB&lt;br /&gt;should operate first and then fuse. Not vice-versa. Because CB is the main protection&lt;br /&gt;or main breaking device.&lt;br /&gt;• Why control transformer is earthed?&lt;br /&gt;If it is not earthed grounding of control circuit at two different places can cause&lt;br /&gt;bypassing of logics. In case of primary and secondary of the control transformer is&lt;br /&gt;getting the main fuse will blow off. (If secondary is not grounded then 415v will be&lt;br /&gt;superimposed in the control circuit during short circuit of primary and secondary&lt;br /&gt;winding)&lt;br /&gt;• When the fuse will take over?&lt;br /&gt;When the current increases beyond 700% then the fuse will take over from the&lt;br /&gt;thermal overload protection.&lt;br /&gt;• What is interlocks provided for the valve MCC&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 333 -&lt;br /&gt;a) Mechanical interlock, which will not allow the other contactor to close if one&lt;br /&gt;contactor, is closed.&lt;br /&gt;b) 42 auxiliary contacts are wired in the control ckt. 42-1 contact in 42-2 and 42-2&lt;br /&gt;contact in 42-1.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 334 -&lt;br /&gt;• How to calculate the full load current of the motors?&lt;br /&gt;If kW is given, full load current = 1.5 times kW rating.&lt;br /&gt;If hp is given, full load current =2 times hp rating.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the safety interlock provided in MCC cell?&lt;br /&gt;The MCC cell door can&#39;t open if the cell is in on condition.&lt;br /&gt;• How the fuse is selected?&lt;br /&gt;Fuse rating should be 2.5 times the full load current.&lt;br /&gt;• How will you improve the IR value of a motor?&lt;br /&gt;By providing external heating. (By filament lamps)&lt;br /&gt;By providing internal heating by applying the low voltage.&lt;br /&gt;By circulating hot and dry air.&lt;br /&gt;• Why 110V has been chosen in MCC cell?&lt;br /&gt;To isolate control circuit from power circuit for Human safety at control circuit side.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of DIODE across the interposing coils in PLC?&lt;br /&gt;To dissipate the stored energy in magnetic field of the interposing coils (Free&lt;br /&gt;wheeling action). If it is not provided the stored energy will affect the PLC card&lt;br /&gt;circuit.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the in-built protections provided in MCC cell?&lt;br /&gt;Fuses for short circuit protection.&lt;br /&gt;OLR for over load and single phasing protection.&lt;br /&gt;Electrical and Mechanical interlock in valve cell against short circuit.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the plugging of an induction motor?&lt;br /&gt;It is an electrical braking of an induction motor by sudden reversal of phase&lt;br /&gt;sequence.&lt;br /&gt;• Why CT operated over load relay is using for loads of high acceleration time upto 30&lt;br /&gt;seconds? How it getting back?&lt;br /&gt;The saturable current transformers linearly transforms the current upto twice the set&lt;br /&gt;current, but above this value the transformer core gets saturated and the secondary&lt;br /&gt;current is proportionally less. Thus these relays permit heavy starting conditions of&lt;br /&gt;motors and offer dependable protection against overload.&lt;br /&gt;When current reduces the core gets de-saturated, as material design is such.&lt;br /&gt;• How many earthing should be done for motors? Why?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 335 -&lt;br /&gt;Two. For reliability.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the significance of frame size of motor?&lt;br /&gt;In order to make practical choice, interchangeability and large scale production&lt;br /&gt;possible.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 336 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is polarisation index?&lt;br /&gt;a) It is defined as a ratio of 10 minutes resistance value to 1-minute resistance value.&lt;br /&gt;b) It gives a quantitative information about the insulation with respect to moisture,&lt;br /&gt;dirt and other contamination.&lt;br /&gt;c) A PI value of less than 1.0 indicates a need for immediate reconditioning.&lt;br /&gt;• Why megger value of 1 minute is less than 10-minute value?&lt;br /&gt;After 10 minutes the high voltage applied make the molecules such a way that&lt;br /&gt;stabilised in a good insulation. If insulation is weak it leads to more leakage current&lt;br /&gt;due to high potential.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the classification of duty of rotating electrical machines?&lt;br /&gt;S1 – Continuous operation at rated load (MCR) in 40 °C&lt;br /&gt;S2 – Short time operation (STR) for 5 minute or 15 minutes or 30 minutes.&lt;br /&gt;S3 – Intermittent periodic operation (resting and loading e.g. cranes, lifts etc)&lt;br /&gt;S4 – As for S3 but with starting&lt;br /&gt;S5 – As for S3 with electric braking&lt;br /&gt;S6 – Continuous cyclic operation.&lt;br /&gt;• What should be the value of insulation resistance of induction motor?&lt;br /&gt;In Rm = kV + 1 M OHMS.&lt;br /&gt;Insulation resistance of any electrical machine (motor or generator) should be above&lt;br /&gt;0.5-M ohms in all cases.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the classes of insulation?&lt;br /&gt;Y – 90οC (max) cotton, silk, paper, wood without oil impregnation&lt;br /&gt;A – 105οC Materials of class Y impregnated with natural resins,insulating oils.&lt;br /&gt;E – 120οC Synthetic resin enamels, cotton and proper laminations.&lt;br /&gt;B – 130οC Mica, glass fibre, asbestos with suitable bonding substance.&lt;br /&gt;F – 155οC Class B with more thermally resistant bonding materials.&lt;br /&gt;H – 180οC Glass fibre and asbestos, mica with silicon resins.&lt;br /&gt;C – &gt;180οC Mica, ceramics, glass, quartz and asbestos without binders.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the checks on the motor during the preventive maintenance?&lt;br /&gt;IR Value&lt;br /&gt;Resistance and Inductance measurement&lt;br /&gt;PI value (should &gt; 1.0)&lt;br /&gt;• What are the tests pressures used in lyra contact testing?&lt;br /&gt;125 A - 3 kg&lt;br /&gt;250 A - 5 kg.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 337 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 338 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the causes of motor vibration?&lt;br /&gt;a) Broken rotor.&lt;br /&gt;b) Slacked stator core.&lt;br /&gt;c) Slacked rotor core.&lt;br /&gt;d) Rotor winding unbalance.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the causes for motor high current?&lt;br /&gt;a) High frequency (51 Hz - 105% current)&lt;br /&gt;b) Low frequency (48 Hz – 102% current)&lt;br /&gt;c) High voltage&lt;br /&gt;d) Low voltage&lt;br /&gt;e) Mechanical over load&lt;br /&gt;• What are the causes for motor unbalance current?&lt;br /&gt;a) Loose connection&lt;br /&gt;b) Voltage unbalance&lt;br /&gt;c) Turns short circuit&lt;br /&gt;• What are the sources of 240 V AC class I supply? What are the functions of each&lt;br /&gt;part of UPS?&lt;br /&gt;Six sources.&lt;br /&gt;Three 20 kVA UPS for safety related loads.&lt;br /&gt;Two 60 kVA UPS for non-safety related loads.&lt;br /&gt;One 60 kVA UPS as a standby to safety related loads.&lt;br /&gt;These all UPS are back up by 220V DC batteries.&lt;br /&gt;Rectifier&lt;br /&gt;This converts AC to DC supply for inverter.&lt;br /&gt;Functions&lt;br /&gt;1. Produces DC voltage.&lt;br /&gt;2. Supplies trickle charge to batteries.&lt;br /&gt;3. Full load boost charge capacity.&lt;br /&gt;Inverter&lt;br /&gt;This converts DC to AC supply for loads.&lt;br /&gt;20 kVA inverter is transistor based and 60 kVA inverter is thyristor based.&lt;br /&gt;Static switch.&lt;br /&gt;To take stand by UPS into service.&lt;br /&gt;Manual bypass&lt;br /&gt;To take main UPS to maintenance by putting stand by UPS into service.&lt;br /&gt;• What is station Black out condition?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 339 -&lt;br /&gt;Simultaneous failures of class IV and class III supply is called Station Black out. In&lt;br /&gt;this condition class II power UPS will feed the necessary loads for a 30 minutes of&lt;br /&gt;duration. After that supplementary control room (SCR) 5 kVA UPS is used for&lt;br /&gt;secondary shut down system (SSS) ion chamber amplifier.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 340 -&lt;br /&gt;220 kV SYSTEM&lt;br /&gt;• What is meant by Dielectric strength?&lt;br /&gt;The maximum electrical potential gradient that a material can withstand without&lt;br /&gt;rupture usually specified in volts/millimeter of thickness. This also has known as&lt;br /&gt;electric strength.&lt;br /&gt;• Give switchyard specification.&lt;br /&gt;1. Type : Out door.&lt;br /&gt;2. Scheme : Double main bus bar with bypass switching scheme is provided.&lt;br /&gt;This allows maintenance of one bus or one CB without interruption.&lt;br /&gt;3. Normal voltage : 220 kV.&lt;br /&gt;4. Rated voltage : 245 kV (400 kV)&lt;br /&gt;5. Impulse voltage : 1050 kV (peak)&lt;br /&gt;6. One-minute level : 460 kV (rms.)&lt;br /&gt;7. Dynamic current capacity: 102 kA (peak) and 40 kA for one sec.&lt;br /&gt;8. Rated current capacity : 2000 A for main and 1600 A for feeder bus.&lt;br /&gt;9. Clearances : Phase to earth – 2100 mm.&lt;br /&gt;Phase to phase – 2100 mm.&lt;br /&gt;Phase to ground – 5500 mm.&lt;br /&gt;Sectional clearance – 4300 mm.&lt;br /&gt;Creepage clearance – (Total) 5600 mm.&lt;br /&gt;– (Protected) 2800 mm.&lt;br /&gt;10. Maximum temperature rise above ambient - 45°C.&lt;br /&gt;11. CB – SF6&lt;br /&gt;12. Isolator – motor operated rotating type.&lt;br /&gt;13. Number of bays – 16 Nos.&lt;br /&gt;• Give the details of switchyard 220 kV CB, Isolator, CT, CVT and lightning arrestor.&lt;br /&gt;220 kV SF6 Circuit Breaker&lt;br /&gt;1. Make – ABB&lt;br /&gt;2. Air pressure blocking a. Close Block – 17.3 bar.&lt;br /&gt;b. Open block – 16.7 bar.&lt;br /&gt;c. Auto reclose block – 19 bar.&lt;br /&gt;3. SF6 pressure block a. Alarm – 5.2 bar.&lt;br /&gt;b. Rated – 6 bar.&lt;br /&gt;c. Limit – 5 to 6 bar.&lt;br /&gt;d. Open block – 5 bar&lt;br /&gt;4. Weight of gas / pole : 20 kgs.&lt;br /&gt;5. Closing time : 130-milli sec.&lt;br /&gt;6. Method of closing : Electro-pneumatic.&lt;br /&gt;7. Compressor pressure : 20.5 kg/cm2.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 341 -&lt;br /&gt;Isolator&lt;br /&gt;1. Type : High-pressure pressure relieving isolator (HPPR) central pole double&lt;br /&gt;break.&lt;br /&gt;2. CB and Isolator clearances : Phase to Phase – 4500 mm.&lt;br /&gt;Phase to earth – 2300 mm.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 342 -&lt;br /&gt;Current transformer&lt;br /&gt;1. Make : TELK made hermetically sealed.&lt;br /&gt;2. Type : Single pole dead tank.&lt;br /&gt;Capacitor voltage transformer (CVT)&lt;br /&gt;This is capacitive potential divider and inductive medium mineral oil sealed.&lt;br /&gt;ABB. make 245 kV/110 √3 V.&lt;br /&gt;3 cores for metering and protection.&lt;br /&gt;Lightning arrestor&lt;br /&gt;Type : WS surge arrestor of ZODIVER type and SMX style.&lt;br /&gt;Gapier zinc oxide arrestor. Multi unit construction for transport, storage and erection.&lt;br /&gt;Rated voltage : 216 kV rms.&lt;br /&gt;Operating voltage : 184 kV rms.&lt;br /&gt;• For a fault in switchyard lightning arrestor, what protection will act?&lt;br /&gt;Bus bar differential protection.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of the CVT?&lt;br /&gt;To provide synchronising signal&lt;br /&gt;To provide voltage indication&lt;br /&gt;To facilitate the carrier communication&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of wave trap?&lt;br /&gt;Carrier communication signals are sent through the lines. These are high frequency&lt;br /&gt;signals. This signal should be prevented from entering the switchyard. The wave trap&lt;br /&gt;is LC ckt, which is tuned for 50 Hz. Since it is connected in series with the line it&lt;br /&gt;will effectively block the carrier signal entering into the switchyard.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of lightning arrestor?&lt;br /&gt;Due to lightning and switching surges high voltages are induced in the lines. If&lt;br /&gt;equipment’s. Connected is subjected to this high voltage the insulation will fail. In&lt;br /&gt;order to avoid the failure of insulation the LA is used. When the la is subjected to&lt;br /&gt;high voltage it will conduct and discharge the current to the earth.&lt;br /&gt;(It will divert the over voltages to earth and protect the substation)&lt;br /&gt;• What is meant by restriking voltage?&lt;br /&gt;The high voltage that will appear across the contact just after the quenching of the&lt;br /&gt;arc is called restriking voltage.&lt;br /&gt;• What does switching surges mean?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 343 -&lt;br /&gt;When a line is switched on high voltage will appear on the line due to its inductance&lt;br /&gt;and capacitance. This voltage is known as switching surges.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 344 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of compressed air in SF6 breaker?&lt;br /&gt;This used for drive for opening and closing of the contacts.&lt;br /&gt;(Arc quenching is taken care by SF6 gas)&lt;br /&gt;• Why switchyard is located indoors of coastal plants?&lt;br /&gt;Saline atmosphere will deposit on the insulators causing its flashover. The building&lt;br /&gt;kept under positive pressure compared with outside thus preventing the (saline) air&lt;br /&gt;entering from outside to inside the building.&lt;br /&gt;• Why disc insulators grooved at bottom?&lt;br /&gt;To increase the creepage distance, reduce the chances of flash over.&lt;br /&gt;• How cap and pin attached to insulator?&lt;br /&gt;By cementing.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the material of cap, pin, and insulator?&lt;br /&gt;Cap = galvanised cast iron&lt;br /&gt;Pin = forged steel pin&lt;br /&gt;Insulator = porcelain.&lt;br /&gt;• Why insulators are glazed?&lt;br /&gt;If not glazed, it will absorbs water, resistance comes down, leakage current through&lt;br /&gt;porcelain, temperature increases till porcelain is puncture&lt;br /&gt;• What is the station ground resistance?&lt;br /&gt;Less than 0.5 ohms.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the various design of CT&#39;s in switchyard?&lt;br /&gt;Bus coupler CT&#39;s- live tank design 2000-1000A/1A&lt;br /&gt;All other CT&#39;s- dead tank design 800-600-400A/1A - lines and GT.&lt;br /&gt;125A/1A – SUT&lt;br /&gt;• Advantage of CVT over EMPT.&lt;br /&gt;Used as coupling capacitors for PLCC.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the main parts of 220 kV Circuit Breaker?&lt;br /&gt;Pole column filled with SF6&lt;br /&gt;Pneumatic drive system with compressed air circuit&lt;br /&gt;Control cubicle unit&lt;br /&gt;• What is the type of 220 kV circuit breaker?&lt;br /&gt;220 kV, SF6 breaker, single pole, puffer type.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 345 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the levels of SF6 gas in 220 kV breaker and their significance?&lt;br /&gt;7 kg/cm2 - normal pressure&lt;br /&gt;5.2 bar - alarm&lt;br /&gt;5.0 bar - closing/tripping operation blocked.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 346 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the difference between circuit breaker and isolator?&lt;br /&gt;Isolator is a disconnecting switch which is not having the making and breaking&lt;br /&gt;capacity.&lt;br /&gt;Bus coupler - 2000A&lt;br /&gt;Feeders - 1600 A&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of ground switch?&lt;br /&gt;To discharge the trapped electrical charges to ground to give complete isolation.&lt;br /&gt;(To discharge the residual potential)&lt;br /&gt;• What is the type of Lightning Arrestor?&lt;br /&gt;Station type, heavy duty, gap less zinc oxide.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of grading ring?&lt;br /&gt;This assembly is provided to have uniform voltage gradient.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the properties of SF6 gas?&lt;br /&gt;Physical properties&lt;br /&gt;1. Colourless&lt;br /&gt;2. Odorless&lt;br /&gt;3. Non-toxic. Pure SF6 gas is not harmful to the health.&lt;br /&gt;4. Non-inflammable.&lt;br /&gt;5. Density- more gas density, 5 times that of air at 20°C and at atmospheric&lt;br /&gt;pressure. The gas starts liquefying at certain low temperature. The temperature of&lt;br /&gt;liquefaction depends on pressure. At 15 kg f / cm2 the gas starts liquefying at&lt;br /&gt;10°C. Hence this gas is not suitable for high pressures &gt;15 kg f / cm2&lt;br /&gt;6. The heat transferability of SF6 gas is 2 to 2.5 times that of air at same pressure.&lt;br /&gt;Hence for equal conductor size the current carrying capacity is relatively more.&lt;br /&gt;Chemical properties&lt;br /&gt;1. Stable upto 500°C.&lt;br /&gt;2. Inert gas due to the chemical inertness. The life of the metallic parts, contacts is&lt;br /&gt;longer in SF6 gas. The components do not get oxidised or deteriorated. Hence the&lt;br /&gt;maintenance requirement is reduced. However moisture is very harmful to the&lt;br /&gt;properties of the gas. In the presence of the moisture, hydrogen fluoride is formed&lt;br /&gt;during arcing which can attract the metallic and insulating parts in the circuit&lt;br /&gt;breaker.&lt;br /&gt;3. Electro negative gas – Ability of an atom to attract means carrying a negative&lt;br /&gt;electric charge.&lt;br /&gt;These advantages offer increased safety, reduction in size, weight, noiseless&lt;br /&gt;operation, easy installation, handling and maintenance.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 347 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protections are there for BUSBAR?&lt;br /&gt;Instantaneous over current protection&lt;br /&gt;Bus bar differential protection&lt;br /&gt;Local breaker back up protection&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 348 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protections are there for lines?&lt;br /&gt;Directional earthfault protection&lt;br /&gt;Directional over current protection&lt;br /&gt;Local breaker back up protection&lt;br /&gt;Pole discrepancy&lt;br /&gt;Main protection (distance protection)&lt;br /&gt;Directional OverCurrent Relay For Line-1&amp;amp;2&lt;br /&gt;MICOM-P127&lt;br /&gt;(This relay is in addition to the existing electro-mechanical directional O/C relay)&lt;br /&gt;Setting Details&lt;br /&gt;CTR= 600/1A&lt;br /&gt;VTR= 220kV/110V&lt;br /&gt;Directional Over Current Setting&lt;br /&gt;Description Symbol in Relay Set value LED Indication&lt;br /&gt;IDMT Directional over&lt;br /&gt;current (Stage#1)&lt;br /&gt;Secondary 1.33Amps Primary&lt;br /&gt;(800Amps) TMS = 0.1 (67ABC)&lt;br /&gt;Directional&lt;br /&gt;O/C(Stage#2)&lt;br /&gt;Secondary 3.33Amps&lt;br /&gt;Primary (2000Amps)&lt;br /&gt;Instantaneous.&lt;br /&gt;(67ABC)&lt;br /&gt;Directional&lt;br /&gt;O/C(Stage#3)&lt;br /&gt;Secondary 5Amps&lt;br /&gt;Primary (3000Amps)&lt;br /&gt;Instantaneous.&lt;br /&gt;(67ABC)&lt;br /&gt;Directional Earth Fault Current Setting&lt;br /&gt;Description Symbol in Relay Set value LED Indication&lt;br /&gt;IDMT Directional Earth&lt;br /&gt;Fault current (Stage#1)&lt;br /&gt;Secondary 0.2Amps Primary&lt;br /&gt;(120Amps) TMS = 0.1 (67N)&lt;br /&gt;Directional Earth Fault&lt;br /&gt;(Stage#2)&lt;br /&gt;Secondary 4Amps&lt;br /&gt;Primary (2400Amps)&lt;br /&gt;Instantaneous.&lt;br /&gt;(67N)&lt;br /&gt;Directional Earth Fault&lt;br /&gt;(Stage#3)&lt;br /&gt;Secondary 6Amps&lt;br /&gt;Primary (3600Amps)&lt;br /&gt;Instantaneous.&lt;br /&gt;(67N)&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 349 -&lt;br /&gt;MICOM-P127&lt;br /&gt;Directional OverCurrent Relay For Line-3&amp;amp;4&lt;br /&gt;Setting Details&lt;br /&gt;CTR= 800/1A&lt;br /&gt;VTR= 220kV/110V&lt;br /&gt;Directional Over Current Setting as on 07/09/2002&lt;br /&gt;Description Symbol in Relay Set value LED Indication&lt;br /&gt;IDMT Directional over&lt;br /&gt;current (Stage#1)&lt;br /&gt;Secondary 1.0Amps Primary&lt;br /&gt;(800Amps) TMS = 0.2 (67ABC)&lt;br /&gt;Directional&lt;br /&gt;O/C(Stage#2)&lt;br /&gt;Secondary 0.94 Amps&lt;br /&gt;Primary (750Amps)&lt;br /&gt;Instantaneous.&lt;br /&gt;(67ABC)&lt;br /&gt;Directional&lt;br /&gt;O/C(Stage#3)&lt;br /&gt;Secondary 2.5Amps&lt;br /&gt;Primary (2000Amps)&lt;br /&gt;Instantaneous.&lt;br /&gt;(67ABC)&lt;br /&gt;Directional Earth Fault Current Setting&lt;br /&gt;Description Symbol in Relay Set value LED Indication&lt;br /&gt;IDMT Directional Earth&lt;br /&gt;Fault current (Stage#1)&lt;br /&gt;Secondary NOT USED&lt;br /&gt;Primary TMS = (67N)&lt;br /&gt;Directional Earth Fault&lt;br /&gt;(Stage#2)&lt;br /&gt;Secondary NOT USED&lt;br /&gt;Primary&lt;br /&gt;Instantaneous.&lt;br /&gt;(67N)&lt;br /&gt;Directional Earth Fault&lt;br /&gt;(Stage#3)&lt;br /&gt;Secondary NOT USED&lt;br /&gt;Primary&lt;br /&gt;Instantaneous.&lt;br /&gt;(67N)&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 350 -&lt;br /&gt;220KV SWITCH YARD LINES&lt;br /&gt;DESCRIPTION LINE-01 LINE-02 LINE-03 LINE-04&lt;br /&gt;REMARKS&lt;br /&gt;LINE LENGTH&lt;br /&gt;IN KM&lt;br /&gt;13 16 62 62&lt;br /&gt;CT RATIO 600/1 A 600/1 A 800/1 A 800/1 A&lt;br /&gt;01 DISTANCE&lt;br /&gt;RELAY&lt;br /&gt;SETTINGS.(21)&lt;br /&gt;Relay character QUAD QUAD LENT LENT&lt;br /&gt;K1 1 2 4 4&lt;br /&gt;K2 0 0 0.8 0.8&lt;br /&gt;K3 32 32 N/A N/A&lt;br /&gt;K4 0 1 4 4&lt;br /&gt;K5 0.7 0.4 0.3 0.3&lt;br /&gt;K6 0 0 0.02 0.02&lt;br /&gt;K11 1 1 1 1&lt;br /&gt;K12 0.6 0 0.3 0.3&lt;br /&gt;K13 0.08 0.04 0.02 0.02&lt;br /&gt;K14/24 1 1 1 1&lt;br /&gt;K15 1 1 1 1&lt;br /&gt;K21 4 2 2 2&lt;br /&gt;K22 0.5 0.6 0.5 0.5&lt;br /&gt;K31 6 3 4 4&lt;br /&gt;K32 0.9 0.9 0.5 0.5&lt;br /&gt;K33 1 1 1 1&lt;br /&gt;K35 1 1 2 2&lt;br /&gt;K36 0 0.2 0.7 0.7&lt;br /&gt;K37 1 0.5 0.25 0.25&lt;br /&gt;A/b N/A N/A 1 1&lt;br /&gt;Z-2 TIME(m sec) Inst. Inst. 400 400&lt;br /&gt;Z-3 TIME(m sec) 120 120 800 800&lt;br /&gt;L#2- Z-2 &amp;amp; Z-3&lt;br /&gt;changed on&lt;br /&gt;18/6/02 &amp;amp; L#1 on&lt;br /&gt;21/06/02&lt;br /&gt;Tp ALL LEFT ALL LEFT ALL LEFT ALL LEFT&lt;br /&gt;Td ALL LEFT ALL LEFT ALL LEFT ALL LEFT&lt;br /&gt;SW-1 RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT&lt;br /&gt;SW-2 LEFT LEFT LEFT LEFT&lt;br /&gt;SW-3 RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT&lt;br /&gt;SW-4 RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT&lt;br /&gt;SW-5 RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT&lt;br /&gt;SW-6 RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT&lt;br /&gt;SW-7 LEFT LEFT LEFT LEFT&lt;br /&gt;SW-8 LEFT LEFT LEFT LEFT&lt;br /&gt;SW-9 RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT&lt;br /&gt;Z-1 LEFT LEFT LEFT LEFT&lt;br /&gt;Z-2 LEFT LEFT LEFT LEFT&lt;br /&gt;Z-3 RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT RIGHT&lt;br /&gt;ANGLE (Ph-Ph) 80 80 85 85&lt;br /&gt;ANGLE (Ph-N) 80 80 75 75&lt;br /&gt;TEST OPTION 0 0 0 0&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 351 -&lt;br /&gt;DESCRIPTION LINE-01 LINE-02 LINE-03 LINE-04 REMARKS&lt;br /&gt;2 DIRECTIONAL&lt;br /&gt;OVER CURRENT&lt;br /&gt;(67 A,B,C.)&lt;br /&gt;CT RATIO 600/1 A 600/1 A 800/1 A 800/1 A L#2 Settings&lt;br /&gt;changed on&lt;br /&gt;18/6/02 &amp;amp; L#1 on&lt;br /&gt;21/6/02&lt;br /&gt;PSM 1.25 (750A) 1.25 (750A) 1.0 (800A) 1.0 (800A)&lt;br /&gt;TMS 0.1 0.1 0.2 0.2&lt;br /&gt;High set 5A 5A 5A 5A&lt;br /&gt;L#2 Settings&lt;br /&gt;changed on&lt;br /&gt;18/6/02 &amp;amp; L#1 on&lt;br /&gt;21/6/02&lt;br /&gt;3 DIRECTIONAL&lt;br /&gt;EARTH FAULT&lt;br /&gt;(67N)&lt;br /&gt;PSM 0.2A 0.2A 20%(0.2A) 20%(0.2)&lt;br /&gt;TMS 0.1 0.1 0.225 0.225&lt;br /&gt;High set 2A 2A 400%(4A) 400%(4A)&lt;br /&gt;L#2 Settings&lt;br /&gt;changed on&lt;br /&gt;18/6/02 &amp;amp; L#1 on&lt;br /&gt;21/6/02&lt;br /&gt;4 LBB&lt;br /&gt;PROTECTION&lt;br /&gt;(50Z)&lt;br /&gt;PSM 0.2 0.2 0.2 0.2&lt;br /&gt;KNOB 1 1 1 1&lt;br /&gt;2/50Z 0.25 sec 0.25 sec 0.25 sec 0.25 sec&lt;br /&gt;5 POLE&lt;br /&gt;DISCRIPENCY&lt;br /&gt;(47)&lt;br /&gt;2/47T 0.1 sec 0.1 sec 0.1 sec 0.1 sec&lt;br /&gt;6 ISOLATOR&lt;br /&gt;PARALLEL(29)&lt;br /&gt;TIMER(29) 25 sec 25 sec 25 sec 25 sec&lt;br /&gt;7 POWER RELAY&lt;br /&gt;(32)&lt;br /&gt;PSM N/A N/A 10 ma 10 ma&lt;br /&gt;TIME N/A N/A 0 0&lt;br /&gt;8 INST, OVER&lt;br /&gt;CURRENT&lt;br /&gt;RELAY&lt;br /&gt;(50A,,B,C.)&lt;br /&gt;KNOB N/A N/A 94% 94%&lt;br /&gt;2/50 ABC N/A N/A MIN. sec MIN. sec&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 352 -&lt;br /&gt;BATTERIES&lt;br /&gt;• What are the disadvantages of the maintenance free battery?&lt;br /&gt;The life of battery is only five years.&lt;br /&gt;The state of charge of a battery not knowing by the specific gravity of a battery. We&lt;br /&gt;can know by voltage only.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the problems of hydrogen concentration?&lt;br /&gt;If the concentration of hydrogen more than 4% and less than 74% explosion&lt;br /&gt;problems will be there. Therefore the concentration of hydrogen is restricted to less&lt;br /&gt;than 1% by air changer ventilation system.&lt;br /&gt;• Why lead acid battery requires so much large initial charging?&lt;br /&gt;Initially for a new battery, negative plate will be PbO instead of Pb. To convert all of&lt;br /&gt;them back to Pb, we need so much prolonged initial charging.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protections adopted in UPS or PMCC supply?&lt;br /&gt;LV (incomer) or UPS input&lt;br /&gt;CTZM, Over current, Short circuit protections&lt;br /&gt;PMCC S or T input or UPS output&lt;br /&gt;Under voltage (27), 51RYB, 51N protections.&lt;br /&gt;• Write chemical equation for lead acid cell.&lt;br /&gt;PbO2 + H2 SO4 􀃆 PbSO4 +2 H2 (during discharge)&lt;br /&gt;Pb + SO4 􀃆 PbSO4 (during charge)&lt;br /&gt;• Is the chemical reaction of plante cells same as tubular lead acid cells?&lt;br /&gt;No. Plante cells having both electrodes are lead (Pb) only.&lt;br /&gt;During charging, H2O 􀃆 H2 + O2&lt;br /&gt;O2 react with Pb to form PbO2 + (+ve plate)&lt;br /&gt;During discharge, Pb + c 􀃆PbSO4 (on -ve plate)&lt;br /&gt;While PbO2 􀃆 Pb + O2 (on +ve plate).&lt;br /&gt;That is converted back to lead.&lt;br /&gt;Therefore PbSO4 formed only on -ve plate. That is sulphation problem are reduced&lt;br /&gt;by 50%&lt;br /&gt;• What are the advantages of plante type batteries?&lt;br /&gt;Plante plate type batteries have longer life and can with stand rapid discharge.&lt;br /&gt;• Why battery room should be located separately in a power station?&lt;br /&gt;Possibility of battery explosion&lt;br /&gt;Corrosive atmosphere by acid spray.&lt;br /&gt;Fire hazard.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 353 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the disadvantages of nickel cadmium battery?&lt;br /&gt;Status of charge not known&lt;br /&gt;Number of cells are more&lt;br /&gt;Cost very high&lt;br /&gt;Environmental protection agency considers cadmium as a hazardous material,&lt;br /&gt;difficult to discard at the end of life.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the effects of temperature in lead acid battery?&lt;br /&gt;Higher electrolyte temp - ah capacity increases but life reduces.&lt;br /&gt;Lower electrolytic temp - ah capacity reduces since chemical reaction rate reduces.&lt;br /&gt;• Why ventilation is essential for Ni-Cad also?&lt;br /&gt;Gases evolved H2 O2 can form explosive mixture.&lt;br /&gt;• How H2 O2 generated in lead acid battery?&lt;br /&gt;At end of charge, when most of the Pb is converted. H2 O2 generated from H2O. O2&lt;br /&gt;appears as gas at positive plate. H2 at negative plate, i.e. gassing starts.&lt;br /&gt;• Why current reduced after gassing?&lt;br /&gt;Excessive gassing shortens the life of battery by scouring the active materials at the&lt;br /&gt;surface of the plates.&lt;br /&gt;• Why aged battery consumes more water?&lt;br /&gt;As aging increases, antimony migrates to negative plate 􀃆 secondary cell reaction.&lt;br /&gt;Therefore more charging current require 􀃆 more water consumption.&lt;br /&gt;• What happens after aging?&lt;br /&gt;Shedding of active material during charging.&lt;br /&gt;Shedding increases with overcharging, heavy discharge, batteries short ckt.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the other effect of low temperature?&lt;br /&gt;When specific gravity decreases, acid freezing point increases, soon reached at low&lt;br /&gt;temperature, volume increases container cracks.&lt;br /&gt;• Why temperature correction required?&lt;br /&gt;As temperature increases, specific gravity decreases. The hydrometer immersion is&lt;br /&gt;more, showing lower readings. Therefore 10ºC raises, 7 points to be added,&lt;br /&gt;corrected to get 27 ºC reading.&lt;br /&gt;• What is meant by sulphation of the cell?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 354 -&lt;br /&gt;During the discharge lead sulphate is produced and during the charging the same is&lt;br /&gt;converted back into lead and lead peroxide. If the cell is left under charged, lead&lt;br /&gt;sulphate would form which will not reverse back into lead and lead peroxide during&lt;br /&gt;charging. Due to this the cell will loose its original capacity.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 355 -&lt;br /&gt;• What you meant by shedding?&lt;br /&gt;During the charging and discharging the active materials will undergo volumetric&lt;br /&gt;changes. Due to this some of the material may not be retained with the parent&lt;br /&gt;material and will shed and collected at the bottom of the container. This loss of&lt;br /&gt;active material is called shedding. Due to this the cell will loose its capacity.&lt;br /&gt;• Acid should be poured to water. Why is it so?&lt;br /&gt;When acid and water is mixed lot of heat is generated. Hence there is chances of&lt;br /&gt;splashing of the liquid. If water is poured to acid will splash causing injuries. In the&lt;br /&gt;other case splashing will be of water with concentration of acid, which will not&lt;br /&gt;hazardous as the other one.&lt;br /&gt;• What types of lighting fittings are used in the battery room?&lt;br /&gt;Flame proof acid resistant&lt;br /&gt;• Why ungrounded 250V DC system adopted in our system?&lt;br /&gt;The 250V DC system is feeding to some of the vital loads such as breaker control&lt;br /&gt;etc. Even if one ground has occurred then also these controls should be available.&lt;br /&gt;Continuous monitoring of ground current is employed to eliminate the by passing of&lt;br /&gt;logic due to double ground.&lt;br /&gt;• Why battery capacity limits to 20 minute?&lt;br /&gt;Battery cost is more.&lt;br /&gt;It is better to restore class 3 faster by DG set then putting large battery.&lt;br /&gt;20 min, is enough to shutdown the unit safely.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the main parts of lead acid battery?&lt;br /&gt;a. Container&lt;br /&gt;b. Lead dioxide positive plates&lt;br /&gt;c. Lead negative plates&lt;br /&gt;d. Post strap and seal assemble&lt;br /&gt;e. Separators and retainers&lt;br /&gt;f. Sulphuric acid electrolyte&lt;br /&gt;g. Inter cell connector (lead plated copper)&lt;br /&gt;• What are the different types of charging?&lt;br /&gt;(Normally always) Float charging – 2.15V per cell&lt;br /&gt;It maintains the battery fully charged condition during standby operation by&lt;br /&gt;delivering a small amount of current to cancel the effect of battery natural selfdischarge.&lt;br /&gt;Equalizing charging (2.7V/cell) once in 3 months&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 356 -&lt;br /&gt;Recharge a battery capacity through recovering all useable active materials in the&lt;br /&gt;cell plates.&lt;br /&gt;Boost charging&lt;br /&gt;Boost charging is a quick charging process, which is generally required, if the battery&lt;br /&gt;is drained to a large extent.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 357 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the double sulphate reaction?&lt;br /&gt;Pb O2 + Pb + 2H2 SO4 ↔ 2PbSO4 +2H2O&lt;br /&gt;During charging oxygen at positive plate and hydrogen at negative plate are&lt;br /&gt;releasing.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the effects of over charging?&lt;br /&gt;Gassing&lt;br /&gt;Heating&lt;br /&gt;Loosening of plate active material&lt;br /&gt;• What you mean by Drooping characteristics of charger?&lt;br /&gt;When the charger is connected to excess load of charger rating the charger should&lt;br /&gt;able to supply the load with out over loaded by maintaining the terminal voltage&lt;br /&gt;within limit without over load trip. This called a drooping output voltage&lt;br /&gt;characteristics.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the effects of under charging?&lt;br /&gt;Sulphation&lt;br /&gt;Buckling of plates&lt;br /&gt;• What are the effects of high temperature?&lt;br /&gt;Gassing of electrolyte and evaporation&lt;br /&gt;Service life is halved for every 8 deg increase above 25 deg.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the effects of low temperature?&lt;br /&gt;Increased electrolyte viscosity.&lt;br /&gt;• What type of thermometer is used for acid batteries?&lt;br /&gt;Alcohol type thermometer.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the tests for battery?&lt;br /&gt;Conduct test – to check the capacity batteries&lt;br /&gt;Impedance test – to check the utilization of active materials.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the functions of charger?&lt;br /&gt;1. For initial charging.&lt;br /&gt;2. For float charging.&lt;br /&gt;3. For battery equalizing charging.&lt;br /&gt;4. For battery boost charging.&lt;br /&gt;5. To supply normal DC loads.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 358 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the rating of switchyard battery charger and batteries?&lt;br /&gt;Switchyard is having Float cum boost charger of 282 V DC maximum and 100&lt;br /&gt;Amps rated charger of six-pulse full wave thyristerised controlled rectifier.&lt;br /&gt;Batteries are tubular 220 V DC. +ve plate is made up of low antimory lead selenium&lt;br /&gt;(Pb) and –ve plate is made up of paste plate type (O2). Container or tube is made up&lt;br /&gt;of polyester and glass fibre.&lt;br /&gt;1. Momentary load 160 A / minute.&lt;br /&gt;2. Continuous load 40 A / hour.&lt;br /&gt;3. Cell voltage 1.8 V DC and total number of cells are 106 in battery bank.&lt;br /&gt;4. Float voltage 2.16 V per cell to 2.18 V per cell.&lt;br /&gt;5. Maximum system voltage is 106 * 2.18 = 242 V DC&lt;br /&gt;Battery rated for 224 A for one minute or 80 A for 60 minutes.&lt;br /&gt;Specific gravity 1110 ± 5 and specific gravity after 10 hrs discharge is 1150 ± 5.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protections provided in charger?&lt;br /&gt;1. Over load (49).&lt;br /&gt;2. Over voltage (59).&lt;br /&gt;3. Short-circuit (3250 Amps).&lt;br /&gt;4. Phase sequence and phase fail.&lt;br /&gt;5. di/dt and dv/dt protection.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 359 -&lt;br /&gt;CIRCUIT BREAKER&lt;br /&gt;• Give circuit breaker nameplate details of 6.6 kV, and 415 V.&lt;br /&gt;6.6 kV (SF6 circuit Breaker) 415 V (Air Circuit Breaker)&lt;br /&gt;Type HPA12/1240C(Tr./ PM) 812 (MCC/UPS)&lt;br /&gt;HPA12/2040C(Tr./ PM) 610 (Tie/PM/MCC)&lt;br /&gt;3037 (B/c, Incomer)&lt;br /&gt;Standard IEC 56&lt;br /&gt;Rated voltage 12 kV (6.6 kV) 415 V&lt;br /&gt;Insulation level 28 / 75 kV 660 V&lt;br /&gt;Rated current 1250A/2000A 1600A/1000A/3750A&lt;br /&gt;Breaking current 40 kA 50 kA (rms.)&lt;br /&gt;Making current 100 kA 105 kA (peak)&lt;br /&gt;Short ckt withstand 40 kA/sec 50 kA/sec&lt;br /&gt;Closing time 52 milli sec 60 sec (III/IV) &amp;amp; 30 sec (II)&lt;br /&gt;Opening time 75 milli sec 35 sec (III/IV) &amp;amp; 40 sec (II)&lt;br /&gt;SF6 pressure 2.3 - 2.8 bar (2.2 alarm) at 20°C&lt;br /&gt;Sliding contact Copper with silver of 10 microns&lt;br /&gt;• What are the difference between DCCB and ACCB?&lt;br /&gt;DCCB&lt;br /&gt;Two poles seriesed for one side.&lt;br /&gt;Breaker is adequately de-rated for use in dc circuits.&lt;br /&gt;Only DINF, DIRS provided. DIT 5 will not work for dc.&lt;br /&gt;In GFB, magnetic blowout coils used to increase the speed of rise of arc into the arc&lt;br /&gt;chutes for effective quenching.&lt;br /&gt;ACCB&lt;br /&gt;The inherent current zero of sine wave helps arc quenching. For DCCB arc&lt;br /&gt;quenching is difficult, since current zero is not existing naturally.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the indications used in 415V and 6.6 kV breakers panel?&lt;br /&gt;415 V Breaker 6.6 kV Breaker&lt;br /&gt;Open Green Green&lt;br /&gt;Close Red Red&lt;br /&gt;Test White&lt;br /&gt;Service Blue&lt;br /&gt;Auto trip Yellow White&lt;br /&gt;Spring charge Blue&lt;br /&gt;Gas pressure Yellow&lt;br /&gt;Voltage (RYB) Red&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 360 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 361 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the advantages and disadvantages of 415V English Electric breaker?&lt;br /&gt;Advantages&lt;br /&gt;1. Auto reclosing shutters.&lt;br /&gt;2. Proven wiping contacts.&lt;br /&gt;3. Sturdy rugged mechanism.&lt;br /&gt;4. Reliable aux. Switches contacts.&lt;br /&gt;5. Slow closing facility independent of closing spring.&lt;br /&gt;Disadvantages&lt;br /&gt;Bulky, more space, spring charge motor 5A. , Spring charging time 14 sec 4 sec at&lt;br /&gt;timing, trip extends in test position also. No neutral bus bar link, we cannot finger&lt;br /&gt;contact resistance since fixed on bus side.&lt;br /&gt;• Type of closing spring is compression type.(415V)&lt;br /&gt;• Why parallel operations of classIII buses are not permitted?&lt;br /&gt;Fault on one side affects the other buses, switchgear fault level rating is exceeded.&lt;br /&gt;• Why auto transfer is blocked for back up protection?&lt;br /&gt;Because Backup protection operates normally for bus faults. All main protections are&lt;br /&gt;generally operating for internal faults therefore there is no point in restoring the&lt;br /&gt;power supply through auto transfer when there is a bus fault existing.&lt;br /&gt;• What decides the control transformer VA rating?&lt;br /&gt;Contactor coil VA rating.&lt;br /&gt;• Can we use AC contactor in DC circuit?&lt;br /&gt;Yes, but with adequate de-rating.&lt;br /&gt;• Can we use ac coils in dc circuit?&lt;br /&gt;Yes with economy resistor in series.&lt;br /&gt;• Why shading rings provided in armature core of ac contactor. Why not for dc&lt;br /&gt;contactor?&lt;br /&gt;Because the force developed is not steady in ac therefore contacts will chatter but if&lt;br /&gt;shading ring is used force developed becomes steady due to splitting of phases of&lt;br /&gt;flux, therefore contacts becomes bounce free and humming sound reduces.&lt;br /&gt;• Why copper contact are not used in contactor?&lt;br /&gt;Because corrosion rate increases. Poor surface property , large closing force&lt;br /&gt;required.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 362 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why pure silver is not used in contactor?&lt;br /&gt;Affected by sulphur, mechanical or arcing damages (adv. Lower voltage drop)&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 363 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the types of contactors?&lt;br /&gt;Type Contacts Rating Use&lt;br /&gt;3 TB 41 2 NO + 2 NC 12 A 0 – 5.5 kW&lt;br /&gt;3 TA 22 2 NO + 2 NC 30 A 7.5 – 11 kW&lt;br /&gt;3 TA 13 2 NO + 2 NC 38 A 15 kW&lt;br /&gt;3 TA 24 4 NO + 2 NC 70 A 18 – 38 kW&lt;br /&gt;3 TA 16 4 NO + 2 NC 105 A 40 – 48 kW&lt;br /&gt;3 TA 28 4 NO + 2 NC 170 A 55 – 80 kW&lt;br /&gt;3 TA 28 3 NO + 3 NC 170 A 55 – 80 kW&lt;br /&gt;3 TB 56 4 NO + 2 NC 400 A 93 kW for F/M supply PM.&lt;br /&gt;3 TD 11 2 NO + 2 NC 12 A 0 – 1.5 kW for valve motors.&lt;br /&gt;3 T I 22 2 NO + 2 NC 30 A 1.6 – 7.5 kW for valve motors.&lt;br /&gt;• What material used for contactor?&lt;br /&gt;Silver-nickel for &lt;100A&lt;br /&gt;Silver-cadmium oxide for large currents.&lt;br /&gt;• Why pick up voltage is more than drop out voltage?&lt;br /&gt;Initially air gap is more. Large force is required to overcome the high reluctance&lt;br /&gt;initially. After closing air gap is reduced. Hence drop voltage is reduced.&lt;br /&gt;• Can we file the pitted contacts of contactor?&lt;br /&gt;No, use emery paper and etc.&lt;br /&gt;• How the contact resistance can increase?&lt;br /&gt;Humidity + salty air, dust, poor contact pressure&lt;br /&gt;• Fusing current- the current at which the fuse element melts depends upon the&lt;br /&gt;material, length and diameter.&lt;br /&gt;• Fusing factor- fusing current /rated current (1.25 -1.75)&lt;br /&gt;• Prospective fault current – first loop of fault current&lt;br /&gt;• Cut off current - actual peak value of current reached due to interruption by fuse&lt;br /&gt;blowing.&lt;br /&gt;• What is rated current and short circuit current?&lt;br /&gt;Rated current = VA / √3 * V Amps.&lt;br /&gt;Short circuit current = VA * 100 / %Z * √3 * V Amps.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the advantage of lower cut off current?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 364 -&lt;br /&gt;Less electromagnetic forces on contactor / CB’s&lt;br /&gt;• How two fuses in-series are discriminated?&lt;br /&gt;Total I2t of minor fuse should be less than pre-arcing I2t of major fuse.&lt;br /&gt;Major fuse should be greater than 1.5 times the minor fuse.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 365 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why OLR time set high for belt driven fans?&lt;br /&gt;Because acceleration time is high.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the safety reason to keep the contactor / MCC remote from motor?&lt;br /&gt;Contactor = sparking equipment. Not suiting for hazardous location.&lt;br /&gt;• Where wound type CT used and where not used?&lt;br /&gt;Used where low CT ratio req.&lt;br /&gt;Not used where high short ckt. Current exists.&lt;br /&gt;• What is advantage of cast resin CT’s?&lt;br /&gt;Can withstand bursting forces under short ckt, protect damages against external&lt;br /&gt;causes impervious to moisture.&lt;br /&gt;• Why fuses with fusing factor more than 1.5 is not allowed in PVC cables?&lt;br /&gt;Because PVC cables have low thermal capacity than paper cables. Full loading of&lt;br /&gt;PVC only possible if it has close excess current protection (i.e.) Fusing Factor = 1.5&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 366 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the advantages of HRC fuses re-wirable fuses? What are the characteristics&lt;br /&gt;of HRC fuse?&lt;br /&gt;1. Consistent and stable characteristics for accuracy of discrimination. Capacity&lt;br /&gt;to break at high and low current. It is inverse time characteristics, as the&lt;br /&gt;current is high the time taken to break the circuit is less.&lt;br /&gt;2. Arc quenching is reliable. Chemical action between quartz and arc gas gives&lt;br /&gt;high resistance to the arc. Quartz does not produce more gas after observing&lt;br /&gt;heat as its sand powder observes more heat of the arc.&lt;br /&gt;3. Non deteriorating since it is sealed. No maintenance, Cheap and indication is&lt;br /&gt;available.&lt;br /&gt;Characteristics&lt;br /&gt;1. I2t characteristics. This determines the energy that element can pass and to&lt;br /&gt;determine the cut off characteristics.&lt;br /&gt;105 Total I2t&lt;br /&gt;104&lt;br /&gt;103&lt;br /&gt;102 Pre-arcing I2t&lt;br /&gt;10&lt;br /&gt;10 50 100 150 200&lt;br /&gt;Fuse rating&lt;br /&gt;2. Inverse time characteristics, which is useful for selection of the fuse for motor.&lt;br /&gt;75&lt;br /&gt;50&lt;br /&gt;Current&lt;br /&gt;20&lt;br /&gt;10&lt;br /&gt;0.2 0.5 0.7 0.9 1 sec&lt;br /&gt;Time&lt;br /&gt;Inverse time characteristics&lt;br /&gt;Current&lt;br /&gt;Fuse characteristics&lt;br /&gt;Margin to avoid fuse operation&lt;br /&gt;During starting&lt;br /&gt;Minimum fusing current&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 367 -&lt;br /&gt;Staring current&lt;br /&gt;Running current&lt;br /&gt;Time&lt;br /&gt;Motor selection characteristics&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 368 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the advantage of CMM relay over normal Inv. O/C current relay?&lt;br /&gt;Inv. O/C relay under protects at low current and over protects at high currents.&lt;br /&gt;CMM: accounts for both +ve and –ve sequence currents i.e. Single phasing /&lt;br /&gt;unbalance supply conditions and gives three times more weightage for the –ve phase&lt;br /&gt;sequence current heating than + ve sequence current heating. i.e. Net rotor heating =&lt;br /&gt;I1&lt;br /&gt;2 + 3 I2&lt;br /&gt;2.&lt;br /&gt;Therefore CMM relay protection characteristic is closely matched to motor heating&lt;br /&gt;characteristic. So it is better than thermal overload relay also.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of anti-pumping relay?&lt;br /&gt;When closing signal is continuously existing even after the closing of the breaker the&lt;br /&gt;anti-pumping relay will be picked up and it will not allow the breaker to close back&lt;br /&gt;in case of tripping of the breaker.&lt;br /&gt;• Why breaker tripping is prohibited on very low pressure?&lt;br /&gt;The efficiency with which the arc quenching is taking place in the breaker depends&lt;br /&gt;on the air pressure. So if the air pressure is low effective arc quenching will not take&lt;br /&gt;place which will result in damage of CB. Hence the tripping of the breaker at very&lt;br /&gt;low air pressure is prevented.&lt;br /&gt;• Why neutral breaker used in DG neutral grounding?&lt;br /&gt;In case of high earth fault currents it is therefore normal practice to install a circuit&lt;br /&gt;breaker in the neutral of the generator in order to reduce the total fault clearance&lt;br /&gt;time.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protections used in Class III &amp;amp; Class IV 415 V LV side?&lt;br /&gt;Class III 415 V LV side&lt;br /&gt;1. 51 (inverse over current)&lt;br /&gt;2. 50 (instantaneous over current)&lt;br /&gt;3. 27 (under voltage)&lt;br /&gt;4. 51N (earth fault)&lt;br /&gt;5. 64 (REF)&lt;br /&gt;Class IV 415 V LV side&lt;br /&gt;1. 51 RYB (inverse over current)&lt;br /&gt;2. 51N (earth fault)&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 369 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protections used in 415 V Class II side?&lt;br /&gt;LV to UPS&lt;br /&gt;1. CTZM&lt;br /&gt;2. 50 (instantaneous over current)&lt;br /&gt;3. short circuit&lt;br /&gt;UPS to PMCC S &amp;amp; T&lt;br /&gt;1. 51 RYB (inverse over current)&lt;br /&gt;2. 27 (under voltage)&lt;br /&gt;3. 51N (earth fault)&lt;br /&gt;From Class III to Class II tie&lt;br /&gt;CTZM at Class III and 51, 51N at Class II.&lt;br /&gt;• Define the followings.&lt;br /&gt;Insulation level – it is the combination of rated voltage, the corresponding impulse&lt;br /&gt;withstand voltage, which together characterize the insulation of the equipment as&lt;br /&gt;regards its ability to withstand the electrical stresses.&lt;br /&gt;Rated short circuit breaking current – it is the highest RMS value of short circuit&lt;br /&gt;current which the circuit breaker is capable of breaking the circuit in safe.&lt;br /&gt;Making current – it is the peak value of first loop of current of short circuit current&lt;br /&gt;which the circuit breaker is capable of making at the rated voltage.&lt;br /&gt;Rated making current = 2.5 times rated breaking current.&lt;br /&gt;Short time rating – it is the RMS value of current that the circuit breaker can carry in&lt;br /&gt;a fully closed position during a specified time.&lt;br /&gt;Impulse withstand voltage – it is the amplitude of the standard voltage wave with the&lt;br /&gt;insulation of equipment can withstand.&lt;br /&gt;Power frequency withstand voltage – it is RMS value of alternating voltage wave of&lt;br /&gt;power frequency (50 Hz) which the insulation of equipment should withstand.&lt;br /&gt;• What is switchgear?&lt;br /&gt;Equipment which is used for switching, controlling and protecting an electrical&lt;br /&gt;circuit.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 370 -&lt;br /&gt;• Bus bar specifications of 6.6kV and 415 V.&lt;br /&gt;415V&lt;br /&gt;Aluminium 200 X 12mm&lt;br /&gt;2 nos. per phase, 1 no. for neutral&lt;br /&gt;Bus bar joints – silver plated to 5 micron thick (tightness 50 NM)&lt;br /&gt;6.6kV&lt;br /&gt;Copper&lt;br /&gt;Silver coated joints&lt;br /&gt;Insulation level – 27kV&lt;br /&gt;Fault level estimated – 27kA Designed – 40kA&lt;br /&gt;• What is the type of arc extinction in switchgears?&lt;br /&gt;415V – resistance method (through arc splitter)&lt;br /&gt;6.6kV – single puffer principle&lt;br /&gt;• How Arc quenching is done?&lt;br /&gt;When fault occurs depending on design element melts at one point and arc starts and&lt;br /&gt;a transient current is super imposed on prospective current. When the sum of two is&lt;br /&gt;zeroing the arc is quenching.&lt;br /&gt;• What is lock out relay?&lt;br /&gt;It is the relay to prevent the closing of circuit breaker after tripping (protection)&lt;br /&gt;without attention of the operator.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the significance of SF6 gas pressure in 6.6kV breakers?&lt;br /&gt;Density gauge&lt;br /&gt;Green – correct SF6 pressure (3 –3.5bar)&lt;br /&gt;Yellow – pressure for breaking system fault current (refilling should be done)&lt;br /&gt;Red – SF6 pressure less than 2 bar, which indicates leak in the system.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the measure of atmospheric pressure and PSI?&lt;br /&gt;1 Atmospheric pressure = 1.033 kg/cm2.&lt;br /&gt;1 PSI = 0.07031 kg/cm2.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the distribution of DC control supply in CL IV, III, II- 415V and 6.6 kV?&lt;br /&gt;Closing coil and Trip coil 2 supply from one source.&lt;br /&gt;Trip coil 1 supply from one source.&lt;br /&gt;Protections supply from one source.&lt;br /&gt;• Why 86.1 and 86.2 relays are used?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 371 -&lt;br /&gt;All electrical protection is wired to 86.1 and under voltage protection is wired to 86.2&lt;br /&gt;relay for automatic restoration in EMTR.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 372 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is the difference between lockout of 6.6 kV and 415 V CB’s?&lt;br /&gt;Voltage levels.&lt;br /&gt;Manual / auto reset.&lt;br /&gt;Lockout relays of 415 V breakers are all Electro-magnetic type. There is no&lt;br /&gt;mechanical latch. But in 6.6 kV it is of mechanical latch type relays.&lt;br /&gt;• If breaker contact resistance is more what action to be taken?&lt;br /&gt;In 6.6 kV breakers 1250 A breaker contact resistance is &lt;100 μς.&lt;br /&gt;2000 A breaker contact resistance is &lt;50 μς.&lt;br /&gt;If contact resistance is found more than this value should be sent to the manufacturer&lt;br /&gt;for repair.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the interlocks between 415 V and 6.6 kV switch gear?&lt;br /&gt;6.6 kV&lt;br /&gt;Breaker closed cannot rack in or out.&lt;br /&gt;Service lever cannot move while breaker closed.&lt;br /&gt;Breaker cannot be closed in in-between position.&lt;br /&gt;415 V&lt;br /&gt;Breaker door cannot be opened when breaker is in service.&lt;br /&gt;Breaker cannot be closed in in-between position.&lt;br /&gt;Breaker closed cannot be rack in or out.&lt;br /&gt;• Where are the provision of GR-A and GR-B tie possibilities?&lt;br /&gt;Bus D1-D2 to E1-E2 (CL III 6.6 kV)&lt;br /&gt;Bus X to Bus Y (CL III 415V)&lt;br /&gt;Bus S to Bus T (CL II 415 V)&lt;br /&gt;• What are the properties of SF6 gas?&lt;br /&gt;This is inert gas. Odorless, non-toxic, colourless, stable, non-inflammable and&lt;br /&gt;density is more hence high dielectric strength. The special property of this gas is&lt;br /&gt;Electro negativity. This gas attracts electrons to form –ve ions and –ve ion are havier&lt;br /&gt;than electrons and more slow in conduction, so that resistance in medium is increases&lt;br /&gt;and get arc get extinguishes.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 373 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 374 -&lt;br /&gt;CABLES&lt;br /&gt;• What are the purposes of cable trays?&lt;br /&gt;a. Avoid sagging of cables&lt;br /&gt;b. Give mechanical support&lt;br /&gt;• What are the disadvantages of paper insulation?&lt;br /&gt;a. Absorbs moisture.&lt;br /&gt;b. Cable termination/sealing problems.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the advantages of XLPE?&lt;br /&gt;a. Easy routing at heights&lt;br /&gt;b. Easy maintenance&lt;br /&gt;c. Large current (90 ºC)&lt;br /&gt;d. No sheath (no fatigue)&lt;br /&gt;e. No paper tape wrapping technique&lt;br /&gt;f. High dielectric strength&lt;br /&gt;g. Very little deformation even at high temp,&lt;br /&gt;h. More rated current, overload, short ckt capacity&lt;br /&gt;i. Low tan delta and hence suits long routes&lt;br /&gt;j. Very light&lt;br /&gt;k. Good mechanical properties.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the specified cable life?&lt;br /&gt;50 years.&lt;br /&gt;• How armours /sheaths grounded?&lt;br /&gt;1 core cables -- sheaths/shields/armours grounded at one end only, other end&lt;br /&gt;insulated to prevent the circulating current through sheaths.&lt;br /&gt;3 core cables -- grounded at both ends but not including core balance CT’s, since&lt;br /&gt;even small induced current causes 50N operation.&lt;br /&gt;• Why armouring done?&lt;br /&gt;For mechanical strength, protect against damage by impact of an object.&lt;br /&gt;• How the required conductor size can be reduced by use of HRC fuses?&lt;br /&gt;HRC fuse limits the peak amplitude of fault current. HRC fuse melts at prospective&lt;br /&gt;current but not allows circuit to pass their high rupturing capacity that is it’s kA.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 375 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the types of cables used in 6.6 kV and 415 V system voltages?&lt;br /&gt;In 6.6 kV system AC (unearthed) grade having stranded aluminium conductors&lt;br /&gt;cables are used. Their insulation’s are as follows.&lt;br /&gt;1. XLPE – Crossed linked polyethylene insulation.&lt;br /&gt;2. FRLS PVC – Fire retardant low smoke insulation with PVC inner and outer&lt;br /&gt;insulation. In RB copper conductor stranded cables are used.&lt;br /&gt;3. FS – fire survival insulation.&lt;br /&gt;4. HR PVC – heat resistant insulation.&lt;br /&gt;In 415 V system 1100 V grade copper or aluminium stranded cables are used. Their&lt;br /&gt;insulations are HR PVC and FS type.&lt;br /&gt;• At what temperature cables are rated?&lt;br /&gt;Normally cables are rated for 40°C&lt;br /&gt;Maximum temp in °C Short time temp in °C&lt;br /&gt;PVC 70 160&lt;br /&gt;HRPVC 85 160&lt;br /&gt;Fire survival 90 250&lt;br /&gt;Silicon rubber 90 250&lt;br /&gt;XLPE cable 90 250&lt;br /&gt;• Why 1.1 kV grade cables used for 415V?&lt;br /&gt;To take care of the both earthed / unearthed systems.&lt;br /&gt;• While carrying out cable joints, why should we ensure the continuity of 1) metallised&lt;br /&gt;paper for PILC, 2) sheath and armour.&lt;br /&gt;Continuity of metallised paper ensures less voltage gradient, hence preventing&lt;br /&gt;puncture of insulation.&lt;br /&gt;Continuity of sheath / armour ensures that grounding is maintained, so no over&lt;br /&gt;voltage is induced, and easy to detect earthfault in cables.&lt;br /&gt;• Why bimetallic washers provided in aluminium copper transition joints?&lt;br /&gt;To avoid galvanic corrosion failure.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the type cable used in radiation areas?&lt;br /&gt;Mineral insulated (MI) cables.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 376 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 377 -&lt;br /&gt;EMTR AND AUTO TRANSFER&lt;br /&gt;• What is meant by EMTR?&lt;br /&gt;In case of normal supply failure to CL-III &amp;amp; CL-II the loads will be fed by the&lt;br /&gt;alternative/standby sources. This changeover of supply is called Emergency&lt;br /&gt;Transfer.&lt;br /&gt;• How EMTR is initiated?&lt;br /&gt;EMTR is initiated on sensing the CL-III &amp;amp; CL-II bus under voltage.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the routes of EMTR?&lt;br /&gt;CL-III bus under voltage. The DG’s will start. All the breakers connected to the&lt;br /&gt;affected bus will trip. DG breaker will close on dead bus. Loads will be restored one&lt;br /&gt;by one.&lt;br /&gt;CL-II bus under voltage. The tie breaker of the affected bus will close.&lt;br /&gt;• What does load-shedding mean?&lt;br /&gt;When there is only one source to feed the two buses, the total loads can not be fed by&lt;br /&gt;this single source. Hence some of the less important load will not be allowed to start&lt;br /&gt;or it will be tripped if it is running.&lt;br /&gt;• What does total load-shedding mean?&lt;br /&gt;Even after the load shedding the is continue to deliver more than the rated power&lt;br /&gt;sensed by overpower relay or running with under frequency sensed by the under&lt;br /&gt;frequency relay the total load shedding will take place. In case of auxiliary&lt;br /&gt;transformer is feeding the total load shedding will take place after 4 minutes.&lt;br /&gt;• What does auto transfer mean?&lt;br /&gt;If one of the sources is tripped on main protection its breaker will be tripped and the&lt;br /&gt;tie-breaker will close. This transfer of supply from one source to other source is&lt;br /&gt;called auto transfer. To restore the class IV whenever the UT or SUT is lost Auto&lt;br /&gt;transfer is provided.&lt;br /&gt;• Why auto transfer is prevented if the backup protection is operated?&lt;br /&gt;The back up protection is supposed to operate in case of a bus fault. Hence the auto&lt;br /&gt;transfer is prevented.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the types Auto transfer scheme?&lt;br /&gt;1. Fast transfer scheme to close the tie-breaker in less than 200 milli seconds. This&lt;br /&gt;limits transient current and voltage dip in the bus and does quick acceleration of&lt;br /&gt;the motors.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 378 -&lt;br /&gt;2. Slow transfer after 200 milli seconds.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 379 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the conditions for Auto transfer scheme?&lt;br /&gt;Backup protections are not allowed to initiate the Auto transfer. Because under&lt;br /&gt;voltage may exist in the bus. Similarly protection in LV of the transformers are not&lt;br /&gt;initiating the Auto transfer scheme. There are three metrics used in Auto transfer&lt;br /&gt;scheme and 2/3 logic is adopted.&lt;br /&gt;Conditions&lt;br /&gt;1. Fault generator (86BG or 86A1).&lt;br /&gt;2. Fault in UT.&lt;br /&gt;3. Fault in GT.&lt;br /&gt;4. Fault in 220 kV bus (SUT).&lt;br /&gt;5. Fault in SUT (86M).&lt;br /&gt;• What are the uses of EMTR scheme?&lt;br /&gt;1. To restore class III when class IV supply fails.&lt;br /&gt;2. To extend supply to class II when UPS fails.&lt;br /&gt;3. In one DG condition to load restoration.&lt;br /&gt;4. Sub sequent restoration of large motor loads.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the sequences of motor load restoration in EMTR?&lt;br /&gt;1. AHPPW –1001 - 4 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;2. APWC – 1003 - 8 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;3. APWC – 1004 - 12 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;4. AHPPW –1002 - 16 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;5. PPP – 1001 - 20 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;6. MOD – 1002 - 24 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;7. MOD – 1001 - 28 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;8. Air Comp – 1002 - 32 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;9. ABFP – 1006 - 36 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;10. 7343 Exst Fan 1003 - 40 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;11. ECCS PM 1001 - 44 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;12. ECCS PM 1002 - 48 Sec.&lt;br /&gt;• Why synchronizing scheme has been adopted? What are interlocks provided?&lt;br /&gt;To check running and incoming buses, which are going to be interconnected are in&lt;br /&gt;synchronism with each other.&lt;br /&gt;Interlocks&lt;br /&gt;1. Synch selector.&lt;br /&gt;2. Only one breaker can operate at a time.&lt;br /&gt;3. Master synch relay contact should available (bypass will bypass this synch&lt;br /&gt;contact).&lt;br /&gt;Bypass facility is provided to close the breaker on dead bus only.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 380 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the settings provided in synchronizing scheme (SKE Relay)?&lt;br /&gt;Voltage – V1- V2 = 10%&lt;br /&gt;Frequency – t = 0.05 Sec (2.5 Hz)&lt;br /&gt;% Slip – 0.45&lt;br /&gt;Phase angle difference - 20°.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 381 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the major losses in nuclear power generating system?&lt;br /&gt;Condenser - 500 MW.&lt;br /&gt;Moderator - 40 MW.&lt;br /&gt;C/V and E/S system - 3.7 MW.&lt;br /&gt;• Give the specification of DG and NGR of DG.&lt;br /&gt;DG specification&lt;br /&gt;Type HSPTL 12/653 synchronous generator.&lt;br /&gt;KVA 2815&lt;br /&gt;Volts 6600 V&lt;br /&gt;Amps 246 A&lt;br /&gt;Phase 3&lt;br /&gt;Frequency 50 Hz&lt;br /&gt;Insulation Class-F&lt;br /&gt;PF 0.8&lt;br /&gt;Duty S1&lt;br /&gt;IC 01&lt;br /&gt;IP 23&lt;br /&gt;RPM 1000&lt;br /&gt;Exciter 110 V, 3.2 A (Brush – less of permanent magnet, electronic&lt;br /&gt;automatic voltage regulator)&lt;br /&gt;Ambient temp 50°C&lt;br /&gt;NGR specification&lt;br /&gt;Resistance at 20°C 95.3Ω&lt;br /&gt;Voltage 6.6 kV/√3&lt;br /&gt;Insulation class 7.2 kV&lt;br /&gt;Transient current 40 A / second.&lt;br /&gt;Continuous rating 10 Amps.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the operational requirement of DG’s?&lt;br /&gt;1. Whenever class IV fails DG sets (2 + 1 standby) are started by EMTR and capable&lt;br /&gt;of restoring class III loads within 30 Seconds. One example is given below.&lt;br /&gt;Event Minutes Seconds Milli seconds Difference&lt;br /&gt;Class IV fail 00 00 280 00:00:280&lt;br /&gt;EMTR initiate 00 01 303 00:01:023&lt;br /&gt;DG start (1, 2, 3) 00 01 336 00:00:033&lt;br /&gt;Voltage, Speed reached 00 07 257 00:05:921&lt;br /&gt;CB 351, 361, 370 Closed 00 07 491 00:00:234&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 382 -&lt;br /&gt;Restoration will be done in 07 seconds and 491 milli seconds. After this to build up&lt;br /&gt;power and frequency it takes about 1 minute 26 seconds and 852 milli seconds. Then&lt;br /&gt;load restoration starts as per EMTR scheme.&lt;br /&gt;2. DG’s are capable of paralleling with 6.6 kV class IV supplies.&lt;br /&gt;3. DG’s are capable of paralleling with each other.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 383 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the design criteria’s of DG’s?&lt;br /&gt;1. 4000 starts and 4000 hrs run at full load for lifetime.&lt;br /&gt;2. Operation at 45°C and high atmospheric condition.&lt;br /&gt;3. Designed to run in earthquake and seismic condition.&lt;br /&gt;4. Designed to start as per EMTR scheme and take load as per EMTR and load&lt;br /&gt;shedding scheme in one-DG condition without drop in voltage or frequency 25%&lt;br /&gt;and 5% respectively.&lt;br /&gt;5. Designed for run in high speed and to build up voltage and speed within 10&lt;br /&gt;seconds.&lt;br /&gt;6. Designed to start and loading with external row water for cooling for 3 minutes.&lt;br /&gt;7. Designed to start at normal and load condition temperature.&lt;br /&gt;8. Designed to run at no load for 4 hrs in a 4 months with affecting the load and over&lt;br /&gt;load.&lt;br /&gt;9. Designed to supply power in one-DG condition.&lt;br /&gt;10. Continuous supply is 2250 kW and can run at 2475 kW for 2 hrs in 24 hrs at 6.6&lt;br /&gt;kV and 0.8 PF.&lt;br /&gt;11. Designed to start and stop at 48 V DC supply and stop at 220 V DC in the case of&lt;br /&gt;48 V DC is not available.&lt;br /&gt;12. DG – 3 is physically separated for control and installed at adjacent unit. Because&lt;br /&gt;in case of unit is not avail then for cooling water is available in other unit.&lt;br /&gt;13. Monorail of 3 Ton is provided.&lt;br /&gt;14. Provisions are made for filtered air and ventilation and combustion.&lt;br /&gt;15. Co2 fire fighting system is provided for smoothening effect in case of fire.&lt;br /&gt;16. Active process water from class III is provided.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the auxiliaries required for DG?&lt;br /&gt;1. Starting air system.&lt;br /&gt;Components are compressor, air dryer, air receiver, solenoid valve for start&lt;br /&gt;control, pneumatic starting air valve, air distributor and injection valve at each&lt;br /&gt;cylinder.&lt;br /&gt;This system operates at high pressure and also provided with soft start of 8-bar&lt;br /&gt;pressure in testing of system periodically.&lt;br /&gt;2. Lub oil system.&lt;br /&gt;This is closed loop of having oil sump of capacity of 7 days at full load. This also&lt;br /&gt;supplies oil to bearing lubrication, crankshaft, piston, and wiper.&lt;br /&gt;This closed loop Circuit includes pre-lubricating circuit and normal lubricating&lt;br /&gt;circuit. Pre- lubricating circuit is controlled by PLC, but at first commissioning&lt;br /&gt;and overhauling pre-lub start immediately.&lt;br /&gt;3. Water cooling system.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 384 -&lt;br /&gt;This is provided with closed loop fresh water for remove heat from lubricating oil&lt;br /&gt;system, charge air cooler, engine components (cylinder lines, cylinder head etc).&lt;br /&gt;Fresh water chemistry is controlled to avoid organic growth and corrosion. This&lt;br /&gt;water is heated for normal operation to avoid thermal shock. This water is cooled&lt;br /&gt;by active process water. One tank is provided to transfer fresh water to the&lt;br /&gt;system. Before transferring fresh water chemical addition should be done.&lt;br /&gt;4. Fuel oil system.&lt;br /&gt;The engine driven fuel oil pump is flooded with fuel oil from the day tank by&lt;br /&gt;gravity. Low-pressure fuel from fuel pump is supplied to individual injection&lt;br /&gt;pump is injected to individual cylinders through injectors.&lt;br /&gt;5. Combustion air and exhaust gas system.&lt;br /&gt;The engine is supplied by compressed combustion air with the help of exhaust gas&lt;br /&gt;driver Turbo – charger. Each bank cylinder is provided with a Turbo – charger.&lt;br /&gt;Turbo – charger is provided with filters. The exhaust is passes through silencer.&lt;br /&gt;6. Speed governing system.&lt;br /&gt;Governer is hydraulic mechanical type. The governer is linked to the fuel racks.&lt;br /&gt;The maximum work output of the UG – 8 governer is 8 lb – ft over the full 42°&lt;br /&gt;travel. For full load 30°is sufficient and remaining for overloading.&lt;br /&gt;Governer comprises&lt;br /&gt;a. Speed droop setting.&lt;br /&gt;b. Oil sight glass.&lt;br /&gt;c. Load limiter&lt;br /&gt;d. Compensation pointer and adjuster.&lt;br /&gt;e. Local speed adjuster.&lt;br /&gt;7. Two numbers of ventillation fans are provided in each DG building. One starts at&lt;br /&gt;respective DG breaker close and other at &gt;45°C. DG room is provided with 7&lt;br /&gt;numbers of smoke detectors (ionized type) and 7 numbers of flame detectors&lt;br /&gt;(photoelectric type).&lt;br /&gt;8. Separate DG’s are having separate MCC for their auxiliaries power supply. For&lt;br /&gt;DG – 1 auxiliaries MCC P1. For DG – 2 auxiliaries MCC Q1 and for DG – 3&lt;br /&gt;MCC DG – 3 is provided.&lt;br /&gt;9. Phase winding is provided with two RTD’s for hotspot measurement and bearing&lt;br /&gt;provided with one RTD each.&lt;br /&gt;10. LCP is provided one each for each DG.&lt;br /&gt;• When DG’s start is not possible?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 385 -&lt;br /&gt;1. DG trip.&lt;br /&gt;2. Turning gear engaged.&lt;br /&gt;3. DG set stop push button pressed.&lt;br /&gt;• What are stages of DG starting?&lt;br /&gt;1. At start signal compressed air through solenoid valve passes over piston and&lt;br /&gt;rotates the shaft.&lt;br /&gt;2. At speed &gt;60-rpm ignition starts.&lt;br /&gt;3. Closing of excitation starts at &gt;800-rpm.&lt;br /&gt;4. At speed of &gt; 900-rpm rated speed and rated voltage signal starts.&lt;br /&gt;5. Closing of over speed is at &gt;1150-rpm.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 386 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the protections provided for DG?&lt;br /&gt;1. Differential protection (87).&lt;br /&gt;2. Over speed of engine.&lt;br /&gt;3. Reverse power protection (in LOCA condition time delay).&lt;br /&gt;4. Low lubricating oil pressure.&lt;br /&gt;5. Cooling water temperature high.&lt;br /&gt;6. 6.6 kV switchgear protections.&lt;br /&gt;7. Excitation failure.&lt;br /&gt;8. Emergency stops push button.&lt;br /&gt;In LOCA condition 4 – 8 protections are not permitted to operate.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 387 -&lt;br /&gt;Electronics&lt;br /&gt;• What is Diode?&lt;br /&gt;Diode is a two-layer semiconductor device, conducts only positive cycles when&lt;br /&gt;applied to anode.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Thyristor?&lt;br /&gt;Thyristor is a four or more layer semiconductor device &amp;amp; having 3 or more&lt;br /&gt;junctions. It is also called Silicon Controlled Rectifiers (SCR). A healthy SCR must&lt;br /&gt;block in both the directions at least 1MΩ resistance, a fused SCR will conducts in&lt;br /&gt;both directions.&lt;br /&gt;• What is material used in making semiconductor?&lt;br /&gt;Silicon &amp;amp; Germanium are the raw materials used for making semiconductor.&lt;br /&gt;Semiconductors are located between conductors &amp;amp; insulators in the resistivity&lt;br /&gt;spectrum &amp;amp; allow current to flow only under certain conditions.&lt;br /&gt;• What is material used in making non-linear resistor &amp;amp; purpose of it in field discharge&lt;br /&gt;resistor?&lt;br /&gt;Silicon carbide materials used for making non-linear resistor. The purpose of this&lt;br /&gt;resistor is to avoid surge voltage when field breaker opens. These resistors are&lt;br /&gt;connected in parallel to the main field winding (Rotor).&lt;br /&gt;• How over voltage is produced in Field breaker?&lt;br /&gt;Over voltages appear if synchronous generators and motors fall out of step inducing&lt;br /&gt;an AC voltage in the field system. Depending on the type of construction of the&lt;br /&gt;machine and the slip this voltage can become un-permissibly high, for this purpose&lt;br /&gt;over voltage protectors are provided in the field breaker cubicle.&lt;br /&gt;• What is firing angle?&lt;br /&gt;The angle in the AC cycle at which the thyristor starts conducting at the application&lt;br /&gt;of positive voltage to gate is known as the firing angle (α)&lt;br /&gt;• What is Inverter operation?&lt;br /&gt;When firing angle a = 90º the positive &amp;amp; negative voltages areas are equal. With a&lt;br /&gt;higher than 90º the negative areas are greater so the total voltage becomes negative.&lt;br /&gt;This condition is termed as &#39;Inverter Operation&quot;.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the purpose of RC network across thyristor?&lt;br /&gt;RC network across each thyristor protects against Hole Storage Effect.&lt;br /&gt;• Why reactors are provided in Thyristor bridges?&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 388 -&lt;br /&gt;Reactors are provided to limit the rate of rise of current (di/dt) in the device, thereby&lt;br /&gt;avoiding possible damage to the device. They also effect a proper sharing of load&lt;br /&gt;among thyristor bridges when connected in parallel.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 389 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is purpose of connecting thyristor bridges in parallel?&lt;br /&gt;Thyristor bridges are connected in parallel to improve current rating.&lt;br /&gt;• What is purpose of Load angle limiter?&lt;br /&gt;Load angle limiter, it either limits the angle between grid load center and the rotor&lt;br /&gt;axis or generator terminal &amp;amp; rotor axis.&lt;br /&gt;• What is purpose of Rotor angle limiter?&lt;br /&gt;It limits generator voltage &amp;amp; rotor voltage.&lt;br /&gt;• What is purpose of Rotor current limiter?&lt;br /&gt;It limits overloading of rotor.&lt;br /&gt;• What is purpose of Stator current limiter?&lt;br /&gt;It limits the stator current.&lt;br /&gt;• What is purpose of Slip stabilization?&lt;br /&gt;It avoids oscillation of the AC machine (Rotor oscillations).&lt;br /&gt;• What is purpose of reactive power (VAR)?&lt;br /&gt;It is an energy required to built up magnetic field to drive the power.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the advantage of Static Excitation?&lt;br /&gt;Fast response time, high reliability, interchangeability of parts during operation, less&lt;br /&gt;wear &amp;amp; tear due to static devices &amp;amp; less maintenance.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the advantage of field forcing in the rotor?&lt;br /&gt;Field forcing acts for 10 seconds to maintain the generator terminal voltage during&lt;br /&gt;fault condition so as to operated the protection relays.&lt;br /&gt;• When the negative sequence reactance arises?&lt;br /&gt;Negative sequence arises whenever there is any unbalance present in the system.&lt;br /&gt;Their effect is to set up a field rotating in opposite direction to the main field.&lt;br /&gt;• When the Zero sequence reactance arises?&lt;br /&gt;If a machine is operating with an earthed neutral, a system earth fault will give rise to&lt;br /&gt;zero sequence current in the machine.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 390 -&lt;br /&gt;Basic Electricity&lt;br /&gt;• What is Current?&lt;br /&gt;The flow of electrons in a circuit is called current, it is measured in Amperes (I).&lt;br /&gt;• What is Voltage?&lt;br /&gt;Voltage is the difference in potential (charge) between two points or voltage is the&lt;br /&gt;amount of driving force or pressure applied to a circuit, it is measured in Volts (V).&lt;br /&gt;• What is Resistance?&lt;br /&gt;The resistance of a circuit is the circuit&#39;s opposition to the movement of electrons. A&lt;br /&gt;resistor restricts or limits the amount of current flowing in a electrical circuit, it is&lt;br /&gt;measured in Ohm (Ω).&lt;br /&gt;Series Resistor: When resistors are connected in series they have one point in&lt;br /&gt;common. The total resistance is equal to the sum of the individual resistors.&lt;br /&gt;R tot = R1 + R2 + R3&lt;br /&gt;The current in a series circuit is the same in each component of the circuit because&lt;br /&gt;the current must flow through each resistor in series to get to the next resistor.&lt;br /&gt;I tot = I1 = I2 = I3&lt;br /&gt;The applied voltage divides across each component in a circuit in proportion to the&lt;br /&gt;resistance of the component. V tot = V1 + V2 + V3&lt;br /&gt;Parallel Resistor: When resistors are connected in parallel, they have two points in&lt;br /&gt;common. The total resistance of parallel resistors is equal to the reciprocal of the&lt;br /&gt;sum of the reciprocal of the individual resistors. R tot of a parallel circuit is called the&lt;br /&gt;equivalent resistance,&lt;br /&gt;R eq = 1&lt;br /&gt;1/R&lt;br /&gt;1&lt;br /&gt;+ 1/R&lt;br /&gt;2&lt;br /&gt;+1/R&lt;br /&gt;3&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 391 -&lt;br /&gt;• Why color-coding is necessary for resistor?&lt;br /&gt;A wide variety of resistors are physically large enough to have their resistance value&lt;br /&gt;printed on them. However, carbon composition resistors are too small for this&lt;br /&gt;method of identification so a color coding system is used. Four bands are printed on&lt;br /&gt;one end of the resistor and are read from the band closest to the end of the resistor&lt;br /&gt;toward the center. Each color represents a numerical value as indicated below.&lt;br /&gt;0- Black 3- Orange 6- Blue 9- White ±5% - Gold } Tolerance&lt;br /&gt;1- Brown 4- Yellow 7- Violet 0.1- Gold ±10% - Silver }&lt;br /&gt;2- Red 5- Green 8- Grey 0.01- Silver&lt;br /&gt;Suppose the color bands of a resistor are yellow, violet, red and gold. The resistance&lt;br /&gt;value is determined as follows:&lt;br /&gt;4 7 00 = 4700Ω&lt;br /&gt;Yellow = 4&lt;br /&gt;Violet = 7&lt;br /&gt;Red = 2 (two zeros)&lt;br /&gt;Gold = ±5%&lt;br /&gt;4700+5% = 4935} The actual resistance should be between 4467 and 4935 ohms.&lt;br /&gt;4700-5% = 4465}&lt;br /&gt;Occasionally a fifth band is used to indicate the failure rate of the resistor:&lt;br /&gt;Yellow 0.001% per 1000 hours&lt;br /&gt;Orange 0.01% per 1000 hours&lt;br /&gt;Red 0.1% per 1000 hours&lt;br /&gt;Brown 1.0% per 1000 hours&lt;br /&gt;• What does Ohm&#39;s Law states?&lt;br /&gt;In a closed electrical circuit, current is directly proportional to voltage and inversely&lt;br /&gt;proportional to resistance at constant temperature.&lt;br /&gt;I= V/R. Where I= Current, V= Voltage &amp;amp; R= Resistance&lt;br /&gt;• What does Kirchhoff&#39;s voltage law states?&lt;br /&gt;Kirchhoff&#39;s voltage law states that &quot; the algebraic sum of potential rises and drops&lt;br /&gt;around a closed loop is zero.&quot; Σ􀀴V= 0&lt;br /&gt;• What does Kirchhoff&#39;s current law states?&lt;br /&gt;Kirchhoff&#39;s current law states that &quot; the algebraic sum of current entering and leaving&lt;br /&gt;a node is zero.&quot; (A node is a junction of two or more branches.)&lt;br /&gt;• What is a Capacitor?&lt;br /&gt;When two conductors are placed side by side, separated by a nonconductive&lt;br /&gt;material, and connected across a battery, free electrons drift in the direction of the&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 392 -&lt;br /&gt;driving voltage is called capacitor. Its unit is farad, normally in micro farad (μf) or&lt;br /&gt;Pico farad (pf).&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 393 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is Inductor?&lt;br /&gt;Inductors use the ability of electrical current to create a magnetic field. If a voltage is&lt;br /&gt;applied to a coil of wire, the current flowing in the coil will cause a magnetic field to&lt;br /&gt;develop. The more times the wire is coiled and the more current there is in the coil,&lt;br /&gt;the greater the strength of the magnetic field. Its unit is Henry, normally in milli&lt;br /&gt;Henry (mH).&lt;br /&gt;• What is Inductance?&lt;br /&gt;The property of a coil that opposes a change in the current flow is called inductance.&lt;br /&gt;The inductance of a coil depends on four factors:&lt;br /&gt;1) The number of turns (windings) in the coil. Inductance is proportional to the&lt;br /&gt;square of the number of turns in the coil.&lt;br /&gt;2) The diameter of the coil. The larger the diameter of the coil, the higher the&lt;br /&gt;inductance.&lt;br /&gt;3) The permeability (ability to become magnetized) of the core material.&lt;br /&gt;4) The length of the coil. The shorter the coil, the higher the inductance.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Power?&lt;br /&gt;Power is a rate of doing work, or works done per unit in time. The unit for measuring&lt;br /&gt;power is the Watt (W). Power in watts is equal to the product of the applied voltage&lt;br /&gt;and the current flowing. Stated algebraically, P = I E&lt;br /&gt;• What is Alternating Current?&lt;br /&gt;Continually changing amount and direction of the current and voltage is called&lt;br /&gt;alternating current (AC). The components of an ac circuit causes a time period to be&lt;br /&gt;introduced between current and voltage; that is, current and voltage are out of phase.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 394 -&lt;br /&gt;Few definitions and symbols used in alternating current&lt;br /&gt;1) Amplitude or peak value: The maximum value reached by a waveform.&lt;br /&gt;2) Capacitive reactance (XC): measured in ohms, is the opposition to a change in&lt;br /&gt;current flow provided by a capacitor. Capacitive reactance causes current to lead&lt;br /&gt;voltage by 90°: Xc = 1/2p f C.&lt;br /&gt;3) Cycle: The portion of a waveform contained in one period of time.&lt;br /&gt;4) Effective value: The value of voltage that occurs at 45° (0.7071 times the&lt;br /&gt;maximum value).&lt;br /&gt;5) Frequency: The number of cycles per second is called frequency and measured in&lt;br /&gt;Hertz (Hz).&lt;br /&gt;6) Impedance (Z): The opposition to current flow in an ac circuit. It is a combination&lt;br /&gt;of resistance, Inductance and capacitance.&lt;br /&gt;7) Inductive Reactance (XL): Inductive reactance, measured in ohms, is the&lt;br /&gt;opposition to a change in current flow produced by a coil of wire. Inductive&lt;br /&gt;reactance causes current to lag voltage by 90° : XL = 1/2π f L.&lt;br /&gt;8) Instantaneous value: The magnitude of a waveform at any instant of time.&lt;br /&gt;9) Period (T): The time interval between successive repetitions of a periodic&lt;br /&gt;waveform.&lt;br /&gt;10) Periodic waveform: A waveform that continually repeats itself after the same&lt;br /&gt;time interval.&lt;br /&gt;11) Resistance: the opposition of a circuit to the movement of electrons. Resistance&lt;br /&gt;in an ac circuit acts the same as resistance in dc circuit.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 395 -&lt;br /&gt;Measuring Instruments&lt;br /&gt;• What is Voltmeter?&lt;br /&gt;It is an instrument to measure voltage. It is always connected in parallel to the power&lt;br /&gt;supply.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Ammeter?&lt;br /&gt;It is an instrument to measure the current flowing in a circuit. It is always connected&lt;br /&gt;in series with the load.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Megger?&lt;br /&gt;The megohmmeter, commonly called a megger for short, is used to measure very&lt;br /&gt;high resistance values. It is primarily used to test the insulation of conductors. To&lt;br /&gt;measure high resistance values, a high voltage is applied, either by the use of a handcranked&lt;br /&gt;generator or electronic power supply.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Clamp-On Ammeter?&lt;br /&gt;Clamp-on ammeter is used to check the current in a circuit, without being physically&lt;br /&gt;connected in a circuit. They are convenient to use in the field since the circuit does&lt;br /&gt;not have to be opened to take a current reading.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Infrared or Thermal scanner?&lt;br /&gt;Infrared or thermal scanners are used to measure temperature without contact with&lt;br /&gt;the equipment. They produce an image of the component showing temperature&lt;br /&gt;variations, this is effective in spotting worn or loose connections and components in&lt;br /&gt;industrial circuits.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Phase sequence indicator?&lt;br /&gt;Phase sequence indicator used to indicate the 3-phase direction- comes in two styles;&lt;br /&gt;Lights and meters. In the lighted variety, a sequence of light goes on for the phase&lt;br /&gt;sequence being read, while the meter indicates which phase direction it is reading.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Rotation tester?&lt;br /&gt;This device is used during the installation of a motor to determine the direction of the&lt;br /&gt;motor once it is installed. The shaft is mechanically rotated in the desired direction&lt;br /&gt;and the meter indicates if that is the direction in which the motor will rotate.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 396 -&lt;br /&gt;DC Machines&lt;br /&gt;Conversion of one form of energy into another enables us to use natural power&lt;br /&gt;sources as well as manufactured power sources to produce our electrical power&lt;br /&gt;supply. Although electricity can be produced by friction, pressure, heat, light,&lt;br /&gt;chemical action and magnetism, the most common method used by large power&lt;br /&gt;producers is magnetism.&lt;br /&gt;• What is Electric Generator?&lt;br /&gt;Electric generators are called a dynamo that converts mechanical energy into&lt;br /&gt;electrical energy. A dynamo consists of two basic parts- the stationary part and the&lt;br /&gt;rotating part.&lt;br /&gt;• How electromotive force is created in a generator?&lt;br /&gt;When a conductor cuts the magnetic lines of forces, an Electro motive force (emf) is&lt;br /&gt;generated.&lt;br /&gt;The magnitude of the generated voltage is directly proportional to the rate of change&lt;br /&gt;at which a conductor cuts the magnetic lines of force.&lt;br /&gt;• What is DC motor?&lt;br /&gt;An electric motor converts electrical energy in to mechanical energy.&lt;br /&gt;• How many types of DC motors are there?&lt;br /&gt;DC shunt motor: shunt motor speed varies slightly from no load to full load.&lt;br /&gt;DC series motor: series motor speed varies greatly as load changes.&lt;br /&gt;DC compound motor: the compound motor contains both a shunt field and a series&lt;br /&gt;field and therefore has characteristics between the shunt and the series motors. This&lt;br /&gt;motor has the good starting torque characteristics provided by the series field, while&lt;br /&gt;the shunt field provides for a relatively constant speed.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 397 -&lt;br /&gt;Maintenance &amp;amp; Troubleshooting&lt;br /&gt;• Troubleshooting is a field if repair work that usually tells how well the student&lt;br /&gt;has learned the lessons. The principles involved in control functions, components&lt;br /&gt;and circuit analysis, along with the basic laws of electricity.&lt;br /&gt;• Your best tool when troubleshooting is your ability of think. Don&#39;t jump to&lt;br /&gt;conclusions. Have confidence in your ability. Learn how the equipment in your&lt;br /&gt;area is supposed to operate both electrically and mechanically.&lt;br /&gt;• Observe all plant rules and regulations. Electricity can be dangerous. In addition&lt;br /&gt;to the hazards of electrical shock and electrocution, burns from an electrical flash&lt;br /&gt;can be devastating. Be careful when opening the circuit. The inductive kick that&lt;br /&gt;can occur when a circuit opens produces a voltage that is many times the voltage&lt;br /&gt;applied to the system.&lt;br /&gt;• No matter how complex or expensive an electrical control system is, the&lt;br /&gt;components of the system begin to deteriorate as soon as they are installed and&lt;br /&gt;failure of some components in the system will ultimately result.&lt;br /&gt;• Blown fuses, overload contacts, open contacts, short circuits, burned out coils and&lt;br /&gt;grounds are responsible for most electrical circuit failures.&lt;br /&gt;• Troubleshooting can be generalized in 3 steps:&lt;br /&gt;1) Determine the symptoms; that is, find out how it acts. (When equipment is&lt;br /&gt;operating properly, you should find out how it is supposed to function.)&lt;br /&gt;2) Decide by logical reasoning what might be wrong. (Try to isolate the problem&lt;br /&gt;to a section of the control.)&lt;br /&gt;3) Determine what has to be done to correct the problem.&lt;br /&gt;• If we are troubleshooting an existing circuit, one that has been in service and&lt;br /&gt;operated properly, we can eliminate the possibility of fault installations or design.&lt;br /&gt;• The first step- determine the symptoms- can best be accomplished by working&lt;br /&gt;with the machine operator and following the machine through its sequence to the&lt;br /&gt;point of failure.&lt;br /&gt;• Remember that no matter how complex, control circuit are made up of only two&lt;br /&gt;things. Contacts that open and close a circuit and coils that operate the contacts,&lt;br /&gt;keeping in mind the control voltage.&lt;br /&gt;• Probably the single most important rule in trouble shooting is to remember to&lt;br /&gt;change only one thing at a time.&lt;br /&gt;• Remember the operator knows the machine operation and can be an asset to you&lt;br /&gt;in your troubleshooting. Question the operator but don&#39;t challenge his operating&lt;br /&gt;ability.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 398 -&lt;br /&gt;• Anyone attempting to troubleshoot without a drawing and a meter is wasting the&lt;br /&gt;time.&lt;br /&gt;• Instead of random checking the circuit; start from the source to the machine or&lt;br /&gt;from the machine to the source.&lt;br /&gt;• Finally take time to think.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 399 -&lt;br /&gt;Radiation Protection&lt;br /&gt;Fission reaction&lt;br /&gt;92U235&lt;br /&gt;0n1&lt;br /&gt;54Xe144 + 38Sr90 + neutron + radiation + Energy&lt;br /&gt;Tritium formation&lt;br /&gt;1H2&lt;br /&gt;0n1&lt;br /&gt;1H3&lt;br /&gt;1 Seivert = 100 Rem&lt;br /&gt;Annual Dose Limit (ADL) = 20 mSev or 2 Rem for Employees.&lt;br /&gt;Annual Dose Limit (ADL) = 1 5 mSev or 1.5 Rem for Contractor.&lt;br /&gt;Annual Dose Limit (ADL) = 1 mSev or 100 mRem for Public.&lt;br /&gt;5 Years = 100 mSev or 10 Rem&lt;br /&gt;DAC (Derived Air concentration)&lt;br /&gt;&gt;10 DAC use tritium bottles&lt;br /&gt;10-15 DAC use airline&lt;br /&gt;&gt;50 DAC use ventilated plastic suite (VP suite)&lt;br /&gt;1 DAC for 1 hour = 0.01 mSev or 1 mRem.&lt;br /&gt;• Why no entry for Moderator room &amp;amp; Pump room during operating condition?&lt;br /&gt;Due to the presence of N16 &amp;amp; O17, which are high gamma emitter, their field is&lt;br /&gt;around 7 mev.&lt;br /&gt;• What are the gases discharged to the stack?&lt;br /&gt;Argon-41, Tritium, fission products, noble gases &amp;amp; Iodine particulates.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 400 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the emergencies provided in the plant?&lt;br /&gt;Plant Emergency: Excessive release of radioactive material or high radiation fields in&lt;br /&gt;a section of the plant&lt;br /&gt;Site Emergency: Uncontrolled release of radioactive material or high radiation fields&lt;br /&gt;with in the site boundary&lt;br /&gt;Off- Site Emergency: High release of radioactive material from the plant resulting in&lt;br /&gt;significantly increased radiation fields and/or contamination levels extending to&lt;br /&gt;areas outside the site&lt;br /&gt;Emergency Planning Zones (EPZ): Emergency planning zone, defined around the&lt;br /&gt;plant up to 16 km, provides a basic geographic frame work for decision making&lt;br /&gt;on implementing measures as part of a graded response in the event of an&lt;br /&gt;emergency. The area around the Kaiga generating station is divided into the&lt;br /&gt;following Zones up to 16 km radius.&lt;br /&gt;Exclusion Zone: The exclusion Zone extends up to a distance of 1.6 km around the&lt;br /&gt;central plant zone of 0.7 km where no public habitation is permitted. This zone is&lt;br /&gt;physically isolated from out side areas by plant fencing and is under the control of&lt;br /&gt;Kaiga Generating Station.&lt;br /&gt;Sterilised Zone: Sterilised zone is an area where no new growth of population is&lt;br /&gt;permitted. Natural growth is however allowed in this Zone. This are extends up to&lt;br /&gt;a radius of 5 km from the central plant Zone. This Zone is defined to restrict the&lt;br /&gt;population to an easily transportable number in case of an emergency.&lt;br /&gt;Primary Zone: The primary Zone extends up to 8 km from central part Zone where&lt;br /&gt;protective measures like evacuation and sheltering are required against possible&lt;br /&gt;plume exposures during an Emergency.&lt;br /&gt;Secondary Zone: The secondary Zone extends up to 16 km from central plant Zone&lt;br /&gt;protective measures like sheltering control on food stuff are required against&lt;br /&gt;possible exposure from ingestion of radioactivity.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 401 -&lt;br /&gt;CLASSIFICATION OF EMERGENCIES&lt;br /&gt;Emergencies are classified on the basis of the nature and severity of the incident. The&lt;br /&gt;effect of the emergency may be restricted either to a small area of the plant or a few&lt;br /&gt;individuals or it may pose damage to the installation staff. Emergencies of more&lt;br /&gt;severe nature could result in unacceptably enhanced release of radioactive materials&lt;br /&gt;or toxic/noxious substance from the plant of resulting in hazard in the surrounding&lt;br /&gt;public domain. Accordingly the emergencies are classified into:&lt;br /&gt;1. Plant emergency&lt;br /&gt;2. Site emergency&lt;br /&gt;3. Off-site emergency&lt;br /&gt;Plant Emergency&lt;br /&gt;This type of emergency is classified in to&lt;br /&gt;a) Personal emergency&lt;br /&gt;b) Emergency Alert&lt;br /&gt;c) plant emergency&lt;br /&gt;Personal Emergency: This involves accidents or incidents in any of the plant areas,&lt;br /&gt;which call for emergency treatment of personal. The situation may result from&lt;br /&gt;high radiation exposure or significant contamination or abnormal intake of&lt;br /&gt;radioactivity by personal. The examples of personal emergencies are listed in&lt;br /&gt;Annexure-I.&lt;br /&gt;Emergency Alert/Emergency Standby: This involves abnormal conditions, which&lt;br /&gt;have a potential to proliferate in to a more serious situation but still provide time&lt;br /&gt;for pre-cautionary and constructive steps to prevent an emergency situation or&lt;br /&gt;migrate its consequences. The examples of emergency Alert are listed in&lt;br /&gt;Annexure-II.&lt;br /&gt;Plant emergency This involves excessive release of radioactive materials or high&lt;br /&gt;radiation fields in a section of the plant requiring operator action and/or automatic&lt;br /&gt;operation of the safety system. Although positive isolation or restriction on&lt;br /&gt;occupancy of the affected areas might be enforced, evacuation of personal might&lt;br /&gt;be required if it is suspected that the doses to personal or likely to exceed the&lt;br /&gt;intervention levels. The examples of plant emergency conditions or listed in&lt;br /&gt;Annexure-III.&lt;br /&gt;Site Emergency&lt;br /&gt;This class of emergency arises due to situation, which seriously affect plant&lt;br /&gt;operation involving high radiation fields in accessible areas and release of&lt;br /&gt;radioactive materials extending beyond the plant up to the site environment. The&lt;br /&gt;protective measures such as incorporation of stable Iodine, sheltering and evacuation&lt;br /&gt;of personal from plant areas other than control room to areas designated to be&lt;br /&gt;habitable under the site emergency conditions and evacuation of non-essential&lt;br /&gt;persons from the site may be considered. The examples of site-emergency condition&lt;br /&gt;are listed in Annexure –IV.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 402 -&lt;br /&gt;Off-site Emergency&lt;br /&gt;An Off site emergency situation results when the release of radioactive materials&lt;br /&gt;from the plant is of a magnitude necessitating protective action to be taken for&lt;br /&gt;members of the public in the neighborhood of the plant.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 403 -&lt;br /&gt;EMERGENCY DECLARATION AND NOTIFICATIONS:&lt;br /&gt;Declaration of Emergencies shall be made by the Duty SCE / PED based on the&lt;br /&gt;information from the plant or as per the advice from Kaiga emergency Committee&lt;br /&gt;(KGEC).&lt;br /&gt;Declaration of Emergency: Siren will be sounded as described below for declaring&lt;br /&gt;emergency. Following the Siren, there should be an announcement.&lt;br /&gt;Siren: Short intermittent siren 5 seconds on, 5 seconds off for a period of two&lt;br /&gt;minutes.&lt;br /&gt;Emergency Announcement:&lt;br /&gt;The announcement shall be made as follows;&lt;br /&gt;&quot;ATTENTION ALL PERSONNEL - THERE IS PLANT EMERGENCY&quot;&lt;br /&gt;THE INCIDENT AREA IS …………………………………….&lt;br /&gt;THE ASSEMBLY AREA IS ……………………………………&lt;br /&gt;THE EMERGENCY CONTROL CENTRE IS……………...…..&lt;br /&gt;PERSONS PRESENT AT …………… SHOULD AVOID GOING TO ………...&lt;br /&gt;This announcement shall be repeated thrice in English, Hindi and Kannada.&lt;br /&gt;Evacuation: Evacuation if necessary will be made by announcement on Public&lt;br /&gt;Address (PA) system.&lt;br /&gt;Termination of Emergency: A continuous Siren is sounded for 2 minutes. Following&lt;br /&gt;the emergency Siren, there shall be an announcement in English, Hindi and Kannada&lt;br /&gt;on public address system terminating the emergency.&lt;br /&gt;Notification Codes:&lt;br /&gt;The messages for notification of start/termination of on site and off-site emergencies&lt;br /&gt;are indicated as follows. These should be disseminated to various agencies. The&lt;br /&gt;codes for notification of commencement or termination of various types of&lt;br /&gt;emergencies are:&lt;br /&gt;a) External radiation exposure (mSv) DAC-hr (HTO) DAC-hr(I-131)&lt;br /&gt;DAC-hr (I-131) ------(≤ 1)&lt;br /&gt;(For meeting iodine thyroid dose limit of 50 mSv)&lt;br /&gt;The explanatory notes for these guidelines are given in Annexure-IX.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 404 -&lt;br /&gt;Countermeasures during a radiation emergency: Following countermeasures have&lt;br /&gt;been identified for control of exposures during a radiological emergency within the&lt;br /&gt;plant site areas and in the public domain.&lt;br /&gt;1. Sheltering&lt;br /&gt;2. Administration of Stable Iodine&lt;br /&gt;3. Evacuation.&lt;br /&gt;4. Relocation.&lt;br /&gt;5. Control of Access.&lt;br /&gt;6. Control of Food and Water&lt;br /&gt;7. Decontamination of Affected Areas and Buildings.&lt;br /&gt;DOMAIN:&lt;br /&gt;Domain 1 = 0.1 mSv/hr&lt;br /&gt;Domain 2 = 0.01 mSv/hr&lt;br /&gt;Domain 3 = less than 0.01 mSv/hr&lt;br /&gt;Stochastic and Deterministic effects.&lt;br /&gt;Stochastic effects: Stochastic effects are those for which the probability of an effect&lt;br /&gt;occurring, rather than its severity, is regarded as a function of dose, without&lt;br /&gt;threshold. Example: Cancer.&lt;br /&gt;Deterministic effects: Deterministic effects are those for which the severity of the&lt;br /&gt;effect varies with the dose, and for which a threshold may, therefore, occur.&lt;br /&gt;Examples Cataract, permanent or temporary sterility.&lt;br /&gt;Practices: Any human activity, which increases the overall exposure to radiation, is&lt;br /&gt;a &quot;Practice&quot; such as operation of nuclear power stations.&lt;br /&gt;Intervention: Any human action intended to reduce or avert exposures to sources&lt;br /&gt;which are not part of controlled practices or which are out of control as a&lt;br /&gt;consequence of an accident is &quot;Intervention&quot;.&lt;br /&gt;Objectives of Radiation Protection: Prevent deterministic effects and to limit the&lt;br /&gt;stochastic effects to levels deemed to be acceptable.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 405 -&lt;br /&gt;Principles of Radiation Protection:&lt;br /&gt;Practices:&lt;br /&gt;a. Justification: No practice shall be adopted unless its introduction produces a&lt;br /&gt;sufficient benefit to the exposed individual or to the society to offset the&lt;br /&gt;radiation harm that it might cause.&lt;br /&gt;b. Optimisation: All exposures shall be kept As Low As Reasonably Achievable&lt;br /&gt;(ALARA) economic and social factors being taken into consideration.&lt;br /&gt;c. Dose limitations: Individual exposures are limited by dose limits since the&lt;br /&gt;dose above the dose limits are unacceptable&lt;br /&gt;Intervention: The general principles of radiological protection for intervention are:&lt;br /&gt;a. The reduction in dose should be sufficient to justify the harm and the costs to&lt;br /&gt;the individual and the society due to the intervention.&lt;br /&gt;b. The benefit of the reduction in dose less the cost of intervention should be As&lt;br /&gt;Large As Reasonably Achievable.&lt;br /&gt;c. Dose limits do not apply in case of intervention. However there will be some&lt;br /&gt;projected dose levels above which intervention will be justified because of&lt;br /&gt;serious deterministic effects.&lt;br /&gt;Dose limits: Occupational Workers&lt;br /&gt;a. For stochastic effects: The dose limit for uniform irradiation of the whole body&lt;br /&gt;shall be 20 mSv (2 Rem) averaged over 5 years (January 1,1999 to December&lt;br /&gt;31,2003) and shall not exceed 30 mSv (3 Rem) in a single year.&lt;br /&gt;b. The average whole body dose for the occupational workers in the station&lt;br /&gt;should normally not exceed 5 mSv (500 Rem).&lt;br /&gt;c. For deterministic effects, the dose limit shall be 500 mSv (50 Rem) in a year&lt;br /&gt;to Bone surface, Skin and for the lens of the eye, for which the limit shall be&lt;br /&gt;150 mSv (15 Rem) in a year.&lt;br /&gt;The whole body exposure level should Remain less 10 mSv (1 Rem) in any month&lt;br /&gt;and 15 mSv (1.5 Rem) in any calendar quarter.&lt;br /&gt;In case of intakes of radioactive material into the body, the total amount of activity&lt;br /&gt;taken into the body in a calendar year shall not exceed one ALI (Annual Limit on&lt;br /&gt;Intake).&lt;br /&gt;Incase of exposure resulting from both external radiation and intake of radionuclides&lt;br /&gt;in the body it shall be ensured that the sum of effective dose resulting from all such&lt;br /&gt;exposures does not exceed the annual dose limits.&lt;br /&gt;Whole body dose Ii -- + Σ -- &lt; 1&lt;br /&gt;0.02 Sv (ALI) I&lt;br /&gt;Where Ii is the intake of the i th radio-nuclide and (ALI) i the ALI value for the i th&lt;br /&gt;radio-nuclide.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 406 -&lt;br /&gt;Planned Exposure: Situation may occur in-frequently during normal operations when&lt;br /&gt;it may be necessary to permit a few workers to receive dose in excess of the annual&lt;br /&gt;whole body dose limit. In such circumstances, Station director may permit exposure&lt;br /&gt;such that dose does not exceed 30 mSv in a single year and 20 mSv averaged over 5&lt;br /&gt;years.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 407 -&lt;br /&gt;External Exposure Control: Any external whole body exposure that exceeds 5 mSv&lt;br /&gt;(0.5 Rem) in any month is referred to as significant dose.&lt;br /&gt;Internal Exposure Control&lt;br /&gt;a. Proper ventilation of work areas and use of the recommended protective&lt;br /&gt;equipment would avoid intake of radionuclides in the body.&lt;br /&gt;b. In any case of actual or suspected high intakes HPU should be contacted for&lt;br /&gt;advice and appropriate action.&lt;br /&gt;KGS-Operating Manual on Radiation Protection Procedures&lt;br /&gt;For assessment of internal exposure due to tritium, bioassay of urine will be taken as&lt;br /&gt;the standard reference. For assessment of internal exposure by radionuclides other&lt;br /&gt;than tritium bioassay and/ or whole body counting whichever is applicable will be&lt;br /&gt;taken as standard reference. For control of intake of tritium the following procedures&lt;br /&gt;shall be l Exposure Control followed:&lt;br /&gt;Permissible Contamination levels&lt;br /&gt;Air borne Contamination the levels of air borne contamination in working areas at&lt;br /&gt;the station should be maintained below the Derived Air Concentration (DAC) values&lt;br /&gt;DAC (Bq/m3) = ALI Bq/2400 m3&lt;br /&gt;Investigation of Doses&lt;br /&gt;Investigation levels Whole body dose: Committee (SDIC) shall investigate these&lt;br /&gt;exposures&lt;br /&gt;Dose Reference Levels for Investigation&lt;br /&gt;Tissue/Organ Investigation Levels mSv (Rem)&lt;br /&gt;Monthly Quarterly Yearly&lt;br /&gt;Whole body 10 (1) 15 (1.5) 20 (2)&lt;br /&gt;Skin 100 (10) 300 (30) 500 (50)&lt;br /&gt;Lens of Eyes 30 (3) 80 (8) 150 (15)&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 408 -&lt;br /&gt;The functions of SDIC:&lt;br /&gt;a. To investigate fully the causes of the doses above the investigation levels and&lt;br /&gt;to prepare a factual report.&lt;br /&gt;b. To suggest Remedial measures to prevent recurrence of such doses.&lt;br /&gt;c. To suggest further action in respect of work to be allocated to the exposed&lt;br /&gt;person.&lt;br /&gt;d. To recommend Remedial measure and medical follow up wherever necessary.&lt;br /&gt;Exposure exceeding any of the limits stipulated below shall be regarded as&lt;br /&gt;potentially serious:&lt;br /&gt;Whole body dose: 100 mSv (10 Rem)&lt;br /&gt;Exposure to Eye Lens: 300 mSv (30 Rem)&lt;br /&gt;Such cases shall be referred to Head, Medical Group, BARC and Chairman,&lt;br /&gt;SARCOP immediately&lt;br /&gt;Head, Medical Group, BARC shall initiate appropriate medical investigation&lt;br /&gt;Medical report shall be submitted to Chairman, SARCOP, within a week. Chairman,&lt;br /&gt;SARCOP shall constitute a special committee for investigation of such exposures.&lt;br /&gt;Tritium half life: Radiological =12.3 years, Biological = 7 days, tritium effective =&lt;br /&gt;(TR *TB) / (TR +TB)&lt;br /&gt;(12.3*365*7) / (12.3+365+7) = 7 Days&lt;br /&gt;REVERSE SQUARE LAW: Dose at a rate form the point of source is inversely&lt;br /&gt;proportional to the square of the distance. I is inversely proportional to L / d square&lt;br /&gt;Technical specification Values: Fission products&lt;br /&gt;Noble gases 14.8 TBq / day, Tritium = 13TBq/day, Ar 41 = 2.04 TBq / day,&lt;br /&gt;I-131 = 185 MBq/day, Particulate = 1480 MBq / day&lt;br /&gt;Liquids: Tritium = 1.295 TBq/day&lt;br /&gt;RADIOACTIVE TRANSPORT INDEX: 1 meter from the source shield. Declaration&lt;br /&gt;of radioactive material = 70 kiloBq / kg&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 409 -&lt;br /&gt;Maintenance Performance Planning&lt;br /&gt;1. Essential sequence of maintenance Jobs execution.&lt;br /&gt;Identify maintenance jobs, asses safety, radiological precautions, plan the work,&lt;br /&gt;do the pre-job briefing, take the safety and ALARA measures, carry out the&lt;br /&gt;maintenance, test and normalise equipment or system, update records and history&lt;br /&gt;cards, review maintenance performance and devise future strategy, achieve&lt;br /&gt;excellence in maintenance through dedicated team work.&lt;br /&gt;2. Maintenance performance indicator based on equipment &amp;amp; work control&lt;br /&gt;Maintenance performance indicator (MPI) is the measure of performance of each&lt;br /&gt;aspects of maintenance. These are established as convenient measures to evaluate&lt;br /&gt;current performance levels against standard as well as an index to compare with&lt;br /&gt;past performance.&lt;br /&gt;MPI base on equipment performance (EMPI)&lt;br /&gt;a) Equivalent availability % (should be as high as possible)&lt;br /&gt;Equipment operating time x 100&lt;br /&gt;Equipment operating time + down time&lt;br /&gt;b) Mean time between failures (MBTF) should be as high as possible&lt;br /&gt;Number of operating hours&lt;br /&gt;Number of failures/breakdowns&lt;br /&gt;c) Meantime to repair (MTTR) as low as possible&lt;br /&gt;Sum of repair time&lt;br /&gt;Number of breakdowns&lt;br /&gt;d) Number of plant outage caused due to equipment failure. (Objective should&lt;br /&gt;be zero)&lt;br /&gt;e) Number of respective failures during reporting period. (as low as possible)&lt;br /&gt;f) Number of breakdowns during reporting period (As low as possible)&lt;br /&gt;3. Maintenance Performance indicator based on work control&lt;br /&gt;a. Work control indicator (WCI) should be near to unity&lt;br /&gt;No. of DR received from control room per month&lt;br /&gt;No. of PM jobs planned&lt;br /&gt;4. Maintenance performance indicator based on maintenance man hours&lt;br /&gt;1) Man hours spent on breakdown maintenance&lt;br /&gt;2) Man hours spent on PM including implementation of ECN/FCN’s etc.&lt;br /&gt;3) % man hours spent on breakdown maintenance&lt;br /&gt;Man hours spent on = Breakdown maintenance 100&lt;br /&gt;Total maintenance man hour available&lt;br /&gt;4) % of man hours spent on PM&lt;br /&gt;= Man hours spent on PM x 100&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 410 -&lt;br /&gt;Total maintenance man hour available&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 411 -&lt;br /&gt;• What is FME explaining with the examples?&lt;br /&gt;Foreign material is defined as material that is not part of a system or component as&lt;br /&gt;designed. This includes dirt, debris, broken or missing parts, slag, tools rags,&lt;br /&gt;liquids/chemicals, lapping compounds, grinding particles and any other item that&lt;br /&gt;would affect the intended operation of a system or component&lt;br /&gt;All personnel shall assume responsibility for preventing the introduction of foreign&lt;br /&gt;material into systems. This will minimize damage or harmful effects. Such as&lt;br /&gt;corrosion, fuel damage, component malfunction, or failure, changes in chemistry.&lt;br /&gt;Reduced heat transfer, increased radiation levels, changes in system flow&lt;br /&gt;characteristic and improper contact operation.&lt;br /&gt;Specific actions includes the following&lt;br /&gt;Work packages will be planned using field walk downs to determine specific FME&lt;br /&gt;recommendations&lt;br /&gt;If temporary dams are installed which will not be readily visible upon system&lt;br /&gt;closure, verification of removal shall be included in the checklist.&lt;br /&gt;• What is the importance of communications?&lt;br /&gt;Effective, open communication is essential for safe and efficient performance of&lt;br /&gt;plant maintenance. Expressing concerns describing assignments, discussing&lt;br /&gt;problems, are few aspects of maintenance of communication. Clear and&lt;br /&gt;unambiguous communication is an integral part of procedure compliance and safe&lt;br /&gt;work practice. The following additional communication practices will be followed.&lt;br /&gt;a. Repeat back is used to ensure accurate communication, especially when portable&lt;br /&gt;radios, headsets, or telephones are being used.&lt;br /&gt;b. Upon completion of a task, technicians shall report job completions to their&lt;br /&gt;supervisors and seek additional assignments.&lt;br /&gt;c. To confirm to the principle of solving problems at the lowest possible level,&lt;br /&gt;potential grievance issues are to be discussed with the first line supervisor.&lt;br /&gt;d. Plant approved terminology, equipment identification and abbreviations are to be&lt;br /&gt;used at all times.&lt;br /&gt;e. 2-way communication is required at times!&lt;br /&gt;f. Listen&lt;br /&gt;g. Understand&lt;br /&gt;h. Then reply or repeat message.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 412 -&lt;br /&gt;• Importance of self checking peer verification&lt;br /&gt;a. STAR Principle&lt;br /&gt;S- Stop pause before performing a task,&lt;br /&gt;T- Think Understand exactly what is to be done before taking any action.&lt;br /&gt;A- Act Touch the component without actuating it. Then do it.&lt;br /&gt;R- Review, verifies that the actual responses is the expected response.&lt;br /&gt;b. Self-checking is a self-verification step or action before it is performed. This&lt;br /&gt;behavior is developed through constant checking to ensure the intended action is&lt;br /&gt;correctly and positively performed on the right equipment. Consistently applied this&lt;br /&gt;will minimize error by forming a barrier against complacency and over confidence.&lt;br /&gt;All are responsible for conducting self-checking prior to manipulating a component&lt;br /&gt;or devices, or altering equipment configuration. For examples relays, positioning&lt;br /&gt;switches, breaker or valves, lifting/landing wires, connecting test equipment,&lt;br /&gt;removing or installing fuses.&lt;br /&gt;c. Any deficiency found in the field like labels, nameplate missing/tampered&lt;br /&gt;should be intimated to the supervisor.&lt;br /&gt;d. Do it right the first time.&lt;br /&gt;e. Peer verification is achieved through the use of inspection points, these include&lt;br /&gt;dual verification, independent verification, supervisory verification and quality&lt;br /&gt;verification. Peer verification leads to a broader concept of checking other.&lt;br /&gt;f. Questioning attitude should develop for continuously learning.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 413 -&lt;br /&gt;The distinction between predictive and periodic maintenance is presented below.&lt;br /&gt;a. Use predictive maintenance results to trend and monitor equipment performance&lt;br /&gt;so that needed corrective or preventive maintenance can be performed before&lt;br /&gt;equipment failure.&lt;br /&gt;b. Predictive maintenance actions are determined by the data required to monitor&lt;br /&gt;equipment condition.&lt;br /&gt;Examples are as follows:&lt;br /&gt;Vibration analysis (includes spectral analysis and bearing temperature&lt;br /&gt;monitoring) and lubrication oil and grease analysis are used to monitor rotating&lt;br /&gt;equipment.&lt;br /&gt;Infrared surveys (thermography) are performed on heat producing equipment&lt;br /&gt;such as motors, circuit breakers, batteries, load centers, bus ducts, transformers&lt;br /&gt;and insulated areas to monitor for high resistance or insulation breakdown.&lt;br /&gt;Oil analyses are performed on lubrication for rotating equipment to identify&lt;br /&gt;degrading equipment and chemical breakdown of lubricants.&lt;br /&gt;Motor operated valves are diagnostically tested and analysed. Tests determine&lt;br /&gt;parameters such as run current, valve stem thrust and torque switch and limit&lt;br /&gt;switch actuation points.&lt;br /&gt;c. Periodic maintenance is time based action taken on equipment to prevent&lt;br /&gt;breakdown and involves servicing such as lubrication, filter changes, cleaning,&lt;br /&gt;testing, adjustments, calibration and inspection. Periodic maintenance can also be&lt;br /&gt;initiated because of the results of predictive maintenance, vendor&lt;br /&gt;recommendation, or experience. Examples are as follows:&lt;br /&gt;a. Scheduled valve re-packing to avoid leakage based on previous experience.&lt;br /&gt;b. Replacement of bearings or pump realignment as indicated from vibration&lt;br /&gt;analysis and/or lubricating oil analysis&lt;br /&gt;c. Major or minor overhauls based on experience or vendor&lt;br /&gt;recommendations.&lt;br /&gt;d. Maintenance on equipment belonging to a redundant safety system if so&lt;br /&gt;allowed by the Technical Specifications&lt;br /&gt;d. Preventive Maintenance Programme Effectiveness&lt;br /&gt;Continually review the preventive maintenance programme for effectiveness, and&lt;br /&gt;change if necessary based on changes in plant design, operating conditions,&lt;br /&gt;regulatory commitments and as found conditions. In addition, unexpected&lt;br /&gt;equipment failures should result in a critical self-assessment to determine why the&lt;br /&gt;previous maintenance activities were insufficient to maintain equipment&lt;br /&gt;reliability. The primary objectives of the programme are to reduce future&lt;br /&gt;component failures, optimize preventive maintenance tasks and use of resources,&lt;br /&gt;identify programme scope and satisfy regulatory and utility concerns. Emphasize&lt;br /&gt;obtaining accurate feedback on preventive maintenance tasks. Enhancement,&lt;br /&gt;provide additional guidance on methods to determine preventive maintenance&lt;br /&gt;effectiveness.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 414 -&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 415 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the advantages and disadvantages of planned maintenance?&lt;br /&gt;Advantages of Planned Maintenance.&lt;br /&gt;1. As the name reflects maintenance jobs planned properly ie. manpower, tools,&lt;br /&gt;tackles, required for maintenance is well planned and readily available or&lt;br /&gt;reserved for planned job&lt;br /&gt;2. Procedures for doing the job in well known before doing the job and job can&lt;br /&gt;be performed as per procedure/checklist.&lt;br /&gt;3. It saves the time and unplanned outages of equipment.&lt;br /&gt;4. Common facilities/tools/tackles/ in the section in the section can be made&lt;br /&gt;available at the right time as job and requirements for that are already well&lt;br /&gt;planned.&lt;br /&gt;5. Overtime to employees can be limited.&lt;br /&gt;6. Job can be done systematically, accurately as quality job can be expected.&lt;br /&gt;Disadvantages of Unplanned maintenance.&lt;br /&gt;1. Unplanned job won’t have any expectations when to start, when to stop.&lt;br /&gt;2. Man power/tools tackles were available/not available at the right time is not&lt;br /&gt;ensured.&lt;br /&gt;3. Job may have to do in hurry which can lead to mistaken or job can be done&lt;br /&gt;leisurely (no sufficient work front for the available manpower.) so wastage of&lt;br /&gt;man machine tools etc.&lt;br /&gt;4. In NPP we cannot accept unplanned jobs, as all works are safety&lt;br /&gt;related/important.&lt;br /&gt;• What is pre-job briefing and post job briefing?&lt;br /&gt;Pre-job briefing: Unit no, DR/WP/, USI/system/load, Job description, Eqpt history,&lt;br /&gt;Scope of Job, Any special tool or equipment required, Safety/Alarm, Procedures,&lt;br /&gt;expectation for the job, tech specifications requirements, communication, FME&lt;br /&gt;requirements, environmental concepts, any abnormal conditions.&lt;br /&gt;Post job briefing: Details of work done, difficulties faced, deficiency found, parts&lt;br /&gt;replaced, experience to be communicated, review modification, review procedure,&lt;br /&gt;any suggestions, drawing updating, updating of history card, completion of&lt;br /&gt;checklist, any testing/logic checks required, clearance for surrendering permit.&lt;br /&gt;Question and answers Electrical Maintenance Unit&lt;br /&gt;- 416 -&lt;br /&gt;• What are the activities by which performance of the station will be judged?&lt;br /&gt;Activities of station by which performance is judged by public&lt;br /&gt;a. Capacity factor.&lt;br /&gt;b. Availability factor.&lt;br /&gt;c. Radiation release (gas and liquid effluents).&lt;br /&gt;d. Thermal release.&lt;br /&gt;e. Man-rem.&lt;br /&gt;f. Development programs.&lt;br /&gt;g. Public awareness.&lt;br /&gt;h. Usefulness of the plant product to the public.&lt;br /&gt;i. Employment and other facilities provided to the local public.&lt;br /&gt;j. The Basic amenities provided to the employees.&lt;br /&gt;k. The standard of living of the employees.&lt;br /&gt;l. The profit earned by the Plant.&lt;br /&gt;m. The quality and cleanliness in and around the Plant.</description><link>http://john-bose.blogspot.com/2009/05/question-and-answers-electrical_21.html</link><author>noreply@blogger.com (bose)</author><thr:total>8</thr:total></item></channel></rss>